Quarterlytics / PQ Group Holdings Inc.

PQ Group Holdings Inc.

pqg · NYSE
Claim this profile
Ticker pqg
Exchange NYSE
Sector
Industry
Employees 1001-5000
← All annual reports
FY2018 Annual Report · PQ Group Holdings Inc.
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
A N N U A L   R E P O R T   2 0 1 8

Simpler +
STRONGER 

Y
N
A
P
M
O
C

R
U
O

WE ARE AN INTEGRATED GLOBAL PROVIDER 
of specialty catalysts, materials, chemicals, and services that enable environmental 
improvements, enhance consumer products, and improve personal safety. Our value-added products seek to 
address global demand trends that are often either the subject of significant environmental and safety regulations  
or are driven by consumer preferences for environmentally friendlier alternative products. We believe these  
factors position us to drive sales in excess of the gross domestic product (GDP) growth rate and provide us with  
high margin growth opportunities. Specifically, our products and solutions help companies produce vehicles  
with improved fuel efficiency and cleaner emissions. Our materials are critical ingredients in consumer products 
that make teeth brighter and skin softer. We produce highly engineered materials that make highways and  
airports safer for road and air travelers. Because our products are predominantly inorganic and carbon-free, we 
believe we contribute to improving the sustainability of our planet.

We believe we are a leader in each of our product groups, holding what we estimate to be a number one or 
number two supply share position for products that generated more than 90% of our 2018 sales. We believe that 
our global footprint and efficient network of strategically located manufacturing facilities provide us with a strong 
competitive advantage in serving our customers both regionally as well as globally.

BY THE 
NUMBERS

~200 
years in  
business

~3,200 
employees

6  
continents

~4,000 
global  
customers

~70 
manufacturing  
facilities

COMPETITIVE 
ADVANTAGES
Unique portfolio of  
businesses

Leading positions in  
secular growth markets

Innovation potential

KEY INVESTMENT
HIGHLIGHTS

#1 and #2 positions in  
nearly all product lines

GDP+ sales growth

Input cost small as % of   
customer total product cost 

Track record of innovation

High margin environmentally 
friendly applications

Strong sustainable free  
cash flow

REFINING SERVICES
We are the leading provider of sulfuric acid recycling services to North American 
refineries for the production of alkylate, an essential gasoline component for lowering 
vapor pressure and increasing octane to meet stringent gasoline specifications and fuel 
efficiency standards. We are also a leading North American producer of virgin sulfuric 
acid for water treatment, mining, and industrial applications.

CATALYSTS 
We are a global supplier of finished silica catalysts and supports necessary to produce 
high strength and high stiffness plastics used in packaging films, bottles, containers, 
and other molded applications. We are also a leading global supplier of zeolites used 
for catalysts that remove NOx from diesel engine emissions as well as sulfur from fuels 
during the refining process.

PERFORMANCE CHEMICALS
We are a leading global supplier of silicate and derivative products which serve as 
an environmentally friendly substitute for materials used in a variety of applications. 
These include end uses such as matting agents in surface coatings, clarifying agents 
for edible oils and beverages, additives into paints and coatings for thermal insulation, 
and in cosmetics to improve feel attributes.

PERFORMANCE MATERIALS 
We are an industry leader in North America, Europe, and South America in transportation 
safety. Our products are used to delineate roads and runways with highly reflective 
markings, improving safety by enhancing visibility at night and in poor weather. Our 
microspheres also serve as functional additives in industrial applications, including 
polymers and plastics, and in abrasive applications for metal surfaces.

2018 SALES AND ZEOLYST JV SALES BY REGION AND END USE1

REGION

North America

South America

Rest of World

Asia

Europe

4% 4%

10%

61%

21%

END USE

Packaging & Engineered Plastics

Industrial & Process Chemicals 

Natural Resources 

Fuels & Emissions Controls 

Consumer Products 

Highway Safety & Construction 

20%

17%

7%

19%

21%

16%

1  Sales include proportionate 50% share of sales from Zeolyst joint venture

2018 FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

($ in millions) 

Sales 

Adjusted EBITDA 

Cash from operations  

Full Year 
2018 

1,608.2 

464.0 

248.6 

Full Year 
2017 

1,472.1 

453.3 

165.2 

%
Change

9.2%

2.4%

50.5%

Refer to page 54 of accompanying Form 10-K for reconciliations of net income to Adjusted EBITDA.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Message from President and Chief Executive Officer BELGACEM CHARIAG

“ 

Having successfully completed our foundational first year as a publicly listed company, PQ is poised to capitalize  
on great momentum and opportunity in our core markets and businesses. Our leadership team is focused, 
committed and confident in our ability to deliver on our financial and strategic growth objectives to drive value 
for our customers, shareholders, and employees.

” 

DEAR SHAREOWNER,

As this is my first letter as CEO since deciding to join 
PQ in August 2018, I would like to share with you why  
I am excited about the Company, our team and the 
growth potential to drive value for our shareholders. 
First, we have a unique portfolio of fundamentally strong 
businesses. All are of a specialty nature, highly differentiated, 
well positioned with customers as a leader in each of their 
respective key product lines and benefiting from favorable 
secular market growth trends. Second, our established 
technology platform is a key competitive advantage, with  
a nearly 200-year track record of providing innovative 
product solutions for customers. The combination  
of these factors has driven our ability to grow 
sustainably through macroeconomic cycles while 
maintaining healthy and leading profit margins.

OUR 2018 ACCOMPLISHMENTS
In our first full year as a public company since listing on 
the New York Stock Exchange in September 2017, our 
team successfully executed on our key strategic and 
financial objectives: 

Safety and Environment: We intensified our focus on 
health, safety and environment (HSE), delivering more than 
40% improvement on all HSE performance metrics, and 
confidently progressing toward our goal of being a top 
quartile HSE performer.

Customers: We reinforced our engagement with our 
customers, collaborating both locally and globally to 
enable our operational and investment plans to meet their 
demand needs, aligning both our short and long term 
future growth and success.

Financial: We delivered strong top line growth with healthy 
margins that resulted in a 50% increase in our operating 
cash flow which drove a $135 million repayment of our 
long term debt.

Our Strategy

In the fourth quarter, we launched a strategic portfolio 
assessment with a goal of developing pathways to become 
Simpler and Stronger in order to accelerate our execution 
on three key value drivers:

•  Profitable Growth
•  Capital Efficiency
•  Free Cash Flow

Since completing this evaluation, we have advanced 
implementation in two key areas: 

On the Technology Front

Our key competitive advantages and successes are 
derived from our expertise in silicates, silica, zeolites, 
glass, and catalyst technologies. Further, we have a long 

 
 
 
The realignment of our 
portfolio moves us closer  
to our goal of becoming
SIMPLER + 
STRONGER 
positioning the 
businesses with a clear 
strategy and approach  
to value creation. 

COMPETITIVE ADVANTAGES

Unique portfolio 
of businesses

Leading positions in 
secular growth markets

Innovation potential

E V O L U T I O N   P A T H W A Y S
O p p o r t u n i t y   M a n a g e m e n t

Commercial Intensity

Time Value of Technology

KEY VALUE DRIVERS

Profitable  
Growth

Capital 
Efficiency

Free Cash 
Flow

history of established partnerships with our customers in 
developing new technologies and solutions. We also have 
the ability to tailor and scale specialty grades of these 
materials to meet changing customer needs and also 
provide technical support for large scale commercialization. 

We expect that the autonomy and focus of this  
new structure will nurture a stronger culture of 
ownership and accountability and drive significant  
cost efficiencies and improved results through 
increased commercial intensity.

However, one conclusion of our strategic assessment  
was that we need to drive a cultural transformation of our 
technology platform from an autonomous R&D and 
technical support mindset to one that is more directly 
integrated with our business and strategic growth priorities 
and end uses. 

Therefore, in 2019, as we are optimizing our resource 
allocations, we are also realigning our technology structure 
and processes to drive universal methodologies and 
standardization. This should enable us to accelerate 
and increase the commercial value of our investments 
to provide a direct impact on our mid to long term 
growth profile.

On the Business Front

We have streamlined our structure by eliminating one 
management reporting layer and created four vertical 
business units: Refining Services, Catalysts, Performance 
Chemicals and Performance Materials. Each of these 
business units is unique and has different demand drivers. 
Each is well positioned to operate independently with 
direct ownership and accountability to drive improved 
performance. At the same time, we believe there is 
opportunity to leverage our best in class capabilities 
across the portfolio. These capabilities include technology, 
material science expertise, furnace engineering, and our 
global production and distribution network.

With a clear strategic and value creation mindset and 
culture, we look forward to updating you on our progress 
toward a Simpler and Stronger portfolio.

LOOKING AHEAD TO 2019
PQ is poised to capitalize on great momentum and 
opportunity in our core markets and businesses. Our 
leadership team is focused, committed and confident in 
our ability to deliver on our financial and strategic growth 
objectives to drive value for our customers, shareholders, 
and employees. 

•  We will continue driving our HSE performance    

towards a top quartile level.

•  We will continue to optimize the uniqueness of  
our businesses in order to grow their leading  
positions in respective key end markets.

•  We will continue to drive organic growth through  
technology innovation, commercial intensity  
and operational efficiencies.

•  We will strive to maintain stable, profitable  
growth and improve capital efficiency. 

Belgacem Chariag 
President and Chief Executive Officer

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549 
FORM 10-K

(Mark One)

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT 
OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018 
OR

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE 
ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from                      to                     

Commission File Number: 001-38221

PQ Group Holdings Inc.

Delaware
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)

300 Lindenwood Drive
Malvern, Pennsylvania
(Address of principal executive offices)

81-3406833
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)

19355
(Zip Code)

(610) 651-4400
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of each class

Common stock, par value $0.01 per share

Name of exchange on which registered

New York Stock Exchange

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  

    No  

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  

    No  

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange 
Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has 
been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  

    No  

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant 
to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant 
was required to submit such files).    Yes  

    No  

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§ 229.405 of this chapter) is not contained 
herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by 
reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.    Yes  

    No  

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting 
company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” 
and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer

Non-accelerated filer

Accelerated filer

Smaller reporting company
Emerging growth company

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for 
complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  

    No  

The aggregate market value of PQ Group Holdings Inc. voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates as of June 29, 
2018 (the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter) based on the closing sale price of $18.00 
per share as reported on the New York Stock Exchange was $711,130,212.

The number of shares of common stock outstanding as of February 25, 2019 was 135,705,568.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Portions of the PQ Group Holdings Inc. Proxy Statement for the 2019 Annual Meeting of Stockholders are incorporated by reference 
into Part III of this report.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC.

INDEX—FORM 10-K
December 31, 2018

Item 1.

Business

Item 1A. Risk Factors
Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments
Item 2.

Properties

Item 3.

Legal Proceedings

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures

PART I

PART II

Item 5.

Item 6.

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer 
Purchases of Equity Securities

Selected Financial Data

Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

Item 8.

Item 9.

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

Item 9B. Other Information

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Item 11. Executive Compensation

PART III

Item 12.

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related 
Stockholder Matters

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

Item 14. Principal Accounting Fees and Services

PART IV

Item 15. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
Item 16. Form 10-K Summary
Signatures

Index to Consolidated Financial Statements

Page

2

20

39

39

40

40

41

43

45

80

81

82

82

82

83

83

83

83

83

84

87
88

F-1

i

Forward-looking Statements

PART I

This Annual Report on Form 10-K (“Form 10-K”) includes statements that express our opinions, expectations, beliefs, 
plans, objectives, assumptions or projections regarding future events or future results and therefore are, or may be deemed 
to be, “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 (the “Act”).  
The following cautionary statements are being made pursuant to the provisions of the Act and with the intention of obtaining 
the  benefits  of  the  “safe  harbor”  provisions  of  the Act.  The  words  “believe,”  “may,”  “will,”  “estimate,”  “continue,” 
“anticipate,” “intend,” “expect,” “should” and similar expressions are intended to identify forward-looking statements. 
We have based these forward-looking statements largely on our current expectations and projections about future events 
and financial trends that we believe may affect our financial condition, results of operations, business strategy, short- and 
long-term business operations and objections, and financial needs. Examples of forward-looking statements include, but 
are not limited to, statements we make regarding our liquidity, including our belief that our current level of operations, 
cash and cash equivalents, cash flow from operations and borrowings under our credit facilities and other lines of credit 
will provide us adequate cash to fund the working capital, capital expenditure, debt service and other requirements for our 
business for the foreseeable future.  These forward-looking statements are subject to a number of risks, uncertainties and 
assumptions. Moreover, we operate in a very competitive and rapidly changing environment and new risks emerge from 
time to time.  It is not possible for our management to predict all risks, nor can we assess the impact of all factors on our 
business or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may cause actual results to differ materially from those 
contained in any forward-looking statements we may make.  In light of these risks, uncertainties and assumptions, the 
forward-looking events and circumstances discussed herein may not occur and actual results could differ materially and 
adversely from those anticipated or implied in the forward-looking statements. Some of the key factors that could cause 
actual results to differ from our expectations include risks related to:

• 
• 
• 
• 
• 

• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 

• 
• 
• 
• 

our exposure to local business risks and regulations in different countries; 
general economic conditions; 
exchange rate fluctuations; 
legal and regulatory compliance; 
significant developments relating to the U.S. administration, U.S. courts’ or the United Kingdom’s 
referendum on membership in the European Union;
technological or other changes in our customers’ products; 
our and our competitors’ research and development; 
fluctuations in prices of raw materials and relationships with our key suppliers; 
substantial competition; 
non-payment or non-performance by our customers; 
reliance on a small number of customers; 
potential early termination or non-renewal of customer contracts in our refining services product group; 
reductions in highway safety spending or taxes earmarked for highway safety spending;
seasonal fluctuations in demand for some of our products; 
retention of certain key personnel; 
realization of our growth projects; 
potential product liability claims; 
existing and potential future government regulation; 
the extensive environmental, health and safety regulations to which we are subject; 
disruption of production and distribution of our products; 
risk of loss beyond our available insurance coverage; 
product quality; 
successful integration of acquisitions; 
our joint venture investments; 
our failure to protect our intellectual property and infringement on the intellectual property rights of third 
parties; 
information technology risks; 
potential labor disruptions; 
litigation and other administrative and regulatory proceedings; and
our substantial indebtedness.

1

The forward-looking statements included herein are made only as of the date hereof.  You should not rely upon forward-
looking statements as predictions of future events.  Although we believe that the expectations reflected in the forward-looking 
statements  are  reasonable,  we  cannot  guarantee  that  the  future  results,  levels  of  activity,  performance  or  events  and 
circumstances reflected in the forward-looking statements will be achieved or occur.  Moreover, neither we nor any other 
person assumes responsibility for the accuracy and completeness of the forward-looking statements.  We undertake no 
obligation to update publicly any forward-looking statements for any reason after the date of this Form 10-K to conform 
these statements to actual results or to changes in our expectations.

ITEM 1.   BUSINESS.

PQ Group Holdings Inc. (“PQ Group Holdings” or the “Company”) was incorporated in Delaware on August 7, 2015. 
PQ Holdings Inc. (“PQ Holdings”), a manufacturer of specialty catalysts, materials and chemicals, was incorporated in 
Delaware  on  June  22,  2007.  Founded  in  1831,  our  business  has  a  nearly  200-year  history  of  innovation,  enabling 
environmental improvements in fuel efficiency and emissions, safer highway and airport travel, and healthier personal care 
products, while improving sustainability of our planet. On October 3, 2017, PQ Group Holdings completed its initial public 
offering (“IPO”). Our common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the stock ticker “PQG”. 

Eco Services Operations LLC (“Eco Services”), which acquired substantially all of the assets of Solvay USA Inc.’s 
sulfuric acid refining services business unit on December 1, 2014 (the “2014 Acquisition”), was incorporated in Delaware 
on July 30, 2014. On May 4, 2016, we consummated a series of transactions (the “Business Combination”) to reorganize 
and combine the businesses of PQ Holdings and Eco Services under a new holding company, PQ Group Holdings, pursuant 
to a reorganization and transaction agreement, dated August 17, 2015, as amended, by and among PQ Group Holdings, PQ 
Holdings, PQ Corporation, Eco Services, Eco Services Holdings LLC, Eco Services Group Holdings LLC and certain 
investment funds affiliated with CCMP Capital Advisors, LLC (now known as CCMP Capital Advisors, LP; “CCMP”). We 
refer to the business of PQ Holdings prior to the Business Combination as “legacy PQ” and the business of Eco Services 
prior to the Business Combination as “legacy Eco.” Unless the context otherwise indicates, the terms “PQ Group Holdings 
Inc.,” “we,”, “us,” “our,” or the “Company” mean PQ Group Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries.

Our Company

We  are  an  integrated  global  provider  of  specialty  catalysts,  materials  and  chemicals,  and  services  that  enable 
environmental improvements, enhance consumer products, and improve personal safety. Our value-added products seek to 
address global demand trends that are often either the subject of significant environmental and safety regulations or are 
driven by consumer preferences for environmentally friendlier alternative products, which we believe positions us to grow 
sales in excess of gross domestic product growth rates and provides us with high-margin growth opportunities. Specifically, 
our products and solutions help companies produce vehicles with improved fuel efficiency and cleaner emissions. Our 
materials are critical ingredients in consumer products that make teeth brighter and skin softer. We produce highly engineered 
materials that make highways and airports safer for drivers and pilots. Because our products are predominantly inorganic 
and carbon-free, we believe we contribute to improving the sustainability of our planet. 

We believe we are a leader in each of our product groups, holding what we estimate to be a number one or number 
two supply share position for products that generated more than 90% of our 2018 sales. We believe that our global footprint 
and efficient network of strategically located manufacturing facilities provide us with a strong competitive advantage in 
serving our customers both regionally as well as globally. We believe that we hold our leading supply share positions in the 
key regions that we serve. 

We believe our products deliver significant value to our customers, as demonstrated by our profit margins. Our products 
typically constitute a small portion of our customers’ overall end-product costs yet are critical to product performance. Our 
catalysts are highly technical, customized products that require customer collaboration and significant lead and qualification 
time, capital investment resources, and intellectual property to develop. As a result, we have generally maintained stable 
margins through macro economic cycles.

In 2018, we served over 4,000 customers globally across many end uses and, as of December 31, 2018, operated 71
manufacturing  facilities  which  are  strategically  located  across  six  continents.  We  are  highly  diversified  by  business, 
geography, and end use, and in 2018 the majority of our sales were for applications that have historically had relatively 
predictable, consistent demand patterns driven by consumption or frequent replacement cycles.

2

(1)   Percentage calculations include $156.7 million of total sales attributable to our Zeolyst Joint Venture (“Zeolyst JV”), 
which represents 50% of its total sales for the year ended December 31, 2018.  Refer to “Management’s Discussion 
and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Basis of Presentation” for a description of the treatment 
of our Zeolyst Joint Venture in our consolidated financial information.

(2)   Based on the delivery destination for products sold in 2018.

Our Strategy

We intend to capitalize on our strong business foundation, market-based approach, and experienced management team 
to grow sales profitably, maintain high margins, deploy capital efficiently and generate free cash flow in order to create 
shareholder value. We believe that our long history of operational excellence and proven reliability, technology leadership, 
strong customer relationships, innovation track record and consistent business execution developed from our almost two 
centuries of combined industry experience positions us well to execute on our business strategy. 

Our Industry

Our industry is characterized by constant development of new products and the need to support customers with new 
product innovation and technical services to meet their challenges, coupled with consistent product quality and a reliable 
source of supply in a safe and environmentally sustainable manner. Products sold to our customers can be a high value-add 
even when they represent only a small portion of the overall end product costs, and success can be achieved by helping 
customers improve their product performance, value, and quality. As a result, operating margins in this sector have historically 
been high and generally stable through economic cycles. In addition, many products in the specialty chemicals and materials 
industry benefit from economics that favor incumbent producers because the capital cost to expand existing capacity is 
typically significantly less than the capital cost necessary to build a new plant. The combination of attractive operating 
margins and generally predictable maintenance capital expenditure requirements can produce attractive cash flows. 

3

Our End Markets

The table below summarizes our key end use applications and products as well as the significant growth drivers in 

those applications.

2018 Sales 
and
Zeolyst JV
Total Sales(1)

2017 Sales 
and
Zeolyst JV
Total Sales(1)

2016 Pro 
Forma
Sales and
Zeolyst JV
Total Sales(1)
(2)

21%

21%

20%

Key End Uses

Fuels &
Emission
Controls

Consumer
Products

16%

16%

18%

Highway Safety
& Construction

19%

17%

16%

Packaging &
Engineered
Plastics

17%

17%

17%

Significant Growth Drivers

Key PQ Products

• Global regulatory requirements to:

• Refinery catalysts

• Remove nitrogen oxides from
emissions

• Remove sulfur from diesel and
gasoline

• Increase gasoline octane in order to
improve fuel efficiency while lowering
vapor pressure to regulated levels

• Improve lubricant characteristics to
improve fuel efficiencies

• Substitution of silicate materials for
less environmentally friendly chemical
additives in detergent and cleaning end
uses

• Emission control catalysts

• Catalyst recycling services

• Silicate for catalyst
manufacturing

• Silica gels for edible oil and
beer clarification

• Demand for improved quality and shelf
life of beverages

• Demand for improved oral hygiene and
appearance

• Precipitated silicas and zeolites
for the surface coating, dentifrice,
and dishwasher and laundry
detergent applications

• Demand for enhanced "dry and wet"
visibility of road and airport markings to
improve safety

• Drive for weight reduction in cements

• Reflective markings for
roadways and airports

• Hollow glass beads, or
microspheres, for cement
additives

• Demand for increased process
efficiency and reduction of by-products
in production chemicals

• Catalysts for high-density
polyethlene and chemicals
syntheses

• Demand for high-density polyethlene
lightweighting of automotive
components

• Enhanced properties in plastic
composites for the automotive and
electronics industries

• Antiblocks for film packaging

• Solid and hollow microspheres
for composite plastics

Industrial &
Process
Chemicals

20%

21%

21%

• Demand in the tire industry for reduced
rolling resistance

• Silicate precursors for the tire
industry

• Usage of silicate in municipal water
treatment to inhibit corrosion in aging
pipelines

• Growth in manufacturing North
America driving demand for metal
finishing

• Glass beads, or microspheres,
for metal finishing end uses

Natural
Resources

7%

8%

8%

• More environmentally friendly drilling
fluids for oil and gas production

• Silicates for drilling muds

• Recovery in global oil drilling/U.S.
copper production

• Sulfuric acid for mining

• Growing demand for lighter weight
cements in oil and natural gas wells

• Microspheres for oil well
cements

• Silicates and alum for water
treatment mining

• Bleaching aids for paper

4

(1)   Percentage calculations include $156.7 million, $143.8 million and $131.3 million of total sales attributable to our 
Zeolyst Joint Venture, which represents 50% of its total sales for each of the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017
and  2016,  respectively.  Refer  to  “Management’s  Discussion  and Analysis  of  Financial  Condition  and  Results  of 
Operations - Basis of Presentation” for a description of the treatment of our Zeolyst Joint Venture in our consolidated 
financial information.

(2)   Pro  forma  information  gives  effect  to  the  consummation  of  the  Business  Combination  and  the  related  financing 

transactions as if they occurred on January 1, 2015.

Our Competitive Strengths

Favorable Secular Growth Trends Across the Portfolio

We focus on serving end use applications where we believe significant future growth potential exists. Our products 
address our customers’ needs, which are typically driven either by regulatory regimes or consumer preferences, on a global 
basis. In addition, our product sales and development efforts are driven by regional infrastructure and development trends. 
In 2018, a majority of our sales were to end uses such as fuels and emission controls, consumer products, and highway 
safety and construction that generally do not exhibit as pronounced cyclicality as other applications. We believe that our 
products incorporate environmental and safety innovative solutions to address evolving customer demands, examples of 
which include the following:

Light- and heavy-duty diesel engines are subject to a broad set of regulatory requirements, and are expected to be 
subject to increasingly stricter standards. Countries typically adopt a set of standards that limit the amount of nitrogen 
oxides, carbon dioxide, and other emissions allowed for diesel engines. The US Environmental Protection Agency and 
European Union have led other nations in terms of standards that limit the amount of nitrogen oxides, carbon dioxide and 
other emissions for diesel engines. Current truck standards, Europe VI, have largely been in place since 2010 for North 
America and since 2014 for Europe. Other emerging regions are expected to implement similar standards over the next two 
years. Specifically, China announced that it is moving to China VI (equivalent to Euro VI) starting in 2020. India has also 
announced  a  similar  plan  starting  in  2020. We  believe  that  compliance  with  existing  regulations  as  well  as  any  future 
regulations will offer global opportunities for our zeolite catalyst product group to support our customers in meeting these 
standards through our sales of emission control catalysts.

Given stringent fuel efficiency standards that are driving the design of new engines and the resulting higher-octane 
gasoline requirements that can be achieved through alkylate blending, we believe that our refining services product group 
is well positioned to benefit from any related growth in demand for alkylates.

Increased use of plastics as a substitute for heavier and less versatile materials such as glass and metal is driving 
increased global demand for polyethylene capacity expansions and production. In particular, these expansions are shifting 
towards silica-based technology, which we believe will drive growth for our silica catalysts product group.

We believe that additional demand and higher standards for retroreflectivity (or visibility) for roadway and aviation 
markings will continue to benefit our materials product group. We benefit from increased use and density per mile of road 
markings that include our products, such as some states and municipalities instituting wider highway striping lines. Further, 
we anticipate a benefit from recent innovations, including our ThermoDrop® product, which simplifies the road striping 
operations for our customers by using a new durable thermal plastic road marking material and a new, faster-drying road 
marking system, Visilok®, which can reduce traffic disruption during striping operations and improve road worker safety 
by reducing the amount of time needed to complete the road marking process.

We also expect to benefit from trends towards the use of more environmentally friendly products where we believe 
we have opportunities to displace other less environmentally friendly materials through our Performance Chemicals group. 
Most of our products are manufactured from commonly found materials such as industrial sand and soda ash, which are 
more environmentally friendly than carbon-based products. For example, precipitated silicas are displacing carbon black 
in tires, and solid and hollow microspheres are displacing plastic volumes in lightweighting applications. We have also 
developed a family of gentle silica-based dentifrice abrasives that produce more effective cleaning toothpastes and we have 
developed  a  product  family,  Britesil  silicates,  which  improves  convenience  while  eliminating  phosphates  in  automatic 
dishwashing applications.

5

Leading Supply Positions in Key Product Groups

We believe that we maintain a leading supply position in each of our major product groups, holding what we estimate 
to be the number one or two supply share position in 2018 for products that generated more than 90% of our sales. We 
believe that our global footprint and efficient network of strategically located manufacturing facilities provides us with a 
strong competitive advantage in serving our customers both globally and regionally, and that it would be costly for our 
competitors to replicate our network. These leadership positions serve industries that are attractive due to the need for 
customized and innovative products, stability of demand, and growth potential driven by the regulatory environment and 
consumer preferences. We produce value-added products that we believe are critical to the performance characteristics of 
our customers’ products. 

In our Environmental Catalysts and Services business, we primarily compete on a global basis with the exception of 
our refining services product group, where we operate in North America and hold an estimated number one supply share 
position in the United States in sulfuric acid regeneration based on 2018 sales volume with an estimated supply share of 
greater than 50%. We are a leading supplier of refinery hydrocracking finished and support catalysts used to remove sulfur, 
and emission control catalysts used in the heavy- and light-duty diesel industries to reduce nitrogen oxide emissions. We 
are also a global supplier of silica catalysts and supports for polyethylene manufacturers and the exclusive supplier of methyl 
methacrylate (“MMA”) catalysts used in the patented Alpha process practiced by the global MMA leader. 

In our Performance Chemicals and Materials business, where we are a leading supplier in the United States, Europe 
and  Latin America,  we  largely  support  customers  with  regional  and  local  production  due  to  costs  of  shipping.  For  the 
chemicals product group, we estimate that we had approximately three times the sodium silicate supply share of our nearest 
competitor based on 2018 sales volume. 

Innovation Track Record 

Many  of  our  products  require  close  customer  collaboration  to  address  application  challenges  that  are  constantly 
evolving. As  a  result,  we  work  with  our  customers  over  many  years  in  order  to  develop  products  to  meet  customized 
specifications and performance characteristics while also maintaining strict quality standards. While we are unable to predict 
future shifts in customer demand, the long lead-time required for product development and commercialization, which can 
be up to ten years in our Environmental Catalysts and Services business, provides the opportunity for us to build long-term 
relationships with customers. 

These long-term relationships have allowed us to innovate together with our customers to meet evolving demands. 
For example, we have developed zeolite-based catalysts that are an effective and efficient method to reduce pollutants from 
heavy- and light-duty diesel engines and enable our customers to meet increasingly stringent vehicle emission standards 
worldwide. In personal care applications, we have collaborated with leading consumer products companies over a number 
of years to develop a family of gentle silica-based dentifrice abrasives that produce more effective cleaning toothpastes. In 
addition, our proprietary silica catalyst has enabled development of a high strength high-density polyethylene (“HDPE”) 
resin that is used for making lightweight plastic gasoline tanks for automobiles. While we believe we are well positioned 
to capitalize on future innovation opportunities, the constantly evolving needs of our customers make it difficult to predict 
the pace or scope of future innovation opportunities. 

Long-Term, High-Quality Customer Relationship

We collaborate with leading multinational companies that often seek global solutions. Our customers include large 
industrial companies such as BASF, Honeywell, and 3M, and global catalyst producers such as Albemarle and W.R. Grace. 
We  also  supply  catalysts  to  leading  chemical  and  petrochemical  producers  such  as  BASF,  Dow  Chemical,  Lucite, 
LyondellBasell, and Shell. We supply personal care ingredients and additives to leading consumer products companies such 
as Unilever and Colgate-Palmolive. We have long-term relationships with our top ten customers, based on 2018 sales, that 
average more than 50 years. In addition, our customer base is diversified, with our top ten customers in 2018 representing 
approximately 23% of our sales for the year ended December 31, 2018 and no customer representing more than 4% of our 
sales during this period. However, the percentage of our sales generated by our top customers may increase in the future as 
a result of changes in industry dynamics or shifts in customer demand and contracts. 

6

Pass-through of Raw Material Costs and Long Term Customer Arrangements

We have been able to mitigate the impact of raw material or energy price volatility using a variety of mechanisms, 
including hedging and raw material cost pass-through clauses in our sales contracts and other adjustment provisions. For 
the year ended December 31, 2018, approximately 40% of our Performance Chemicals sales (mostly comprised of sodium 
silicate sales) were derived from contracts that included raw material pass-through clauses. Most of our refining services 
contracts feature minimum volume protection and/or quarterly price adjustments for items such as commodity inputs, labor, 
the Chemical Engineering Plant Cost Index or natural gas. In 2018, approximately 80% of our refining services product 
group sales were sold under contracts that included some form of raw material pass-through clause. These price adjustments 
generally reflect our refining services actual cost structure in producing sulfuric acid, and tend to provide us with some 
protection against volatility in labor, fixed costs and raw material pricing. Freight expenses are generally passed through 
directly to customers. 

Our products are predominantly inorganic and carbon-free, and are produced from readily available raw materials 
such as industrial sand and soda ash, which prices have historically been less volatile than oil. We also use natural gas in 
our furnaces where our North American facilities have benefited from the plentiful supplies of shale gas. In addition, we 
have long-term supply contracts with many of our key raw materials suppliers across our product groups.

Within  our  Environmental  Catalysts  and  Services  business,  we  partner  with  customers  under  long-term  contract 
agreements,  mutually  exclusive  product  supply  arrangements  and/or  specified  products  for  certain  license  production 
processes. In our refining services product group, approximately 70% of our production capacity serves customers with 
five  to  ten  year  take  or  pay  contracts  for  our  regeneration  product  line.  Excluding  contracts  with  automatic  evergreen 
provisions, approximately 60% of our sulfuric acid volume for the year ended December 31, 2018 was under contracts 
expiring at the end of 2020 or beyond.

 In our silica catalysts product group, we supply under various term agreements ranging from 1 to 10 years for each 
of polyolefin catalysts, silica supports and support catalysts, and are a mutually exclusive supplier of methyl methacrylate 
catalyst to a leading global producer. In our zeolite catalysts product group, we operate with a mix of evergreen and various 
term contracts ranging from 1 to 3 years to supply catalysts and zeolite powders for the refining, petrochemical and chemical 
industries and nitrogen oxide control catalysts for diesel transportation industries.  Within the Performance Chemicals and 
Materials business, our performance chemical product group operates under customer supply contracts ranging from 1 to 
5 years.  Our performance materials product group typically operates under customer supply contracts that typically last 
one year. 

Stable Margins and Cash Flow Generation Across Macroeconomic Cycles 

We  have  demonstrated  the  ability  to  maintain  stable  margins  while  continuing  to  grow  our  business  in  different 
macroeconomic environments. We believe that the stability of our margins and cash flows during this period is because our 
value-added products, which are critical to the performance of our customers’ products, typically represent only a small 
portion of our customers’ overall end-product costs.

Our cash flow generation has been driven, in part, by our disciplined capital investment and tax attributes that may 
also provide cash flow benefits in the future. As of December 31, 2018, we had $284.2 million of net operating losses for 
U.S. federal income tax purposes, along with related net operating losses for state tax purposes, and $344.2 million of tax 
deductible intangibles and goodwill, both of which may provide us with additional cash tax savings in future years in which 
we generate taxable income. 

Experienced Management Team 

Our senior management team has substantial industry experience and a proven track record. Their cumulative industry 
experience extends to a broad range of execution capabilities, including acquisition integration, strategic management, 
operations, sales and marketing, and new product and application development. In 2016, our management team integrated 
legacy  Eco  into  our  Environmental  Catalysts  and  Services  business  while  also  growing  the  business  and  successfully 
implementing cost reduction initiatives. Our senior management team has also reorganized our company from a products-
based business to a markets-based business to better align our offerings with the needs of our customers. There is a renewed 
focus on serving our customers by developing solutions through technical sales, services, and product development, and 
we have added additional management personnel experienced in innovation and market driven organizations. 

7

Our Business Segments

We are an integrated, global provider of specialty catalysts, materials and chemicals, and services that share common 
end uses, manufacturing techniques, and process technology. For example, all of our product groups address challenges 
faced by global automotive companies to meet increasingly strict fuel efficiency standards. Our manufacturing platform is 
based on furnace technology and proprietary knowledge developed from almost two centuries of combined experience 
applying silicates chemistry production and the development of applications across a broadening set of end uses. All of our 
product groups produce materials through our furnace process, other than our silica catalysts and zeolite catalysts product 
groups, which are derivatives of our Performance Chemicals product group. We believe we have a differentiated capability 
around furnace operations that enables us to operate more efficiently than most of our competitors.

We conduct operations through two reporting segments: (1) Environmental Catalysts and Services, and (2) Performance 
Materials  and  Chemicals.  In  our  Environmental  Catalysts  and  Services  segment,  we  have  three  product  groups:  silica 
catalysts, zeolite catalysts, and refining services. We operate our zeolite catalyst product group through Zeolyst International 
and Zeolyst C.V. (our 50% owned joint venture with CRI Zeolites, an affiliate of Royal Dutch Shell plc. that we refer to 
collectively as our “Zeolyst Joint Venture”). In our Performance Materials and Chemicals segment, we have two product 
groups: performance materials and performance chemicals.

The table below summarizes certain information regarding our two reporting segments and our five product groups 

for the year ended December 31, 2018.

Segments and Product Groups

Sales

Year ended December 31, 2018

% of Total
Sales

Zeolyst Joint 
Venture 
Sales(1)

% of Total 
Sales and 
Zeolyst Joint 
Venture 
Sales(1)(2)

Net
Income

Adjusted 
EBITDA(1)

% of Total 
Adjusted 
EBITDA(1)(3)

(in millions, except percentages)

Environmental Catalysts &

Services

Silica Catalysts

Zeolite Catalyst

Refining Services

$

72.1

—

455.6

4.5 % $

— %

28.3 %

—

156.7

—

Subtotal

$

527.7

32.8 % $

156.7

Performance Materials &

Chemicals

Performance Chemicals

$

717.3

44.6 % $

Performance Materials

Sales Eliminations

378.3

(11.8)

23.5 %

(0.7)%

Subtotal

$

1,083.8

67.4 % $

Eliminations/Corporate

(3.3)

(0.2)%

—

—

—

—

—

4.1 %

8.9 %

25.8 %

38.7 %

40.6 %

21.4 %

(0.7)%

61.3 %

$

257.6

51.4%

$

243.4

48.6%

(37.0)

Total

$

1,608.2

100.0 % $

156.7

100.0 % $

58.3

$

464.0

100.0%

(1)   Percentage calculations include $156.7 million of total sales attributable to our Zeolyst Joint Venture, which represents 
50% of its total sales for the year ended December 31, 2018. Refer to “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of 
Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Basis of Presentation” for a description of the treatment of our Zeolyst 
Joint Venture in our consolidated financial information.

(2)   Percentage calculations exclude $3.3 million in intersegment sales eliminations.

(3)   Percentage calculations exclude $37.0 million in corporate expenses.

8

Environmental Catalysts & Services 

Our Environmental Catalysts and Services business is a leading global innovator and producer of catalysts for the 
refinery, emissions control, and petrochemical industries and is also a leading provider of catalyst recycling services to the 
North American refining industry. We believe our products are critical for our customers in these growing applications and 
impart essential functionality in chemical and refining production processes and in emission control for engines. Our catalysts 
are highly technical and customized for our customers, and can require up to ten years of development and collaboration 
with customers in order to commercialize. Catalyst specifications are constantly evolving in order to address changing 
customer demands and requirements for lower cost and improved quality. As a result, we must continuously collaborate 
with our customers to create new and more efficient pathways for the production of chemicals and fuels. 

Silica Catalysts. In our silica catalysts product group, we sell both the finished catalyst and catalyst supports, which 
are critical catalyst components for the production of HDPE, a high strength and high stiffness plastic used in packaging 
films, bottles, containers, and other molded applications. We also produce a catalyst that is used globally for the production 
of methyl methacrylate, the monomer for acrylic engineering resins, a clear scratch-resistant plastic used in sheet or molded 
form to replace glass and as a durable surface coating. Because these catalysts are highly technical and customized for our 
customers to produce resins with specific properties, they are often covered under long-term supply agreements and, in 
some cases, we are a customer’s sole source supplier. In addition, we produce silica products that are used to prevent opposite 
faces of polyolefin and polyester films from adhering to one another during manufacturing or otherwise. 

Zeolite Catalysts. Our zeolite catalysts product group is a leading global supplier of emission control catalysts as well 
as a supplier of specialty catalysts, precursors, and formulations to refineries and downstream petrochemicals and chemical 
companies. We operate this product group through our 50% share in our Zeolyst Joint Venture. These specialty zeolite-
based catalysts are sold to the emission control industry for use in diesel emission control units in both on-road and non-
road diesel engines. In addition, our zeolite catalysts product group is a leading supplier to the hydrocracking catalyst 
industry as a direct seller and supplier to other catalyst suppliers. 

Many of our zeolite powders are used in an advanced emission control technology called selective catalytic reduction. 
This process uses ammonia to react with engine exhaust gases via our catalysts in order to convert nitrogen oxides (NOx), 
a pollutant, into nitrogen and water. We believe that our zeolite catalysts can enable selective catalytic reduction technology 
to reduce the amount of nitrogen oxides in such exhaust gases by more than 90%. We believe that this technology is one of 
the most cost-effective methods to reduce diesel engine emissions. Emission control regulations have created demand for 
this technology, and we believe that future regulations will generate additional growth and development opportunities for 
this technology and, as a result, our zeolite catalysts and precursors. 

Refining Services. In 2018, we estimate that our refining services product group had a regenerated sulfuric acid supply 

share in excess of 50% in the United States, which we believe is substantially larger than our closest competitor.

Sulfuric acid is the primary catalyst used in the production of alkylates for gasoline production at refineries. Alkylate 
is a critical gasoline additive that increases octane and lowers vapor pressure. Alkylate is also a major component of premium 
gasoline which is needed in order for turbocharged engines to meet increasingly stringent fuel efficiency standards. Our 
refining  services  product  group  provides  recycling  and  end-to-end  logistics  for  refiners  who  use  sulfuric  acid  in  their 
alkylation units. These recycling units also produce virgin sulfuric acid and sodium bisulfate, which we sell into the water 
treatment, mining, and general industrial and chemicals industries.  

After sulfuric acid is used in an alkylation unit, it becomes spent acid, which is diluted with water and hydrocarbons, 
and then needs to be recycled before it can be reused. Sulfuric acid regeneration enables refineries to manage their spent 
acid and obtain fresh acid for reuse in their alkylation processes. Because storage space for fresh and spent acid is typically 
limited, and the cost to refineries of interruption to their alkylation units would be significant, refineries seek to have a 
continuous and reliable source of supply for sulfuric acid. By providing regeneration services, as well as purchasing by-
product sulfur from customers as a source of energy and for use in manufacturing virgin sulfuric acid, we believe that we 
provide our refining customers with a full solution for their sulfuric acid needs. 

Sulfuric acid is created either through the burning of sulfur in furnaces, or as a by-product of other industrial processes, 
primarily the smelting of copper and other base metals. We produce a range of high quality virgin sulfuric acid products by 
burning sulfur in our plants for supply to a diverse set of end uses. Sulfur-burned acid is generally considered to be of higher 
purity and quality than smelter-produced acid and, as a result, smelter-produced acid is not suitable for some industrial users 
including several of our larger customers who require higher quality and differentiated sulfuric acid products, such as super-
saturated sulfuric acid (oleum) and other high purity specialty acids. Virgin sulfuric acid and regenerated sulfuric acid are 

9

 
manufactured in our regeneration plants using the same production equipment and, in addition, we have one facility in 
Houston, Texas that produces only virgin sulfuric acid from sulfur. 

Competition

Our silica catalysts and zeolite catalysts products groups are leading global catalyst platforms that primarily produce 
catalysts and services for customers in the petrochemicals and refining industries. In these areas we primarily compete with 
other global producers such as W.R. Grace, BASF, UOP, and Albemarle, as well as other niche competitors such as Tosoh, 
Axens, and Haldor Topsoe, and we typically compete on the basis of performance, product consistency, reliability, and 
responsiveness to changes in customer demand.

Our  refining  services  product  group  is  highly  regionalized  due  to  shipping  costs  and  our  customer  integration 
requirements. Our network of facilities is concentrated in the major areas of growth in sulfuric acid demand in the United 
States. Approximately 60% of United States refining capacity is located in the Gulf Coast region and California and our 
plant locations in these key refining regions enables us to maintain highly efficient supply chain networks with our customers, 
including in some cases captive pipelines connecting us to our refinery customers. In addition product can be shipped by 
barge, rail and truck. We compete in the North American refining services industry with competitors such as Chemtrade 
and Veolia and we compete on the basis of price, reliability, and responsiveness to changes in customer demand, which is 
a function of scale, proximity to customer locations and operational expertise. We believe that we benefit from industry 
economics that favor incumbent producers because the capital cost to expand existing capacity is typically significantly 
less than the capital cost necessary to build a new plant and new plants can involve more challenges in obtaining the necessary 
local,  regional  and  state  permits.  In  addition,  existing  supply  chains,  including  captive  pipeline  connections  and  other 
transportation logistics add to the competitive advantages available to incumbent producers. As a result, we believe that our 
integrated and strategically located network of facilities and end-to-end logistics assets in the United States provide us with 
a significant competitive advantage and would be costly for our competitors to replicate.

Manufacturing

We  manufacture  our  zeolyst-based  catalyst  products  using  sodium  silicate  liquids  purchased  directly  from  our 
performance chemicals product group to make specialty zeolite products.  These zeolites are either used directly to produce 
catalysts or are sold as a precursor to other catalyst manufacturers. 

Catalyst Manufacturing Platform

10

We produce regenerated sulfuric acid and virgin sulfuric acid through our furnace operations. Regenerated sulfuric 
acid is produced by breaking down the spent acid in our furnace into the usable components of sulfuric acid and water. 
Virgin sulfuric acid is produced by burning sulfur and certain sulfur-rich components at high temperatures within a furnace. 
The chart below summarizes the manufacturing platform for our refining services product group. 

Refining Services Manufacturing Platform

Performance Materials & Chemicals 

Our Performance Materials and Chemicals business is a silicates and specialty materials producer with leading supply 
positions for the majority of our products sold in North America, Europe, South America, Australia and Asia, except China, 
serving diverse and growing end uses such as personal and industrial cleaning products, highway beads, fuel efficient tires 
(“green tires”), surface coatings, and food and beverage. Our products are essential additives, ingredients, and precursors 
that are critical to the performance characteristics of our customers’ products, yet typically represent only a small portion 
of our customers’ overall end-product costs. We believe that our global footprint enables us to compete more effectively on 
a global basis due to the costs associated with shipping these products over extended distances. We believe that our network 
of strategically located manufacturing facilities allows us to serve our customers at a lower cost than our competitors and 
with quicker delivery times for our products. Our products are also used in some cases as a substitute for less environmentally 
friendly materials. For example, specialty silicates are displacing phosphates in dish detergents, precipitated silicas are 
displacing  carbon  black  in  tires,  and  hollow  and  solid  microspheres  are  displacing  plastic  volumes  in  transportation 
lightweighting  applications.  Our  Performance  Materials  and  Chemicals  business  consists  of  two  product  groups: 
performance chemicals and performance materials. 

Performance Chemicals. Our performance chemicals product group includes silicate products and derivatives, which 
are used in a variety of applications such as matting agents in surface coatings, clarifying agents for edible oils and beverages, 
precursors  for  green  tires,  and  additives  for  cleaning  and  personal  care  products.  Silicates  are  a  family  of  products 
manufactured primarily from readily available materials, such as industrial sand and soda ash. These raw materials are 
typically  fused  in  a  furnace  and  then  dissolved  in  water  under  pressure  to  form  water-soluble  silicates  for  use  in  our 
downstream products, such as precipitated silica and silica gels. We sell our performance chemicals products to customers 
who use silicates as precursors, such as sodium silicates that are used in the growing precipitated silica end uses, as well as 
for downstream derivative products, such as silicas used as additives in toothpaste formulation and silica gels that are used 
as adsorbents in food and beverage manufacturing. 

Our performance chemicals product group, which is the backbone of our additives and catalyst platform, is highly 
regionalized because of the expense of shipping sodium silicates extended distances due to their water content. As a result, 
our network of regional silicate plants is strategically located to support the customers that we serve. In addition, we maintain 

11

a few larger dedicated facilities to service our derivative products. Our performance chemicals product technology requires 
significant know-how and scale in order to be able to operate in a cost effective manner. We believe that we are the only 
global silicates producer who can supply all of the major regions, excluding China, and we estimate that we have three 
times  the  sodium  silicates  supply  share  as  our  nearest  competitor  based  on  2018  sales  volume.  Key  end  uses  for  our 
performance chemicals products include catalyst precursors, food and beverage, personal care, cleaning products, coatings, 
tires, soil stabilization and paper de-inking. 

Silicates. Silicates and their family of derivatives, such as silicas, have functional attributes that are used as additives 
and  ingredients  to  enhance  product  performance  as  binders,  fillers,  flow  control  agents,  and  carriers  in  our  customers’ 
products. Our silicates are used in a diverse range of applications. In detergents and cleaning products, silicates provide 
corrosion  inhibition,  alkalinity,  emulsification,  and  deflocculation.  In  construction  materials  such  as  roofing  granules, 
cement, ceramics, adhesives, and coatings, our products are used as a binding agent. In addition, our products are ingredients 
in  consumer  products,  including  personal  care  and  consumer  cleaning  products,  where  customers  are  seeking  more 
environmentally friendly products without loss of effectiveness or performance. We believe that our products have the 
environmental  and  safety  profile  to  address  these  evolving  customer  demands.  Silicates  and  silicate  derivatives  are 
recognized on the Safer Chemicals Ingredients List of the EPA’s Safer Choice program, which we believe positively impacts 
our ability to compete in consumer product applications. 

Silicate  Derivatives.  Silica  derivatives  include  specialty  silicas,  zeolite  products,  spray  dry  silicates,  magnesium 
silicate, and other specialty chemicals. Silica derivatives are used in personal care products as a binder in pharmaceutical 
products, and as a source of alkaline in cleaning products, such as industrial cleaners. In addition, our silica derivatives are 
used in natural resources applications such as in drilling fluids as a lubricant binder. Some of our silicas and zeolites are 
used by our Environmental Catalysts and Services business to produce catalysts and catalyst precursors. We believe that 
this internal source of supply is a competitive advantage both for our performance chemicals product group, which can take 
advantage of opportunities to maximize the use of our sodium silicates production capacity and for our silica catalysts and 
zeolite catalysts product groups, which are able to access a consistent quality source of precursors. 

Silica Gels. Silica gels are used as drying agents or adsorbents and desiccants for food and industrial products. For 
example, silica gels are used in the brewing industry to remove certain compounds that cause chilled beer to look cloudy, 
and are used as clarification agents for wines and fruit juices, and as an adsorbent of free fatty acid and other contaminants 
in the refining of cooking oils. In personal care, silica gels are used as carriers for vitamins and pharmaceuticals, and as a 
flow conditioner and an oil absorption agent in face powders. In industrial and engineered plastics, silica gels are used for 
gloss control in coil, wood, general industrial, leather and other high-performance surface coatings applications. In addition, 
highly-porous specialty silica gels are used in ink-receptive coatings for inkjet media. Some recently developed silica-based 
products are designed for ultraviolet-cured coatings and other low solvent formulations that offer more environmentally 
friendly characteristics. Silica gels are also used to create coatings that have significant capacity to absorb ink in order to 
allow for quick setting of colorants and faster ink dry times, which can improve color density and reduce ink bleed. 

Precipitated Silicas. Precipitated silicas represent the largest volume of specialty silica products based on 2018 sales 
volume, but are also concentrated among a limited number of suppliers. Precipitated silica applications include filler in 
rubber for green tire applications and gel dentifrice formulations used in toothpaste as an abrasive or thickener. Precipitated 
silicas are an alternative to calcium carbonates because of their compatibility with different fluorides and their softness. In 
addition, precipitated silicas are used as functional filler in polyethylene membranes for lead-acid batteries, which are used 
in most automobiles. In agricultural end uses, precipitated silicas are used as carriers for liquid ingredients in dry animal 
feeds and as a flow aid and dispersant in insecticide formulations for crop care. We continue to collaborate with our customers 
to innovate in this industry. For example, we recently worked with certain customers to deliver enhanced products for 
whitening applications that offer improved cleaning performance with low abrasion. 

Zeolites. We produce zeolites by combining sodium silicate with aluminum trihydrate and other materials. These 
products are used as builders in detergents. We also use these products to serve newer applications such as stabilizers in the 
production of polyvinylchloride, a titanium dioxide replacement for paints and coatings, and coatings applications for food 
grade paper. 

Other Specialty Silicates. Other specialty silicates that we produce are used for a variety of industrial, personal care, 
and cleaning products. End uses include refractory, cleaning products, oil processing, hair bleach, fire retardants, water 
treatment, and adhesives. Our specialty silicate products are also used in drilling fluids for oil and gas wells to maintain 
drill hole integrity. 

12

Performance Materials. Our performance materials product group includes specialty glass products, such as highly 
engineered microspheres made from either recycled glass or fresh batch material using our proprietary furnace operations. 
We  believe  that  we  are  an  industry  leader  in  North America,  Europe,  South America,  and Asia,  excluding  China,  in 
microspheres. These products are used in the reflective markings used on roads and runways to enhance visibility at night 
and in poor weather to improve safety. Our microspheres, which can be solid or hollow, are also used as additives in plastics 
for lightweighting and in abrasive media, where they are used to clean, peen and debur metal surfaces, such as for turbine 
blades used in aerospace and power generation industries. 

In the highway safety applications, our microspheres are used with a variety of binders, such as water- and solvent-
borne paint, epoxy coatings, and thermoplastics. Our microspheres are mixed in with, and/or dropped onto, these binders 
as pavement markings are being applied. These microspheres remain partly exposed after the markings dry and provide 
retroreflectivity  that  increases  the  visibility  of  the  road  markings  at  night  and  during  inclement  weather. We  sell  these 
microspheres primarily to federal and state government agencies, municipalities, highway contractors, binder manufacturers 
and  airport  agencies.  Demand  for  our  performance  materials  products  has  grown  as  a  result  of  increased  spending  for 
maintenance and upgrading of existing roads and the construction of new roads around the world. Demand for our highway 
safety products is principally driven by replacement demand and new road construction and, as such, demand for these 
products has grown through economic cycles without exhibiting as pronounced cyclicality as other end uses. Highway 
safety budgets in the United States are typically funded by taxes on gasoline and are not typically tied to economic cycles 
or to the state and local government budgeting process. The United States federal government has taken an active role in 
implementing regulations and initiating infrastructure development in an effort to improve highway safety. In addition, the 
continuing  need  to  maintain  and  upgrade  an  aging  United  States  highway  infrastructure  has  translated  into  relatively 
consistent government expenditure in this area. The most recent innovation from our performance materials product group 
is our ThermoDrop® product, which simplifies the road striping operations for our customers by using a new durable thermal 
plastic road marking material. We have also introduced a new faster-drying road marking system, Visilok®, which can 
reduce traffic disruption during striping operations and improve road worker safety by reducing the amount of time needed 
to complete the road marking process. 

We also sell highly specialized solid and hollow microspheres and metal coated particles for a variety of uses such as 
plastic  additives,  conductive  applications,  metal  finishing,  and  other  industrial  and  consumer  applications.  For  metal 
finishing,  our  performance  materials  are  propelled  from  blasting  equipment  to  clean,  peen,  debur,  and  finish  metal  in 
industrial and process chemical end uses. Our performance material products offer the ability to design lighter parts while 
maintaining strength and reliability. Our performance materials are often a preferred substitute for other media such as 
industrial sand, aluminum oxide, iron and steel because they do not damage parts and they allow for better process control, 
limit surface contamination, and can be more environmentally friendly. 

Other applications for our microspheres include additives into paints and coatings for thermal insulation, to reduce 
weight and ingredients in cosmetics to improve feel attributes and improve flow functionality. Our microspheres are also 
used in drilling fluids to provide lubrication and strength. Within the natural resources industry, our performance materials 
are  used  in  oil-drilling  muds  to  improve  lubricity  and  reduce  friction  in  horizontal  drilling.  In  addition,  our  hollow 
microspheres are used as sensitizers for water-based industrial explosives in mining, quarrying, and construction. Sensitizers 
are also used in explosives to increase the energy of a detonation. 

Competition

In our Performance Materials and Chemicals business, we primarily compete with other global producers such as 
OxyChem, Grace and Evonik. We believe that our industry leadership position, scale, and industry presence provides us 
with a competitive advantage over competitors who compete only in particular end uses. We believe that it would be costly 
and difficult for a new entrant or existing competitor to replicate our breadth or economies of scale in the production of 
microspheres.

We believe that we are the only global silicates producer with operations in North America, Europe, South America 
and Australia, and we believe that we have technical and cost advantages in all of these regions as compared to our competitors 
as a result of the scale and breadth of our product offerings and operations. We compete primarily on a regional basis due 
to the costs associated with shipping sodium silicates, and we estimate that we had approximately three times the sodium 
silicate  supply  share  of  our  nearest  competitor  based  on  2018  sales  volume.  Our  network  of  regional  silicate  plants  is 
strategically located to support the industries that we serve. In addition, we maintain a few larger dedicated facilities to 
service our derivative products. We believe that our network of strategically located manufacturing facilities allows us to 
serve our customers at a lower cost than our competitors and with quicker delivery times for our products. In the industry 

13

served by our Performance Materials and Chemicals business, we compete primarily on the basis of performance, product 
consistency, quality, reliability, and ability to innovate in response to customer demands. Our competitors are primarily 
regional suppliers. 

Manufacturing

Performance  chemicals  are  produced  through  an  integrated  supply  chain  beginning  with  regional  and  large  scale 
upstream production of sodium silicates and downstream derivatives. Sodium silicates are produced regionally because of 
the expense of shipping sodium silicates extended distances due to their water content. Our sodium silicates are produced 
by fusing industrial sand and soda ash in our proprietary furnace operations. We dissolve the molten silicate from the furnace 
into  water  and  sell  these  products  in  liquid  form.  Downstream  derivatives  are  produced  through  a  variety  of  chemical 
operations that create aqueous, solid, and gel forms for our products. 

For the year ended December 31, 2018, approximately 40% of our North American silicate sales, which represented 
a significant portion of our performance chemicals product group sales, were derived from contracts that included raw 
material cost pass-through clauses. Under these contracts, there is usually a time lag of between three and nine months for 
cost changes to pass-through, depending on the magnitude of the change, industry dynamics and the terms of the particular 
contract. 

Performance Chemicals Manufacturing Platform

14

We produce our highway safety products and other microspheres by crushing raw materials, such as recycled glass 
or cullet, and then feeding these raw materials into a furnace. The product is coated or treated in other ways to meet particular 
customer and end use specifications. The beads are then bagged and stocked for shipment. The flowchart below outlines 
our performance materials’ production process. 

Performance Materials Manufacturing Platform

Raw Materials

We estimate that our raw materials costs represent approximately 40% of total cost of goods sold in the year ended 
December 31, 2018. Our products are predominantly inorganic and carbon-free, and are produced from readily available 
raw materials such as industrial sand and soda ash, which prices have historically been less volatile than oil. We also use 
natural gas in our furnaces where our North American facilities have benefited from the plentiful supplies of shale gas. In 
addition, we have long-term supply contracts with many of our key raw materials suppliers across our product groups. We 
have also been able to mitigate the impact of raw material or energy price volatility using a variety of mechanisms, including 
hedging and raw material cost pass-through clauses in our sales contracts and other adjustment provisions. 

We are able to negotiate our supply agreements for our key raw materials based on our leading industry position and 
global scale in an effort to achieve competitive pricing. We also maintain a raw material quality audit and qualification 
program designed to ensure that the material we purchase satisfies stringent quality requirements. Key raw materials for 
our product groups include:

Key Raw Materials

Product Group

Soda Ash

Performance Chemicals, Refining Services, Performance Materials

Sodium hydroxide ("caustic soda")

Performance Chemicals, Refining Services

Cullet

Sulfur

Industrial sand

Aluminum trihydrate

Performance Materials

Refining Services

Performance Chemicals, Performance Materials

Performance Chemicals, Refining Services

While natural gas is not a direct feedstock for any individual product, we use natural gas powered furnaces to heat 
raw materials and create the chemical reactions necessary to manufacture our products. We maintain multiple suppliers 

15

wherever possible and we seek to hedge our exposure to fluctuations in prices for natural gas through hedging activity in 
the United States, forward purchases of natural gas in the United States, Canada, and Europe, and the use of pass-through 
clauses for raw material and natural gas costs in our customer contracts. However, we may not be successful in passing 
through all increases in raw material costs or maintaining an uninterrupted supply of natural gas for all of our furnaces. See 
“Risk Factors-Risks Related to Our Business - If we are unable to pass on increases in raw material prices, including natural 
gas, to our customers or to retain or replace our key suppliers, our results of operations and cash flows may be negatively 
affected”.

Joint Ventures 

We have entered into several long-standing joint ventures to supplement our businesses and access other geographic 
locations,  minimize  costs  and  accelerate  growth  in  areas  we  believe  have  significant  business  potential,  with  the  most 
significant of these joint ventures including the following: 

Zeolyst Joint Venture. Our Zeolyst Joint Venture is a long-standing partnership with CRI Zeolites Inc., which is an 
affiliate of Royal Dutch Shell, that dates back to 1988 and is focused on the development, manufacture and sale of zeolite-
containing catalysts through manufacturing facilities located in Kansas and the Netherlands. We combine our expertise in 
zeolite supply and technology with our partner’s expertise in global refinery catalyst sales and technology. We have a 50% 
ownership stake in our Zeolyst Joint Venture. We supply sodium silicates from our performance chemicals product group 
to the Zeolyst Joint Venture to make specialty zeolites, which are used as precursors in emission control and custom catalysts. 
We also produce specialty zeolites that are precursors for the production of hydrocracking catalysts and other refinery and 
petrochemical catalysts that are used by our other product groups and sold to third parties. We manage the production of 
these specialty zeolites due to our expertise in zeolite production. These catalysts include aromatic catalysts that upgrade 
aromatic by-product streams, dewaxing catalysts that improve lube oil performance and diesel cold flow performance, and 
paraffin  isomerization  catalysts  that  upgrade  olefins  to  high  octane  gasoline  blending  components  for  refinery  and 
petrochemical customers.

PQ Holdings Mexicana S.A. de C.V. PQ Holdings Mexicana was established in 2000 as a joint venture with Solvay 
Alkalis, Inc. for the manufacture, marketing and sale of various chemicals, including sodium silicate, through manufacturing 
facilities in Tlalnepantla and Guadalajara, Mexico. We have an 80% ownership stake in PQ Holdings Mexicana. 

Research and Development 

We benefit from the highly-skilled technical capabilities of our employees dedicated to new product development. 
We operate six research and development facilities in the United States, Canada, the United Kingdom, the Netherlands, 
France and Spain. Our research and development activities are directed toward the development of new and improved 
products, processes, systems and applications for customers. Our research and development team is organized to support 
each  of  our  operating  businesses  and  staffed  with  experienced  scientists,  technical  service  representatives  and  process 
engineers with direct knowledge of our products. This business group and customer-oriented team structure provides strong 
links between our product development and manufacturing functions and our customer collaboration and specifications. 
These connections enable us to focus our development on timely and relevant products for our customers while remaining 
attentive to manufacturing considerations to enable us to produce new products profitably and in a timely manner. Product 
development activities are organized into research and development projects that are subject to regular reviews by the 
business teams in order to understand and address our customers’ evolving needs and invest in our growth by prioritizing 
innovation driven by these identified needs. In addition, we hold senior-level project reviews to ensure best practices are 
shared and consistent metrics are used to determine a project’s merit and the size of the potential opportunity. 

Intellectual Property 

We evaluate on a case-by-case basis how best to use patents, trademarks, copyrights, trade secrets and other available 
intellectual property protections in order to protect our products and our critical investments in research and development, 
manufacturing and marketing. We focus on securing and maintaining patents for certain inventions such as composition-
of-matter, while maintaining other inventions such as process improvements as trade secrets, derived from our market-
based business model, in an effort to maximize the value of our product portfolio and manufacturing capabilities and reinforce 
our competitive advantage. Our policy is to seek appropriate intellectual property protection for significant product and 
process developments in the major areas where the relevant products are manufactured or sold. Patents may cover products, 
processes, intermediate products and product uses. Patents extend for varying periods in accordance with the date of patent 
application filing and the legal life of patents in the various countries in which the patents are registered. The protection 

16

afforded, which may also vary from country to country, depends upon the type of subject matter covered by the patent and 
the scope of the claims of the patent. 

In most industrial countries, patent protection may be available for new substances and formulations, as well as for 
unique applications and production processes. However, given the geographical scope of our business and our continued 
growth strategy, there are regions of the world in which we do business or may do business in the future where intellectual 
property  protection  may  be  limited  and  difficult  to  enforce.  Moreover,  we  monitor  our  competitors’  products  and,  if 
circumstances were to dictate that we do so, we would vigorously challenge the actions of others that conflict with our 
patents,  trademarks  and  other  intellectual  property  rights.  We  maintain  appropriate  information  security  policies  and 
procedures reasonably designed to ensure the safeguarding of confidential information including, where appropriate, data 
encryption, access controls and employee awareness training. 

We own or have rights to a number of patents relating to our products and processes. As of December 31, 2018, we 
owned 52 patented inventions in the United States, with approximately 309 patents issued in countries around the world 
and  approximately  120  patent  applications  pending  worldwide  covering  more  than  20  additional  inventions.  As  of 
December 31,  2018,  we  also  had  trademark  rights  in  approximately  613  trademark  registrations  worldwide,  including 
approximately 77 U.S. trademark registrations. We also have approximately 37 pending trademark applications, which 
include applications in the United States and worldwide. In addition to our registered and applied-for intellectual property 
portfolio, we also claim ownership of certain trade secrets and proprietary know-how developed by and used in our business. 
Including our joint ventures, we are party to certain arrangements whereby we license in the right to use certain intellectual 
property rights in connection with our business. 

Seasonality

Seasonal changes and weather conditions typically affect our performance materials and refining services product 
groups. In particular, our performance materials product group generally experiences lower sales and profit in the first and 
fourth quarters of the year because highway striping projects typically occur during warmer weather months. Additionally,
our refining services product group typically experiences similar seasonal fluctuations as a result of higher demand for 
gasoline products in the summer months. As a result, our working capital requirements tend to be higher in the first and 
fourth quarters of the year, which can adversely affect our liquidity and cash flows. Because of this seasonality associated 
with certain of our product groups, results for any one quarter are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be 
achieved for any other quarter or for the full year. 

Employees 

As of December 31, 2018, we had 3,188 employees worldwide, of which 1,455 were employed in the United States, 
503 were employed in Canada, Mexico, Brazil and Argentina, 888 were employed throughout Europe, 38 were employed 
in South Africa and 99 were employed in Indonesia. Our remaining employees are dispersed throughout Asia and Australia, 
primarily in Australia, China, Thailand and Japan. As of December 31, 2018, approximately 50% of our employees were 
represented by a union, works council or other employee representative body. We believe we have good relationships with 
our employees and their respective works councils, unions or other bargaining representatives. There have been no labor 
strikes or work stoppages in these locations in recent history. 

Environmental Regulations 

Obtaining, producing and distributing many of our products involve the use, storage, transportation and disposal of 
toxic  and  hazardous  materials. We  are  subject  to  extensive,  evolving  and  increasingly  stringent  national  and  local 
environmental laws and regulations, which address, among other things, the following: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

emissions to the air; 

discharges to soils and surface and subsurface waters; 

other releases into the environment; 

prevention, remediation or abatement of releases of hazardous materials into the indoor or outdoor environment; 

generation, handling, storage, transportation, treatment and disposal of waste materials; 

maintenance of safe conditions in the workplace; 

17

• 

• 

• 

registration and evaluation of chemicals; 

production, handling, labeling or use of chemicals used or produced by us; and 

stewardship of products after manufacture. 

We  apply  the  principles  of  the  Environmental  Management  standard  of  the  International  Organization  for 
Standardization (ISO 14001) at our facilities throughout the world. For chemical facilities in the United States, we also 
adhere to the Responsible Care RC14001 Technical Specifications of the American Chemistry Council. 

We maintain policies and procedures to monitor and control environmental, health and safety risks, and to monitor 
compliance with applicable state, national, and international environmental, health and safety requirements. We have a 
strong environmental, health and safety organization. We have a staff of professionals who are responsible for environmental 
health, safety and product regulatory compliance. We have implemented a corporate audit program for all of our facilities. 
However, we cannot provide assurance that we will at all times be in full compliance with all applicable environmental 
laws and regulations. We expect that stringent environmental regulations will continue to be imposed on us and our industry 
in general. Evolving chemical regulation programs throughout the world could impose testing requirements or restrictions 
on our chemical raw materials and products. These programs include the 2016 amendments to the U.S. Toxic Substances 
Control Act, under which the EPA will prioritize and evaluate chemicals for regulation, the E.U. REACH regulations, which 
have ongoing registration and evaluation requirements with associated testing costs and potential restrictions, the Korea 
REACH law, which is requiring registration and potentially testing of chemicals, and similar programs being developed in 
Taiwan, Turkey, India, and elsewhere. Based on our chemicals and the various regulations promulgated to date, we do not 
anticipate costly testing requirements or severe restrictions, but cannot guarantee that we will not be subject to requirements 
for our products or raw materials that could materially affect our operations. 

Environmental Remediation. Environmental laws and regulations require mitigation or remediation of the effects of 
the disposal or release of chemical substances. Under some of these regulations, as the current or former owner or operator 
of a property, we could be held liable for the costs of removal or remediation of hazardous substances on or under the 
property, without regard to whether we knew of or caused the contamination, and regardless of whether the practices that 
resulted in the contamination were permitted at the time they occurred. Many of our current or former production sites have 
an extended history of industrial use, and it is impossible to predict precisely what effect these laws and regulations will 
have on us in the future. Soil and groundwater contamination requiring investigation and remediation has been discovered 
at some of the sites, and might occur or be discovered at other sites. Several active and former facilities currently are 
undergoing investigation and remediation, including sites in Rahway, NJ; Dominguez, CA; Martinez, CA; and Tacoma, 
WA. 

Environmental  Programs.  We  have  comprehensive  environmental,  health  and  safety  compliance,  auditing  and 
management programs in place to assist in our compliance with applicable regulatory requirements and with internal policies 
and procedures, as appropriate. Each facility has developed and implemented specific critical occupational health, safety, 
environmental, security and loss control programs. 

We  also  have  implemented  a  Health,  Safety  and  Environmental  (“HSE”)  organizational  structure  with  executive 
committee level leadership and dedicated environmental experts. We have Regional HSE Specialists and Managers who 
are embedded in the field and provide HSE expertise and support to operating sites. Certain, larger sites may have dedicated 
environmental or safety personnel. We have an established Product Safety/Stewardship management system compliant with 
the RC14001 technical specification along with two Product Stewardship Managers, one of which is a REACH Specialist. 
We conduct Product Stewardship reviews as part of new product development and routinely evaluate product safety risk 
for raw materials, intermediates and products. 

Chemical Product Regulation 

As a chemical company, we are subject to extensive and evolving regulations regarding the manufacture, processing, 
distribution, import, export, and labeling of our products and their raw materials. In the European Union, the REACH 
regulations initially went into effect in 2007, with implementation rolling out over time. REACH requires the registration 
of chemicals, along with a dossier of toxicological and ecotoxicity test results, or a plan to conduct such tests if they are 
currently unavailable. Registered chemicals then can be subject to further evaluation and potential restrictions. Our high-
volume chemicals have been registered under REACH; up to 15 lower-volume chemicals (mainly catalysts) will be registered 
by the applicable 2018 deadline. To date, no testing has been required. A couple of our chemicals are being reviewed under 
REACH. Since the promulgation of REACH, other countries (e.g., China, Korea, Taiwan) have enacted and are in the 

18

 
process of implementing similar comprehensive regulation of chemicals. In the United States, legislation has been enacted 
that would require the EPA to review and require testing of certain chemicals. Based on our chemicals and the various 
regulations promulgated to date, we do not anticipate costly testing requirements or severe restrictions, but cannot guarantee 
that we will not be subject to requirements for our products or raw materials that could materially affect our operations. In 
particular, some of our products might be characterized as nanomaterials and then subjected to evolving, new nanomaterial 
regulations. 

Available Information 

Our website address is www.pqcorp.com. We make available free of charge through our website our Annual Report 
on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or 
furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (“Exchange Act”), as 
well as reports on Forms 3, 4 and 5 filed pursuant to Section 16 of the Exchange Act, as soon as reasonably practicable after 
such documents are electronically filed with, or furnished to, the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”).  The SEC 
maintains  an  internet  website,  http://www.sec.gov,  that  contains  reports,  proxy  and  information  statements,  and  other 
information regarding our Company and other issuers that file electronically with the SEC. The information on our website 
is not, and shall not be deemed to be, a part of this report or incorporated into any other filings we make with the SEC.  

Our  Corporate  Governance  Guidelines,  Code  of  Business  Conduct  and  the  charters  of  the  Audit  Committee, 
Compensation  Committee,  Nominating  and  Corporate  Governance  Committee  and  Health,  Safety  and  Environment 
Committee of our Board of Directors are also available on our website and are available in print to any shareholder upon 
request by writing to PQ Investor Relations, 300 Lindenwood Drive, Malvern, PA 19355. In accordance with SEC rules, 
we intend to disclose any amendment (other than any technical, administrative or other non-substantive) to the Code of 
Business Conduct, or any waiver of any provision thereof with respect to any of our executive officers, on our website 
within four business days following such amendment or waiver.

19

ITEM 1A.   RISK FACTORS. 

In addition to the other information contained in this Form 10-K, you should carefully consider the following risks 
that we believe are the material risks that we face. The risks described below could have a material adverse impact on our 
business, financial condition, cash flows and results of operations, and should be read together and in conjunction with the 
forward-looking statements and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” 
included in Item 7 of this Form 10-K, and our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto.

Risks Related to Our Business 

As a global business, we are exposed to local business risks in different countries, which could have a material 

adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. 

We have significant operations in many countries, including manufacturing sites, research and development facilities, 
sales personnel and customer support operations. As of December 31, 2018, we operated 71 manufacturing facilities across 
six continents. For the year ended December 31, 2018, our foreign subsidiaries accounted for 40% of our sales. Our operations 
are affected directly and indirectly by global regulatory, economic and political conditions, including: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

new and different legal and regulatory requirements in local jurisdictions; 

export duties or import quotas; 

domestic and foreign customs and tariffs or other trade barriers, including the threat of escalating trade disputes 
that may result in higher tariffs; 

potential difficulties in staffing and labor disputes; 

potential difficulties in managing and obtaining support and distribution for local operations; 

increased costs of, and availability of, raw materials, energy, transportation or shipping; 

credit risk and financial condition of local customers and distributors; 

potential difficulties in protecting intellectual property rights; 

risk of nationalization of private enterprises by foreign governments; 

potential imposition of restrictions on investments; 

the imposition of withholding taxes or other taxes or royalties on our income, or the adoption of other restrictions 
on foreign trade or investment, including currency exchange controls; 

capital controls; 

potential difficulties in obtaining and enforcing legal judgments in jurisdictions outside the United States; 

potential difficulties in obtaining and enforcing relief in the United States against parties located outside the 
United States; 

potential difficulties in enforcing agreements and collecting receivables; 

risks relating to environmental, health and safety matters; and 

local political, economic and social conditions, including the possibility of hyperinflationary conditions and 
political instability in certain countries. 

We may not be successful in developing and implementing policies and strategies to address the foregoing factors in 
a timely and effective manner at each location where we do business. Consequently, the occurrence of one or more of the 
foregoing factors could have a material adverse effect on our international operations or upon our financial condition, results 
of operations and cash flows. 

20

 
We are affected by general economic conditions and an economic downturn could adversely affect our operations 

and financial results. 

We sell performance chemicals, performance materials, catalysts and services that are used in manufacturing processes 
and  as  components  of,  or  ingredients  in,  other  products  and,  as  a  result,  our  sales  are  correlated  with  and  affected  by 
fluctuations in the level of industrial production and manufacturing output and by fluctuations in general economic activity. 
Producers of performance chemicals, in particular, are likely to reduce their output in periods of significant contraction in 
industrial and consumer demand, while demand for the products we manufacture often depends on trends in demand in the 
end uses our customers serve. General economic conditions and macroeconomic trends, including economic recessions and 
inflation, could affect overall demand for our products and any overall decline in such demand could significantly reduce 
our sales and profitability. In addition, volatility and disruption in financial markets could adversely affect our sales and 
results of operations by limiting our customers’ ability to obtain the financing necessary to maintain or expand their own 
operations. 

Exchange rate fluctuations could adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. 

As a result of our international operations, for the year ended December 31, 2018, we generated 40% of our sales and 
incurred a significant portion of our expenses in currencies other than U.S. dollars. We incur currency transaction risk 
whenever we enter into either a purchase or sale transaction using a currency other than the local currency of the transacting 
entity. The main currencies to which we are exposed, besides the U.S. dollar, are the Euro, British pound, Canadian dollar, 
Mexican peso and the Brazilian real. The exchange rates between these currencies and the U.S. dollar have fluctuated 
significantly in recent years and may continue to do so in the future. In many cases, we sell exclusively in those jurisdictions 
and do not have the ability to mitigate our exposure to currency fluctuations through our operations. Accordingly, to the 
extent that we are unable to match sales made in such foreign currencies with costs paid in the same currency, exchange 
rate fluctuations could adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. In the past, we have 
experienced economic loss and a negative impact on earnings as a result of foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations and 
any future fluctuations may have similar or greater impacts. We expect that the amount of our sales denominated in non-
U.S. dollar currencies may increase in future periods. Given the volatility of exchange rates, there can be no assurance that 
we will be able to effectively manage our currency transaction risks or that any volatility in currency exchange rates will 
not have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations. See “Management’s Discussion and 
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk.” 

Additionally, because our consolidated financial results are reported in U.S dollars, the translation of sales or earnings 
generated in other currencies into U.S. dollars can result in a significant increase or decrease in the amount of those sales 
or earnings in our financial statements, which also affects the comparability of our results of operations and cash flows 
between financial periods. 

Our  international  operations  require  us  to  comply  with  anti-corruption  laws,  trade  and  export  controls  and 

regulations of the U.S. government and various international jurisdictions in which we do business. 

Doing business on a worldwide basis requires us and our subsidiaries to comply with the laws and regulations of the 
U.S.  government  and  various  international  jurisdictions,  and  our  failure  to  successfully  comply  with  these  laws  and 
regulations may restrict our operations, trade practices, investment decisions and partnering activities and may expose us 
to liabilities. Such laws and regulations apply to companies, individual directors, officers, employees and agents. 

In particular, our international operations are subject to U.S. and foreign anti-corruption laws and regulations, such 
as the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act (“FCPA”) and the U.K. Bribery Act (“UKBA”). The FCPA prohibits us from providing 
anything of value to foreign officials for the purposes of influencing official decisions or obtaining or retaining business or 
otherwise  obtaining  favorable  treatment,  and  requires  us  to  maintain  adequate  record-keeping  and  internal  accounting 
practices to accurately reflect our transactions. As part of our business, we may deal with state-owned business enterprises, 
the employees and representatives of which may be considered foreign officials for purposes of the FCPA and UKBA. In 
addition, some of the international locations in which we operate lack a developed legal system and have elevated levels 
of corruption. As a result of our international operations, we are exposed to the risk of violating anti-corruption laws. 

In addition, we are subject to applicable export controls and economic sanctions laws and regulations imposed by the 
U.S. government and other countries. Changes in such laws and regulations may restrict our business practices, including 
cessation of business activities in sanctioned countries or regions or with sanctioned entities or individuals, and may result 
in  modifications  to  compliance  programs. Violations  of  these  legal  requirements  are  punishable  by  criminal  fines  and 

21

imprisonment, civil penalties, disgorgement of profits, injunctions, debarment from government contracts, loss of export 
privileges and other remedial measures. 

We have established policies and procedures designed to assist us and our personnel in complying with applicable 
U.S. and international laws and regulations. These policies and procedures are codified in our Code of Conduct and other 
various policies. However, there can be no assurance that our policies and procedures will effectively prevent us from 
violating these laws and regulations in every transaction in which we may engage, and such a violation could subject us to 
governmental investigations and adversely affect our reputation, business, financial condition and results of operations. 

Significant developments stemming from the U.S. administration, U.S. courts’ or the United Kingdom’s referendum 

on membership in the European Union could have an adverse effect on us.

The U.S. administration has called for substantial changes to trade agreements, such as the North American Free Trade 
Agreement (“NAFTA”), and has raised the possibility of imposing significant increases on tariffs on goods imported into 
the United States, particularly from China and Mexico. For example, throughout 2018, the U.S. administration and China 
have been levying taxes on their respective imports. These changes, as well as any other changes in U.S. social, political, 
regulatory and economic conditions or laws and policies governing foreign trade, manufacturing and development and 
investment in the territories and countries where we or our customers operate could adversely affect our operating results 
and our business.

Additionally, in June 2016, the United Kingdom held a referendum and voted in favor of leaving the European Union 
and in March 2017, the government of the United Kingdom formally initiated the withdrawal process. This referendum has 
created political and economic uncertainty, particularly in the United Kingdom and the European Union, and this uncertainty 
may last for years. Our business could be affected during this period of uncertainty, and perhaps longer, by the impact of 
the United Kingdom’s referendum. In addition, our business could be negatively affected by new trade agreements between 
the United Kingdom and other countries, including the United States, and by the possible imposition of trade or other 
regulatory barriers in the United Kingdom. These possible negative impacts, and others resulting from the United Kingdom’s 
actual or threatened withdrawal from the European Union, may adversely affect our customers’ businesses and our operating 
results.

Alternative technology or other changes in our customers’ products may reduce or eliminate the need for certain 

of our products. 

Many of the products that we sell are used in manufacturing processes and as components of or ingredients in other 
products and, as a result, changes in our customers’ end products or processes or alternative technology may enable our 
customers to reduce or eliminate consumption or use of our products. For example, the ongoing shift in customer preferences 
in the detergent industry from powders to liquid has resulted in lower demand for zeolites. Additionally, shifting consumer 
preference could result in a significant reduction in the future use of fossil fuels, which would have a negative impact on 
our zeolite catalysts and refining services. If we are unable to respond appropriately to such new developments, such changes 
could seriously impair our ability to profitably market certain of our products. 

Our new product development and research and development efforts may not succeed and our competitors may 

develop more effective or successful products. 

The industries in which we operate are subject to periodic technological changes and ongoing product improvements. 
In order to maintain our margins and remain competitive, we must successfully develop, manufacture and market new or 
improved products. As a result, we must commit substantial resources each year to new product research and development. 
Ongoing investments in new product research and development could result in higher costs without a proportional increase 
in revenues. Additionally, for any new product program, there is a risk of technical or market failure, in which case we may 
need to commit additional resources to the program and may not be able to develop the new products needed to maintain 
our competitive position. Moreover, new products may have lower margins than the products they replace or may not 
successfully attract end users. 

We also expect competition to increase as our competitors develop and introduce new and enhanced products. As such 
products are introduced, our products may become obsolete or our competitors’ products may be marketed more effectively. 
If we fail to develop new products, maintain or improve our margins with our new products or keep pace with technological 
developments, our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows will suffer. 

22

Our substantial level of indebtedness could adversely affect our financial condition. 

We have substantial indebtedness, which, as of December 31, 2018, totaled approximately $2,148.4 million. Our 
substantial indebtedness, combined with our other financial obligations and contractual commitments, could have important 
consequences, including: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

requiring us to dedicate a substantial portion of our cash flows from operations to payments on our indebtedness, 
thereby reducing funds available for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions, selling and marketing 
efforts, product development and other purposes; 

increasing our vulnerability to adverse economic and industry conditions, which could place us at a competitive 
disadvantage compared to our competitors that have relatively less indebtedness; 

limiting our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industries in which we 
operate; 

increasing our exposure to rising interest rates because certain of our borrowings are at variable interest rates; 

restricting us from making investments, strategic acquisitions or causing us to make non-strategic divestitures; 
and 

limiting our ability to borrow additional funds, or to dispose of assets to raise funds, if needed, for working 
capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions, product development and other corporate purposes. 

Although the terms of the agreements governing our outstanding indebtedness contain restrictions on the incurrence 
of additional indebtedness, such restrictions are subject to a number of important exceptions and indebtedness incurred in 
compliance with such restrictions could be substantial. If we and our restricted subsidiaries incur significant additional 
indebtedness, the related risks that we face could increase. 

If we are unable to pass on increases in raw material prices, including natural gas, to our customers or to retain 

or replace our key suppliers, our results of operations and cash flows may be negatively affected. 

We purchase significant amounts of raw materials, including soda ash, cullet, industrial sand, aluminum trihydrate, 
sodium hydroxide (commonly known as caustic soda) and sulfur (including hydrogen sulfite), in our performance chemicals, 
performance materials and refining services product groups, and we purchase significant amounts of natural gas to supply 
the energy required in our production process. The cost of these raw materials represents a substantial portion of our operating 
expenses and our results of operations have been, and could in the future be, significantly affected by increases in the costs 
of such raw materials. In addition, we obtain a significant portion of our raw materials from certain key suppliers. If any of 
those suppliers is unable to meet its obligations under current supply agreements, we may be forced to pay higher prices to 
obtain the necessary raw materials. Furthermore, if any of the raw materials that we use become unavailable within the 
geographic area from which we currently source them, we may not be able to obtain suitable and cost-effective substitutes. 
Any interruption of supply or any price increase of raw materials could adversely affect our profitability. 

While we attempt to match raw material price increases with corresponding product price increases, our ability to 
pass  on  increases  in  the  cost  of  raw  materials  to  our  customers  is,  to  a  large  extent,  dependent  upon  our  contractual 
arrangements and market conditions.  There may be periods of time during which we are not able to recover increases in 
the cost of raw materials due to our contractual arrangements or weakness in demand for, or oversupply of, our products. 
Specifically, timing differences between price adjustments of raw materials, which may occur daily, and adjustments to our 
product prices, which in many cases are adjusted quarterly or less often, have had and may continue to have a negative 
effect on our profitability. Even in periods during which raw material prices decline, we may suffer decreasing profits if 
customers seek relief in the form of lower sales prices or if the raw material price reductions occur at a slower rate than 
decreases  in  the  selling  prices  of  our  products.  Furthermore,  some  of  our  performance  chemicals  customers  may  take 
advantage of fluctuating prices by building inventories when they expect product prices to increase and reducing inventories 
when they expect product prices to decrease. Such volatility can result in commercial disputes with customers and suppliers 
with  respect  to  interpretations  of  complex  contractual  arrangements,  the  adverse  resolution  of  which  could  reduce  our 
profitability. 

In the past, we have entered into long-term supply contracts for certain of our raw materials, including for certain of 
our North American soda ash purchases. As these contracts expire, we may not be able to renegotiate or enter into new long-
term supply contracts that will offer similar protection from price increases and other fluctuations on terms that are satisfactory 
to us or at all. 

23

In addition, we have attempted to mitigate our exposure to the significant price volatility of natural gas by implementing 
a hedging program in the United States and entering into forward purchases in the United States, Canada, Europe and other 
parts of the world. Our hedging strategy may not be successful and if energy prices rise, our profitability could be adversely 
affected. With the exception of such natural gas contracts, we typically do not enter into long-term forward contracts to 
hedge against raw material price volatility. 

We face substantial competition in the industries in which we operate. 

The industries in which we operate are highly competitive and we face significant competition from large international 
producers and, particularly in Europe and certain Asia-Pacific regions, smaller regional competitors. Our silica catalysts 
and zeolite catalysts primarily compete with other global producers in the petrochemicals and refining industries such as 
W.R. Grace, BASF, UOP, and Albemarle, as well as other niche competitors such as Tosoh, Axens, and Haldor Topsoe. We 
compete in the North American refining services industry with competitors such as Chemtrade and Veolia. Additionally, 
our Performance Materials and Chemicals business primarily competes with other global producers such as OxyChem, PPG 
and Evonik. We believe that we typically compete on the basis of performance, product consistency, quality, reliability, and 
ability to innovate in response to customer demands. 

Our competitors may improve their competitive position in our core end use applications by successfully introducing 
new products, improving their manufacturing processes, expanding their capacity or manufacturing facilities or responding 
more effectively than us to new or emerging technologies and changes in customer requirements. Some of our competitors 
may be able to lower prices for products that compete with our products if their costs are lower. In addition, consolidation 
among our competitors or customers may result in reduced demand for our products or make it more difficult for us to 
compete. Some of our competitors’ financial, technological and other resources may be greater than ours or they may have 
less debt than we do and, as a result, may be better able to withstand changes to industry conditions. The occurrence of any 
of these events could materially adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. 

We are subject to the risk of loss resulting from non-payment or non-performance by our customers. 

Our credit procedures and policies may not be adequate to minimize or mitigate customer credit risk. Our customers 
may experience financial difficulties, including bankruptcies, restructurings and liquidations. These and other financial 
problems our customers may experience, as well as potential financial weakness in the industries in which we operate, may 
increase our risk in extending trade credit to customers. A significant adverse change in a customer’s financial position 
could cause us to limit or discontinue business with such customer, require us to assume more credit risk relating to such 
customer’s receivables or limit our ability to collect accounts receivable from such customer, any of which could have a 
material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. 

We rely on a limited number of customers for a meaningful portion of our business. A loss of one or more of these 

customers could adversely impact our profitability. 

A loss of any significant customer, including a pipeline customer, or a decrease in the provision of products to any 
significant customer could have an adverse effect on our business until alternative arrangements are secured. Any alternative 
arrangement to replace the loss of a customer could result in increased variable costs relating to product shipment. In addition, 
any new customer agreement entered into by us may not have terms as favorable as those contained in our current customer 
agreements, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. For 
the year ended December 31, 2018 our top 10 customers represented approximately 23% of our sales and no single customer 
represented more than 4% of our sales. 

Refineries, which represent a sizable subset of our Environmental Catalysts and Services business customers, have 
undergone significant consolidation and additional consolidation is possible in the future. Such consolidation could further 
increase our reliance on a small number of customers and further increase our customers’ leverage over us, resulting in 
downward pressure on prices and an adverse effect on our profitability. 

Multi-year customer contracts in our refining services product group are subject to potential early termination and 

such contracts may not be renewed at the end of their respective terms. 

Many  of  the  customer  contracts  in  our  refining  services  product  group  are  multi-year  agreements.  Sulfuric  acid 
regeneration customer contracts are typically on five- to ten-year terms and virgin sulfuric acid customer contracts are 
typically  on  one-  to  five-year  terms,  with  larger  customers  typically  favoring  longer  terms.  Excluding  contracts  with 

24

automatic evergreen provisions, approximately 60% of our sulfuric acid volume for the year ended December 31, 2018 was 
under contracts expiring at the end of 2020 or beyond. In addition, our sulfuric acid regeneration contracts with major 
refinery customers typically allow for termination with advance notice of one to two years. We cannot provide assurance 
that our existing contracts will not be subjected to early terminations or that our expiring contracts will be renewed at the 
end of their terms. If we receive a significant number of such contract terminations or experience non-renewals from key 
customers in our refining services product group, our results of operations, financial condition and cash flows may be 
materially adversely affected. 

Reductions in highway safety spending or taxes earmarked for highway safety spending could result in a decline 

in our sales. 

Approximately 15% of our sales for the year ended December 31, 2018 were derived from products sold into highway 
safety applications. Sales of our performance materials products for highway safety uses are, in part, dependent upon federal, 
state, local and foreign government budgets. A decrease in, or termination of, governmental budgeting for new highway 
safety programs or a significant decrease in the use of our performance materials products in any new highway safety 
projects could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or cash flows by decreasing 
the profitability of our performance materials product group. 

Our quarterly results of operations are subject to fluctuations because the demand for some of our products is 

seasonal. 

Seasonal changes and weather conditions typically affect our performance materials and refining services product 
groups. In particular, our performance materials product group generally experiences lower sales and profit in the first and 
fourth quarters of the year because highway striping projects typically occur during warmer weather months. Additionally, 
our refining services product group typically experiences similar seasonal fluctuations as a result of higher demand for 
gasoline products in the summer months. As a result, our working capital requirements tend to be higher in the first and 
fourth quarters of the year, which can adversely affect our liquidity and cash flows. Because of this seasonality associated 
with certain of our product groups, results for any one quarter are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be 
achieved for any other quarter or for the full year. 

If we lose certain key personnel or are unable to hire additional qualified personnel, we may not be able to execute 

our business strategy and our business could be adversely affected. 

Our success depends, in part, upon the continued services of our highly skilled personnel involved in management, 
research, production and distribution and, in particular, upon the efforts and abilities of our key officers. Although we believe 
that we are adequately staffed in key positions, we may not be able to retain such personnel on acceptable terms or at all, 
and such personnel may seek to compete with us in the future. If we lose the service of any of our key personnel, we may 
not be able to hire replacements with the same level of industry experience and knowledge necessary to execute our business 
strategy, which in turn could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or 
cash flows. 

Our growth projects may result in significant expenditures before generating revenues, if any, which may materially 

and adversely affect our ability to implement our business strategy. 

We have made and continue to make significant investments in each of our businesses. These projects require us to 
commit significant capital to, among other things, implement engineering plans and obtain the necessary permits before we 
generate revenues related to our investments in these businesses. Such projects may take longer to complete or require 
additional unanticipated expenditures and may never generate profits. If we fail to recover our investment, or these projects 
never become profitable, our ability to implement our business strategy may be materially and adversely affected. 

We may be liable for damages based on product liability claims brought against us or our customers for costs 

associated with recalls of our or our customers’ products. 

Even though we are generally a materials and services supplier rather than a manufacturer of finished goods, the sale 
of  our  products  involves  the  risk  of  product  liability  claims  and  voluntary  or  government-ordered  product  recalls.  For 
example, certain of the products that we manufacture provide critical performance functions to our customers’ end products 
and are used in and around other chemical manufacturing facilities, highways, airports and other locations where personal 
injury or property damage may occur or are used in certain consumer goods such as beverages, personal care products and 

25

medicinal applications. While we attempt to protect ourselves from product liability claims and exposures through our 
adherence to standards and specifications and through contractual negotiations and provisions, there can be no assurance 
that our efforts will ultimately protect us from any such claims. A product liability claim or voluntary or government-ordered 
product  recall  could  result  in  substantial  and  unexpected  expenditures,  affect  consumer  or  customer  confidence  in  our 
products and divert management’s attention from other responsibilities. A product recall or successful product liability claim 
or series of claims against us in excess of our insurance coverage and for which we are not otherwise indemnified could 
have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or cash flows. 

We are required to comply with a wide variety of laws and regulations, and are subject to regulation by various 
federal, state and foreign agencies, and our failure to comply with existing and future regulatory requirements could 
adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. 

We  compete  in  industries  in  which  we  and  our  customers  are  subject  to  federal,  state,  local,  international  and 
transnational laws and regulations. Such laws and regulations are numerous and sometimes conflicting, and any future 
changes to such laws and regulations could adversely affect us. For example, our performance materials product group sells 
products used in highway safety applications, and such products are subject to laws and regulations that vary by state. If 
we fail to comply with applicable laws and regulations, we may be subject to civil remedies, including fines, injunctions, 
recalls or seizures, any of which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. 

In order to obtain regulatory approval for certain of our new products, we must, among other things, demonstrate to 
the relevant authority that the product is safe and effective for its intended uses and that we are capable of manufacturing 
the product in accordance with current regulations. The process of seeking approvals can be costly, time-consuming and 
subject to unanticipated and significant delays. Any delay in obtaining, or any failure to obtain or maintain, these approvals 
would adversely affect our ability to introduce new products and to generate sales from those products, and could have an 
adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or cash flows. 

Our  products,  including  the  raw  materials  we  handle,  are  subject  to  rigorous  chemical  registration  and  industrial 
hygiene regulations and investigation. There is risk that a key raw material, chemical or substance, or one of the end products 
of which our products are a part, may be recharacterized as having a toxicological or health-related impact on the environment, 
our customers or our employees. Industrial hygiene regulations are continually strengthened and if such recharacterization 
occurs, the relevant raw material, chemical or product may be banned or we may incur increased costs in order to comply 
with new requirements. Changes in industrial hygiene regulations also affect the marketability of certain of our products, 
and future regulatory changes may have a material adverse effect on our business. 

New laws and regulations, and changes in existing laws and regulations, may be introduced in the future and could 
prevent or inhibit the development, distribution and sale of our products, including as a result of additional compliance 
costs, seizures, confiscation, recall or monetary fines. For example, as discussed in more detail in “Business-Environmental 
Regulations”  and  “Business-Chemical  Product  Regulation,”  we  may  be  materially  impacted  by  regulatory  initiatives 
worldwide with respect to chemical product safety such as the 2016 amendments to the U.S. Toxic Substances Control Act, 
the E.U. regulation “Registration, Evaluation, Authorisation and Restriction of Chemical Substances” (“REACH”), or similar 
regulations  being  enacted  in  other  countries  (e.g.,  China  REACH;  Korea  REACH).  Additionally,  the  current  U.S. 
administration may seek to reduce current environmental standards and regulations, such as the Corporate Average Fuel 
Economy standards, which could have a material adverse effect on our sales into the fuels and emission controls industries. 

We are subject to extensive environmental, health and safety regulations and face various risks associated with 

potential non-compliance or releases of hazardous materials. 

Like other chemical companies, our operations and properties are subject to extensive and stringent federal, state, 
local and foreign environmental laws and regulations. U.S. federal environmental laws that affect us include the Resource 
Conservation and Recovery Act (“RCRA”), the Clean Air Act, the Clean Water Act and the Comprehensive Environmental 
Response Compensation and Liability Act (“CERCLA”). These laws govern, among other things, emissions to the air, 
discharges or releases of hazardous substances to land, surface, subsurface strata and water, wastewater discharges and the 
generation, handling, storage, transportation, treatment, disposal and remediation of hazardous materials and petroleum 
products. We are also subject to other federal, state, local and foreign laws and regulations regarding chemical and product 
safety as well as employee health and safety matters, including process safety requirements. These laws and regulations 
may become more stringent over time and the failure to comply with such laws and regulations can result in significant 
fines or penalties. 

26

We  have  in  the  past  been  and  currently  are  the  subject  of  investigations  and  enforcement  actions  pursuant  to 
environmental laws, including the Clean Air Act. Some of these matters were resolved through the payment of significant 
monetary penalties and a requirement to implement corrective actions at our facilities. For instance, we remain subject to 
a 2007 Consent Decree that resolves certain alleged Clean Air Act violations at our seven refining services operating locations 
involving New Source Review, Prevention of Significant Deterioration and New Source Performance Standard obligations 
under the U.S. federal rules for the pollutants sulfur dioxide and sulfuric acid mist. The Consent Decree required Solvay 
(the owner at the time) to pay a $2 million penalty and spend approximately $34 million on air pollution controls at our 
facilities, the majority of which was received from customers in contractual arrangements. Work under the Consent Decree 
has proceeded since 2007, and we believe that all of the significant capital improvements related to the Consent Decree 
have been completed. One of our operating locations has been released from the scope of the Consent Decree and we are 
seeking release of the other locations covered by the Consent Decree. 

We  are  required  by  these  environmental  laws  and  regulations  to  obtain  registrations,  licenses,  permits  and  other 
approvals in order to operate, to make disclosures to public authorities about our chemical handling and usage activities 
and  to  install  expensive  pollution  control  and  spill  containment  equipment  at  our  facilities,  or  to  incur  other  capital 
expenditures aimed at achieving or maintaining compliance with such laws and regulations. We are preparing to implement 
a substantial environmentally-driven capital improvement project over the next three years and failure to complete this 
project or to timely identify and implement other capital projects required to achieve or maintain compliance could expose 
us to enforcement and penalty. 

Under CERCLA and analogous statutes in local and foreign jurisdictions, current and former owners and operators 
of  land  impacted  by  releases  of  hazardous  substances  are  strictly  liable  for  the  investigation  and  remediation  of  the 
contamination resulting from the release. Liability under CERCLA and analogous laws is strict, unlimited, joint, several 
and retroactive, may be imposed regardless of fault and may relate to historical activities or contamination not caused by 
the affected property’s current owner or operator. We could be held responsible for all cleanup costs at a site, whether 
currently or formerly owned or operated, regardless of fault, knowledge, timing or cause of the contamination. Further, 
under CERCLA and analogous laws, we may be jointly and severally liable for contamination at third party sites where we 
or our predecessors in interest have sent waste for treatment or disposal, even if we complied with applicable laws. In 
addition,  we  may  face  liability  for  personal  injury,  property  damage  and  natural  resource  damage  resulting  from 
environmental conditions attributable to hazardous substance releases at or from facilities we currently own or operate or 
formerly owned or operated or to which we sent waste. As such, a product spill or emission at one of our facilities or 
otherwise resulting from our operations could have adverse consequences on the environment and surrounding community 
and could result in significant liabilities with respect to investigation and remediation. 

Our facilities have an extended history of industrial use, and soil and groundwater contamination exists at some of 
our sites. As of December 31, 2018, we had current investigation, remediation or monitoring obligations at several of our 
current  or  former  sites,  including  Rahway,  New  Jersey;  Dominguez,  California;  Martinez,  California;  and  Tacoma, 
Washington. As of December 31, 2018, we had established reserves of approximately $3.4 million to cover anticipated 
expenses  at  these  sites,  all  of  which  have  reached  relatively  mature  stages  of  either  the  investigation,  remediation  or 
monitoring process. Actual costs to complete these projects may exceed our current estimates. In addition, we have unresolved 
liability at several sites to which we or our predecessors allegedly arranged for the disposal or treatment of hazardous wastes. 
For example, at the Boyertown Sanitary Disposal site in Gilbertsville, Pennsylvania, we are participating in a group of 
parties who disposed of materials at the site to fund investigatory and remedial work. 

As of December 31, 2018, our total reserves associated with environmental remediation and enforcement matters were 
$4.7 million. In addition to the ongoing remediation and monitoring activities discussed above, there is risk that the long-
term industrial use at our facilities may have resulted in, or may in the future result in, contamination that has yet to be 
discovered, which could require additional, unplanned investigation and remediation efforts by us for which no reserves 
have been established, potentially without regard to whether we knew of, or caused, the release of such contaminants. 
Discovery of additional or unknown conditions at our facilities could have an adverse impact on our business by substantially 
increasing  our  capital  expenditures,  including  compliance,  investigation  and  remediation  costs.  Such  environmental 
liabilities attached to our properties, or for properties that we are otherwise responsible for, could have a material adverse 
effect on our results of operations or financial condition. 

27

Existing and proposed regulations to address climate change by limiting greenhouse gas emissions may cause us 

to incur significant additional operating and capital expenses. 

Certain of our operations result in emissions of greenhouse gases (“GHGs”), such as carbon dioxide. Growing concern 
about  the  sources  and  impacts  of  global  climate  change  has  led  to  a  number  of  domestic  and  foreign  legislative  and 
administrative measures, both proposed and enacted, to monitor, regulate and limit carbon dioxide and other GHG emissions. 
In the European Union, our emissions are regulated under the E.U. Emissions Trading System (the “E.U. ETS”), an E.U.-
wide trading scheme for industrial GHG emissions. The E.U. ETS is anticipated to become progressively more stringent 
over time, including by reducing the number of allowances to emit GHGs that E.U. member states will allocate without 
charge to industrial facilities. In the United States, the EPA has promulgated federal GHG regulations under the Clean Air 
Act that affect certain sources. For example, the EPA has issued mandatory GHG reporting requirements, under which our 
Dominguez, California and Baton Rouge, Louisiana facilities currently report. Moreover, California has enacted the Global 
Warming Solutions Act of 2006 (“Assembly Bill 32”), a law that establishes a comprehensive program to reduce GHG 
emissions  from  all  sources  throughout  the  state  and  contains  reporting  requirements  under  which  our  Dominguez  and 
Martinez facilities currently report. Our Dominguez facility also participates in the emissions trading market established 
under Assembly Bill 32. Although we believe it is likely that GHG emissions will continue to be regulated in at least some 
regions of the United States and in other countries (in addition to the European Union) in the future, we cannot yet predict 
the form such regulation will take (such as a cap-and-trade program, technology mandate, emissions tax or other regulatory 
mechanism) or, consequently, estimate any costs that we may be required to incur in respect of such requirements, which 
could, for example, require that we install emission control equipment, purchase emissions allowances, administer and 
manage our GHG emissions program or address other regulatory obligations. Such requirements could also adversely affect 
our energy supply or the costs and types of raw materials that we use for fuel. Accordingly, regulations controlling or limiting 
GHG emissions could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations, including 
by reducing demand for our products. 

Production and distribution of our products could be disrupted for a variety of reasons, and such disruptions could 

expose us to significant losses or liabilities. 

Certain of the hazards and risks associated with our manufacturing processes and the related storage and transportation 
of raw materials, products and wastes may disrupt production at our manufacturing facilities and the distribution of products 
to our customers. These potentially disruptive risks include, but are not limited to, the following: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

pipeline and storage tank leaks and ruptures; 

explosions and fires; 

inclement weather and natural disasters; 

terrorist attacks; 

failure of mechanical, process safety and pollution control equipment; 

chemical spills and other discharges or releases of toxic or hazardous substances or gases; and 

exposure to toxic chemicals. 

These hazards could expose employees, customers, the community and others to toxic chemicals and other hazards, 
contaminate the environment, damage property, result in personal injury or death, lead to an interruption or suspension of 
operations, damage our reputation and adversely affect the productivity and profitability of a particular manufacturing 
facility or our business as a whole. Such hazards could also result in the need for remediation, governmental enforcement, 
regulatory shutdowns, the imposition of government fines and penalties and claims brought by governmental entities or 
third parties. Legal claims and regulatory actions could subject us to both civil and criminal penalties, which could affect 
our product sales, reputation and profitability. 

If disruptions at our manufacturing facilities or in our distribution channels occur, alternative options with sufficient 
capacity or capabilities may not be available, may cost substantially more or may require significant time to start production 
or  distribution. Any  of  these  scenarios  could  negatively  affect  our  business  and  financial  performance.  If  one  of  our 
manufacturing facilities or distribution channels is unable to produce or distribute our products for an extended period of 
time, our sales may be reduced by the shortfall caused by the disruption and we may not be able to meet our customers’ 
needs,  which  could  cause  them  to  seek  other  suppliers.  Furthermore,  to  the  extent  a  production  disruption  occurs  at  a 
manufacturing  facility  that  has  been  operating  at  or  near  full  capacity,  the  resulting  shortage  of  our  product  could  be 

28

particularly harmful because production at the manufacturing facility may not be able to reach levels achieved prior to the 
disruption. Such risks are heightened in our refining services product group, which has operations and customers primarily 
located in the Gulf Coast, which is susceptible to a heightened risk of hurricanes, and Northern California, which is susceptible 
to a heightened risk of earthquakes. For example, in August 2017 we shut down our Houston and Baytown refining services 
facilities in coordination with our refinery partners in anticipation of Hurricane Harvey. The operational interruption at these 
facilities negatively impacted our sales in 2017 by approximately $7.7 million.

The insurance that we maintain may not fully cover all potential exposures. 

We maintain property, business interruption, casualty and other types of insurance, but such insurance may not cover 
all  risks  associated  with  the  operation  of  our  business  or  our  manufacturing  process  and  the  related  use,  storage  and 
transportation of raw materials, products and wastes in or from our manufacturing sites or distribution centers. While we 
have purchased what we deem to be adequate limits of coverage and broadly worded policies, our coverage is subject to 
exclusions  and  limitations,  including  higher  self-insured  retentions  or  deductibles  and  maximum  limits  and  liabilities 
covered.  Notwithstanding  diligent  efforts  to  successfully  procure  specialty  coverage  for  environmental  liability  and 
remediation, we may incur losses beyond the limits or outside the terms of coverage of our insurance policies, including 
liabilities for environmental remediation. In addition, from time to time, various types of insurance for companies in the 
industries in which we operate have not been available on commercially acceptable terms or, in some cases, at all. We are 
potentially at additional risk if one or more of our insurance carriers fail. Additionally, severe disruptions in the domestic 
and global financial markets could adversely impact the ratings and survival of some insurers. Future downgrades in the 
ratings of enough insurers could adversely impact both the availability of appropriate insurance coverage and its cost. In 
the future, we may not be able to obtain coverage at current levels, if at all, and our premiums may increase significantly 
on coverage that we maintain. 

We could be subject to damages based on claims brought against us by our customers or lose customers as a result 

of the failure of our products to meet certain quality specifications. 

Our products provide important performance attributes to our customers’ products. If a product fails to perform in a 
manner consistent with quality specifications, or has a shorter useful life than that which was guaranteed, a customer could 
seek replacement of the product or damages for costs incurred as a result of the product failing to perform as guaranteed. 
A successful claim or series of claims against us could cause reputational harm and have a material adverse effect on our 
financial condition and results of operations and could result in a loss of one or more customers. 

We may engage in strategic acquisitions or dispositions of certain assets or businesses that could affect our business, 

results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. 

We may selectively pursue complementary acquisitions, such as the Business Combination, and joint ventures, such 
as our Zeolyst Joint Venture, each of which inherently involves a number of risks and presents financial, managerial and 
operational challenges, including: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

potential disruption of our ongoing business and distraction of management; 

difficulty with integration of personnel and financial and other systems; 

hiring additional management and other critical personnel; and 

increasing the scope, geographic diversity and complexity of our operations. 

In addition, we may encounter unforeseen obstacles or costs in the integration of acquired businesses. For example, 
the presence of one or more material liabilities of an acquired company that are unknown to us at the time of acquisition 
may have a material adverse effect on our business. Our acquisition and joint venture strategy may not be received positively 
by customers, and we may not realize any anticipated benefits from acquisitions or joint ventures. 

We  may  also  opportunistically  pursue  dispositions  of  certain  assets  and  businesses,  which  may  involve  material 
amounts of assets or lines of business, which could adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. 
If any such dispositions were to occur, under the terms of the agreements governing our outstanding indebtedness, we may 
be required to apply the proceeds of the sale to repay such indebtedness. 

29

The pro forma and non-GAAP financial information included in this Form 10-K is presented for informational 

purposes only and may not be an indication of our financial condition or results of operations in the future. 

The unaudited pro forma combined financial information included in this Form 10-K is presented for informational 
purposes only and is not necessarily indicative of what our actual financial condition or results of operations would have 
been had the Business Combination been completed on the date indicated. The assumptions used in preparing the pro forma 
financial information may not prove to be accurate and other factors may affect our financial condition or results of operations. 
Accordingly, our financial condition and results of operations in the future may not be consistent with, or evident from, 
such pro forma financial information. The non-GAAP financial information included in this Form 10-K includes information 
that we use to evaluate our past performance, but you should not consider such information in isolation or as an alternative 
to measures of our performance determined under GAAP. 

Our joint ventures may not operate according to their business plans if our partners fail to fulfill their obligations 
or differences in views among our partners results in delayed decisions or failures to agree on major issues, which may 
adversely affect our results of operations and force us to dedicate additional resources to these joint ventures. 

We currently participate in a number of joint ventures and may enter into additional joint ventures in the future. The 
nature of a joint venture requires us to share control with unaffiliated third parties and we sometimes have joint and several 
liability with our joint venture partners. If our joint venture partners do not fulfill their obligations, or if differences in views 
among the joint venture participants results in delayed decisions or failures to agree on major issues, the affected joint 
venture may not be able to operate according to its business plan. For example, our Zeolyst Joint Venture is structured as a 
general partnership in which we are equal partners with CRI Zeolites Inc. Accordingly, we do not control the Zeolyst Joint 
Venture and cannot unilaterally undertake strategies, plans, goals and operations or determine when cash distributions will 
be made to us. Furthermore, we are liable on a joint and several basis with CRI Zeolites Inc. for all of the partnership’s 
liabilities if it does not have sufficient assets to satisfy such liabilities. Such factors may adversely affect our results of 
operation and force us to dedicate additional and unexpected resources to our joint ventures. 

Our failure to protect our intellectual property rights could adversely affect our future performance and growth. 

Protection of our proprietary processes, methods, compounds and other technologies is important to our business. We 
depend upon our ability to develop and protect our intellectual property rights to distinguish our products from those of our 
competitors. Failure to protect our existing intellectual property rights may allow our competitors to copy our products and 
may result in the loss of valuable proprietary technologies or other intellectual property. Failure to protect our innovations 
and trademarks by securing intellectual property rights could also result in our having to pay other companies for infringing 
on their intellectual property rights. We rely on a combination of patent, trade secret, trademark and copyright law as well 
as regulatory and judicial enforcement to protect such technologies and trademarks. In addition, the laws of many foreign 
countries do not protect our intellectual property rights to the same extent as the laws of the United States. As of December 31, 
2018, we owned 52 patented inventions in the United States, with approximately 309 patents issued in countries around the 
world and approximately 120 patent applications pending worldwide covering more than 20 additional inventions. Some 
of these patents are licensed to others. In addition, we have acquired certain rights under patents and inventions of others 
through licenses. Should any of these licenses granted to us by third parties terminate prior to the expiration of the licensed 
intellectual property, we would need to cease using the licensed intellectual property, and either develop or license alternative 
technologies. In such a case, there can be no assurance that alternative technologies exist or that we would be able to obtain 
such a license on favorable terms. 

Competitors and third parties may infringe on our patents or violate our intellectual property rights. Defending and 
enforcing our intellectual property rights can involve litigation and can be expensive and time consuming. Such proceedings 
could put our patents at risk of being invalidated and confidential information may be disclosed through the discovery 
process; these costs and diversion of resources could harm our business. 

We cannot provide any assurances that any of our pending applications will mature into issued patents, or that any 
patents that have issued or may issue in the future do or will include claims with a scope sufficient to provide any competitive 
advantage. Patents involve complex legal and factual questions and, therefore, the issuance, scope, validity and enforceability 
of  any  patent  claims  we  have  or  may  obtain  cannot  be  predicted  with  certainty.  Patents  may  be  challenged,  deemed 
unenforceable, invalidated or circumvented. Patents may be challenged in the courts, as well as in various administrative 
proceedings before the United States Patent and Trademark Office or foreign patent offices. We are currently and may in 
the future be a party to various adversarial patent office proceedings involving our patents or the patents of third parties. 
Such challenges can result in some or all of the claims of the challenged patent being invalidated, deemed unenforceable, 

30

or interpreted narrowly which, in the case of challenges to our own patents, may be adverse to our interests. Accordingly, 
the issuance of patents is not conclusive of the validity, scope, or enforceability of such patents. Moreover, even if valid 
and enforceable, competitors may be able to design around our patents or use pre-existing technologies to compete with 
us. 

We also rely upon unpatented proprietary know-how, continuing technological innovation and other trade secrets to 
develop and maintain our competitive position, which may not provide us with complete protection against competitors. 
Misappropriation or unauthorized disclosure of our proprietary know-how could harm our competitive position or have an 
adverse effect on our business. While it is our policy to enter into confidentiality agreements with our employees and third 
parties to protect our intellectual property rights and we strive to maintain the physical security of our properties and the 
security of our IT systems, there can be no assurances that: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

our confidentiality agreements will not be breached; 

our security measures will not be breached; 

such agreements will provide meaningful protection for our trade secrets or proprietary know-how; or 

adequate remedies will be available in the event of an unauthorized use or disclosure of such trade secrets and 
know-how. 

In addition, there can be no assurances that others will not obtain knowledge of these trade secrets through independent 

development or other access by legal means. 

Measures taken by us to protect these assets and rights may not provide meaningful protection for our trade secrets 
or proprietary manufacturing expertise and adequate remedies may not be available in the event of an unauthorized use or 
disclosure of our trade secrets or manufacturing expertise. In addition, as noted above, our patents and other intellectual 
property rights may be challenged, invalidated, circumvented or rendered unenforceable. 

Furthermore, we cannot provide assurance that any pending patent or trademark application filed by us will result in 
an issued patent or registered trademark or, if patents are issued to us, that those patents will provide meaningful protection 
against competitors or against competitive technologies. The failure of our patents or other measures to protect our processes, 
apparatuses, technology, trade secrets and proprietary manufacturing expertise, methods and compounds or trademarks and 
provide us with freedom to exclude competition could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results 
of operations and cash flows. See “Business-Intellectual Property.” 

Our products may infringe the intellectual property rights of others, which may cause us to incur unexpected costs 

or prevent us from selling our products. 

Our industry is characterized by vigilant pursuit of intellectual property rights, particularly with respect to our silica 
catalysts  and  zeolite  catalysts  product  groups.  Like  us,  our  competitors  rely  on  intellectual  property  rights  to  maintain 
profitability and competitiveness. As the number of products and competitors has increased, the likelihood of intellectual 
property disputes has risen. Although it is our policy and intention not to infringe valid patents of which we are aware, our 
processes, apparatuses, technology, proprietary manufacturing expertise, methods, compounds and products may infringe 
on issued patents or infringe or misappropriate other intellectual property rights of others. Accordingly, we continually 
monitor  third-party  intellectual  property  to  confirm  our  freedom  to  operate.  Nevertheless,  we  may  be  subject  to  legal 
proceedings and claims in the ordinary course of our business, including claims of alleged infringement of the patents or 
trademarks or infringement or misappropriation of other intellectual property rights of third parties by us or our licensees 
in connection with their use of our products. Intellectual property litigation is expensive and time-consuming, regardless 
of the merits of any claim, and could divert the attention of our management and technical personnel away from operating 
our business. If we were to discover that our processes, apparatuses, technology, products or trademarks infringe the valid 
intellectual property rights of others, we might need to obtain licenses from these parties or substantially reengineer or 
rebrand our products in order to avoid infringement. We may not be able to obtain the necessary licenses on acceptable 
terms, or at all, or be able to reengineer our products successfully or at an acceptable cost. Moreover, if we are sued for 
infringement and lose the suit, we could be required to pay substantial damages and/or be enjoined from using or selling 
the  infringing  products  or  technology  or  using  the  infringing  trademark. Additionally  or  alternatively,  we  may  seek  to 
challenge third-party patents in administrative proceedings before the United States patent office or one or more foreign 
patent offices. Any of the foregoing could cause us to incur significant costs and prevent us from selling our products, which 
could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. Even if we ultimately 
prevail, the existence of lawsuits could prompt our customers to switch to alternative products. In addition, we have agreed, 

31

and will continue to agree, to indemnify certain customers for certain intellectual property infringement claims related to 
intellectual property relating to our products and the manufacture thereof. Should there be infringement claims against our 
licensees, we could be required to indemnify them for losses resulting from such claims or to refund amounts they have 
paid to us. 

Losses and damages in connection with information technology risks could adversely affect our operations. 

Our  operations  materially  depend  on  the  reliable  performance  of  a  complex,  worldwide  and  highly  available 
information technology infrastructure with integrated processes. The networks and data centers we use are subject to damage 
by material events such as major disruptions to public infrastructure, including power outages, cyber or terrorist attacks, 
viruses, malware, physical or electronic break-ins and fires. Despite various disaster recovery plans, there can be no assurance 
that  our  systems  are  appropriately  redundant  even  though  we  control  the  operations  at  the  back-up  facility  we  use. 
Accordingly, such an event could cause material disruptions in our operations. 

The broad use of information technology systems has increased the risk of unauthorized access to confidential data, 
such as customer information, strategic projects, product formulas and other trade secrets, and the risk of destruction or 
manipulation of material data by employees or third parties. Release of third party confidential information could materially 
harm our reputation, affect our relationships with such parties and expose us to liability. Although we have introduced many 
security  measures,  including  firewalls  and  information  technology  security  policies,  these  measures  may  not  offer  the 
appropriate level of security. A security breach or other compromise of our information security safeguards could expose 
our confidential information, including third party confidential information in our possession (such as customer information) 
to theft and misuse, which could in turn adversely affect our relationships with such third parties and have an adverse effect 
on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. 

We  depend  on  good  relations  with  our  workforce,  and  any  significant  disruptions  could  adversely  affect  our 

operations. 

As of December 31, 2018, we had 3,188 employees globally, approximately 50% of which were represented by a 
union, works council or other employee representative body. As of December 31, 2018, approximately 70% of our U.S. 
unionized employees were covered under collective bargaining agreements that will expire on or before December 31, 2019. 
Failure  to  reach  agreement  with  any  of  our  unionized  work  groups  regarding  the  terms  of  their  collective  bargaining 
agreements or annual pay increases may result in a labor strike, work stoppage or slowdown. In addition, a large number 
of  our  employees  are  employed  in  countries  in  which  employment  laws  provide  greater  bargaining  or  other  rights  to 
employees than the laws of the United States. Such employment rights require us to work collaboratively with the legal 
representatives of the employees to effect any changes to labor arrangements. For example, many of our employees in 
Europe are represented by works councils that must approve any changes in conditions of employment, including salaries, 
benefits and staff changes, and may impede efforts to restructure our workforce. Although we believe that we have a good 
working relationship with our employees, a strike, work stoppage or slowdown by our employees or a dispute with our 
employees could result in a significant disruption to our operations or higher ongoing labor costs. In addition, our ability 
to make adjustments to control compensation and benefit costs, or otherwise adapt to changing business needs, may be 
limited by the terms and duration of our collective bargaining agreements. 

We are subject to certain risks related to litigation filed by or against us, as well as administrative and regulatory 

proceedings, and adverse results may harm our business. 

We cannot predict with certainty the cost of defense, the cost of prosecution or the ultimate outcome of litigation and 
other administrative and regulatory proceedings filed by or against us, including remedies or damage awards, and adverse 
results in any litigation or other administrative and regulatory proceedings may materially harm our business. Litigation 
and other administrative and regulatory proceedings may include, but are not limited to, actions relating to intellectual 
property,  commercial  arrangements,  environmental,  health  and  safety  matters,  joint  venture  agreements,  labor  and 
employment matters, domestic and foreign antitrust matters or other harms resulting from the actions of individuals or 
entities outside of our control. In the case of intellectual property litigation and proceedings, adverse outcomes could include 
the  cancellation,  invalidation  or  other  loss  of  material  intellectual  property  rights  used  in  our  business  and  injunctions 
prohibiting our use of our processes, apparatuses, technology, trade secrets and proprietary manufacturing expertise, methods 
and compounds that are subject to third-party patents or other third-party intellectual property rights. Litigation based on 
environmental matters or exposure to hazardous substances in the workplace or from our products could result in significant 
liability for us. For example, we are currently subject to various asbestos premises liability claims that relate to employee 

32

or  contractor  exposure  to  asbestos  contained  in  certain  building  materials  at  our  sites.  Furthermore,  our  international 
operations expose us to potential administrative and regulatory proceedings in foreign jurisdictions. Antitrust authorities in 
Brazil have publicly announced that they are investigating alleged cartel activities by Brazilian silicate manufacturers, 
including our Brazilian subsidiary (“PQ Brazil”). The authorities allege that the activities occurred over an approximately 
10-year period beginning in the late 1990s, which is prior to the time we owned PQ Brazil. PQ Brazil is fully cooperating 
with the authorities. Adverse outcomes in any of the foregoing could have a material adverse effect on our business.

The terms of our indebtedness restrict our current and future operations, particularly our ability to respond to 

change or to take certain actions. 

The  indentures  governing  our  outstanding  indebtedness  contain  a  number  of  restrictive  covenants  that  impose 
significant operating and financial restrictions on us and may limit our ability to engage in acts that may be in our long-
term best interest, including restrictions on our ability to incur additional indebtedness, make investments, acquisitions, 
loans and advances, sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of our assets or incur liens. See “Management’s Discussion and 
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Financial Condition, Liquidity and Capital Resources—Debt.” 
In addition, the restrictive covenants in the agreements governing our senior secured credit facilities require us to maintain 
specified financial ratios and satisfy other financial condition tests. Our ability to meet these financial ratios and tests can 
be affected by events beyond our control. 

A breach of such covenants could result in an event of default unless we obtain a waiver to avoid such default. If we 
are unable to obtain a waiver, such a default may allow our creditors to accelerate the related debt and may result in the 
acceleration of, or default under, any other debt to which a cross-acceleration or cross-default provision applies. In the event 
our lenders or noteholders accelerate the repayment of our borrowings, we and our subsidiaries may not have sufficient 
assets to repay that indebtedness. 

We may be adversely affected by changes in LIBOR reporting practices or the method in which LIBOR is determined.

LIBOR, the London interbank offered rate, is the basic rate of interest used in lending between banks on the London 
interbank market and is widely used as a reference for setting the interest rate on loans globally.  Our senior secured term 
loan facility and asset-based revolving credit facility use LIBOR as a reference rate such that the interest due to our creditors 
under those facilities is calculated using LIBOR.  As of December 31, 2018, we had outstanding approximately $1,157.5 
million of debt that was indexed to LIBOR.

On July 27, 2017, the United Kingdom’s Financial Conduct Authority, which regulates LIBOR, announced that it 
intends to phase out LIBOR by the end of 2021.  It is unclear if LIBOR will cease to exist at that time or if new methods 
of calculating LIBOR will be established such that it continues to exist after 2021.  The U.S. Federal Reserve, in conjunction 
with the Alternative Reference Rates Committee, a steering committee comprised of large U.S. financial institutions, is 
considering replacing U.S. dollar LIBOR with a new index calculated by short-term repurchase agreements, backed by 
Treasury securities.  The future of LIBOR at this time is uncertain and any changes in the methods by which LIBOR is 
determined or regulatory activity related to LIBOR’s phaseout could cause LIBOR to perform differently than in the past 
or cease to exist.  If LIBOR ceases to exist, we may need to renegotiate our credit agreements that utilize LIBOR as a factor 
in determining the interest rate to replace LIBOR with the new standard that is established.

Because our operations are conducted through our subsidiaries and joint ventures, we are dependent on the receipt 
of distributions and dividends or other payments from our subsidiaries and joint ventures for cash to fund our operations 
and expenses, including to make future dividend payments, if any. 

Our  operations  are  conducted  through  our  subsidiaries  and  joint  ventures. As  a  result,  our  ability  to  make  future 
dividend payments, if any, is dependent on the earnings of our subsidiaries and joint ventures and the payment of those 
earnings to us in the form of dividends, loans or advances and through repayment of loans or advances from us. Payments 
to us by our subsidiaries and joint ventures will be contingent upon our subsidiaries’ or joint ventures’ earnings and other 
business considerations and may be subject to statutory or contractual restrictions. We do not currently expect to declare or 
pay dividends on our common stock for the foreseeable future; however, to the extent that we determine in the future to 
pay dividends on our common stock, the agreements governing our outstanding indebtedness significantly restrict the ability 
of our subsidiaries to pay dividends or otherwise transfer assets to us. 

33

We may need to recognize impairment charges related to goodwill, identified intangible assets and fixed assets. 

We are required to test goodwill and any other intangible asset with an indefinite life for possible impairment on the 
same date each year and on an interim basis if there are indicators of a possible impairment. We are also required to evaluate 
indefinite-lived intangible assets and fixed assets for impairment if there are indicators of a possible impairment. 

There is significant judgment required in the analysis of a potential impairment of goodwill, identified intangible 
assets and fixed assets. If, as a result of a general economic slowdown or deterioration in one or more of the industries in 
which we operate or in our financial performance or future outlook, or if the estimated fair value of our long-lived assets 
decreases,  we  may  determine  that  one  or  more  of  our  long-lived  assets  is  impaired. An  impairment  charge  would  be 
determined based on the estimated fair value of the assets and any such impairment charge could have a material adverse 
effect on our results of operations and financial position. 

Our ability to utilize our net operating losses is uncertain. 

As of December 31, 2018, we had $284.2 million of net operating losses for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Our 
ability to utilize these net operating losses to offset future income tax liabilities depends on our future financial performance 
and our future taxable income. In addition, $144.4 million of these net operating losses are currently subject to limitation 
under Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), potentially impacting our ability to 
realize the benefits of these net operating losses. 

Generally, if an ownership change occurs within three years of the closing date of the most recent change in control 
transaction, any existing net operating losses and certain built-in losses would be subject to an additional limitation pursuant 
to Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code (“IRC”). Change in control as defined by Section 382 occurs when there is an 
ownership change among stockholders owning directly or indirectly 5% or more of our common stock and that results in 
an aggregate ownership change with respect to such stockholders of more than 50% of our common stock. 

We have analyzed our transactional history and determined that the most recent change in control occurred in December 
of 2014. The Business Combination that occurred in May of 2016 did not result in a change in control as defined by Section 
382, and as such, did not further limit the net operating losses available to us.

Our management believes that it is more likely than not that we will realize the entire $144.4 million of net operating 
losses subject to limitation in future years. The remaining $139.9 million relates to periods after the most recent change in 
control and would not be subject to Section 382 limitations.

On December 22, 2017, the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (“TCJA”) was signed into law. The TCJA mandated significant 
changes to U.S. corporate taxation. Notable legislative changes include a reduction of the corporate tax rate from 35% to 
21%, new additional limitations on the tax deductibility of interest, extensive changes to the regime governing the taxation 
of foreign earnings, immediate deductions for certain investments instead of deductions for depreciation expense over time, 
as well as modification or repeal of certain business deductions and credits. We are continuing to evaluate the overall impact 
of the TCJA, particularly as additional guidance is released by the U.S. Treasury and various tax jurisdictions. Any changes 
in tax laws or regulations could adversely affect our results of operations, cash flows and financial condition.

We have unfunded and underfunded pension plan liabilities. We will require current and future operating cash 
flow to fund these shortfalls. We have no assurance that we will generate sufficient cash flow to satisfy these obligations. 

We maintain defined benefit pension plans covering employees who meet age and service requirements. While some 
of our plans have been frozen, our net pension liability and cost is materially affected by the discount rate used to measure 
pension obligations, the longevity and actuarial profile of our workforce, the level of plan assets available to fund those 
obligations and the actual and expected long-term rate of return on plan assets. Significant changes in investment performance 
or a change in the portfolio mix of invested assets can result in corresponding increases and decreases in the valuation of 
plan assets, particularly equity securities, or in a change in the expected rate of return on plan assets. Assets available to 
fund the pension and other postemployment benefit obligations of our plans as of December 31, 2018 were approximately 
$287.5 million, or approximately $86.6 million less than the measured pension benefit obligation on a GAAP basis. In 
addition, any changes in the discount rate could result in a significant increase or decrease in the valuation of pension 
obligations, affecting the reported funded status of our pension plans as well as the net periodic pension cost in the following 
years. Similarly, changes in the expected return on plan assets can result in significant changes in the net periodic pension 
cost in the following years. 

34

We also contribute to two multi-employer pension plans on behalf of certain of our employees in the United States 
pursuant  to  union  agreements  that  generally  provide  defined  benefits  to  employees  covered  by  collective  bargaining 
agreements. A total of approximately 18 employees currently participate in such multi-employer pension plans. Funding 
requirements for benefit obligations of multi-employer pension plans are subject to certain regulatory requirements and we 
may be required to make cash contributions to one of these plans to satisfy certain underfunded benefit obligations. Absent 
an applicable exemption, a contributor to a U.S. multi-employer plan is liable upon its withdrawal from, or the termination 
of, a plan for its proportionate share of the plan’s underfunding, if any.

We also provide certain health care and life insurance benefits to certain of our employees and their dependents in the 
United  States  upon  the  retirement  of  such  employee  from  us  pursuant  to  union  agreements.  Costs  of  these  other  post-
employment benefit plans are dependent upon numerous factors, assumptions and estimates. 

Risks Related to our Common Stock 

CCMP and INEOS continue to have significant influence over us, which could limit your ability to influence the 

outcome of key transactions, including a change of control. 

As of December 31, 2018, investment funds affiliated with CCMP beneficially owned approximately 45.7% of our 
outstanding common stock and INEOS beneficially owned approximately 22.3% of our outstanding common stock. For as 
long as affiliates of CCMP and INEOS continue to beneficially own a substantial percentage of the voting power of our 
outstanding common stock, they will continue to have significant influence over us. For example, they will be able to 
strongly influence or effectively control the election of all of the members of our board of directors and our business and 
affairs, including any determinations with respect to mergers or other business combinations, the acquisition or disposition 
of assets, the incurrence of additional indebtedness, the issuance of any additional shares of common stock or other equity 
securities, the repurchase or redemption of shares of our common stock and the payment of dividends. 

Additionally, CCMP and INEOS are in the business of making investments in companies and may acquire and hold 
interests  in  businesses  that  compete  directly  or  indirectly  with  us.  CCMP  and  INEOS  may  also  pursue  acquisition 
opportunities  that  may  be  complementary  to  our  business,  and,  as  a  result,  those  acquisition  opportunities  may  not  be 
available to us. 

Our stock price could be extremely volatile and, as a result, you may not be able to resell your shares at or above 

the price you paid for them. 

Since launching our IPO in September 2017, the price of our common stock, as reported on the New York Stock 
Exchange, has ranged from a low of $12.88 on March 2, 2018 to a high of $18.69 on July 10, 2018. In addition, the stock 
market in general has been highly volatile. As a result, the market price of our common stock is likely to be similarly volatile, 
and investors in our common stock may experience a decrease, which could be substantial, in the value of their stock, 
including decreases unrelated to our operating performance or prospects, and could lose part or all of their investment. The 
price of our common stock could be subject to wide fluctuations in response to a number of factors, including those described 
elsewhere herein and others such as: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

variations in our operating performance and the performance of our competitors; 

actual or anticipated fluctuations in our quarterly or annual operating results; 

publication of research reports by securities analysts about us, our competitors or our industry; 

our failure or the failure of our competitors to meet analysts’ projections or guidance that we or our competitors 
may give to the market; 

additions or departures of key personnel; 

strategic decisions by us or our competitors, such as acquisitions, divestitures, spin-offs, joint ventures, strategic 
investments or changes in business strategy; 

the passage of legislation or other regulatory developments affecting us or our industry; 

changes in legislation, regulation and government policy as a result of the U.S. presidential and congressional 
elections; 

35

 
• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

speculation in the press or investment community; 

changes in accounting principles; 

terrorist acts, acts of war or periods of widespread civil unrest; 

natural disasters and other calamities; and 

changes in general market and economic conditions. 

In addition, broad market and industry factors may negatively affect the market price of our common stock, regardless 
of  our  actual  operating  performance,  and  factors  beyond  our  control  may  cause  our  stock  price  to  decline  rapidly  and 
unexpectedly. We are exposed to the impact of any global or domestic economic disruption, including any potential impact 
of the vote by the United Kingdom to exit the European Union, commonly referred to as “Brexit.” 

In the past, securities class action litigation has often been initiated against companies following periods of volatility 
in  their  stock  price. This  type  of  litigation  could  result  in  substantial  costs  and  divert  our  management’s  attention  and 
resources, and could also require us to make substantial payments to satisfy judgments or to settle litigation. 

If  we  fail  to  maintain  effective  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  and  effective  disclosure  controls  and 
procedures, we may not be able to accurately report our financial results in a timely manner or prevent fraud, which 
may adversely affect investor confidence in our company. 

We are required to comply with the SEC’s rules implementing Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, which requires 
management to certify financial and other information in our quarterly and annual reports, and we are required to disclose 
significant changes made in our internal controls and procedures on a quarterly basis. In addition, we are required to make 
our first annual assessment of our internal control over financial reporting pursuant to Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley 
Act for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018. This assessment includes disclosure of any material weakness identified 
by our management in our internal control over financial reporting.

If we identify a material weakness in our internal control over financial reporting, we may not be able to remediate 
the material weakness identified in a timely manner or maintain all of the controls necessary to remain in compliance with 
our reporting obligations. For example, we experienced a material weakness as a private company related to our control 
environment following the Business Combination, which was the result of the fact that Eco Services had insufficient resources 
and  financial  expertise  to  effectively  carry  out  the  accounting  functions  for  its  business.   This  material  weakness  was 
remediated as of March 31, 2017 and we have no newly identified material weaknesses as of December 31, 2018. If we are 
unable to assert that our internal control over financial reporting is effective, or if our independent registered public accounting 
firm is unable to express an unqualified opinion as to the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting in 
future periods, investors may lose confidence in the accuracy and completeness of our financial reports, the market price 
of our common stock could be negatively affected, and we could become subject to investigations by the New York Stock 
Exchange, on which our securities are listed, the SEC or other regulatory authorities, which could require additional financial 
and management resources.

Your percentage ownership in us may be diluted by future issuances of capital stock, which could reduce your 

influence over matters on which stockholders vote. 

Our board of directors has the authority, without action or vote of our stockholders, to issue all or any part of our 
authorized  but  unissued  shares  of  common  stock,  including  shares  issuable  upon  exercise  of  options,  or  shares  of  our 
authorized but unissued preferred stock. Issuances of common stock or voting preferred stock would reduce your influence 
over matters on which our stockholders vote and, in the case of issuances of preferred stock, would likely result in your 
interest in us being subject to the prior rights of holders of that preferred stock. 

There may be sales of a substantial amount of our common stock by our current stockholders, and these sales could 

cause the price of our common stock to fall. 

As of December 31, 2018, there were 135,592,045 shares of our common stock outstanding. Approximately 45.7%

and 22.3% of our outstanding common stock is held by affiliates of CCMP and by INEOS, respectively. 

Sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market, or the perception that such sales will occur, 
could adversely affect the market price of our common stock and make it difficult for us to raise funds through securities 
offerings in the future. 

36

Investment funds affiliated with CCMP may require us to register shares of our common stock held by them for resale 
under the federal securities laws, subject to reduction upon the request of the underwriter of the offering, if any. Registration 
of those shares would allow the investment funds affiliated with CCMP to immediately resell their shares in the public 
market. Any such sales or anticipation thereof could cause the market price of our common stock to decline. 

In addition, we have registered shares of our common stock that are reserved for issuance under our 2016 Stock 

Incentive Plan and 2017 Omnibus Incentive Plan.

Provisions  in  our  charter  documents  and  Delaware  law  may  deter  takeover  efforts  that  may  be  beneficial  to 

stockholder value. 

In addition to investment funds affiliated with CCMP’s and INEOS’s beneficial ownership of a substantial percentage 
of our common stock, provisions in our certificate of incorporation and bylaws and Delaware law could make it harder for 
a third party to acquire us, even if doing so might be beneficial to our stockholders. These provisions include a classified 
board of directors and the ability of our board of directors to issue preferred stock without stockholder approval that could 
be used to dilute a potential hostile acquiror. Our certificate of incorporation imposes some restrictions on mergers and other 
business combinations between us and any holder of 15% or more of our outstanding common stock other than INEOS and 
investment funds affiliated with CCMP. As a result, you may lose your ability to sell your stock for a price in excess of the 
prevailing market price due to these protective measures, and efforts by stockholders to change the direction or management 
of the company may be unsuccessful.

Our certificate of incorporation designates courts in the State of Delaware as the sole and exclusive forum for 
certain types of actions and proceedings that may be initiated by our stockholders, which could limit our stockholders’ 
ability to obtain a favorable judicial forum for disputes with us or our directors, officers or employees. 

Our certificate of incorporation provides that, subject to limited exceptions, the Court of Chancery of the State of 

Delaware is the sole and exclusive forum for: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

any derivative action or proceeding brought on our behalf; 

any action asserting a claim of breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any of our directors, officers or other employees 
to us or our stockholders; 

any action asserting a claim against us arising pursuant to any provision of the General Corporation Law of the 
State of Delaware, our certificate of incorporation or our bylaws; 

any action to interpret, apply, enforce or determine the validity of our certificate of incorporation or bylaws; or 

any other action asserting a claim against us that is governed by the internal affairs doctrine (each, a “Covered 
Proceeding”). 

In  addition,  our  certificate  of  incorporation  provides  that  if  any  action  the  subject  matter  of  which  is  a  Covered 
Proceeding is filed in a court other than the specified Delaware courts without the approval of our board of directors (each, 
a “Foreign Action”), the claiming party will be deemed to have consented to (i) the personal jurisdiction of the specified 
Delaware courts in connection with any action brought in any such courts to enforce the exclusive forum provision described 
above and (ii) having service of process made upon such claiming party in any such enforcement action by service upon 
such claiming party’s counsel in the Foreign Action as agent for such claiming party. 

Any person or entity purchasing or otherwise acquiring any interest in shares of our capital stock shall be deemed to 
have notice of and to have consented to these provisions. These provisions may limit a stockholder’s ability to bring a claim 
in a judicial forum that it finds favorable for disputes with us or our directors, officers or other employees, which may 
discourage such lawsuits against us and our directors, officers and employees. Alternatively, if a court were to find these 
provisions of our certificate of incorporation inapplicable to, or unenforceable in respect of, one or more of the specified 
types of actions or proceedings, we may incur additional costs associated with resolving such matters in other jurisdictions, 
which could adversely affect our business and financial condition. 

Our certificate of incorporation contains a provision renouncing our interest and expectancy in certain corporate 

opportunities, which could adversely impact our business. 

Each of CCMP and INEOS, and the members of our board of directors who are affiliated with CCMP and INEOS, 
by the terms of our certificate of incorporation, are not required to offer us any corporate opportunity of which they become 

37

 
aware and can take any such corporate opportunity for themselves or offer it to other companies in which they have an 
investment. We, by the terms of our certificate of incorporation, expressly renounce any interest or expectancy in any such 
corporate opportunity to the extent permitted under applicable law, even if the opportunity is one that we or our subsidiaries 
might reasonably have pursued or had the ability or desire to pursue if granted the opportunity to do so. Our certificate of 
incorporation may not be amended to eliminate our renunciation of any such corporate opportunity arising prior to the date 
of any such amendment. 

CCMP and INEOS are in the business of making investments in companies and may from time to time acquire and 
hold interests in businesses that compete directly or indirectly with us. These potential conflicts of interest could have a 
material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects if CCMP or INEOS allocate 
attractive corporate opportunities to themselves or their affiliates instead of to us. 

Regulations related to conflict minerals could adversely impact our business. 

The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 contains provisions to improve transparency 
and accountability concerning the supply of certain minerals, known as conflict minerals, originating from the Democratic 
Republic of Congo (the “DRC”) and adjoining countries. The SEC requires annual disclosure and reporting requirements 
for those companies who use conflict minerals mined from the DRC and adjoining countries in their products. There will 
be costs associated with complying with these disclosure requirements, including for diligence to determine the sources of 
conflict minerals used in our products and other potential changes to products, processes or sources of supply as a consequence 
of such verification activities. These rules could adversely affect the sourcing, supply and pricing of materials used in our 
products. As there may be only a limited number of suppliers offering “conflict free” conflict minerals, we cannot be sure 
that we will be able to obtain necessary conflict minerals from such suppliers in sufficient quantities or at competitive prices. 

Because we have no current plans to pay cash dividends on our common stock for the foreseeable future, you may 
not receive any return on investment unless you sell your common stock for a price greater than that which you paid 
for it. 

We may retain future earnings, if any, for future operations, expansion and debt repayment and have no current plans 
to pay any cash dividends for the foreseeable future. Any decision to declare and pay dividends in the future will be made 
at the discretion of our board of directors and will depend on, among other things, our results of operations, financial 
condition, cash requirements, contractual restrictions and other factors that our board of directors may deem relevant. In 
addition, our ability to pay dividends may be limited by covenants of any existing and future outstanding indebtedness we 
or our subsidiaries incur, including our credit facilities and outstanding notes. See “-Because our operations are conducted 
through our subsidiaries and joint ventures, we are dependent on the receipt of distributions and dividends or other payments 
from our subsidiaries and joint ventures for cash to fund our operations and expenses, including to make future dividend 
payments, if any.” As a result, you may not receive any return on an investment in our common stock unless you sell your 
common stock for a price greater than that which you paid for it. 

38

ITEM 1B.   UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS.

None.

ITEM 2.  

PROPERTIES.

Our operating headquarters are located in Malvern, Pennsylvania. As of December 31, 2018, we had 71 manufacturing 
facilities in 19 countries on six continents. We also had 14 administrative facilities and six research and development facilities 
located in 13 countries. Our joint ventures operated out of seven facilities located in six countries, including six manufacturing 
facilities. We also own or lease other properties, including office buildings, warehouses, testing facilities and sales offices. 

The table below presents summary information regarding our principal facilities as of December 31, 2018. 

Approximate
Square Feet

Owned or 
leased

PM&C

EC&S

Principal Use or Key End Uses
Served

Location

Administrative facilities:

Amersfoort, Netherlands

Lenexa, Kansas, United States

Malvern, Pennsylvania, United States

Research and development facilities:

Toronto, Canada

St. Pourcain-sur-Sioule, France

Eijsden, Netherlands

Warrington, United Kingdom

Conshohocken, Pennsylvania, United States

Barcelona, Spain

Manufacturing facilities:

4,176

14,489

33,000

Leased

Leased

Leased

1,300

Leased

30,916

4,306

14,155

74,968

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

20,548

Leased

Melbourne-Dandenong, Australia

59,599

Owned

Jacana, Brazil

Rio Claro, Brazil

Toronto, Canada

Lamotte, France

Wurzen, Germany

Pasuruan, Indonesia

Guadalajara, Mexico

Tlalnepantla, Mexico

Eijsden, Netherlands

43,753

193,750

75,471

130,567

Owned

Owned

Owned

Leased

124,915

Owned

68,489

105,866

Owned

Owned

136,209

Owned

165,850

Owned/
Leased(1)

Maastricht, Netherlands

70,073

Leased

Winschoten, Netherlands

Delfzijl, Netherlands

Bangkok, Thailand

134,548

38,373

12,056

Leased
Leased(2)

Owned

Warrington, United Kingdom

Augusta, Georgia, United States (Plant 500)

Baton Rouge, Louisiana, United States

Baytown, Texas, United States

371,063

121,502

13,503,600

348,480

Owned

Leased

Owned

Owned

39

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

Administrative

Administrative

Administrative

Research and Development

Research and Development; Highway
Safety & Construction

Research and Development

Research and Development

Research and Development

Research and Development, Highway
Safety & Construction

Highway Safety & Construction and
Consumer Products

Consumer Products and Industrial &
Process Chemicals

Highway Safety & Construction and
Industrial & Process Chemicals

Industrial & Process Chemicals

Industrial & Process Chemicals and
Natural Resources

X

Consumer Products and Packaging &
Engineered Plastics

Industrial & Process Chemicals

Industrial & Process Chemicals and
Consumer Products

Consumer Products and Industrial &
Process Chemicals

Consumer Products and Industrial &
Process Chemicals

Packaging & Engineered Plastics and
Industrial & Process Chemicals

X

Fuels and Emission Controls

Highway Safety & Construction

Consumer Products, Packaging &
Engineered Plastics and Highway &
Safety Construction

Highway Safety & Construction

Fuels & Emission Controls

Fuels & Emission Controls

X

X

X

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brownwood, Texas, United States

107,900

Owned

Chester, Pennsylvania, United States

Dominguez, California, United States

Gurnee, Illinois, United States

Joliet, Illinois, United States

Hammond, Indiana, United States

Houston, Texas, United States

Kansas City, Kansas, United States

Martinez, California, United States

Muscatine, Iowa, United States

Rahway, New Jersey, United States

Paris, Texas, United States

Portland, Oregon, United States

Potsdam, New York, United States

172,707

1,437,480

96,000

168,657

1,132,560

2,003,760

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

220,679

Owned(3)

5,096,520

105,072

124,035

147,158

1,176,120

88,798

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

St. Louis, Missouri, United States

44,034

Owned

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

Highway Safety & Construction and
Packaging & Engineered Plastics

Industrial & Process Chemicals and
Packaging & Engineered Plastics

X

Fuels & Emission Controls

X

X

X

X

Industrial & Process Chemicals

Highway Safety & Construction and
Consumer Products

Fuels & Emission Controls

Fuels & Emission Controls

Fuels & Emission Controls and
Packaging & Engineered Plastics

Fuels & Emission Controls

Highway Safety & Construction

Consumer Products and Industrial &
Process Chemicals

Highway Safety & Construction

X

Fuels & Emission Controls

Highway Safety & Construction

Production for Consumer Products and
Highway & Safety Construction

(1)  Approximately 89,911 square feet is owned and approximately 75,939 square feet is leased.

(2) 

The facility is used by our Zeolyst Joint Venture under a ground lease that we entered into with a third party.

(3)  We lease a portion of the site to our Zeolyst Joint Venture.

ITEM 3.   LEGAL PROCEEDINGS.

From time to time we may be subject to various legal claims and proceedings incidental to the normal conduct of 
business, relating to such matters as personal injury, product liability and warranty claims, waste disposal practices, release 
of chemicals into the environment and other matters that may arise in the ordinary course of our business. We currently 
believe that there is no litigation pending that is likely to have a material adverse effect on our business. Regardless of the 
outcome,  legal  proceedings  can  have  an  adverse  impact  on  us  because  of  defense  and  settlement  costs,  diversion  of 
management resources and other factors. 

ITEM 4.   MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES.

Not applicable.

40

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PART II

ITEM 5.   MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS 

AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES.

Market Information, Holders and Dividends

Our common stock began trading on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) under the symbol “PQG” on September 
29, 2017. As of February 25, 2019, there were 111 shareholders of record of our common stock. A substantially greater 
number of holders of our common stock hold their shares in “street name” through banks, brokers and other financial 
institutions.

We have not and do not currently intend to pay regular dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future. The 
declaration and payment of any future dividends by our Board of Directors is subject to compliance with the covenants 
contained in the agreements governing our credit facilities, the indentures governing our outstanding notes, applicable law 
and  other  considerations.  See  Note  16  to  our  consolidated  financial  statements  included  in  this  Form  10-K  for  details 
regarding covenant restrictions on the payment of dividends under our debt agreements.

Stock Performance Graph

The graph below shows the cumulative total shareholder return of our common stock for the period from September 
29, 2017 to December 31, 2018 as compared to the cumulative total return of the Russell 2000 Total Return Index and the 
S&P 1500 Specialty Chemicals Index, assuming an investment of $100 made at the respective closing prices on September 
29, 2017. The information contained in the graph below is furnished and therefore not to be considered “filed” with the 
SEC, and is not incorporated by reference into any document that incorporates this Form 10-K by reference.

9/29/2017

12/31/2017

12/31/2018

PQG

Russell 2000

$

SP 1500 Spec Chem

$

100

100

100

41

95

$

103

106

86

92

99

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Tax Withholdings

The following table contains information about shares of common stock delivered to the Company by employees to 
satisfy withholding tax obligations of the employees in connection with the vesting of restricted stock awards and restricted 
stock units during the fourth quarter of 2018.

October 2018

November 2018

December 2018

Total

Total Number of
Shares of Common
Stock Purchased

Average Price
Paid per Share of
Common Stock

116,740

$

— $

6,376

$

123,116

17.68

—

13.80

Total Number of
Shares of Common Stock
Purchased as Part of
Publicly Announced
Plan or Programs
N/A

N/A

N/A

Maximum Number
(or Dollar Value) of
Shares of Common Stock
that May Yet Be
Purchased Under the
Plans or Programs
N/A

N/A

N/A

42

ITEM 6.  

SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA.

Selected financial data for the Company is presented in the following table and should be read in conjunction with  
“Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” included in Item 7 and our 
consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included in this Form 10-K. Selected financial data has been 
derived from our audited consolidated financial statements. Historical results are not necessarily indicative of the results to 
be expected for future periods.

Legacy Eco operated as a business unit of Solvay until the acquisition of substantially all of the assets of Solvay’s 
Eco Services business unit by Eco Services on December 1, 2014, and therefore, the financial statements of legacy Eco 
contained in this Form 10-K for periods prior to such acquisition are not necessarily indicative of what legacy Eco’s financial 
position, results of operations and cash flows would have been had legacy Eco operated as a separate, standalone entity 
independent of Solvay. Accordingly, references to “Predecessor” include the period from January 1, 2014 to November 30, 
2014. For 2014, the results include 11 months of legacy Eco operating activity (January 1, 2014 to November 30, 2014) 
and include amounts that have been “carved out” from Solvay’s financial statements using assumptions and allocations 
made by Solvay to reflect Solvay’s Eco Services business unit on a stand-alone basis. References to “Successor” refer to 
the period from inception of Eco Services (July 30, 2014) to December 31, 2014, but only include one month of legacy Eco 
operating activity (December 1, 2014 to December 31, 2014), because there was no operating activity for the period from 
inception (July 30, 2014) to November 30, 2014, and reflects legacy Eco on a stand-alone basis.

In addition to the analysis of historical results of operations, we have prepared unaudited supplemental pro forma 
results of operations for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015. The unaudited pro forma statements of operations 
reflect pro forma adjustments to the results of PQ Group Holdings to give effect to the Business Combination and the related 
financing transactions as if they had occurred on January 1, 2015. The unaudited pro forma adjustments include: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

elimination of intercompany sales between legacy PQ and legacy Eco; 

adjustments to depreciation expense related to the step-up in fair value of property, plant and equipment; 

adjustments to amortization expense related to the step-up in fair value of definite-lived intangible assets; 

removal of non-recurring adjustments related to the step-up in the fair value of inventory; 

adjustments to stock compensation expense to reflect charges as they relate to our new capital structure; 

adjustments related to the amortization of the step-up in fair value of property, plant, equipment and definite-
lived intangible assets related to our Zeolyst Joint Venture; 

adjustments to interest expense related to the senior secured term loan facility; 

adjustments related to the write-off of existing deferred financing fees, original issue discounts and prepayment 
penalties; and 

the tax effect of the aforementioned adjustments, including the effect related to the change in tax status of Eco 
Services from a limited liability company to a C-corporation. 

The unaudited pro forma statements of operations have been prepared in accordance with Article 11 of Regulation S-
X by combining the historical results of operations of legacy Eco and legacy PQ for the periods prior to May 4, 2016 and 
should  be  read  in  conjunction  with  our  historical  consolidated  financial  statements  and  related  notes  thereto  included 
elsewhere in this Form 10-K. 

The  unaudited  pro  forma  statements  of  operations  have  been  prepared  for  illustrative  purposes  only  and  are  not 
necessarily indicative of the combined results of operations that would have been realized had the pro forma transactions 
been completed as of the dates indicated, nor are they meant to be indicative of any anticipated future results of operations. 
The  unaudited  pro  forma  adjustments  are  based  upon  available  information  and  assumptions  we  believe  are  factually 
supportable, directly attributable to the Business Combination and the related financing transactions, and with respect to 
the statement of operations, expected to have a continuing impact on our business, and that we believe are reasonable under 
the circumstances. In addition, the unaudited pro forma statements of operations do not include any pro forma adjustments 
to reflect expected cost savings or restructuring actions which may be achievable or the impact of any non-recurring activity 
and transaction-related costs. 

We believe that the unaudited pro forma statements of operations are a useful presentation of our results of operations 

as they provide comparative information, period-over-period, on a more comparable basis.

43

Net (loss) income

attributable to PQ
Group Holdings Inc.

Net income (loss) per

share:

Basic income (loss) per

share

Diluted income (loss) per

share

Weighted average shares

outstanding:

Historical

Year ended
December 31,

Pro Forma

Year ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

2015

2016

2015

Successor

Predecessor

Period from
inception
(July 30, 
2014) to
December 31, 
2014

Period
from
January 1, 
2014 to 
November 
30, 2014

(In thousands, except per

share data)

Operating Results:

Sales

$

1,608,154

$

1,472,101

$

1,064,177

$

388,875

$ 1,403,041

$ 1,413,201

$

35,539

$

361,823

Net (loss) income

59,621

58,563

(79,158)

11,427

(57,707)

(25,171)

(22,061)

30,545

$

58,300

$

57,603

$

(79,746)

$

11,427

$

(58,932)

$

(26,942)

$

(22,061)

$

30,545

—

—

—

—

$

$

0.44

0.43

$

$

0.52

0.52

$

$

(1.02)

(1.02)

$

$

0.51

0.51

$

$

— $

— $

(0.99)

— $

— $

(0.99)

$

$

Basic

Diluted

133,380,567

111,299,670

78,016,005

22,615,787

134,684,931

111,669,037

78,016,005

22,615,787

—

—

—

—

22,390,231

22,390,231

Year ended December 31,

2018

2017

2016

2015

Successor

Predecessor

Period 
from
inception
(July 30, 
2014) to
December 
31, 2014

Period
from
January 1,
2014 to
November
30, 2014

(In thousands)

Financial Position and Other Data:

Cash and cash equivalents

$

57,854

$

66,195

$

70,742

$

25,155

$

22,627

$

Property, plant and equipment, net

1,208,979

1,230,384

1,181,388

481,073

472,156

Total assets

4,327,425

4,415,455

4,259,671

1,007,636

1,025,094

Total debt, including current portion

2,113,957

2,230,486

2,562,198

Total stockholders' equity

1,664,145

1,631,919

1,027,944

673,101

235,293

675,254

217,824

—

—

—

—

—

Cash flows data:

Net cash provided by (used in):

Operating activities

Investing activities

Financing activities

$

248,644

$

165,173

$

122,708

$

44,715

$

(2,057)

$

57,593

(119,290)

(195,982)

(1,915,763)

(38,725)

(888,347)

(137,225)

19,833

1,858,445

(3,462)

913,031

(32,852)

(24,741)

44

ITEM 7.   MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS 

OF OPERATIONS.

Overview 

We are a global provider of specialty catalysts, materials, chemicals, and services with leading supply positions across 
our portfolio. We compete in the global specialty chemicals and materials industry where we seek to focus on attractive, 
high-growth applications. Our products and services provide critical performance to our customers’ products and we are 
able to offer many of our customers regionally sourced materials to reduce costs and improve delivery logistics. We provide 
our customers with a combination of product technology and applications knowledge, global supply chain capabilities, and 
local production and logistical support.

We conduct operations through two reporting segments: (1) Environmental Catalysts and Services, and (2) Performance 
Materials  and  Chemicals.  Our  Environmental  Catalysts  and  Services  business  consists  of  three  product  groups:  silica 
catalysts, zeolite catalysts, and refining services. Our Environmental Catalysts and Services business is a leading global 
innovator and producer of catalysts for the refinery, emissions control, and petrochemical industries and is also a leading 
provider of catalyst recycling services to the North American refining industry. We believe our products are critical for our 
customers in these growing applications and impart essential functionality in chemical and refining production processes 
and in emission control for engines. Our Performance Materials and Chemicals business consists of two product groups: 
performance chemicals and performance materials. Our Performance Materials and Chemicals business is a silicates and 
specialty materials producer with leading supply positions for the majority of our products sold in North America, Europe, 
South America, Australia and Asia, except China, serving diverse and growing end uses such as personal and industrial 
cleaning products, highway beads, fuel efficient tires (“green tires”), surface coatings, and food and beverage. Our products 
are essential additives, ingredients, and precursors that are critical to the performance characteristics of our customers’ 
products, yet typically represent only a small portion of our customers’ overall end-product costs. In 2018, we served over 
4,000 customers globally across many end uses and, as of December 31, 2018, operated out of 71 manufacturing facilities, 
which are strategically located across six continents. 

On February 21, 2019, we announced that we will change the structure of our internal organization to create four 
independent businesses in order to promote increased visibility to business unit performance, optimize the Company’s 
product portfolio and create efficiencies. The reorganization, which will be effective as of March 1, 2019, will lead to the 
recognition of four reportable segments as follows:

•  Catalyst (including the Zeolyst Joint Venture)

•  Performance Chemicals

•  Performance Materials

•  Refining Services

Beginning with the quarter ending March 31, 2019, the segment results and disclosures will reflect the new segment 

structure for all periods presented.

Basis of Presentation

In accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”), legacy Eco was the 
accounting acquirer in the Business Combination and, as such, legacy Eco is treated as our predecessor. Investment funds 
affiliated with CCMP held a controlling interest in legacy Eco and a non-controlling interest in legacy PQ prior to the 
Business Combination. 

The following table summarizes, for each of the periods specified below and for which financial information is included 
for PQ Group Holdings in this Form 10-K, the portion, if any, of the financial results of legacy PQ and legacy Eco that is 
included in the financial results for such periods presented in accordance with GAAP. 

45

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

Operations of legacy Eco

Included

Included

Included

Operations of legacy PQ

Included

Included

Partially included
(May 4 to
December 31)

Our zeolite catalysts product group operates through our Zeolyst Joint Venture, which we account for as an equity 
method investment in accordance with GAAP.  We do not record sales by our Zeolyst Joint Venture as revenue and such 
sales are not consolidated within our results of operations.  However, Adjusted EBITDA reflects our share of the earnings 
of our Zeolyst Joint Venture that have been recorded as equity in net income from affiliated companies in our consolidated 
statements of operations and includes Zeolyst Joint Venture adjustments on a proportionate basis based on our 50% ownership 
interest.

Key Performance Indicators 

Adjusted EBITDA and Adjusted Net Income

Adjusted EBITDA and adjusted net income are financial measures that are not prepared in accordance with GAAP 
and that we use to evaluate our operating performance, for business planning purposes and to measure our performance 
relative to that of our competitors. Adjusted EBITDA and adjusted net income are presented as key performance indicators 
as we believe these financial measures will enhance a prospective investor’s understanding of our results of operations and 
financial  condition.  EBITDA  consists  of  net  income  (loss)  attributable  to  PQ  Group  Holdings  before  interest,  taxes, 
depreciation and amortization. Adjusted EBITDA consists of EBITDA adjusted for (i) non-operating income or expense, 
(ii) the impact of certain non-cash, nonrecurring or other items included in net income (loss) and EBITDA that we do not 
consider indicative of our ongoing operating performance, and (iii) depreciation, amortization and interest of our 50% share 
of our Zeolyst Joint Venture. Adjusted net income consists of net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings adjusted 
for (i) non-operating income or expense and (ii) the impact of certain non-cash, nonrecurring or other items included in net 
income (loss) that we do not consider indicative of our ongoing operating performance. We believe that these non-GAAP 
financial measures provide investors with useful financial metrics to assess our operating performance from period-to-
period by excluding certain items that we believe are not representative of our core business. 

You should not consider adjusted EBITDA or adjusted net income in isolation or as alternatives to the presentation 
of our financial results in accordance with GAAP. The presentation of our adjusted EBITDA and adjusted net income 
financial measures may differ from similar measures reported by other companies and may not be comparable to other 
similarly titled measures. In evaluating adjusted EBITDA and adjusted net income, you should be aware that we are likely 
to incur expenses similar to those eliminated in this presentation in the future and that certain of these items could be 
considered recurring in nature. Our presentation of adjusted EBITDA and adjusted net income should not be construed as 
an inference that our future results will be unaffected by unusual or nonrecurring items. Reconciliations of adjusted EBITDA 
and adjusted net income to GAAP net income (loss) are included in the results of operations discussion that follows for 
each of the respective periods.

Key Factors and Trends Affecting Operating Results and Financial Condition 

Sales 

Our Environmental Catalysts and Services sales have grown primarily due to expansion into new end applications, 
including emission control catalysts, polymer catalysts, and refining catalysts, as well as continued supply share gains. Sales 
in our Environmental Catalysts and Services segment are made on both a purchase order basis and pursuant to long-term 
contracts. 

Historically,  our  Performance  Materials  and  Chemicals  business  has  experienced  relatively  stable  demand  both 
seasonally and throughout economic cycles, due to the diverse consumer and industrial end uses that our products serve. 
Expansions into new applications, including personal care and consumer cleaning, as well as share gains in existing end 

46

uses, have added to our sales growth. Product sales from our performance chemicals product group are made on both a 
purchase order basis and pursuant to long-term contracts. In the performance materials product group, sales have been 
driven by the growth of spending on repair, maintenance and upgrade of existing highways and the construction of new 
highways and roads by governments around the world. Product sales in our performance materials product group are made 
principally on a purchase order basis. There may be modest fluctuations in timing of orders, but orders are mainly driven 
by demand and general economic conditions. 

Cost of Goods Sold 

Cost of goods sold consists of variable product costs, fixed manufacturing expenses, depreciation expense and freight 
expenses. Variable  product  costs  include  all  raw  materials,  energy  and  packaging  costs  that  are  directly  related  to  the 
manufacturing process. Fixed manufacturing expenses include all plant employment costs, manufacturing overhead and 
periodic maintenance costs. The primary raw materials for our Environmental Catalysts and Services business include spent 
sulfuric acid, sulfur, sodium silicates, acids, bases, and certain metals. Most of our refining services contracts feature take-
or-pay volume protection and/or quarterly price adjustments for commodity inputs, labor, the Chemical Engineering Index 
(U.S. chemical plant construction cost index) and natural gas. Spent acid for our refining services product group is supplied 
by customers for a nominal charge as part of their contracts. Over 80% of our refining services product group sales for the 
year ended December 31, 2018 were under contracts featuring quarterly price adjustments. The price adjustments generally 
reflect actual costs for producing acid and tend to protect us from volatility in labor, fixed costs and raw material pricing.  

The primary raw materials used in the manufacture of products in our Performance Materials and Chemicals business 
include soda ash, industrial sand, aluminum trihydrate, sodium hydroxide (also known as “caustic soda”), and cullet. For 
the year ended December 31, 2018, approximately 40% of our North American silicate sales, which is a significant portion 
of our performance chemicals product group sales, were derived from contracts that included raw material pass-through 
clauses. Under these contracts, there generally is a time lag of three to nine months for price changes to pass through, 
depending on the magnitude of the change in cost and other market dynamics. Freight expenses are generally passed through 
directly to customers. 

While natural gas is not a direct feedstock for any product, all businesses use natural gas powered furnaces to heat 
raw materials and create the chemical reactions necessary to produce end-products. We maintain multiple suppliers wherever 
possible, hedge exposure to fluctuations in prices for natural gas purchases in the United States, make forward purchases 
of natural gas in the United States, Canada, and Europe to mitigate our exposure to price volatility, and structure our customer 
contracts when possible to allow for the pass-through of raw material and natural gas costs. 

Joint Ventures 

We account for our investments in our equity joint ventures under the equity method. Our largest joint venture, the 
Zeolyst Joint Venture, manufactures high performance, specialty, zeolite-based catalysts for use in the emission control 
industry,  the  petrochemical  industry  and  other  areas  of  the  broader  chemicals  industry. We  share  proportionally  in  the 
management of our joint ventures with the other parties to each such joint venture. 

Seasonality 

Seasonal changes and weather conditions typically affect our performance materials and refining services product 
groups. In particular, our performance materials product group generally experiences lower sales and profit in the first and 
fourth quarters of the year because highway striping projects typically occur during warmer weather months. Additionally,
our refining services product group typically experiences similar seasonal fluctuations as a result of higher demand for 
gasoline products in the summer months. As a result, our working capital requirements tend to be higher in the first and 
fourth quarters of the year, which can adversely affect our liquidity and cash flows. Because of this seasonality associated 
with certain of our product groups, results for any one quarter are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be 
achieved for any other quarter or for the full year. 

Foreign Currency 

As a global business, we are subject to the impact of gains and losses on currency translations, which occur when the 
financial statements of foreign operations are translated into U.S. dollars. We operate a geographically diverse business 
with approximately 40% of our sales for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 in currencies other than the U.S. 
dollar. Because our consolidated financial results are reported in U.S. dollars, sales or earnings generated in currencies other 

47

than the U.S. dollar can result in a significant increase or decrease in the amount of those sales and earnings when translated 
to U.S. dollars. The foreign currencies to which we have the most significant exchange rate exposure include the Euro, 
British pound, Canadian dollar, Brazilian real and the Mexican peso. 

Pro Forma Results of Operations 

In addition to the analysis of historical results of operations, we have prepared unaudited supplemental pro forma 
results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2016. The unaudited pro forma statement of operations reflects pro 
forma adjustments to the results of PQ Group Holdings to give effect to the Business Combination and the related financing 
transactions as if they had occurred on January 1, 2015. The unaudited pro forma adjustments include: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

elimination of intercompany sales between legacy PQ and legacy Eco; 

adjustments to depreciation expense related to the step-up in fair value of property, plant and equipment; 

adjustments to amortization expense related to the step-up in fair value of definite-lived intangible assets; 

removal of non-recurring adjustments related to the step-up in the fair value of inventory; 

adjustments to stock compensation expense to reflect charges as they relate to our new capital structure; 

adjustments related to the amortization of the step-up in fair value of property, plant, equipment and definite-
lived intangible assets related to our Zeolyst Joint Venture; 

adjustments to interest expense related to the senior secured term loan facility; 

adjustments related to the write-off of existing deferred financing fees, original issue discounts and prepayment 
penalties; and 

the tax effect of the aforementioned adjustments, including the effect related to the change in tax status of Eco 
Services from a limited liability company to a C-corporation. 

The unaudited pro forma statement of operations has been prepared in accordance with Article 11 of Regulation S-X 
by combining the historical results of operations of legacy Eco and legacy PQ for the periods prior to May 4, 2016 and 
should  be  read  in  conjunction  with  our  historical  consolidated  financial  statements  and  related  notes  thereto  included 
elsewhere in this Form 10-K. 

The unaudited pro forma statement of operations has been prepared for illustrative purposes only and is not necessarily 
indicative of the combined results of operations that would have been realized had the pro forma transactions been completed 
as of the dates indicated, nor are they meant to be indicative of any anticipated future results of operations. The unaudited 
pro forma adjustments are based upon available information and assumptions we believe are factually supportable, directly 
attributable  to  the  Business  Combination  and  the  related  financing  transactions,  and  with  respect  to  the  statement  of 
operations, expected to have a continuing impact on our business, and that we believe are reasonable under the circumstances. 
In addition, the unaudited pro forma statement of operations does not include any pro forma adjustments to reflect expected 
cost savings or restructuring actions which may be achievable or the impact of any nonrecurring activity and transaction-
related costs. 

We believe that the unaudited pro forma statement of operations is a useful presentation of our results of operations 

as it provides comparative information, period-over-period, on a more comparable basis.

48

Results of Operations 

Year Ended December 31, 2018 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2017

Highlights 

The following is a summary of our financial performance for the year ended December 31, 2018 compared with the 

year ended December 31, 2017.

Sales 

•   Sales increased $136.1 million to $1,608.2 million. The increase in sales was primarily due to increased volumes 

and higher average customer prices and favorable mix for the year ended December 31, 2018.

Gross Profit 

•   Gross profit increased $4.9 million to $381.7 million. Our increase in gross profit was primarily due to higher 
pricing, increased volumes and the earnings contributed by the Sovitec acquisition, which were partially offset 
by higher manufacturing costs and the unfavorable impact on our product mix due to increased sales of lower-
margin goods for the year ended December 31, 2018.

Operating Income 

•  Operating income increased by $17.7 million to $183.6 million. Our increase in operating income was primarily 
due  to  an  increase  in  gross  profit,  as  noted  above,  and  the  favorable  impact  related  to  a  long-term  contract 
termination, which was partially offset by increased public-company costs for the year ended December 31, 
2018.

Equity in Net Income of Affiliated Companies 

•  Equity in net income of affiliated companies for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $37.6 million, compared 
with net income of $38.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease was due to lower earnings 
of $3.4 million generated by our Zeolyst Joint Venture during the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared 
to the year ended December 31, 2017 and $2.0 million of lower amortization on the fair value step-up of the 
underlying assets of our Zeolyst Joint Venture, which was a result of the Business Combination.

49

The following is our consolidated statements of operations and a summary of financial results for the years ended 

December 31, 2018 and 2017. 

Years ended
December 31,

Change

2018

2017

$

%

Sales

Cost of goods sold

Gross profit
Gross profit margin

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Other operating expense, net

Operating income
Operating income margin

Equity in net (income) from affiliated companies

Interest expense, net

Debt extinguishment costs

Other expense, net

Income (loss) before income taxes and noncontrolling

interest

Provision (benefit) for income taxes
Effective tax rate

Net income

Less: Net income attributable to the noncontrolling interest

Net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.

$

Sales

$ 1,608.2

(in millions, except percentages)
$ 1,472.1

136.1

$

1,226.5

1,095.3

131.2

4.9

21.9
(34.7)
17.7

1.2
(65.3)
(54.1)
(13.3)

149.2

148.2

376.8
25.6%

146.7

64.2

165.9
11.3%
(38.8)
179.0

61.9

24.4

(60.6)
(119.2)
196.6%

58.6

1.0

57.6

$

$

1.0

0.3

0.7

381.7
23.7%

168.6

29.5

183.6
11.4%
(37.6)
113.7

7.8

11.1

88.6

29.0
32.7%

59.6

1.3

58.3

9.2 %

12.0 %

1.3 %

14.9 %

(54.0)%

10.7 %

(3.1)%

(36.5)%

(87.4)%

(54.5)%

(246.2)%

(124.3)%

1.7 %

30.0 %

1.2 %

Years ended
December 31,

Change

2018

2017

$

%

(in millions, except percentages)

Sales:

Silica Catalysts

Refining Services

Environmental Catalysts & Services

Performance Chemicals

Performance Materials

Eliminations

Performance Materials & Chemicals

$

72.1

$

75.3

$

455.6

527.7

717.3

378.3
(11.8)
1,083.8

398.4

473.7

687.6

324.2
(10.0)
1,001.8

Inter-segment sales eliminations

(3.3)

(3.4)

(3.2)
57.2

54.0

29.7

54.1
(1.8)
82.0

0.1

Total sales

$

1,608.2

$

1,472.1

$

136.1

(4.2)%

14.4 %

11.4 %

4.3 %

16.7 %

18.0 %

8.2 %

(2.9)%

9.2 %

50

Environmental Catalysts & Services: Sales in Environmental Catalysts and Services for the year ended December 31, 
2018 were $527.7 million, an increase of $54.0 million, or 11.4%, compared to sales of $473.7 million for the year ended 
December 31, 2017. The increase in sales was primarily due to higher average selling price and customer mix of $28.6 
million and an increase in volumes of $25.5 million.

The higher average selling price and customer mix was driven by higher cost pass-through pricing in our virgin sulfuric 
acid product group and favorable customer pricing in our regeneration services product group. The increase in volumes was 
driven by higher customer demand within our virgin sulfuric acid, regeneration services and polyolefin catalysts product 
lines, which was partially offset by lower methyl methacrylate sales.

Performance Materials & Chemicals: Sales in Performance Materials and Chemicals for the year ended December 31, 
2018 were $1,083.8 million, an increase of $82.0 million, or 8.2%, compared to sales of $1,001.8 million for the year ended 
December 31, 2017. The increase in sales was primarily due to higher sales volumes of $49.2 million, higher average selling 
price and favorable customer mix of $31.3 million and the favorable effects of foreign currency translation of $1.5 million.

The integration of Sovitec into our existing European operations, growth in North American highway safety product 
sales and higher sodium silicate industrial demand more than offset a decline in consumer product sales. Higher average 
selling prices were principally a result of favorable cost pass-through pricing and price increases in certain product lines. 
The favorable effects of foreign currency were primarily driven by the weaker Euro and British Pound compared to the 
U.S. dollar, which were partially offset by a stronger Brazilian Real as compared to the U.S. dollar.

Gross Profit 

Gross profit for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $381.7 million, an increase of $4.9 million, or 1.3%, compared 
with $376.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The increase in gross profit was due to favorable customer 
pricing of $59.9 million, higher volumes of $36.7 million and favorable foreign currency translation of $1.1 million, which 
was offset by unfavorable manufacturing costs of $78.4 million, unfavorable product mix of $12.4 million and higher 
depreciation expense of $2.0 million.

Increased customer demand within our virgin sulfuric acid and regeneration services product groups, the integration 
of Sovitec into our existing European operations and higher sodium silicate industrial sales volumes more than offset a 
decline in sales related to the timing of customer orders in the methyl methacrylate market and slower sales in our consumer 
products group. The unfavorable change in manufacturing costs was driven by higher raw material costs, some of which 
are passed through in price, increased shipping and handling costs and the timing of plant maintenance costs incurred during 
the year ended December 31, 2018. The unfavorable change in manufacturing costs was partially offset by lower highway 
product group start-up costs, which were incurred during the year ended December 31, 2017. Unfavorable product mix was 
driven by increased volumes of lower-margin products.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses 

Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended December 31, 2018 were $168.6 million, an increase
of $21.9 million, or 14.9%, compared with $146.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The increase in selling, 
general and administrative expenses was due to higher compensation related expenses due to an increase in employee 
headcount, higher stock compensation expense of $10.7 million related to awards issued in conjunction with our IPO and 
increased professional fees.

Other Operating Expense, Net 

Other operating expense, net for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $29.5 million, a decrease of $34.7 million, 
or 54.0%, compared with $64.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease in other operating expense, 
net was due to gains recognized in the year ended December 31, 2018 on the termination of a customer supply contract of 
$20.6 million and insurance recoveries totaling $6.5 million related to losses sustained as a result of Hurricane Harvey in 
August 2017 (of which $5.5 million was recorded in other operating expense, net), and higher expenses in the year ended 
December 31, 2017 related to severance and restructuring costs for a plant reduction in force, legal and professional fees 
related to our IPO, management advisory fees for agreements that terminated as a result of our IPO and transaction-related 
costs for our June 2017 acquisition of Sovitec. Partially offsetting the decrease in other operating expense, net was an 
increase in amortization expense related to the intangible assets identified as part of the Sovitec acquisition.

51

Equity in Net Income of Affiliated Companies 

Equity in net income of affiliated companies for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $37.6 million, a decrease of 
$1.2 million, compared with income of $38.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease was primarily 
due  to  $42.9  million  of  earnings  generated  by  our  Zeolyst  Joint Venture  during  the  year  ended  December 31,  2018  as 
compared to $46.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 which was a result of higher manufacturing costs, offset 
by increased sales of higher-margin products, and $2.0 million of lower amortization expense on the fair value step-up of 
the underlying assets of our Zeolyst Joint Venture, which was a result of the Business Combination. 

Interest Expense, Net 

Interest  expense,  net  for  the  year  ended  December 31,  2018  was  $113.7  million,  a  decrease  of  $65.3  million,  as 
compared with $179.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease in interest expense was due to lower 
average debt balances, mainly as a result of the repayment of outstanding debt with the proceeds from our IPO in October 
2017, and reduction in interest rates related to our refinancing efforts completed during the year ended December 31, 2017
and first quarter of 2018.

Debt Extinguishment Costs 

Debt extinguishment costs for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 were $7.8 million and $61.9 million, 

respectively. 

During the year ended December 31, 2018, we prepaid $100.0 million of outstanding principal balance on the New 
Term  Loan  Facility  (as  defined  below).  In  connection  with  this  prepayment,  we  wrote  off  $0.6  million  of  previously 
unamortized deferred financing costs and original issue discount of $1.3 million as debt extinguishment costs.

On February 8, 2018 we refinanced our existing senior secured term loan facility with a new $1,267.0 million senior 
secured term loan facility to reduce the applicable interest rates. We recorded $2.1 million of new creditor and third-party 
financing fees as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, previously unamortized deferred financing costs of $1.4 million
and original issue discount of $2.4 million associated with the existing senior secured term loan facility were written off as 
debt extinguishment costs.

On December 11, 2017, we completed the issuance of $300.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 5.75% Senior 
Unsecured  Notes  due  2025,  which  were  used  to  repay  the  remaining  outstanding  balance  on  our  Floating  Rate  Senior 
Unsecured Notes due 2022 and 8.5% Senior Notes due 2022.  In conjunction with the issuance of the senior unsecured 
notes, we paid $14.0 million in prepayment premiums and recorded $0.4 million of new creditor and third-party financing 
fees as debt extinguishment costs.  In addition, previous unamortized deferred financing costs of $5.3 million and original 
issue discount of $1.2 million associated with the old debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs.

On October 3, 2017, we completed our IPO whereby we issued 29 million shares of our common stock at an offering 
price of $17.50 per share and used the proceeds to repay $446.2 million of our Floating Rate Senior Unsecured Notes due 
2022. In conjunction with the IPO, we paid $32.3 million in prepayment premiums and wrote off existing unamortized 
deferred financing costs of $0.7 million and original issue discount of $7.6 million as debt extinguishment costs.

On August 7, 2017, we repriced the existing U.S. dollar-denominated tranche and existing Euro-denominated tranche 
of our term loans to reduce the applicable interest rates. We recorded $0.2 million of new creditor and third-party financing 
fees as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, previous unamortized deferred financing costs of $0.1 million and original 
issue discount of $0.2 million associated with the old debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs. 

Other Expense, Net 

Other expense, net was $11.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, a favorable change of $13.3 million, 
compared with other expense, net of $24.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The change in other expense, 
net primarily consisted of $13.8 million of foreign currency losses for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to 
foreign currency losses of $25.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. 

Provision (Benefit) for Income Taxes 

The provision for income taxes for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $29.0 million compared to a $119.2 million
benefit for the year ended December 31, 2017. The effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2018 was 
32.7% compared to 196.6% for the year ended December 31, 2017. The difference between the U.S. federal statutory income 

52

tax rate and our effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2018 was mainly due to the impact of the Global 
Intangible Low Taxed Income (“GILTI”) provisions of U.S. tax reform, the effect of permanent differences related to foreign 
currency exchange gain or loss, changes in valuation allowances, higher tax rates in foreign jurisdictions as compared to 
the U.S. statutory tax rate, foreign withholding taxes and state taxes.The difference between the U.S. federal statutory income 
tax rate and our effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2017 was mainly due to the tax effects of U.S. 
tax reform which reduced the corporate tax rate, lower tax rates in foreign jurisdictions as compared to the U.S. federal tax 
rate, state taxes and foreign withholding taxes.

Net Income Attributable to PQ Group Holdings 

For the foregoing reasons and after the effect of the non-controlling interest in earnings of subsidiaries for each period 
presented, net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings was $58.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 as 
compared to net income of $57.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017.

Adjusted EBITDA

Summarized Segment Adjusted EBITDA information is shown below in the following table:

Segment Adjusted EBITDA(1):

Environmental Catalysts & Services(2)
Performance Materials & Chemicals

Total Segment Adjusted EBITDA(3)

Unallocated corporate expenses

Adjusted EBITDA

Years ended
December 31,

Change

2018

2017

$

%

(in millions, except percentages)

$

257.6

$

243.6

$

243.4

501.0
(37.0)
464.0

$

240.2

483.8
(30.5)
453.3

$

$

14.0

3.2

17.2
(6.5)
10.7

5.7%

1.3%

3.6%

21.3%

2.4%

(1)  We define Segment Adjusted EBITDA as EBITDA adjusted for certain items as noted in the reconciliation below. 
Our management evaluates the performance of our segments and allocates resources based primarily on Segment 
Adjusted EBITDA. Segment Adjusted EBITDA does not represent cash flow for periods presented and should not be 
considered as an alternative to net income as an indicator of our operating performance or as an alternative to cash 
flows as a source of liquidity. Segment Adjusted EBITDA may not be comparable with EBITDA or Adjusted EBITDA 
as defined by other companies. 

(2) 

The Adjusted EBITDA from our Zeolyst Joint Venture included in the Environmental Catalysts and Services segment 
is $56.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, which includes $42.9 million of equity in net income, excluding 
$6.6  million  of  amortization  of  investment  in  affiliate  step-up,  plus  $12.6  million  of  joint  venture  depreciation, 
amortization  and  interest.  The Adjusted  EBITDA  from  our  Zeolyst  Joint  Venture  included  in  the  Environmental 
Catalysts and Services segment is $58.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, which includes $46.3 million
of equity in net income, excluding $8.6 million of amortization of investment in affiliate step-up, plus $11.1 million
of joint venture depreciation, amortization and interest.

(3)  Our  total  Segment Adjusted  EBITDA  differs  from  our  total  consolidated Adjusted  EBITDA  due  to  unallocated 

corporate expenses. 

Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $464.0 million, an increase of $10.7 million, or 2.4%, 

compared with $453.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. 

Environmental Catalysts & Services: Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $257.6 million, 

an increase of $14.0 million, or 5.7%, compared with $243.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. 

53

The increase in Adjusted EBITDA was driven primarily by higher sales volumes within our virgin sulfuric acid and 
regeneration services product lines and insurance recoveries from Hurricane Harvey. The increase in Adjusted EBITDA 
was partially offset by lower chemical synthesis catalysts sales due to the timing of customer order patterns, increased fixed 
costs and plant maintenance costs incurred at our refining services facilities.  

Performance Materials & Chemicals: Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $243.4 million, 

an increase of $3.2 million, or 1.3%, compared with $240.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. 

The increase in Adjusted EBITDA was due to higher contribution margins from sodium silicate and North American 
highway product group sales, the integration of Sovitec into our European operations and lower restructuring costs related 
to a plant shut-down in the prior year period, which was partially offset by higher fixed costs and labor-related costs.

A reconciliation of net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings to Segment Adjusted EBITDA is as follows:

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

(in millions)

Reconciliation of net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc. to

Segment Adjusted EBITDA

Net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.

$

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

Interest expense, net

Depreciation and amortization

EBITDA

Joint venture depreciation, amortization and interest(a)
Amortization of investment in affiliate step-up(b)
Amortization of inventory step-up(c)
Debt extinguishment costs
Net loss on asset disposals(d)
Foreign currency exchange loss(e)
LIFO expense(f)
Management advisory fees(g)
Transaction and other related costs(h)
Equity-based compensation
Restructuring, integration and business optimization expenses(i)
Defined benefit plan pension cost(j)
Gain on contract termination(k)
Other(l)
Adjusted EBITDA

Unallocated corporate expenses

Segment Adjusted EBITDA

$

58.3

29.0

113.7

185.2

386.2

12.6

6.6

1.6

7.8

6.6

13.8

8.4

—

0.9

19.5

14.0
(0.8)
(20.6)
7.4

464.0

37.0

57.6
(119.2)
179.0

177.1

294.5

11.1

8.6

0.9

61.9

5.8

25.8

3.7

3.8

7.4

8.8

13.2

2.9
—

4.9

453.3

30.5

483.8

$

501.0

$

(a)  We use Adjusted EBITDA as a performance measure to evaluate our financial results. Because our Environmental 
Catalysts and Services segment includes our 50% interest in our Zeolyst Joint Venture, we include an adjustment for 
our 50% proportionate share of depreciation, amortization and interest expense of our Zeolyst Joint Venture. 

(b)  Represents the amortization of the fair value adjustments associated with the equity affiliate investment in our Zeolyst 
Joint Venture as a result of the Business Combination. We determined the fair value of the equity affiliate investment 
and the fair value step-up was then attributed to the underlying assets of our Zeolyst Joint Venture. Amortization is 

54

primarily related to the fair value adjustments associated with inventory, fixed assets and intangible assets, including 
customer relationships and technical know-how. 

(c)  As a result of the Sovitec acquisition and the Business Combination, there was a step-up in the fair value of inventory, 

which is amortized through cost of goods sold in the statement of operations. 

(d)  When asset disposals occur, we remove the impact of net gain/loss of the disposed asset because such impact primarily 

reflects the non-cash write-off of long-lived assets no longer in use. 

(e)  Reflects the exclusion of the negative or positive transaction gains and losses of foreign currency in the statement of 
operations primarily related to the Euro-denominated term loan (which was settled as part of the February 2018 term 
loan refinancing) and the non-permanent intercompany debt denominated in local currency translated to U.S. dollars.  

(f) 

Represents non-cash adjustments to the Company’s LIFO reserves for certain inventories in the U.S. that are valued 
using the LIFO method, which we believe provides a means of comparison to other companies that may not use the 
same basis of accounting for inventories. 

(g)  Reflects consulting fees paid to CCMP and affiliates of INEOS for consulting services that include certain financial 
advisory and management services. These consulting agreements were terminated upon completion of our IPO on 
October 3, 2017.  

(h)  Relates to certain transaction costs related to our IPO and the Sovitec acquisition, which are described in further detail  
in our consolidated financial statements, as well as other costs related to several transactions that are completed, 
pending or abandoned and that we believe are not representative of our ongoing business operations. 

(i) 

(j) 

Includes the impact of restructuring, integration and business optimization expenses which are incremental costs that 
are not representative of our ongoing business operations. 

Represents adjustments for defined benefit pension plan costs in our statement of operations. More than two-thirds 
of our defined benefit pension plan obligations are under defined benefit pension plans that are frozen, and the remaining 
obligations  primarily  relate  to  plans  operated  in  certain  of  our  non-U.S.  locations  that,  pursuant  to  jurisdictional 
requirements, cannot be frozen. As such, we do not view such expenses as core to our ongoing business operations.  

(k)  Represents a non-cash gain on the write-off of the remaining liability under a contractual supply arrangement. As part 
of the 2014 Acquisition, we recognized a liability as part of business combination accounting related to our obligation 
to serve a customer under a pre-existing unfavorable supply agreement. In December 2018, the customer who was 
party to the agreement closed its facility, and as a result, we were relieved from our obligation to continue to supply 
the customer on the below market contract. Because the fair value of the unfavorable contract liability was recognized 
as part of the application of business combination accounting, and since the write-off of the remaining liability was 
non-cash in nature, we believe this gain is a special item that is not representative of our ongoing business operations.

(l)  Other costs consist of certain expenses that are not core to our ongoing business operations, including environmental 
remediation-related costs associated with the legacy operations of our business prior to the Business Combination, 
capital and franchise taxes, non-cash asset retirement obligation accretion and the initial implementation of procedures 
to comply with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. Included in this line-item are rounding discrepancies that may 
arise from rounding from dollars (in thousands) to dollars (in millions). 

55

 
Adjusted Net Income

Summarized adjusted net income information is shown below in the following table:

Reconciliation of net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc. to 

Adjusted Net Income (1)(2)

Net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.
Amortization of investment in affiliate step-up(b)
Amortization of inventory step-up(c)
Debt extinguishment costs
Net loss on asset disposals(d)
Foreign currency exchange loss(e)
LIFO expense(f)
Management advisory fees(g)
Transaction related costs(h)
Equity-based compensation
Restructuring, integration and business optimization expenses(i)
Defined benefit plan pension cost(j)
Gain on contract termination(k)
Other(l)

Adjusted Net Income, including non-cash GILTI tax and tax reform

Impact of non-cash GILTI tax(3)
Impact of tax reform(4)

Adjusted Net Income

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

(in millions)

$

58.3

$

4.2

1.0

4.9

4.1

8.2

5.3

—

0.6

14.9

8.8
(0.5)
(13.0)
4.6

101.4

21.2
(6.0)
116.6

$

$

57.6

6.5

0.6

46.4

3.9

16.1

2.8

2.8

5.6

6.6

7.6

2.0

—

5.9

164.4

—
(106.5)
57.9

(1)   We define adjusted net income as net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings adjusted for non-operating income 
or expense and the impact of certain non-cash or other items that are included in net income that we do not consider 
indicative of our ongoing operating performance. Adjusted net income is presented as a key performance indicator as 
we believe it will enhance a prospective investor’s understanding of our results of operations and financial condition. 
Adjusted net income may not be comparable with net income or adjusted net income as defined by other companies. 

(2)   Refer to the Adjusted EBITDA notes above for more information with respect to each adjustment.

(3)  Amount represents the impact to tax expense in net income before non-controlling interest and the related adjustments 
to net income associated with the GILTI provisions of the TCJA. Beginning January 1, 2018, GILTI results in taxation 
of “excess of foreign earnings,” which is defined as amounts greater than a 10% rate of return on applicable foreign 
tangible asset basis. The Company is required to record incremental tax provision impact with respect to GILTI as a 
result of having historical U.S. net operating loss (“NOL”) amounts to offset the GILTI taxable income inclusion. This 
NOL utilization precludes us from recognizing foreign tax credits (“FTCs”) which would otherwise help offset the 
tax impacts of GILTI. No FTCs will be recognized with respect to GILTI until our cumulative NOL balance has been 
exhausted. Because the GILTI provision does not impact our cash taxes (given available U.S. NOLs), and given that 
we expect to recognize FTCs to offset GILTI impacts once the NOLs are exhausted, we do not view this item as a 
component of core operations. 

(4)   Represents the adjustment for the impact of the TCJA and the rate change in the Netherlands related to the Dutch Tax 

Plan 2019 recorded in net income. 

The adjustments to net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc. are shown net of applicable statutory tax rates.

56

Historical and Pro Forma—Year Ended December 31, 2017 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2016 (the 
Pro  Forma  Discussion  Compares  the  Historical  Year  Ended  December 31,  2017  to  the  Pro  Forma  Year  Ended 
December 31, 2016)

Highlights 

The following is a summary of our financial performance for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared with the 

year ended December 31, 2016. 

Sales 

•   Historical: Sales increased $407.9 million to $1,472.1 million. The increase in sales was primarily due to the 
inclusion of $1,073.8 million of legacy PQ sales in our results of operations for the year ended December 31, 
2017 as compared to $690.5 million of legacy PQ sales included in our results of operations for the period of 
May 4, 2016 through December 31, 2016. 

•   Pro Forma: Sales increased $69.1 million to $1,472.1 million. The increase in sales was primarily due to the 
inclusion of $26.3 million of sales related to the Sovitec acquisition, increased volumes and higher average 
customer prices and favorable mix for the year ended December 31, 2017.

Gross Profit 

•   Historical: Gross profit increased $122.7 million to $376.8 million. Our increase in gross profit was primarily 
due to the inclusion of $247.5 million of legacy PQ gross profit in our results of operations for the year ended 
December 31, 2017 as compared to $142.6 million of legacy PQ gross profit included in our results of operations 
for the period of May 4, 2016 through December 31, 2016.

•   Pro Forma: Gross profit increased $10.9 million to $376.8 million. Our increase in gross profit was primarily 
due to higher pricing, increased volumes and the earnings contributed by the Sovitec acquisition, which was 
partially offset by increased depreciation and higher manufacturing costs for the year ended December 31, 2017.

Operating Income 

•  Historical: Operating income increased by $84.4 million to $165.9 million. Our increase in operating income 
was primarily due to the inclusion of $71.0 million of legacy PQ operating income in our results of operations 
for the year ended December 31, 2017 as compared to the inclusion of $18.0 million of legacy PQ operating 
income in our results of operations for the period of May 4, 2016 through December 31, 2016. 

•  Pro forma: Operating income increased by $22.7 million  to $165.9 million. Our operating income increased 
due to the Sovitec acquisition, higher margins generated by favorable customer price increases and the result of 
cost reduction measures for the year ended December 31, 2017.

Equity in Net Income of Affiliated Companies 

•  Historical: Equity in net income of affiliated companies for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $38.8 million, 
compared with a loss of $2.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase was due to an increase 
in earnings of $49.6 million generated by our Zeolyst Joint Venture during the year ended December 31, 2017
as compared to the the year ended December 31, 2016 and $27.7 million of lower amortization on the fair value 
step-up of the underlying assets of our Zeolyst Joint Venture, which was a result of the Business Combination.

•  Pro Forma: Equity in net income of affiliated companies for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $38.8 
million, compared with income of $35.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase in earnings 
generated  by  our  Zeolyst  Joint Venture  was  due  to  higher  sales  for  emission  control  and  increased  sales  of 
aromatic catalysts.

57

The following is our consolidated statements of operations and a summary of financial results, presented on a historical 
and pro forma basis, for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016. The historical results of operations include legacy 
Eco for all periods presented and legacy PQ for the year ended December 31, 2017 and the period of May 4, 2016 through 
December 31, 2016. The unaudited pro forma results of operations reflect pro forma adjustments to the results of PQ Group 
Holdings  to  give  effect  to  the  Business  Combination  and  the  related  financing  transactions  as  if  they  had  occurred  on 
January 1, 2015.

Historical

Historical

Pro Forma

Years ended
December 31,

Change

Years ended
December 31,

Change

2017

2016

$

%

2017

2016

$

%

(in millions, except percentages)

Sales

Cost of goods sold

Gross profit

$1,472.1

$1,064.2

$ 407.9

38.3 % $1,472.1

$ 1,403.0

$ 69.1

1,095.3

376.8

810.1

254.1

285.2

122.7

35.2 % 1,095.3

48.3 %

376.8

1,037.1

365.9

58.2

10.9

4.9 %

5.6 %

3.0 %

Gross profit margin

25.6%

23.9 %

25.6%

26.1%

Selling, general and

administrative expenses

Other operating expense, net

Operating income

Operating income

margin
Equity in net (income) loss

from affiliated
companies
Interest expense, net

Debt extinguishment costs

Other expense (income), net

Income (loss) before
income taxes and
noncontrolling
interest

Provision (benefit) for
income taxes
Effective tax rate

146.7

64.2

165.9

110.3

62.3

81.5

36.4

1.9

84.4

33.0 %

3.0 %

103.6 %

146.7

64.2

165.9

147.7

75.0

143.2

(1.0)

(10.8)

22.7

(0.7)%

(14.4)%

15.9 %

11.3%

7.7 %

11.3%

10.2%

(38.8)

179.0

61.9

24.4

2.6

140.3

13.8

(6.1)

(41.4)

(1,592.3)%

38.7

48.1

30.5

27.6 %

348.6 %

(500.0)%

(38.8)

179.0

61.9

24.4

(35.2)

187.9

1.8

(11.5)

(3.6)

(8.9)

60.1

35.9

10.2 %

(4.7)%

3,338.9 %

(312.2)%

(60.6)

(69.1)

8.5

(12.3)%

(60.6)

0.2

(68.0)

(30,400.0)%

(119.2)

10.0

(129.2)

(1,292.0)%

(119.2)

58.0

(177.2)

(305.5)%

196.6%

(14.5)%

196.6% 22,295.0%

Net income (loss)

58.6

(79.1)

137.7

(174.1)%

58.6

(57.8)

116.4

(201.4)%

Less: Net income

attributable to the
noncontrolling interest
Net income (loss)

attributable to PQ
Group Holdings
Inc.

1.0

0.6

0.4

66.7 %

1.0

1.2

(0.2)

(16.7)%

$

57.6

$ (79.7)

$ 137.3

(172.3)% $

57.6

$

(59.0)

$116.6

(197.6)%

58

Sales

Historical

Years ended
December 31,

Change

Historical

Pro
Forma

Years ended
December 31,

Change

2017

2016

$

%

2017

2016

$

%

(in millions, except percentages)

Sales:

Silica Catalysts

Refining Services

$

75.3

$

53.0

$

398.4

373.7

Environmental Catalysts &

Services

Performance Chemicals

Performance Materials

473.7

687.6

324.2

426.7

437.5

206.5

22.3

24.7

47.0

250.1

117.7

42.1% $

75.3

$

84.2

$

(8.9)

(10.6)%

6.6%

398.4

373.7

11.0%

473.7

57.2%

57.0%

687.6

324.2

457.9

663.9

291.3

24.7

15.8

23.7

32.9

6.6 %

3.5 %

3.6 %

11.3 %

25.0 %

Eliminations

(10.0)

(5.0)

(5.0)

100.0%

(10.0)

(8.0)

(2.0)

Performance Materials &

Chemicals

Inter-segment sales
eliminations

1,001.8

639.0

362.8

56.8% 1,001.8

947.2

54.6

5.8 %

(3.4)

(1.5)

(1.9)

126.7%

(3.4)

(2.1)

(1.3)

61.9 %

Total sales

$ 1,472.1

$ 1,064.2

$

407.9

38.3% $ 1,472.1

$ 1,403.0

$

69.1

4.9 %

Historical Sales 

Sales for the year ended December 31, 2017 were $1,472.1 million, an increase of $407.9 million, or 38.3%, compared 
to sales of $1,064.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase in sales within our Performance Materials 
and Chemicals segment was due to the inclusion of legacy PQ sales of $1,001.8 million in our results of operations for the 
year ended December 31, 2017 as compared to legacy PQ sales of $639.0 million in our results of operations for the period 
of May 4, 2016 through December 31, 2016. The increase in sales within our Environmental Catalysts and Services segment 
was due to the inclusion of legacy PQ sales of $75.3 million in our results of operations for the year ended December 31, 
2017 as compared to $53.0 million of legacy PQ sales in our results of operations for the period of May 4, 2016 through 
December 31, 2016 and an increase of $24.7 million in our refining services product group. The increase in our refining 
services product group was primarily driven by increased higher average selling price of $20.8 million and increased volumes 
of $3.9 million. The increase in average selling price was driven by the higher realization from sulfuric acid regeneration 
contract renewals and the increase in volumes was due to an increased demand for virgin sulfuric acid.

Pro Forma Sales 

Environmental Catalysts & Services: Sales in Environmental Catalysts and Services for the year ended December 31, 
2017 were $473.7 million, an increase of $15.8 million, or 3.5%, compared to sales of $457.9 million for the year ended 
December 31, 2016. The increase in sales was primarily due to higher average selling price and customer mix of $23.0 
million, which was partially offset by lower volumes of $6.9 million. 

The higher average selling price and customer mix was driven by the higher realization from sulfuric acid regeneration 
contract renewals partly offset by unfavorable virgin sulfuric acid pricing due to the mix of customers. The decrease in 
volumes was driven by lower chemical catalysts sales due to record methyl methacrylate sales volumes in the prior year 
and the impact of hurricane Harvey, which was partially offset by higher virgin sulfuric acid sales volumes due to the timing 
of our customer’s plant turnarounds.

Performance Materials & Chemicals: Sales in Performance Materials and Chemicals for the year ended December 31, 
2017 were $1,001.8 million, an increase of $54.6 million, or 5.8%, compared to sales of $947.2 million for the year ended 
December 31, 2016. The  increase in sales was primarily due to the Sovitec acquisition, which contributed $26.3 million 
in sales, favorable volumes of $14.4 million,  higher average selling price and favorable customer mix of $9.1 million and 
favorable effects of foreign currency translation of $4.8 million.

59

The increase in volumes within Performance Materials and Chemicals was primarily driven by higher sodium silicate 
industrial demand and an increased silicas demand in the personal care industry, which was partially offset by lower North 
America highway sales as well as lower conductive sales volumes due to timing of product life cycles in the electronics 
industries. The higher average selling price was principally a result of favorable U.S. dollar denominated sales and U.S. 
dollar cost pass through pricing in certain foreign locations. The stronger Euro and Brazilian Real as compared to the U.S. 
dollar favorably impacted our sales which was partially offset by a stronger U.S. dollar compared to the British Pound.  

Gross Profit 

Historical: Gross profit for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $376.8 million, an increase of $122.7 million, or 
48.3%, compared with $254.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase in gross profit was due to $247.5 
million attributable to the inclusion of legacy PQ gross profit in our results of operations for the year ended December 31, 
2017 as compared to legacy PQ gross profit of $142.6 million in our results of operations for the period of May 4, 2016 
through December 31, 2016 and an increase of $17.8 million from our refining services product group. The increase in our 
refining services gross profit was due to favorable pricing of $20.8 million and higher volumes of $2.4 million, which was 
partially offset by higher manufacturing costs of $4.4 million. 

The favorable pricing was due to higher realization from sulfuric acid regeneration contract renewals. The increase 

in volume was driven by higher virgin sulfuric acid shipments to the mining industry. 

Pro Forma: Gross profit for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $376.8 million, an increase of $10.9 million, or 
3.0%, compared with $365.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase in gross profit was due to favorable 
pricing of $28.3 million, higher volumes of $13.7 million and $7.7 million related to the Sovitec acquisition, which was 
partially offset by higher manufacturing costs of $20.3 million, higher depreciation expense of $14.1 million and unfavorable 
product mix of $5.3 million. 

The favorable average selling price was a result of higher realization from sulfuric acid regeneration customer contracts 
and the positive impact of U.S. dollar denominated sales and U.S. dollar pass through pricing in certain foreign locations, 
partially offset by unfavorable virgin sulfuric acid customer mix. The favorable increase in volumes was due to higher 
sodium  silicate  industrial  demand,  increased  cullet  demand  in  Europe  and  higher  virgin  sulfuric  acid  sales.    Higher 
manufacturing costs were primarily driven by increased costs to support the start-up of the ThermoDrop® production facility 
for which the product offering was released for sale towards the end of the second quarter of 2017, higher raw material 
costs and higher production and labor inflation costs. The unfavorable product mix is due to the effect of higher methyl 
methacrylate sales volumes through the year ended December 31, 2017. 

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses 

Historical: Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended December 31, 2017 were $146.7 million, 
an increase of $36.4 million, or 33.0%, compared with $110.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase
in selling, general and administrative expenses was due to $125.9 million attributable to the inclusion of legacy PQ selling, 
general and administrative expenses in our results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2017 as compared to 
legacy PQ selling, general and administrative expenses of $76.2 million in our results of operations for the period of May 4, 
2016 through December 31, 2016. This was partly offset by $12.0 million of lower selling, general and administrative 
expenses as a result of cost reduction initiatives within our refining services group. 

Pro Forma: Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended December 31, 2017 were $146.7 million, 

a decrease of $1.0 million, or 0.7%, compared with $147.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2016.

Other Operating Expense, Net 

Historical: Other operating expense, net for the years ended December 31, 2017 was $64.2 million, an increase of 
$1.9 million, or 3.0%, compared with $62.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. Included in other operating 
expense, net was $50.5 million attributable to the inclusion of legacy PQ other operating expense, net in our results of 
operations for the year ended December 31, 2017 as compared to legacy PQ other operating expense, net of $48.4 million
in our results of operations for the period of May 4, 2016 through December 31, 2016.

Pro Forma: Other operating expense, net for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $64.2 million, a decrease of 
$10.8 million, or 14.4%, compared with $75.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The decrease in other operating 
expense, net was due to $5.5 million of lower restructuring and severance related costs, $6.9 million of asset impairment 

60

charges incurred during the year ended December 31, 2016 and $1.7 million of lower environmental remediation charges, 
which was offset by $6.0 million of transaction costs related to our IPO and Sovitec acquisition. 

Equity in Net Income of Affiliated Companies 

Historical: Equity in net income of affiliated companies for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $38.8 million, an 
increase of $41.4 million, compared with a loss of $2.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase was 
primarily due to $46.3 million of earnings generated by our Zeolyst Joint Venture during the year ended December 31, 2017
as compared to $3.3 million for the period of May 4, 2016 through December 31, 2016 and $27.7 million of lower amortization 
expense on the fair value step-up of the underlying assets of our Zeolyst Joint Venture, which was a result of the Business 
Combination. 

Pro Forma: Equity in net income of affiliated companies for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $38.8 million, 
an increase of $3.6 million, compared with income of $35.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase 
in earnings generated by our Zeolyst Joint Venture was due to higher sales for emission control and increased sales of 
aromatic catalysts.

Interest Expense, Net 

Historical: Interest expense, net for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $179.0 million, an increase of $38.7 
million, as compared with $140.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. Interest expense increased primarily due 
to higher third-party interest expense under our debt structure compared to the legacy Eco debt structure on a stand alone 
basis. 

Pro Forma: Interest expense, net for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $179.0 million, a decrease of $8.9 million, 
as compared with $187.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The decrease in interest expense is a result of the 
repayment of high-interest rate debt as well as a reduction in interest rates due to repricing our existing debt structure.

Debt Extinguishment Costs 

Historical: Debt extinguishment costs for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016 were $61.9 million and $13.8 

million, respectively. 

On December 11, 2017, we completed the issuance of $300.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 5.75% Senior 
Unsecured  Notes  due  2025,  which  were  used  to  repay  the  remaining  outstanding  balance  on  our  Floating  Rate  Senior 
Unsecured Notes due 2022 and 8.5% Senior Notes due 2022. In conjunction with the issuance of the senior unsecured notes, 
we paid $14.0 million in prepayment premiums and recorded $0.4 million of new creditor and third-party financing fees as 
debt extinguishment costs. In addition, previous unamortized deferred financing costs of $5.3 million and original issue 
discount of $1.2 million associated with the old debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs.

On October 3, 2017, we completed our IPO whereby we issued 29 million shares of our common stock at an offering 
price of $17.50 per share and used the proceeds to repay $446.2 million of our Floating Rate Senior Unsecured Notes due 
2022. In conjunction with the IPO, we paid $32.3 million in prepayment premiums and wrote off existing unamortized 
deferred financing costs of $0.7 million and original issue discount of $7.6 million as debt extinguishment costs.

On August 7, 2017, we repriced the existing U.S. dollar-denominated tranche and existing Euro-denominated tranche 
of our term loans to reduce the applicable interest rates. We recorded $0.2 million of new creditor and third-party financing 
fees as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, previous unamortized deferred financing costs of $0.1 million and original 
issue discount of $0.2 million associated with the old debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs. 

On November 14, 2016, we repriced our existing senior secured term loan facility. We recorded $0.5 million of new 
creditor and third-party financing costs fees as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, previously unamortized deferred 
financing costs of $0.6 million and original issue discount of $0.8 million associated with the previously outstanding debt 
were written off as debt extinguishment costs.

On May 4, 2016, and concurrently with the consummation of the Business Combination, we refinanced our existing 
credit facilities. We recorded $4.7 million of new creditor and third-party financing fees as debt extinguishment costs. In 
addition, previous unamortized deferred financing costs of $6.3 million and original issue discount of $1.0 million associated 
with the old debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs. 

61

Pro Forma:  On November 14, 2016, we repriced our existing senior secured term loan facility. The company recorded 
$0.5  million  of  new  creditor  and  third-party  financing  costs  fees  as  debt  extinguishment  costs.  In  addition,  previously 
unamortized deferred financing costs of $0.6 million and original issue discount of $0.8 million associated with the previously 
outstanding debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs.

Other (Income) Expense, Net 

Historical: Other expense, net was $24.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, an unfavorable change of 
$30.5 million, compared with other income, net of $6.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The change in other 
expense, net primarily consisted of $25.8 million of foreign currency losses for the year ended December 31, 2017 as 
compared to foreign currency gains of $3.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. 

Pro Forma: Other expense, net was $24.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, an unfavorable change of 
$35.9 million, compared with other income, net of $11.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The change in 
other expense, net primarily consisted of $25.8 million of foreign currency losses for the year ended December 31, 2017
as compared to foreign currency gains of $8.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2016.

(Benefit) Provision for Income Taxes 

Historical: The benefit for income taxes for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $119.2 million compared to a 
$10.0 million provision for the year ended December 31, 2016. The effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 
2017 was 196.6% compared to (14.5)% for the year ended December 31, 2016. The difference between the U.S. federal 
statutory income tax rate and our effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2017 was mainly due to the 
tax effect of U.S. tax reform that reduced the corporate tax rate, lower tax rates in foreign jurisdictions as compared to the 
U.S. federal tax rate, state taxes and foreign withholding taxes. The difference between the U.S. federal statutory income 
tax rate and our effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2016 was mainly due to the tax effect of our 
foreign currency exchange loss recognized as a discrete item for the purposes of calculating the effective tax rate as well 
as the tax effect of repatriating foreign earnings back to the U.S. as dividends, partially offset by lower tax rates in foreign 
jurisdictions as compared to the U.S. federal tax rate, foreign withholding taxes, state taxes, non-deductible transaction 
costs, and change in tax status of legacy Eco. Prior to the Business Combination on May 4, 2016, legacy Eco was a single 
member limited liability company and taxed as a partnership for federal and state income tax purposes. As such, all income 
tax  liabilities  and/or  benefits  of  legacy  Eco  were  passed  through  to  its  members.  Because  legacy  Eco  was  taxed  as  a 
partnership, it did not record deferred taxes on the basis difference on its financial statements. Following the Business 
Combination on May 4, 2016, legacy Eco had a change in tax status and is now taxed as a C-Corporation subject to federal 
and state corporate level income taxes at prevailing corporate rates. Minimal taxes were recorded on the book losses incurred 
by legacy Eco during the periods preceding the Business Combination included in the year ended December 31, 2016, 
causing the fluctuation to the Company’s effective income tax rate in comparison to the taxes recorded for the year ended 
December 31, 2016.

Pro Forma: The benefit for income taxes for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $119.2 million compared to a 
$58.0 million provision for the year ended December 31, 2016. The effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 
2017 was 196.6% compared to 22,295.0% for the year ended December 31, 2016. The difference between the U.S. federal 
statutory income tax rate and our effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2017 was mainly due to the 
tax effect of U.S. tax reform—reducing the corporate tax rate, lower tax rates in foreign jurisdictions as compared to the 
U.S. federal tax rate, state taxes and foreign withholding taxes. The difference between the U.S. federal statutory income 
tax rate and our effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2016 was mainly due to the tax effect of our 
foreign currency exchange loss recognized as a discrete item for the purposes of calculating the effective tax rate as well 
as the tax effect of repatriating foreign earnings back to the U.S. as dividends, partially offset by lower tax rates in foreign 
jurisdictions as compared to the U.S. federal tax rate, foreign withholding taxes, state taxes, non-deductible transaction 
costs, and change in tax status of legacy Eco. Prior to the Business Combination on May 4, 2016, legacy Eco was a single 
member limited liability company and taxed as a partnership for federal and state income tax purposes. As such, all income 
tax  liabilities  and/or  benefits  of  legacy  Eco  were  passed  through  to  its  members.  Because  legacy  Eco  was  taxed  as  a 
partnership, it did not record deferred taxes on the basis difference on its financial statements. Following the Business 
Combination on May 4, 2016, legacy Eco had a change in tax status and is now taxed as a C-Corporation subject to federal 
and state corporate level income taxes at prevailing corporate rates. Minimal taxes were recorded on the book losses incurred 
by legacy Eco during the periods preceding the Business Combination included in the year ended December 31, 2016, 

62

causing the fluctuation to the Company’s effective income tax rate in comparison to the taxes recorded for the year ended 
December 31, 2016.

Net Income (Loss) Attributable to PQ Group Holdings 

Historical: For the foregoing reasons and after the effect of the non-controlling interest in earnings of subsidiaries for 
each period presented, net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings was $57.6 million for the year ended December 31, 
2017 as compared to a net loss of $79.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2016.

Pro Forma: For the foregoing reasons and after the effect of the non-controlling interest in earnings of subsidiaries 
for each period presented, net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings was $57.6 million for the year ended December 31, 
2017 as compared to a net loss of $59.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2016.

Historical and Pro Forma Adjusted EBITDA 

Summarized historical and pro forma Segment Adjusted EBITDA information is shown below in the following table:

Segment Adjusted EBITDA(1):

Environmental Catalysts & Services(2)
Performance Materials & Chemicals

Total Segment Adjusted EBITDA(3)

Unallocated corporate expenses

Adjusted EBITDA

Historical

Pro Forma

Years ended
December 31,

Change

2017

2016

$

%

(in millions, except percentages)

$

243.6

$

221.8

$

240.2

483.8
(30.5)
453.3

$

231.8

453.6
(32.8)
420.8

$

$

21.8

8.4

30.2

2.3

32.5

9.8 %

3.6 %

6.7 %

(7.0)%

7.7 %

(1)  We define Segment Adjusted EBITDA as EBITDA adjusted for certain items as noted in the reconciliation below. 
Our management evaluates the performance of our segments and allocates resources based primarily on Segment 
Adjusted EBITDA. Segment Adjusted EBITDA does not represent cash flow for periods presented and should not be 
considered as an alternative to net income as an indicator of our operating performance or as an alternative to cash 
flows as a source of liquidity. Segment Adjusted EBITDA may not be comparable with EBITDA or Adjusted EBITDA 
as defined by other companies.

(2) 

The Adjusted EBITDA from the Zeolyst Joint Venture included in the Environmental Catalysts and Services segment 
is $58.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, which includes $46.3 million of equity in net income, excluding 
$8.6  million  of  amortization  of  investment  in  affiliate  step-up  plus  $11.1  million  of  joint  venture  depreciation, 
amortization  and  interest.  The  pro  forma  Adjusted  EBITDA  from  the  Zeolyst  Joint  Venture  included  in  the 
Environmental Catalysts and Services segment is $52.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2016, which includes 
$42.3 million of equity in net income, excluding $7.3 million of amortization of investment in affiliate step-up plus 
$10.3 million of joint venture depreciation, amortization and interest.

(3)  Our  total  Segment Adjusted  EBITDA  differs  from  our  total  consolidated Adjusted  EBITDA  due  to  unallocated 

corporate expenses. 

Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $453.3 million, an increase of $32.5 million, or 7.7%, 

compared with $420.8 million on a pro forma basis for the year ended December 31, 2016. 

Environmental Catalysts & Services: Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $243.6 million, 
an increase of $21.8 million, or 9.8%, compared with $221.8 million on a pro forma basis for the year ended December 31, 
2016. 

63

The increase in Adjusted EBITDA was driven primarily by higher pricing from renegotiated regeneration services 
contracts and increased earnings generated by our Zeolyst Joint Venture due to higher sales volumes of aromatic catalyst 
and catalyst sales for emission control. 

Performance Materials & Chemicals: Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $240.2 million, 
an increase of $8.4 million, or 3.6%, compared with $231.8 million on a pro forma basis for the year ended December 31, 
2016. 

The increase in Adjusted EBITDA was due to stronger sodium silicate industrial demand and earnings from the Sovitec 

acquisition partly offset by start-up costs for the new ThermoDrop® production facility. 

A reconciliation of net income and pro forma net loss attributable to PQ Group Holdings to Segment Adjusted EBITDA 

and pro forma Segment Adjusted EBITDA is as follows: 

Historical

Pro Forma

Years ended
December 31,

2017

2016

(in millions)

Reconciliation of net loss attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc. to Segment

Adjusted EBITDA

Net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.

$

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

Interest expense, net

Depreciation and amortization

EBITDA

Joint venture depreciation, amortization and interest(a)
Amortization of investment in affiliate step-up(b)
Amortization of inventory step-up(c)
Impairment of fixed assets, intangibles and goodwill

Debt extinguishment costs
Net loss on asset disposals(d)
Foreign currency exchange (gain) loss(e)
LIFO expense(f)
Management advisory fees(g)
Transaction and other related costs(h)
Equity-based compensation
Restructuring, integration and business optimization expenses(i)
Defined benefit plan pension cost(j)
Other(k)
Adjusted EBITDA

Unallocated corporate expenses

Segment Adjusted EBITDA

$

57.6
(119.2)
179.0

177.1

294.5

11.1

8.6

0.9

—

61.9

5.8

25.8

3.7

3.8

7.4

8.8
13.2

2.9

4.9

453.3

30.5

$

483.8

$

(59.0)
58.0

187.9

165.8

352.7

10.3

5.8

4.9

6.9

1.8

4.8
(9.0)
1.3

5.3

2.6

6.5
17.9

2.8

6.2

420.8

32.8

453.6

(a)  We use Adjusted EBITDA as a performance measure to evaluate our financial results. Because our Environmental 
Catalysts and Services segment includes our 50% interest in our Zeolyst Joint Venture, we include an adjustment for 
our 50% proportionate share of depreciation, amortization and interest expense of our Zeolyst Joint Venture.

(b)  Represents the amortization of the fair value adjustments associated with the equity affiliate investment in our Zeolyst 
Joint Venture as a result of the Business Combination. We determined the fair value of the equity affiliate investment 

64

and the fair value step-up was then attributed to the underlying assets of our Zeolyst Joint Venture. Amortization is 
primarily related to the fair value adjustments associated with inventory, fixed assets and intangible assets, including 
customer relationships and technical know-how. 

(c)  As a result of the Business Combination, there was a step-up in the fair value of inventory at PQ Holdings, which is 

amortized through cost of goods sold in the statement of operations. 

(d)  When asset disposals occur, we remove the impact of net gain/loss of the disposed asset because such impact primarily 

reflects the non-cash write-off of long-lived assets no longer in use. 

(e)  Reflects the exclusion of the negative or positive transaction gains and losses of foreign currency in the statement of 
operations primarily related to the Euro-denominated term loan (which was settled as part of the February 2018 term 
loan refinancing) and the non-permanent intercompany debt denominated in local currency translated to U.S. dollars.

(f) 

Represents non-cash adjustments to the Company’s LIFO reserves for certain inventories in the U.S. that are valued 
using the LIFO method, which we believe provides a means of comparison to other companies that may not use the 
same basis of accounting for inventories.

(g)  Reflects consulting fees paid to CCMP and affiliates of INEOS for consulting services that include certain financial 
advisory and management services. These consulting agreements were terminated upon completion of our IPO on 
October 3, 2017.

(h)  Relates to certain transaction costs related to our IPO and the Sovitec acquisition, which are described in further detail  
in our consolidated financial statements, as well as other costs related to several transactions that are completed, 
pending or abandoned and that we believe are not representative of our ongoing business operations.

(i) 

(j) 

Includes the impact of restructuring, integration and business optimization expenses which are incremental costs that 
are not representative of our ongoing business operations.

Represents adjustments for defined benefit pension plan costs in our statement of operations. More than two-thirds 
of our defined benefit pension plan obligations are under defined benefit pension plans that are frozen, and the remaining 
obligations  primarily  relate  to  plans  operated  in  certain  of  our  non-U.S.  locations  that,  pursuant  to  jurisdictional 
requirements, cannot be frozen. As such, we do not view such expenses as core to our ongoing business operations.

(k)  Other costs consist of certain expenses that are not core to our ongoing business operations, including environmental 
remediation-related costs associated with the legacy operations of our business prior to the Business Combination, 
capital and franchise taxes, non-cash asset retirement obligation accretion and the initial implementation of procedures 
to comply with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. Included in this line-item are rounding discrepancies that may 
arise from rounding from dollars (in thousands) to dollars (in millions).

65

Historical and Pro Forma Adjusted Net Income (loss)

Summarized historical and pro forma adjusted net income (loss) information is shown below in the following table:

Reconciliation of net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc. to 

Adjusted Net Income (Loss)(1)(2)

Net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.
Amortization of investment in affiliate step-up(b)
Amortization of inventory step-up(c)
Impairment of fixed assets, intangibles and goodwill

Debt extinguishment costs
Net loss on asset disposals(d)
Foreign currency exchange (gain) loss(e)
LIFO expense(f)
Management advisory fees(g)
Transaction related costs(h)
Equity-based compensation
Restructuring, integration and business optimization expenses(i)
Defined benefit plan pension cost(j)
Other(k)

Adjusted Net Income (Loss), including tax reform

Impact of tax reform(3)
Adjusted Net Income (Loss)

Historical

Pro Forma

Years ended
December 31,

2017

2016

(in millions)

$

57.6

$

6.5

0.6

—

46.4

3.9

16.1

2.8

2.8

5.6

6.6

7.6

2.0

5.9

$

$

164.4
(106.5)
57.9

$

$

(59.0)
3.6

3.0

4.3

1.1

3.1
(1.6)
0.8

3.3

1.5

4.0

11.4

2.0

3.8
(18.7)
—
(18.7)

(1)   We define adjusted net income (loss) as net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings adjusted for non-operating 
income or expense and the impact of certain non-cash or other items that are included in net income (loss) that we do 
not consider indicative of our ongoing operating performance. Adjusted net income is presented as a key performance 
indicator as we believe it will enhance a prospective investor’s understanding of our results of operations and financial 
condition. Adjusted net income may not be comparable with net income or adjusted net income as defined by other 
companies.

(2)   Refer to the Adjusted EBITDA notes above for more information with respect to each adjustment.

(3)   Represents the provisional adjustment for the impact of the TCJA recorded in net income.

The adjustments to net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings are shown net of applicable statutory tax 

rates.

66

Financial Condition, Liquidity and Capital Resources 

Our primary sources of liquidity consist of cash flow from operations, existing cash balances as well as funds available 
under our asset based lending revolving credit facility. We expect that ongoing requirements for debt service and capital 
expenditures will be funded from these sources of funds. Our primary liquidity requirements include funding working capital 
requirements (primarily inventory and accounts receivable, net of accounts payable and other accrued liabilities), debt 
service  requirements  and  capital  expenditures.  Our  capital  expenditures  include  both  maintenance  of  business,  which 
includes spending on maintenance and health, safety and environmental initiatives as well as growth, which includes spending 
to drive organic sales growth and cost savings initiatives.

We believe that our existing cash, cash equivalents and cash flows from operations, combined with availability under 
our asset based lending revolving credit facility, will be sufficient to meet our presently anticipated future cash needs for 
at least the next 12 months. We may also pursue strategic acquisition opportunities, which may impact our future cash 
requirements. We may, from time to time, increase borrowings under our asset based lending revolving credit facility to 
meet our future cash needs. As of December 31, 2018, we had cash and cash equivalents of $57.9 million and availability 
of $170.9 million under our asset based lending revolving credit facility, after giving effect to $19.8 million of outstanding 
letters  of  credit  and  no  revolving  credit  facility  borrowings,  for  a  total  available  liquidity  of  $228.8  million. As  of 
December 31, 2018, we were in compliance with all covenants under our debt agreements. 

Included  in  our  cash  and  cash  equivalents  balance  as  of  December 31,  2018  was  $40.7  million  of  cash  and  cash 
equivalents held in foreign jurisdictions. We repatriate cash held outside of the United States from certain foreign subsidiaries 
in order to meet domestic liquidity needs. Depending on domestic and foreign cash balances, we have certain flexibility to 
repatriate funds in order to meet domestic liquidity needs. Specifically, we have an intercompany loan structure in place 
with  several  of  our  foreign  subsidiaries  that  allows  us  to  repatriate  foreign  cash  in  a  tax  efficient  manner  from  those 
subsidiaries. In certain cases, the repatriation of foreign cash under previous U.S. tax law had generally been subject to U.S. 
income taxes at the time of cash distribution. Due to the enactment of the TCJA in December 2017, future overseas earnings 
repatriation will generally no longer be subject to U.S. federal income taxes at the time of cash distribution. However, future 
earnings may still be taxed for state income tax purposes, as well as subject to certain foreign withholding tax obligations, 
when cash amounts are distributed back to the U.S.

As  of  December 31,  2018,  our  total  indebtedness  was  $2,148.4  million,  with  up  to  $170.9  million  of  available 
borrowings under our asset based lending revolving credit facility. Our liquidity requirements are significant, primarily due 
to debt service requirements. As reported, our cash interest expense for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
was approximately $105.1 million, $170.1 million and $132.6 million, respectively. Before any impact of hedges, a one 
percent  change  in  assumed  interest  rates  for  our  variable  interest  credit  facilities  would  have  an  annual  impact  of 
approximately $11.7 million on interest expense. 

67

Cash Flow 

Net cash provided by (used in)

Operating activities

Investing activities

Financing activities

2018

Years ended
December 31,

2017

(in millions)

2016

$

$

248.6
(119.3)
(137.2)

$

165.2
(196.0)
19.8

122.7
(1,915.8)
1,858.5

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash, cash equivalents and

restricted cash

Net change in cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash

Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at beginning of period

0.4
(7.5)
67.2

(6.9)
(17.9)
85.1

Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at end of period

$

59.7

$

67.2

$

(5.9)
59.5

25.6

85.1

Net income (loss)
Non-cash and non-operating activities(1)
Changes in working capital

Other operating activities

Net cash provided by operating activities

2018

Years ended
December 31,

2017

(in millions)

$

$

59.6

$

58.6

$

212.4
(21.9)
(1.5)
248.6

$

149.1
(38.3)
(4.2)
165.2

$

2016

(79.1)
195.0

14.0
(7.2)
122.7

(1) 

Includes depreciation, amortization, changes related to purchase accounting fair value adjustments, amortization of 
deferred financing costs and original issue discount, debt extinguishment costs, foreign currency exchange gains and 
losses, pension and postretirement healthcare benefit expense and funding, deferred income tax benefit, net losses on 
asset disposals, stock compensation expense, equity in net income and dividends received from affiliated companies, 
and net interest income on swaps designated as net investment hedges.

Working capital changes that provided (used) cash:

Receivables

Inventories

Prepaids and other current assets

Accounts payable

Accrued liabilities

2018

Years ended
December 31,

2017

(in millions)

2016

$

$

(10.5) $
(9.0)
(6.3)
(0.1)
4.0
(21.9) $

(11.5) $
(21.2)
(3.4)
4.3
(6.5)
(38.3) $

27.8
(2.3)
0.5

11.9
(23.9)
14.0

68

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

Investment in affiliated companies

Loan receivable under the New Markets Tax Credit Arrangement

Business combinations, net of cash acquired

Proceeds from sale of assets

Net interest proceeds on swaps designated as net investment hedges

Other, net

Net cash used in investing activities

Net revolver borrowings

Net cash repayments on debt obligations

Net proceeds from IPO

Other financing activities

Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities

2018

Years ended
December 31,

2017

(in millions)

(131.7) $
(5.0)
—
(1.0)
12.4

4.9

1.1
(119.3) $

(140.5) $
(9.0)
(6.2)
(41.6)
—

—

1.3
(196.0) $

2018

Years ended
December 31,

2017

(in millions)

2016

(121.4)
—
(15.7)
(1,777.7)
—

—
(1.0)
(1,915.8)

2016

(25.0) $
(109.1)
—
(3.1)
(137.2) $

23.6
(483.5)
480.7
(1.0)
19.8

$

(22.0)
1,878.9

—

1.6

$

1,858.5

$

$

$

$

Year Ended December 31, 2018 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2017 

Net cash provided by operating activities was $248.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, compared to 
$165.2 million provided for the year ended December 31, 2017. Cash generated by net income plus non-cash and non-
working capital related activities was higher during the year ended December 31, 2018 by $67.1 million compared to the 
prior year. Cash used by working capital during the year ended December 31, 2018 was favorable compared to the year 
ended December 31, 2017. Working capital for the year ended December 31, 2018 used cash of $21.9 million, compared 
to cash used of $38.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2017.

The increase in cash generated by net income plus non-cash and non-working capital related activities of $67.1 million
as compared to the prior year period was primarily due to lower interest expense under our new debt structure, the integration 
of Sovitec into our existing European operations, higher highway safety sales and higher cost pass-through pricing, which 
was  partially  offset  by  higher  plant  maintenance  costs,  higher  compensation  related  costs  due  to  increased  employee 
headcount and increased labor inflation costs.

The $16.4 million increase in cash from working capital as compared to the prior year was primarily due to favorable 
changes in accounts receivable, inventory and accrued liability balances, which were partially offset by unfavorable changes 
in prepaid and other current assets and accounts payable. 

The favorable change in accounts receivable was due to lower receivable balances in our performance chemicals 
product group, mainly as a result of higher receivable balances at the end of December 31, 2017 as compared to December 31, 
2018, which was offset by stronger sales in our North American highway safety and refining services product groups. The 
favorable change in inventory was driven by depletion of inventory balances versus our higher inventory build in our North 
American highway safety product group in the prior year period. The favorable change in accrued liabilities was primarily 
due to the timing of interest payments. The unfavorable change in prepaid and other current assets is due to our cross 
currency swap transaction entered into during the year ended December 31, 2018. The unfavorable change in accounts 
payable was due to increased raw material costs. 

Net cash used in investing activities was $119.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, compared to net cash 
used of $196.0 million during the year ended December 31, 2017. Cash used in investing activities primarily consisted of 

69

utilizing $131.7 million and $140.5 million to fund capital expenditures during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 
2017, respectively. The acquisitions of a cullet business in May 2018 and Sovitec in June 2017 used cash of approximately 
$1.0 million and $41.6 million during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. During the year ended 
December 31, 2018, we received cash proceeds of $12.4 million related to the sale of assets and $4.9 million in interest 
proceeds related to our cross currency swaps.

Net cash used in financing activities was $137.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, compared to net cash 
provided of $19.8 million during the year ended December 31, 2017. Net cash used in financing activities was primarily 
driven  by  $136.2  million  in  repayments  of  our  term  debt  and  revolving  credit  facility  made  during  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2018. This was partially offset by $8.5 million of new borrowings, less $6.4 million in financing fees, made 
under  the  new  term  loan  facility  for  refinancing  costs.  Net  cash  provided  by  financing  activities  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2017 was mainly due to our IPO, which generated $480.7 million of net cash proceeds used to repay a portion 
of our Floating Rate Senior Unsecured Notes due 2022. 

Year Ended December 31, 2017 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2016 

Net cash provided by operating activities was $165.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to 
$122.7 million provided in the year ended December 31, 2016. Cash generated by net income (loss) after giving effect to 
non-cash and non-working capital related activities recognized in the income statement during the period was higher during 
the year ended December 31, 2017 by $94.8 million compared to the prior year. Cash provided by working capital during 
the year ended December 31, 2017 was unfavorable compared to the year ended December 31, 2016. Working capital for 
the year ended December 31, 2017 used cash of $38.3 million, compared to cash provided of $14.0 million for the year 
ended December 31, 2016.

The increase in net income (loss) after giving effect to non-cash and non-working capital related activities of $94.8 
million as compared to the prior year was due to the inclusion of a full period of legacy PQ operating earnings, stronger 
results generated by increased sodium silicate industrial demand, earnings from the Sovitec acquisition, higher pricing from 
renegotiated regeneration services contracts and increased dividends from our Zeolyst Joint Venture, which was partly offset 
by start-up costs for the new ThermoDrop® production facility.

The decrease in cash from working capital of $52.3 million compared to the prior year was primarily due to the 
inclusion of legacy PQ working capital for the year ended December 31, 2017 as compared to the period from May 4, 2016 
through December 31, 2016 in the prior year. This resulted in unfavorable changes in accounts receivable, inventory, prepaid 
and other current assets and accounts payable. The unfavorable change was partially offset by favorable changes in accrued 
liabilities.

In addition to the inclusion of a full period of legacy PQ working capital, the unfavorable change in accounts receivable 
was  a  result  of  higher  accounts  receivables  from  higher  current  year  pricing  and  volumes. The  unfavorable  change  in 
inventory was driven by inventory build for our new ThermoDrop® product offering. The unfavorable change in accounts 
payable was due to the timing of payments for capital expenditures, increased costs related to our plant closures in Europe 
and higher raw material costs. The favorable change in accrued liabilities was primarily due to the timing of accrued interest 
under our new debt structure.

Net cash used in investing activities was $196.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to cash 
used of $1,915.8 million during the year ended December 31, 2016. Uses of cash during the year ended December 31, 2017
include utilizing $140.5 million to fund capital expenditures and $41.6 million to fund the Sovitec acquisition. Uses of cash 
during the year ended December 31, 2016 include utilizing $1,777.7 million to fund the Business Combination and $121.4 
million to fund capital expenditures.

Net cash provided by financing activities was $19.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to net 
cash provided of $1,858.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The sources of cash flows from financing activities 
during the year ended December 31, 2017 were driven by our IPO, which generated $480.7 million of cash used to repay 
a portion of our Floating Rate Senior Unsecured Notes due 2022. In addition, we used the proceeds of our $300.0 million 
Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025 to repay the remaining Floating Rate Senior Unsecured Notes due 2022 as well as our 
8.5% Senior Notes due 2022. 

The change in cash from financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2016 was primarily driven by the 
issuance of $2,336.0 million in debt, net of financing fees, related to the Business Combination in the prior year, partially 
offset by $465.7 million in debt repayments and $22.0 million in net revolver borrowings.

70

Debt

Term Loan Facility (U.S. dollar denominated)

Term Loan Facility (Euro denominated)

New Term Loan Facility

6.75% Senior Secured Notes due 2022

5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025

ABL Facility

Other

Total debt

Original issue discount

Deferred financing costs

Total debt, net of original issue discount and deferred financing costs

Less: current portion

Total long-term debt, excluding current portion

December 31,

2018

2017

(in millions)
— $

—

1,157.5

625.0

300.0

—

65.9

2,148.4
(18.6)
(15.9)
2,113.9
(7.2)
2,106.7

$

916.2

335.8

—

625.0

300.0

25.0

68.3

2,270.3
(18.4)
(21.4)
2,230.5
(45.2)
2,185.3

$

$

As of December 31, 2018 our total debt was $2,148.4 million, including $14.1 million of other foreign debt and $51.8 
million of notes payable for the New Market Tax Credit (“NMTC”) financing and excluding the original issue discount of 
$18.6 million and deferred financing fees of $15.9 million for our senior secured credit facilities and notes. Our net debt 
was $2,090.5 million including cash of $57.9 million. Our total available liquidity as of December 31, 2018 was $228.8 
million, which represents our cash on hand of $57.9 million plus our excess availability under our asset based lending 
revolving credit facility of $170.9 million, after giving effect to $19.8 million of outstanding letters of credit and no revolving 
credit facility borrowings. We may seek, subject to market conditions and other factors, opportunities to repurchase, refinance 
or otherwise reprice our debt.

Senior Secured Credit Facilities

Concurrent  with  the  Business  Combination  in  May  2016,  we  entered  into  new  senior  secured  credit  facilities 
(collectively, the “Senior Secured Credit Facilities”) comprised of a $1,200.0 million term loan facility consisting of a 
$900.0 million  U.S. dollar-denominated tranche and a $300.0 million Euro-denominated (or €265.0 million) tranche (the 
“Term Loan Facility”), and a $200.0 million asset-based revolving credit facility (the “ABL Facility”). 

The Term Loan Facility was issued at 99.0% of the principal amount. Borrowings under the Term Loan Facility bore 
interest at a rate equal to the LIBOR rate (or EURIBOR rate, as applicable) or the base rate elected by us at the time of the 
borrowing plus a margin of 4.75% or 3.75%, respectively. Further, the LIBOR rate and base rate elected under the facilities 
were subject to a floor of 1.00% and 2.00%, respectively. The Term Loan Facility required minimum scheduled quarterly 
principal payments equal to 0.25% of the original principal amount of the term loans made on the closing date of the Business 
Combination. The Term Loan Facility had a maturity date of November 4, 2022. 

On  November 14,  2016,  we  entered  into  the  First Amendment Agreement  to  the  Term  Loan  Facility  (the  “First 
Amendment”) pursuant to which we, among other things: (a) refinanced the existing $900.0 million U.S. dollar-denominated 
tranche by issuing a U.S. dollar-denominated replacement term loan in the amount of $927.8 million and (b) refinanced the 
existing €265.0 million (or $300.0 million) Euro-denominated tranche by issuing a Euro-denominated replacement term 
loan in the amount of €283.3 million. Included in the U.S. dollar-denominated replacement term loan was an additional 
$30.0 million principal amount of borrowings. Included in the Euro-denominated replacement term loan was an additional 
€19.0 million principal amount of borrowings. The borrowings under the First Amendment bore interest at a rate equal to 
LIBOR rate plus a margin of 4.25% for U.S. dollar-denominated LIBOR Rate loans, the EURIBOR rate plus a margin of 
4.00% for Euro-denominated LIBOR Rate loans, or the base rate plus a margin of 3.25% for base rate loans elected by the 
Company at the time of borrowing. These new replacement term loans had substantially the same terms under the original 
Term Loan Facility subject to the amendments contained in the First Amendment. 

71

On August  7,  2017,  we  entered  into  the  Second Amendment Agreement  to  the Term  Loan  Facility  (the  “Second 
Amendment”) and re-priced the $927.8 million U.S. dollar-denominated tranche and the €283.3 million Euro-denominated 
tranche to reduce the applicable interest rates. The terms of the facilities were substantially consistent following the re-
pricing, except that borrowings under the term loans bore interest at a rate equal to the LIBOR rate plus a margin of 3.25% 
with respect to U.S. dollar-denominated LIBOR rate loans, and the EURIBOR rate plus a margin of 3.25% with respect to 
Euro-denominated EURIBOR rate loans. In addition, the LIBOR rate elected under the facilities was subject to a floor of 
0% and the EURIBOR rate elected under the facilities was subject to a floor of 0.75%.

On February 8, 2018, we refinanced the Term Loan Facility with a new $1,267.0 million senior secured term loan 
facility (the “New Term Loan Facility”) by entering into the Third Amendment Agreement to the Term Loan Facility, which 
amended and restated the Term Loan Facility. The New Term Loan Facility bears interest at a floating rate of LIBOR (with 
a zero percent minimum LIBOR floor) plus 2.50% per annum and matures in February 2025, effectively lowering the 
interest rate margin and extending the maturity of our senior secured term loan facility. The New Term Loan Facility requires 
scheduled quarterly amortization payments, each equal to 0.25% of the original principal amount of the loans under the 
New Term Loan Facility.  

The ABL Facility provides for up to $200.0 million in revolving credit borrowings consisting of up to $150.0 million
in U.S. available borrowings, up to $10.0 million in Canadian available borrowings and up to $40.0 million of European 
available borrowings. Borrowings under the ABL Facility bear interest at a rate equal to the LIBOR rate or the base rate 
elected by us at the time of the borrowing plus a margin of between 1.50%-2.00% or 0.50%-1.00%, respectively, depending 
on availability under the ABL Facility. In addition, there is an annual commitment fee equal to 0.375%, with a step-down 
to 0.25% based on the average usage of the revolving credit borrowings available. As of December 31, 2018, there were    
no revolving credit borrowings under the ABL Facility. Revolving credit borrowings are payable at our option throughout 
the term of the ABL Facility with the balance due May 4, 2021. We were in compliance with all debt covenants as of 
December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

The Company has the ability to request letters of credit under the ABL Facility. The Company had $19.8 million of 
letters of credit outstanding as of December 31, 2018, which reduce available borrowings under the ABL Facility by such 
amounts. 

6.75% Senior Secured Notes due 2022

Concurrent with the Business Combination, we issued $625.0 million of 6.750% Senior Secured Notes due November 
2022 (the “6.75% Senior Secured Notes”) in transactions exempt from or not subject to registration under the Securities 
Act pursuant to Rule 144A and Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933. Interest on the 6.75% Senior Secured Notes 
is payable on May 15 and November 15 of each year, commencing November 15, 2016. No principal payments are required 
with respect to the 6.75% Senior Secured Notes prior to their final maturity. The 6.75% Senior Secured Notes mature on 
November 15, 2022. 

Senior Unsecured Notes - Redeemed in 2017

Concurrent with the Business Combination, we issued $525.0 million aggregate principal amount of floating rate 
Senior Unsecured Notes due 2022 (the “Senior Unsecured Notes”) in a concurrent private placement exempt from the 
registration requirements of the Securities Act. The notes were issued at 98.0% of the principal amount. The Senior Unsecured 
Notes were to mature on May 1, 2022; provided that if the 2022 Notes have been refinanced or otherwise repaid prior to 
such date, the Senior Unsecured Notes were to mature on May 1, 2023. Interest on the Senior Unsecured Notes was paid 
and reset quarterly at an annual rate equal to the three-month LIBOR plus 10.75% per year, with a 1.0% LIBOR floor. 
Interest was payable on March 15, June 15, September 15, and December 15 of each year, commencing on June 15, 2016. 

In conjunction with our IPO, on October 3, 2017, we redeemed $446.2 million in aggregate principal of the $525.0 
million of PQ Corporation’s Senior Unsecured Notes using the proceeds from the IPO. Following the redemption, $78.8 
million aggregate principal amount of the Senior Unsecured Notes remained outstanding. We paid a redemption premium 
of $32.3 million, which was recorded as debt extinguishment costs.

On December 11, 2017, we redeemed the remaining $78.8 million aggregate principal amount of the Senior Unsecured 
Notes with the proceeds from the issuance of the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025.  We paid a redemption premium 
of $6.0 million, which was recorded as debt extinguishment costs.  Refer to the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes section of 
this Management’s Discussion and Analysis for further information. 

72

8.50% Senior Notes due 2022 - Redeemed in 2017

In December 2014, Eco Services issued $200.0 million aggregate principal amount of 8.50% senior notes due 2022 
(the “2022 Notes”) under an indenture dated October 24, 2014. The 2022 Notes were issued in a private transaction exempt 
from the registration requirements of the Securities Act. Pursuant to the indenture governing the 2022 Notes, we assumed 
the obligations of Eco Services under the 2022 Notes following the Business Combination. Interest on the 2022 Notes was 
payable on May 1 and November 1 of each year. 

On December 11, 2017, we redeemed the $200.0 million aggregate principal amount of the 2022 Notes with the 
proceeds from the issuance of the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025.  We paid a redemption premium of $8.0 million, 
which was recorded as debt extinguishment costs.  Refer to the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes section of this note for 
further information.

5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025

On December 11, 2017, we issued $300.0 million aggregate principal amount of floating rate Senior Unsecured Notes 
due 2025 (the “5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes”) in a private placement exempt from the registration requirements of the 
Securities Act. The 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes mature on December 15, 2025. Interest on the 5.75% Senior Unsecured 
Notes is to be paid semi-annually on February 15 and August 15, commencing August 15, 2018, at an annual rate of 5.75% 
per year. 

New Markets Tax Credit Financing

The performance materials (Potters Industries, LLC (“Potters”)) portion of our Performance Materials and Chemicals 
business has entered in to various NMTC financing arrangements to fund the expansion of Potter’s manufacturing facilities 
in Paris, Texas and Augusta, Georgia. The NMTC program, which is administered by the United States Treasury Department, 
requires certain balance sheet commitments.  The NMTC financing arrangements will provide us with certain monetary 
benefits  as  an  offset  to  specifically  identified  capital  expenditures.    The  NMTC  arrangements  require  that  certain 
commitments and covenants be maintained over the course of seven years of the closing transaction in order to recognize 
the benefit.

On October 24, 2013, PQ Holdings’ (and now our) subsidiary Potters entered into a NMTC financing arrangement 
with JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A. and several of its affiliates (“Chase”) and TX CDE V LLC, an affiliate of Texas LIC 
Development  Company  LLC  d/b/a  Texas  Community  Development  Capital  (“TX  CDE”),  whereby  Chase  agreed  to 
contribute $6.6 million and an additional $15.6 million in funds lent to Chase by Potters Holdings II, L.P. to TX CDE. TX 
CDE, in turn, lent $21.0 million in the form of $5.4 million and $15.6 million notes to Potters, which used the proceeds to 
finance  the  expansion  of  Potters’  manufacturing  facility  in  Paris,  Texas  (the  “2013  NMTC Agreement”).  The  capital 
expenditures associated with the 2013 NMTC Agreement were completed in 2014. The $21.0 million of debt related to the 
2013 NMTC Agreement was assumed as part of the Business Combination and was outstanding as of December 31, 2018. 

On May 17, 2016, Potters entered into a NMTC financing arrangement with U.S. Bank N.A. and several of its affiliates 
(“USB”) and MRC XX LLC, an affiliate of Midwest Renewable Capital, LLC (“MRC”), whereby USB agreed to contribute 
$3.7 million and an additional $7.8 million in funds lent to USB by Potters Holdings II, L.P. to MRC. MRC, in turn, lent 
$11.0 million in the form of $7.8 million, $1.3 million and $1.9 million notes to Potters, which used the proceeds to finance 
the expansion of Potters’ manufacturing facility in Augusta, Georgia (the “May 2016 NMTC Agreement”). The $11.0 million
was outstanding as of December 31, 2018. The capital expenditures associated with the May 2016 NMTC Agreement were 
completed in 2017. 

On December 29, 2016, Potters entered into a second NMTC financing arrangement with USB and MRC whereby 
USB agreed to contribute $3.8 million and an additional $7.8 million in funds lent to USB by Potters Holdings II, L.P. to 
MRC. MRC, in turn, lent $11.0 million in the form of $7.8 million, $1.4 million and $1.8 million notes to Potters, which 
used the proceeds as working capital for another expansion of Potters’ manufacturing facility in Paris, Texas (the “December 
2016 NMTC Agreement”). The $11.0 million was outstanding as of December 31, 2018. The capital expenditures associated 
with the December 2016 NMTC were completed in 2017. 

On June 22, 2017, Potters entered into a NMTC financing arrangement with USB and Business Conduit No. 28, LLC, 
an affiliate of Community Reinvestment Fund, Inc. (“CRF”). USB contributed $3.1 million to USB Investment Fund, and 
Potters Leveraged Lender LLC, our indirect subsidiary, lent USB Investment Fund $6.2 million. USB Investment Fund 
then contributed $9.0 million to CRF, which in turn lent $8.8 million to Potters pursuant to a credit agreement (the “June 
2017 NMTC Agreement”). Potters used the $8.8 million in proceeds to acquire equipment for the expansion of Potters’ 

73

manufacturing facility in Paris, Texas. The $8.8 million was outstanding as of December 31, 2018. The capital expenditures 
associated with the June 2017 NMTC Agreement were completed in 2018. 

Sovitec Debt

On June 12, 2017, we acquired Sovitec and assumed its obligations to Belfius Bank NV (“Belfius”).  On June 8, 2017, 
Sovitec entered into a credit agreement with Belfius governing a €14.5 million credit line which is divided into four tranches.  
Tranche A was issued in the amount of €7.5 million in the form of a Euro roll-over credit with a maturity date of December 
31, 2021. Tranche B was issued in the amount of €3.0 million in the form of a Euro roll-over credit with a full principal 
payment due on its maturity date of September 30, 2022. A working capital line of credit (“Working Capital”) of €3.0 million
was issued under the form of straight loans with a maturity date up to 90 days after borrowings are made on the line. A 
capital expenditure line of credit (“CAPEX line”) of €1.0 million was issued under the form of straight loans with a maturity 
date of September 30, 2021. Tranche A is subject to principal payments of €0.8 million made on September 30 and December 
31  of  each  year.  Borrowings  under  the  credit  agreement  bear  rates  based  on  Sovitec’s  ratio  of  net  debt  to  Normalized 
EBITDA. Normalized EBITDA is defined as the Sovitec consolidated operating profit before non-recurring items (i.e. items 
non-related to normal operations of the last twelve month period and provided an acceptable description of the one-off 
character of those items is given) and before taxation, depreciation and amortization.  Interest rate margins are subject to 
being reset on June 30 of each year.  Interest rates reset based on three net debt to Normalized EBITDA ratio ranges of less 
than 2, between 2 and 3 or greater than 3. Rates for each tranche of debt reset based on 1 to 9 month EURIBOR rates (not 
lower than zero) plus a margin that can range between 1.10% to 1.55% for Tranche A, 1.85% to 2.15% for Tranche B, 0.90%
and 1.20% for Working Capital and 1.25% and 1.80% for the CAPEX line.

As of December 31, 2018, the interest rate on the credit agreements are as follows:  Tranche A, 1.10%, Tranche B, 
1.85%,  Working  Capital,  0.90%  and  CAPEX  1.25%. As  of  December 31,  2018,  the  following  principal  balances  are 
outstanding on each debt instrument:   Tranche A, $5.1 million, Tranche B, $3.4 million, Working Capital, $1.9 million and 
CAPEX $1.1 million. We were in compliance with all debt covenants as of December 31, 2018.

Capital Expenditures

Maintenance capital expenditures include spending on maintenance of business, health, safety and environmental 
initiatives. Growth capital expenditures include spending to drive organic sales growth and cost savings initiatives. These 
capital expenditures represent our “book” capital expenditures for which the company has recorded, but not necessarily 
paid for the capital expenditures. 

2018

Years ended
December 31,

2017

(in millions)

2016

Maintenance capital expenditures

Growth capital expenditures

Total capital expenditures

$

$

95.9

37.0

132.9

$

$

103.2

37.9

141.1

$

$

96.0

42.9

138.9

Capital expenditures remained at a level sufficient for required maintenance and certain expansion growth initiatives 
during these periods. Maintenance capital expenditures are lower in the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to 
December 31, 2017 due to lower plant maintenance costs. Maintenance capital expenditures are higher in the year ended 
December 31, 2017 as compared to December 31, 2016 due to the timing of maintenance capital expenditure costs incurred 
on projects beginning in late 2016.

Pension Funding

We paid $7.6 million, $7.9 million and $2.9 million in cash contributions into our defined benefit pension plans and 
other postretirement plans during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. The net periodic pension 
and postretirement expense was $1.1 million, $3.3 million, and $2.0 million for those same periods, respectively.

As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, our pension plans and other post-retirement benefit plans were underfunded by 
$70.9 million and $65.9 million, respectively. In addition, our supplemental retirement plan had a liability balance of $11.9 
million and $12.8 million as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, which is funded by our general assets including 

74

assets held in a Rabbi trust, or restoration plan assets, of $4.2 million and $5.6 million as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, 
respectively. 

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements 

We had $19.8 million and $19.6 million of outstanding letters of credit on our revolver facility as of December 31, 

2018 and 2017, respectively.

Contractual Obligations and Commitments

The following table reflects our contractual obligations, commercial commitments and long-term debt obligations as 

of December 31, 2018.

Long-term debt(1)
Interest payments(2)
Letters of credit(3)
Operating leases
Purchase obligations(4)
Other obligations(5)

Payments due by period

Total

Less than 1
year

1-3 years

3-5 years

(in millions)

More than 5
years

$

2,148.4

$

7.2

$

3.4

$

632.1

$

1,505.6

666.0
19.8

76.2

56.6

20.8

119.8
19.8

18.5

28.5

9.3

239.9
—

25.7

21.9

3.5

189.5
—

14.5

2.8

2.8

116.8
—

17.5

3.5

5.2

Total contractual obligations(6)

$

2,987.9

$

203.1

$

294.4

$

841.7

$

1,648.7

(1)  No  prepayment  or  redemption  of  any  of  our  long-term  debt  balances  has  been  assumed.  Refer  to  the  “Financial 
Condition, Liquidity and Capital Resources” section of this Management’s Discussion and Analysis and Note 16, 
Long-term Debt, in the notes to the consolidated financial statements of PQ Group Holdings included elsewhere in 
this Form 10-K for information regarding the terms of our long-term debt agreements.

(2) 

(3) 

(4) 

Interest on long-term debt excludes the amortization of deferred financing fees and original issue discount. The amounts 
represent minimum interest payments. All future interest payments on Euro-denominated loans were calculated using 
a December 31, 2018 Euro to U.S. Dollar spot exchange rate. 

Letters of credit are used primarily as collateral for various items, including environmental, energy and insurance 
payments. The letters of credit are supported by the Company’s ABL Facility.

Purchase obligations include agreements to purchase goods and services that are enforceable and legally binding and 
that specify all significant terms, including fixed and minimum quantities to be purchased, fixed, minimum or variable 
provisions, and the approximate timing of the transaction. Purchase obligations exclude agreements that are cancelable 
without penalty. 

(5)  Other obligations represent payments related to our pension plans, supplemental retirement plans and other post-
retirement benefit plans. Included in these amounts are expected benefit plan contributions of $5.3 million in 2019. 
Contributions to the benefit plans beyond 2019 cannot be reasonably estimated and are not reflected in this table. 
Included  in  other  obligations  is  $1.0  million  of  capital  lease  liabilities. Approximately  $2.0  million  of  derivative 
liabilities are included in the less than 1 year category, as we cannot make reasonable estimates with respect to the 
timing of their ultimate resolution.

(6)  At December 31, 2018, we had $11.3 million related to unrecognized income tax benefits, including accrued interest 
and penalties. These liabilities are not included in the above table, as we cannot make reasonable estimates with respect 
to the timing of their ultimate resolution. See Note 19  in the notes to the consolidated financial statements of PQ 
Group Holdings included elsewhere in this Form 10-K for further information on our unrecognized income tax benefits.

We expect that we will be able to fund our remaining obligations and commitments with cash flow from operations. 
To the extent we are unable to fund these obligations and commitments with cash flow from operations, we intend to fund 

75

these obligations and commitments with proceeds from available borrowing capacity under our ABL Facility or under future 
financings.

Critical Accounting Policies 

We prepare our consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP and our significant accounting policies 
are described in Note 2 to our consolidated financial statements. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with 
GAAP requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect reported amounts and related disclosures. We base our 
estimates and judgments on historical experience and other relevant factors that we believe to be reasonable under the 
circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities 
that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions 
or conditions. We have identified below the accounting policies and estimates that we believe are most critical in compiling 
our consolidated statements of financial condition and operating results. 

Revenue Recognition

In determining the appropriate amount of revenue to be recognized as we fulfill our obligations under our agreements, 
we perform the following steps: (i) identify the contract with the customer; (ii) determine whether the promised goods or 
services are performance obligations, including whether they are distinct in the context of the contract; (iii) measure the 
transaction price; (iv) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations based on estimated selling prices; and 
(v) recognize revenue when (or as) we satisfy each performance obligation.

We identify a contract when an agreement with a customer creates legally enforceable rights and obligations, which 
occurs when a contract has been approved by both parties, the parties are committed to perform their respective obligations, 
each party’s rights and payment terms are clearly identified, commercial substance exists and it is probable that we will 
collect the consideration to which we are entitled.

Evidence  of  a  contract  with  a  customer  may  take  the  form  of  a  master  service  agreement  (“MSA”),  a  MSA  in 
combination with an underlying purchase order, a combination of a pricing quote with an underlying purchase order or an 
individual purchase order received from a customer. Certain of our customers enter into MSAs that establish the terms, 
including prices, under which orders to purchase goods may be placed. In cases where the MSA contains a distinct order 
for goods or contains an enforceable minimum quantity to be purchased by the customer, we consider the MSA to be evidence 
of a contract with a customer as the MSA creates enforceable rights and obligations. In cases where the MSA does not 
contain a distinct order for goods, evidence of a contract with a customer is the purchase order issued under the MSA. Our 
customers may also negotiate orders via pricing quotes, which typically detail product pricing, delivery terms and payment 
information.  When a customer procures goods under this method, we consider the combination of the pricing quote and 
the purchase order to create enforceable rights and obligations. Absent either a MSA or pricing quote, we consider an 
individual purchase order to create enforceable rights and obligations.

We identify a performance obligation in a contract for each promised good that is separately identifiable from other 
promises in the contract and for which the customer can benefit from the good. The majority of our contracts have a single 
performance obligation, which is the promise to transfer individual goods to the customer. Certain of our contracts include 
multiple performance obligations under which the purchase price for each distinct performance obligation is defined in the 
contract. These distinct performance obligations may include stand-ready provisions, which are arrangements to provide a 
customer assurance that they will have access to output from our manufacturing facilities, or monthly reservations of capacity 
fees. We consider stand-ready provisions and reservation of capacity fees to be performance obligations satisfied over time. 
Revenues related to stand-ready provisions and reservation of capacity fees are recognized on a ratable basis throughout 
the contract term and billed to the customer on a monthly basis.

As described above, our MSAs with our customers may outline prices for individual products or contract provisions. 
MSAs in the our performance chemicals and refining services product groups may contain provisions whereby raw materials 
costs are passed-through to the customer per the terms of their contract. Our exposure to fluctuations in raw materials prices 
is limited, as the majority of pass-through contract provisions reset based on fluctuations in the underlying raw material 
price. MSAs in our refining services product group also contain take-or-pay arrangements, whereby the customer would 
incur a penalty in the form of a shortfall volume fee. Currently there is no history in which customers fail to meet the 
contractual minimum. Revenue from product sales are recorded at the sales price, which includes estimates of variable 
consideration for which reserves are established and which result from discounts, returns or other allowances that are offered 
within contracts with our customers.

76

We recognize revenues when performance obligations under the terms of a contract with our customer are satisfied, 
which generally occurs at a point in time by transferring control of a product to the customer. We determine the point in 
time when a customer obtains control of a product and we satisfy the performance obligation by considering factors including 
when we have a right to payment for the product, the customer has legal title to the product, we have transferred possession 
of the product, the customer has assumed the risks and rewards of ownership of the product and the customer has accepted 
the product. Revenue is measured as the amount of consideration we expect to receive in exchange for transferring goods. 
We do not have any significant payment terms as payment is received at, or shortly after, the point of sale.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets 

Goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives are not amortized, but are tested for impairment annually or more 
frequently if events occur or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of the reporting 
unit below its carrying amount. We perform our annual impairment tests of goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets 
as of October 1 of each year. 

Goodwill is tested for impairment at the reporting unit level. In performing tests for goodwill impairment, we are 
permitted to first perform a qualitative assessment about the likelihood of the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeding 
its fair value. If an entity determines that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its 
carrying amount based on the qualitative assessment, it is required to perform a two-step goodwill impairment test to identify 
the potential goodwill impairment and measure the amount of the goodwill impairment loss, if any, to be recognized for 
that reporting unit. However, if an entity concludes otherwise based on the qualitative assessment, the two-step goodwill 
impairment test is not required. The option to perform the qualitative assessment can be utilized at our discretion, and the 
qualitative assessment need not be applied to all reporting units in a given goodwill impairment test. For an individual 
reporting unit, if we elect not to perform the qualitative assessment, or if the qualitative assessment indicates that it is more 
likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, then we must perform the two-step 
goodwill impairment test for the reporting unit. 

In applying the two-step process, the first step used to identify potential impairment involves comparing the reporting 
unit’s estimated fair value to its carrying value, including goodwill. If the estimated fair value of a reporting unit exceeds 
its carrying value, goodwill is not impaired. If the carrying value exceeds the estimated fair value, there is an indication of 
potential impairment and the second step is performed to measure the amount of impairment, if any. The second step of the 
process involves the calculation of an implied fair value of goodwill for each reporting unit for which step one indicated 
potential impairment. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined in a manner similar to how goodwill is calculated 
in a business combination. That is, the estimated fair value of the reporting unit, as calculated in step one, is allocated to 
the individual assets and liabilities as if the reporting unit was being acquired in a business combination. If the implied fair 
value of goodwill exceeds the carrying value of goodwill assigned to the reporting unit, there is no impairment. If the 
carrying value of goodwill assigned to a reporting unit exceeds the implied fair value of the goodwill, an impairment charge 
is recorded to write down the carrying value. An impairment loss cannot exceed the carrying value of goodwill assigned to 
a reporting unit and the loss establishes a new basis in the goodwill. Subsequent reversal of an impairment loss is not 
permitted. 

For the purposes of the quantitative goodwill impairment test, we determine the fair value of our reporting units using 
a combination of a market approach and an income, or discounted cash flow, approach. Estimating the fair value of a 
reporting unit requires various assumptions including the use of projections of future cash flows and discount rates that 
reflect the risks associated with achieving those cash flows. The key assumptions used in estimating the fair value are 
operating margin growth rates, revenue growth rates, the weighted average cost of capital, the perpetual growth rate, and 
the  estimated  earnings  market  multiples  of  each  reporting  unit.  The  market  value  is  estimated  using  publicly  traded 
comparable company values by applying their most recent annual EBITDA multiples to the reporting unit’s EBITDA for 
the trailing twelve months. The income approach value is estimated using a discounted cash flow approach. The assumptions 
about future cash flows and growth rates are based on our assessment of a number of factors including the reporting unit’s 
recent performance against budget as well as management’s ability to execute on planned future strategic initiatives. Discount 
rate assumptions are based on an assessment of the risk inherent in those future cash flows. 

For intangible assets other than goodwill, definite-lived intangible assets are amortized over their respective estimated 
useful lives. Intangible assets with indefinite lives are not amortized, but rather are tested for impairment at least annually 
or more frequently if events occur or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of the 
intangible asset below its carrying amount. Our indefinite-lived intangible assets include trade names and certain trademarks. 
Similar to the goodwill impairment test, we may first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is necessary to 

77

perform a quantitative impairment test. If we choose to bypass the qualitative assessment, or if the qualitative assessment 
indicates that the indefinite-lived intangible asset is more likely than not impaired, a quantitative impairment test must be 
performed. Unlike the goodwill impairment test, the quantitative test for indefinite-lived intangible assets is a one-step test 
comparing the fair value of the asset to its carrying amount. If the fair value of the indefinite-lived intangible asset is less 
than the carrying amount, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to the difference. 

The unit of accounting used to test our indefinite-lived intangible assets for impairment is at the reporting unit level. 
The fair values of our indefinite-lived trade names and trademarks are determined for impairment testing purposes based 
on an income approach using a discounted cash flow valuation model under a relief from royalty methodology. Significant 
assumptions under the relief from royalty method include the royalty rate a market participant may assume, projected sales 
and the discount rate applied to the estimated cash flows. 

For definite-lived intangible assets, we amortize technical know-how over periods that range from fourteen to twenty 
years, customer relationships over periods that range from seven to fifteen years, trademarks over a fifteen year period, 
contracts over periods that range from two to sixteen years, and permits over five years. We perform an impairment review 
of definite-lived intangible assets when facts and circumstances indicate that the carrying value of an asset may not be 
recoverable from its undiscounted future cash flows. The impairment test for definite-lived intangible assets is consistent 
with the test applied to property, plant and equipment as described in our policy. 

Income Taxes 

We  operate  within  multiple  taxing  jurisdictions  and  are  subject  to  tax  filing  requirements  and  audit  within  these 
jurisdictions. We use the asset and liability method in accounting for income taxes. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are 
recorded for temporary differences between the tax basis of assets and liabilities and their reported amounts in the financial 
statements, using statutory tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. The effect on 
deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in the results of operations in the period that includes 
the enactment date. We evaluate our deferred tax assets each period to ensure that estimated future taxable income will be 
sufficient in character (e.g., capital gain versus ordinary income treatment), amount and timing to result in their recovery. 
A valuation allowance is recorded to reduce the carrying amounts of deferred tax assets unless it is more likely than not 
that those assets will be realized. Considerable judgments are required in establishing deferred tax valuation allowances 
and in assessing exposures related to tax matters. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the 
generation of future taxable income during the periods in which those temporary differences and carryforward deferred tax 
assets become deductible or utilized. We consider the scheduled reversal of taxable temporary differences, projected future 
taxable income and tax-planning strategies in making this assessment. As events and circumstances change, related reserves 
and valuation allowances are adjusted to income at that time. 

In determining the provision for income taxes, we provide deferred income taxes on income from foreign subsidiaries 
as such earnings are taxable upon remittance to the United States, to the extent that these earnings are considered to be 
available for repatriation. We do not provide income taxes on the cumulative unremitted earnings of foreign subsidiaries 
considered permanently reinvested. We establish contingent liabilities for possible assessments by taxing authorities resulting 
from uncertain tax positions including, but not limited to, transfer pricing, deductibility of certain expenses and other state, 
local, and foreign tax matters. We recognize a financial statement benefit for positions taken for tax return purposes when 
it will be more likely than not (greater than 50%) that the positions will be sustained upon tax examination, based solely 
on the technical merits of the tax positions, otherwise, no benefit is recognized. The tax benefits recognized are measured 
based on the largest benefit that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement. We recognize 
potential accrued interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits in income tax expense. Tax examinations are 
often complex as tax authorities may disagree with the treatment of items reported by us and may require several years to 
resolve. These accrued liabilities represent a provision for taxes that are reasonably expected to be incurred on the basis of 
available information but which are not certain. 

On December 22, 2017, the TCJA was enacted into law. The TCJA provided for several significant tax law changes 
and modifications, including the reduction of the U.S. federal corporate income tax rate from 35.0% to 21.0%, the requirement 
for companies to pay a one-time transition tax on earnings of certain foreign subsidiaries that were previously tax deferred, 
as well as the creation of new taxes on certain foreign-sourced earnings. Certain provisions of the TCJA began to impact 
us in our fourth quarter of 2017, while other provisions began impacting us beginning in 2018. 

The corporate tax rate reduction was effective as of January 1, 2018. The TCJA also established other new provisions 
that became effective in 2018. These include, but are not limited to, (1) a new provision designed to tax low-taxed income 

78

of foreign subsidiaries (i.e., “GILTI”), which allows for the possibility of using foreign tax credits ("FTCs") and a deduction 
of up to 50% to offset any resulting income tax liability (subject to some limitations); (2) limitations on the deductibility 
of certain executive compensation; (3) limitations on the deductibility of interest expense (“163(j)”); and (4) limitations on 
the use of FTCs to reduce the U.S. income tax liability. While many of these provisions are expected to have an impact on 
our tax expense and deferred taxes for 2018 and future periods, we expect the GILTI provisions and 163(j) to have the most 
significant impact. While significant additional guidance regarding U.S. tax reform has been put forth during 2018, at this 
time the overall impact of the TCJA on our future income tax provision continues to remain uncertain.

With respect to GILTI, we have experienced significant impact to tax expense in 2018 because of our substantial U.S. 
NOL balance and being unable to avail ourselves of both U.S. foreign tax credits and the GILTI special deduction (“Section 
250 deduction”). The 2018 impact to tax expense with respect to GILTI is $15.4 million. Based on FASB guidance, we are 
permitted to make an accounting policy election to either (1) treat the taxes incurred as a result of the GILTI provision as 
a current-period expense when incurred or (2) factor such amounts into our measurement of deferred taxes. We have elected 
to treat any expense incurred as a current-period expense.

With respect to 163(j), we have experienced a significant disallowance with respect to our current year interest expense. 
Our 163(j) interest disallowance is $57.7 million for 2018. This disallowance has no impact to overall tax expense, given 
that any disallowed interest deductions are permitted to be carried forward indefinitely and, as such, are set up as deferred 
tax assets. We have evaluated the realizability of this deferred tax asset and believe it is more-likely-than-not that it will be 
realized, using reversal of existing taxable temporary differences.

Stock-Based Compensation 

We grant stock-based compensation awards in connection with our stock incentive plans. Under the terms of the 
incentive plans, we are authorized to issue equity awards to our employees, directors and affiliates. The grants have taken 
the form of restricted stock awards, restricted stock units and stock options. Restricted stock awards provide the recipient 
with shares of our stock subject to certain vesting requirements. Restricted stock units provide the recipient with the right 
to receive shares of our stock at a future date if certain vesting conditions are met. Stock option awards provide the recipient 
the ability to purchase shares of our stock at a given strike price upon the satisfaction of certain vesting requirements. 

The  vesting  requirements  associated  with  the  awards  include  a  mix  of  both  service  and  performance  conditions. 
Depending on the award and recipient, the service condition may reflect a cliff vesting provision (e.g., 100% vested upon 
four years of service) or a graded vesting provision (e.g., 33.3% vested each year over a period of three years). Awards 
issued with performance conditions vest based on the occurrence of a defined liquidity event upon which certain investment 
funds  affiliated  with  CCMP  receive  proceeds  exceeding  certain  thresholds. Although  achievement  of  the  performance 
condition is subject to continued service with us, the terms of awards issued with performance conditions stipulate that the 
performance vesting condition can be attained for a period of six months following separation from service. 

We recognize compensation expense related to our equity awards with service conditions on a straight-line basis over 
the stated vesting period for each award. Expense related to our equity awards with performance conditions is recognized 
in the period in which it becomes probable that the performance target will be achieved. No compensation expense has been 
recognized to-date on any of our equity awards subject to vesting based on performance conditions, since a liquidity event 
triggering vesting of the awards has not occurred, nor is it considered probable. 

The grant date fair value of restricted stock awards and restricted stock units is based on the value of our common 
stock as traded on the New York Stock Exchange. The grant date fair value of stock option awards is estimated using a 
Black-Scholes option pricing model. Determining the fair value of stock option awards at the grant date requires judgment, 
including estimates of the average risk-free interest rate, dividend yield, volatility and expected term. Since we have limited 
experience with respect to historical exercise and forfeiture rates or patterns, we have estimated certain assumptions using 
acceptable simplified methods and through benchmarking to our peer group of companies. 

Recently Issued Accounting Standards 

See Note 3 to our consolidated financial statements for a discussion of recently issued accounting standards and their 

effect on us. 

79

ITEM 7A.   QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK.

Our major market risk exposure is potential losses arising from changing rates and prices regarding foreign currency 
exchange rate risk, interest rate risk, commodity price risk and credit risk. The audit committee of our board of directors 
regularly reviews foreign exchange, interest rate and commodity hedging activity and monitors compliance with our hedging 
policy. We do not use financial instruments for speculative purposes, and we limit our hedging activity to the underlying 
economic exposure. 

Foreign Exchange Risk 

Our financial results are subject to the impact of gains and losses on currency translations, which occur when the 
financial statements of foreign operations are translated into U.S. dollars. We operate a geographically diverse business 
with approximately 40% of our sales during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 coming from our international 
operations in currencies other than the U.S. dollar. Because consolidated financial results are reported in U.S. dollars, sales 
or earnings generated in currencies other than the U.S. dollar can result in a significant increase or decrease in the amount 
of those sales and earnings when translated to U.S. dollars. The financial statements of our operations outside the United 
States, where the local currency is considered to be the functional currency, are translated into U.S. dollars using the exchange 
rate in effect at each balance sheet date for assets and liabilities and the average exchange rate for each period for sales, 
expenses, gains, losses and cash flows. The exchange rates between these currencies and the U.S. dollar in recent years 
have fluctuated significantly and may continue to do so in the future. The foreign currencies to which we have the most 
significant exchange rate exposure include the euro, British pound, Canadian dollar, Brazilian real and the Mexican peso. 
Sales in these top five currencies represented approximately 32% of our sales during the year ended December 31, 2018. 
A 10% change in these currencies would have impacted sales by approximately $51.8 million, or 3% of sales assuming 
product pricing remained constant. The effect of translating foreign subsidiaries’ balance sheets into U.S. dollars is included 
in other comprehensive income. The impact of gains and losses on transactions denominated in currencies other than the 
functional currency of the relevant operations are included in other non-operating expense. Income and expense items are 
translated at average exchange rates during the year. Net foreign exchange included in other expense was a $13.8 million
loss for the year ended December 31, 2018. The foreign currency loss realized in the year ended December 31, 2018 was 
primarily  driven  by  the  Euro-denominated  term  loan  and  the  non-permanent  intercompany  debt  denominated  in  local 
currency and translated to U.S. dollars, and was principally non-cash in nature. 

On February 8, 2018, we refinanced our existing senior secured term loan facility whereby the New Term Loan Facility 
was used to repay the then-existing U.S. dollar denominated and Euro denominated Term Loan Facilities, thus reducing 
our exposure to fluctuations in the euro. Concurrent with the term loan refinancing, we entered into multiple cross currency 
swap arrangements to hedge foreign currency risk. The swaps are intended to enable us to effectively hedge our exposure 
on the net investments of certain of our Euro denominated subsidiaries.

As described in Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements included in this Form 10-K, the Financial Accounting 
Standards  Board  (“FASB”)  issued  guidance  in August  2017  with  the  objective  of  improving  the  financial  reporting  of 
hedging  relationships  to  better  portray  the  economic  results  of  an  entity's  risk  management  activities  in  its  financial 
statements. As a result of our early adoption of the FASB guidance, and because the swap agreements are designated as net 
investment hedges, changes in the fair value of the cross-currency swap agreements will be recognized as a component of 
“Foreign  currency  translation,  net  of  tax”  within  “Other  comprehensive  income  (loss),  net  of  tax”  in  the  consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income. In this regard, a favorable foreign currency change in the designated investment value 
of our foreign subsidiaries that use the Euro as their functional currency generally will be offset by an unfavorable foreign 
currency change in the cross-currency swap agreements, and vice versa. At December 31, 2018, a 10% fluctuation in the 
U.S. dollar-to-Euro currency exchange rate would have an approximately $32.0 million impact on the fair value of the 
notional  amount  of  the  cross-currency  swap  agreements  and  an  offsetting  $32.0  million  impact  on  the  designated  net 
investment value of the foreign subsidiaries. In addition, in the event of a significant decline in the U.S. dollar-to-Euro 
exchange rate, our payment obligations to the counterparties could have a material adverse effect on our cash flows. In this 
regard, if, at the expiration or earlier termination of the swap agreements, the U.S. dollar-to-Euro currency exchange rate 
has declined by 10% from the rate in effect at December 31, 2018, we would be required to pay approximately $32.0 million
to the counterparties. The swap agreements entail risk that the counterparties will not fulfill their obligations under the 
agreements. However, we believe the risk is reduced because we have entered into separate agreements with three different 
counterparties, all of whom are large, well-established financial institutions.

80

Interest Rate Risk 

We are exposed to fluctuations in interest rates on our Senior Secured Credit Facilities and on our Floating Rate Senior 
Unsecured Notes. Changes in interest rates will not affect the market value of such debt but will affect the amount of our 
interest payments over the term of the loans. Likewise, an increase in interest rates could have a material impact on our 
cash flow. As of December 31, 2018, a 100 basis point increase in assumed interest rates for our variable interest credit 
facilities, before impact of any hedges, would have an annual impact of approximately $11.7 million on interest expense. 

We hedge the interest rate fluctuations on debt obligations through interest rate cap agreements. We record the fair 
value of these hedges as assets or liabilities and the related unrealized gains or losses are deferred in stockholders’ equity 
as a component of other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax. The interest rate caps had a fair value net asset of $0.1 
million and $1.0 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. Fair value is determined based on estimated amounts 
that would be received or paid to terminate the contracts at the reporting date based on quoted market prices. 

In July 2016, we entered into interest rate cap agreements, paying a premium of $1.6 million to mitigate interest rate 
volatility from July 2016 through July 2020 by employing varying cap rates ranging from 1.50% to 3.00% on $1.0 billion 
of notional variable debt. In November 2018, the Company entered into additional interest rate cap agreements to mitigate 
interest rate volatility from July 2020 through July 2022, with a cap rate of 3.50% on $0.5 billion of notional variable-rate 
debt and a $3.4 million premium annuitized during the effective period.

Commodity Risk 

We purchase significant amounts of natural gas to supply the energy required in our production processes for our 
products in each of our segments. Since we are a producer of inorganic chemicals, natural gas provides an energy source 
for us but is not a direct feedstock for our products. Therefore, exposure to the volatility in energy prices is less than that 
of producers of organic petrochemicals. We purchase approximately 15.9 million MMBtu’s of natural gas in a given year. 
Thus, a $1 increase in the cost of natural gas would impact our cost of goods sold by approximately $15.9 million absent 
hedging. Our purchase agreements with our customers typically provide for the pass through of natural gas price increases; 
however, there is no guarantee that we will continue to be able to pass through future price increases without loss of existing 
customers. We have implemented a hedging program in the United States which allows us to mitigate exposure to natural 
gas volatility with natural gas swap agreements. We also make forward purchases of natural gas related to our production 
at certain subsidiary locations. 

The natural gas swap agreements had a fair value net liability of $0.2 million and fair value net liability of $0.4 million 
at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. Fair value is determined based on estimated amounts that would be received 
or paid to terminate the contracts at the reporting date based on quoted market prices of comparable contracts. The respective 
current and non-current assets are recorded in other current assets and other assets. The related unrealized gains or losses 
are recorded in stockholders’ equity as a component of other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax. Realized gains and 
losses on natural gas hedges are included in production cost and subsequently charged to cost of goods sold in the consolidated 
statements of operations in the period in which inventory is sold. 

Credit Risk 

We are exposed to credit risk on financial instruments to the extent our counterparty fails to perform certain duties as 
required under the provisions of an agreement. We only transact with counterparties having an appropriate credit rating for 
the risk involved. Credit exposure is managed through credit approval and monitoring procedures. 

Concentration of credit risk can result primarily from trade receivables, for example, with certain customers operating 
in the same industry or customer groups located in the same geographic region. Credit risk related to these types of receivables 
is managed through credit approval and monitoring procedures. In the year ended December 31, 2018, we wrote off a 
nominal amount of bad debt on total sales of $1,608.2 million. 

ITEM 8.  

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA.

The consolidated financial statements, supplementary information and financial statement schedules of the Company 

are set forth beginning on page F-1 of this report.

81

ITEM 9.   CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND 

FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE.

None.

ITEM 9A.   CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES.

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Our management, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, evaluated the 
effectiveness  of  our  disclosure  controls  and  procedures  as  of  December 31,  2018.  The  term  “disclosure  controls  and 
procedures,” as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act, means controls and other procedures of 
a company that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by a company in the reports that it files or 
submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the 
SEC’s rules and forms.  Disclosure controls and procedures include, without limitation, controls and procedures designed 
to ensure that information required to be disclosed by a company in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange 
Act  is  accumulated  and  communicated  to  the  company’s  management,  including  its  principal  executive  and  principal 
financial officers, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. Management recognized that any 
controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving 
their objectives and management necessarily applies its judgment in evaluating the cost-benefit relationship of possible 
controls and procedures. Based on that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that, 
as of such date, our disclosure controls and procedures were effective at a reasonable assurance level.

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. 
Internal control over financial reporting is defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act as a process, 
designed by, or under the supervision of the Company’s principal executive and principal financial officers and effected by 
the Company’s board of directors, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability 
of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted 
accounting  principles.  Internal  control  over  financial  reporting  includes  maintaining  records  that  in  reasonable  detail 
accurately and fairly reflect our transactions and dispositions of assets; providing reasonable assurance that transactions are 
recorded  as  necessary  for  preparation  of  our  financial  statements;  providing  reasonable  assurance  that  receipts  and 
expenditures are made only in accordance with management and board authorizations; and providing reasonable assurance 
regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of our assets that could have a 
material effect on our financial statements. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may 
not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the 
risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies 
or procedures may deteriorate. Our management assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting 
as  of  December 31,  2018.  In  making  this  assessment,  management  used  the  criteria  for  effective  internal  control  over 
financial  reporting  described  in  the  “Internal  Control-Integrated  Framework”  (2013)  set  forth  by  the  Committee  of 
Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). Based on the assessment, management concluded that, 
as of December 31, 2018, our internal control over financial reporting was effective based on those criteria.

The  effectiveness  of  our  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  as  of  December 31,  2018  has  been  audited  by 
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report, which is included 
in Item 8.

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

No changes in our internal control over financial reporting occurred during the quarter ended December 31, 2018 that 

materially affected, or which are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

ITEM 9B.   OTHER INFORMATION.

None.

82

PART III

ITEM 10.   DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE.

The information required by this Item 10 will be included in our 2019 Proxy Statement, which we intend to file with 

the SEC within 120 days of our December 31, 2018 fiscal year end, and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 11.   EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION.

The information required by this Item 11 will be included in our 2019 Proxy Statement, which we intend to file with 

the SEC within 120 days of our December 31, 2018 fiscal year end, and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 12.   SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND 

RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS.

The information required by this Item 12 will be included in our 2019 Proxy Statement, which we intend to file with 

the SEC within 120 days of our December 31, 2018 fiscal year end, and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 13.   CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR 

INDEPENDENCE.

The information required by this Item 13 will be included in our 2019 Proxy Statement, which we intend to file with 

the SEC within 120 days of our December 31, 2018 fiscal year end, and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 14.   PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES.

The information required by this Item 14 will be included in our 2019 Proxy Statement, which we intend to file with 

the SEC within 120 days of our December 31, 2018 fiscal year end, and is incorporated herein by reference.

83

ITEM 15.   EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES.
(a)  The following documents are filed as part of this report:

PART IV

(1) and (2)  The response to this portion of Item 15 is submitted as a separate section of this report beginning on page 
F-1. All other schedules have been omitted as inapplicable or are not required, or because the required information is 
included in the consolidated financial statements or accompanying notes.
(3)  The exhibits filed as part of this report are listed in the accompanying index.

Exhibit 
No.

Exhibit 
Description

3.1

3.2

4.1

4.2

10.1

10.2

10.3

Second Restated Certificate of Incorporation of PQ 
Group Holdings Inc.

Amended and Restated Bylaws of PQ Group Holdings 
Inc.

Indenture, dated as of May 4, 2016, among PQ 
Corporation, as Issuer, the Guarantors from time to 
time party thereto and Wells Fargo Bank, National 
Association, as Trustee and Collateral Agent, including 
the form of Global Note attached as Exhibit A thereto
Indenture, dated as of December 11, 2017, among PQ 
Corporation, as Issuer, the guarantors party thereto and 
Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, as trustee

Term Loan Credit Agreement, dated as of May 4, 2016, 
by and among PQ Corporation, CPQ Midco I 
Corporation, the Lenders from time to time party 
thereto, and Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch, 
as Administrative Agent and Collateral Agent, with 
Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Credit Suisse Securities 
(USA) LLC, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., Morgan 
Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., Deutsche Bank Securities 
Inc., Goldman Sachs Lending Partners LLC, Jefferies 
Finance LLC and KeyBanc Capital Markets Inc., as 
Joint Lead Arrangers and Joint Bookrunners

First Amendment Agreement, dated as of November 
14, 2016, to the Term Loan Credit Agreement dated as 
of May 4, 2016, among PQ Corporation, CPQ Midco I 
Corporation, the Guarantors named on the signature 
pages thereto, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as an 
Additional Term Lender, and Credit Suisse AG, 
Cayman Islands Branch, as Administrative Agent and 
Collateral Agent

Second Amendment Agreement, dated as of August 7, 
2017, to the Term Loan Credit Agreement dated as of 
May 4, 2016 (as amended by the First Amendment 
Agreement dated as of November 14, 2016), among PQ 
Corporation, CPQ Midco I Corporation, the Guarantors 
named on the signature pages thereto, Citibank, N.A., 
as an Additional Term Lender, and Credit Suisse AG, 
Cayman Islands Branch, as Administrative Agent and 
Collateral Agent

Incorporated by Reference

Filed
Herewith

File 
No.

Form
10-Q 001-38221

Exhibit
3.1

Filing 
Date
11/14/2017

S-1/A 333-218650

3.2

9/1/2017

S-1

333-218650

4.2

6/9/2017

8-K 001-38221

4.1

12/13/2017

S-1

333-218650

10.1

6/9/2017

S-1

333-218650

10.2

6/9/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.19

8/14/2017

84

Exhibit
No.

10.4

10.5

10.6

10.7

10.8

10.9

10.10

10.11

10.12*

10.13*

10.14*

10.15*

10.16*

10.17*

10.18*

Exhibit 
Description
Third Amendment Agreement, dated as of February 8, 
2018, to the Term Loan Credit Agreement dated as of 
May 4, 2016 (as amended by the First Amendment 
Agreement dated as of November 14, 2016 and the 
Second Amendment Agreement dated as of August 7, 
2017) among PQ Corporation, CPQ Midco I 
Corporation, the Guarantors named on the signature 
pages thereto, Citibank, N.A., as an Additional Term 
Lender, and Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Island Branch, 
as Administrative Agent and Collateral Agent

ABL Credit Agreement, dated as of May 4, 2016, by 
and among PQ Corporation, CPQ Midco I Corporation, 
the Canadian Borrowers from time to time party 
thereto, the European Borrowers from time to time 
party thereto, the Lenders from time to time party 
thereto and Citibank, N.A., as Administrative Agent 
and Issuing Bank, with Citigroup Global Markets Inc., 
Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, JPMorgan Chase 
Bank, N.A., Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., 
Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., Goldman Sachs 
Lending Partners LLC, Jefferies Finance LLC and 
KeyBanc Capital Markets Inc., as Joint Lead Arrangers 
and Joint Bookrunners

Partnership Agreement, dated as of February 1, 1988, 
by and between PQ Corporation and Shell Polymers 
and Catalysts Enterprises Inc.

First Amendment to Partnership Agreement, dated 
January 1, 1993, by and among PQ Corporation, Shell 
Catalyst Ventures Inc. and CRI Zeolites Inc.

Second Amendment to Partnership Agreement, dated 
October 18, 2002, by and between PQ Corporation and 
Shell Catalyst Ventures Inc.

Third Amendment to Partnership Agreement, dated 
January 1, 2005, by and between PQ Corporation and 
CRI Zeolites Inc.

Lease Agreement, dated January 1, 2017, by and 
between The Realty Associates Fund X, L.P. and PQ 
Corporation

Form of Amended and Restated Stockholders 
Agreement between PQ Group Holdings Inc. and 
certain stockholders of PQ Group Holdings Inc.

Incorporated by Reference

Filed
Herewith

File 
No.

Form
8-K 001-38221

Exhibit
10.1

Filing 
Date
2/9/2018

S-1

333-218650

10.3

6/9/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.10

8/14/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.11

8/14/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.12

8/14/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.13

8/14/2017

S-1

333-218650

10.4

6/9/2017

S-1/A 333-218650

10.5

9/1/2017

PQ Group Holdings Inc. 2017 Omnibus Incentive Plan

S-1/A 333-218650 10.14

9/19/2017

Form of Stock Option Award Agreement under the PQ 
Group Holdings Inc. 2017 Omnibus Incentive Plan

Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement under the 
PQ Group Holdings Inc. 2017 Omnibus Incentive Plan

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement under 
the PQ Group Holdings Inc. 2017 Omnibus Incentive 
Plan

PQ Group Holdings Inc. Stock Incentive Plan

Form of Nonqualified Stock Option Award Agreement 
under the PQ Group Holdings Inc. Stock Incentive Plan 

Form of Restricted Stock Agreement under the PQ 
Group Holdings Inc. Stock Incentive Plan 

85

S-1/A 333-218650 10.15

9/1/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.16

9/1/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.17

9/1/2017

S-1

S-1

333-218650

333-218650

10.6

10.7

6/9/2017

6/9/2017

S-1

333-218650

10.8

6/9/2017

Exhibit
No.
10.19*

10.20*

10.21*

10.22*

10.23*

10.24*

10.25*

10.26*

10.27*

21.1

23.1

23.2

31.1

31.2

32.1

32.2

Exhibit 
Description

Form of Director and Officer Indemnification 
Agreement

Severance Agreement, dated August 9, 2018, by and 
between PQ Corporation and Belgacem Chariag

Severance Agreement, dated August 31, 2017, by and 
between PQ Corporation and James F. Gentilcore

Letter Agreement, dated August 9, 2018, by and 
between PQ Corporation, PQ Group Holdings Inc. and 
James F. Gentilcore

Separation and General Release Agreement, dated 
December 21, 2018, by and between PQ Corporation, 
PQ Group Holdings Inc. and James F. Gentilcore

Severance Agreement, dated August 31, 2017, by and 
between PQ Corporation and Michael Crews 

Severance Agreement, dated August 31, 2017, by and 
between PQ Corporation and Scott Randolph 

Severance Agreement, dated August 31, 2017, by and 
between PQ Corporation and Paul Ferrall 

Severance Agreement and General Release, dated 
August 31, 2017, by and between PQ Corporation and 
Michael R. Boyce 

Subsidiaries of PQ Group Holdings Inc.

Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP related to the 
consolidated financial statements and financial 
statement schedule of PQ Group Holdings Inc. as of 
December 31, 2018 and 2017 and for each of the three 
years in the period ended December 31, 2018

Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP related to the 
financial statements of Zeolyst International as of 
December 31, 2018 and 2017 and for each of the three 
years in the period ended December 31, 2018

Certification of Chief Executive Officer of PQ Group 
Holdings Inc. pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-
Oxley Act of 2002
Certification of Chief Financial Officer of PQ Group 
Holdings Inc. pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-
Oxley Act of 2002

Certification of Chief Executive Officer of PQ Group 
Holdings Inc. pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as 
adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley 
Act of 2002

Certification of Chief Financial Officer of PQ Group 
Holdings Inc. pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as 
adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley 
Act of 2002

101.INS XBRL Instance Document
101.SCH XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document
101.CAL XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase

Document

101.DEF XBRL Taxonomy Definition Linkbase Document
101.LAB XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document
101.PRE XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase

Document

86

Incorporated by Reference

Filed
Herewith

File 
No.

Form
S-1/A 333-218650

Exhibit
10.9

Filing 
Date
9/1/2017

8-K 001-38221

10.2

8/9/2018

S-1/A 333-218650 10.18

9/19/2017

8-K 001-38221

10.1

8/9/2018

8-K 001-38221

10.1

12/26/2018

S-1/A 333-218650 10.19

9/19/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.20

9/19/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.21

9/19/2017

S-1/A 333-218650 10.22

9/19/2017

X

X

X

X

X

X

X

X
X
X

X
X
X

* Management contract or compensatory plan

ITEM 16.   FORM 10-K SUMMARY.

None.

87

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly 

caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

SIGNATURES

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC.

Date: March 1, 2019

By:

/s/ MICHAEL CREWS

Michael Crews

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

(Duly Authorized Officer and Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

88

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following 

persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

Signature

Title

Date

/s/ BELGACEM CHARIAG

Chief Executive Officer, President and Director

March 1, 2019

Belgacem Chariag

(Principal Executive Officer)

/s/ MICHAEL CREWS

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

March 1, 2019

Michael Crews

(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

March 1, 2019

March 1, 2019

March 1, 2019

March 1, 2019

March 1, 2019

March 1, 2019

March 1, 2019

March 1, 2019

March 1, 2019

March 1, 2019

/s/ GREG BRENNEMAN

Director

Greg Brenneman

/s/ TIMOTHY WALSH

Director

Timothy Walsh

/s/ MARK McFADDEN

Director

Mark McFadden

/s/ ROBERT TOTH

Director

Robert Toth

/s/ ROBERT COXON

Director

Robert Coxon

/s/ ANDREW CURRIE

Director

Andrew Currie

/s/ JONNY GINNS

Director

Jonny Ginns

/s/ KYLE VANN

Kyle Vann

Director

/s/ MARTIN S. CRAIGHEAD Director
Martin S. Craighead

/s/ KIMBERLY ROSS

Director

Kimberly Ross

89

[THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 
 
 
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Audited Consolidated Financial Statements

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 

and 2016

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2018 and 2017

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Schedule I—Parent Company Financial Information

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
Audited Financial Statements

Report of Independent Auditors

Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2018 and 2017

Statements of Operations and Accumulated Earnings for the Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 

2016

Statements of Changes in Partners’ Capital for the Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

Notes to the Financial Statements

F-2

F-4

F-5

F-6

F-7

F-8

F-9

F-86

F-90

F-91

F-92

F-93

F-94

F-95

F-1

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of PQ Group Holdings Inc.

Opinions on the Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We  have  audited  the  accompanying  consolidated  balance  sheets  of  PQ  Group  Holdings  Inc.  and  its  subsidiaries  (the 
“Company”) as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive 
income (loss), stockholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018, 
including the related notes and schedule of condensed parent company information as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 and 
for each of the three years in the period ended  December 31, 2018 beginning on page F-86 (collectively referred to as the 
“consolidated financial statements”). We also have audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of 
December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee 
of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial 
position of the Company as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of 
the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the 
United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control 
over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework 
(2013) issued by the COSO.

Change in Accounting Principles

As discussed in Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company changed the manner in which it accounts for 
debt prepayment and extinguishment costs and restricted cash in 2018.  

Basis for Opinions

The Company’s management is responsible for these consolidated financial statements, for maintaining effective internal 
control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, 
included in Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting appearing under Item 9A. Our 
responsibility is to express opinions on the Company’s consolidated financial statements and on the Company’s internal 
control over financial reporting based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company 
Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in 
accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange 
Commission and the PCAOB. 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform 
the  audits  to  obtain  reasonable  assurance  about  whether  the  consolidated  financial  statements  are  free  of  material 
misstatement, whether due to error or fraud, and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained 
in all material respects. 

Our  audits  of  the  consolidated  financial  statements  included  performing  procedures  to  assess  the  risks  of  material 
misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond 
to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the 
consolidated  financial  statements.  Our  audits  also  included  evaluating  the  accounting  principles  used  and  significant 
estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. Our 
audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial 
reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness 
of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered 
necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

F-2

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the 
reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally 
accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures 
that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and 
dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to 
permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts 
and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of 
the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, 
use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, 
projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate 
because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania
March 1, 2019 

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2015.

F-3

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS 
(in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Sales

Cost of goods sold

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Other operating expense, net (Note 9)

Operating income

Equity in net (income) loss from affiliated companies

Interest expense, net

Debt extinguishment costs (Note 16)
Other expense (income), net

Income (loss) before income taxes and noncontrolling interest

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

Net income (loss)

Less: Net income attributable to the noncontrolling interest

Net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.

Net income (loss) per share:

Basic income (loss) per share

Diluted income (loss) per share

Weighted average shares outstanding:

Basic

Diluted

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

$

1,608,154

$

1,472,101

$

1,064,177

1,226,520

1,095,265

381,634

168,628

29,450

183,556
(37,611)
113,723

7,751

11,077

88,616

28,995

59,621

1,321

376,836

146,723

64,225

165,888
(38,772)
179,044

61,886

24,364
(60,634)
(119,197)
58,563

960

58,300

$

57,603

$

810,085

254,092

110,252

62,301

81,539

2,612

140,315

13,782
(6,053)
(69,117)
10,041
(79,158)
588
(79,746)

0.44

0.43

$

$

0.52

0.52

$

$

(1.02)
(1.02)

$

$

$

133,380,567

111,299,670

134,684,931

111,669,037

78,016,005

78,016,005

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 

F-4

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS) 
(in thousands) 

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

$

59,621

$

58,563

$

2016
(79,158)

6,865

4,557
(66,834)
(55,412)
(134,570)

(101)
(3,590)
60,601

56,910

115,473

(7,958)
(330)
(35,056)
(43,344)
16,277

1,392

(152)
115,625

$

(465)
(134,105)

Net income (loss)

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

Pension and postretirement benefits

Net (loss) gain from hedging activities

Foreign currency translation

Total other comprehensive income (loss)

Comprehensive income (loss)

Less: Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling

interests

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc. $

14,885

$

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 

F-5

 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS 
(in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

ASSETS

Cash and cash equivalents

Receivables, net

Inventories (Note 10)

Prepaid and other current assets

Total current assets

Investments in affiliated companies (Note 11)

Property, plant and equipment, net

Goodwill

Other intangible assets, net
Other long-term assets

Total assets

LIABILITIES

Notes payable and current maturities of long-term debt

Accounts payable

Accrued liabilities

Total current liabilities

Long-term debt, excluding current portion

Deferred income taxes

Other long-term liabilities

Total liabilities

Commitments and contingencies (Note 23)

EQUITY

Common stock ($0.01 par); authorized shares 450,000,000; issued shares 135,758,269
and 135,244,379 on December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively; outstanding shares
135,592,045 and 135,244,379 on December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively

Preferred stock ($0.01 par); authorized shares 50,000,000; no shares issued or

outstanding on December 31, 2018 and 2017

Additional paid-in capital

Retained earnings (accumulated deficit)

Treasury stock, at cost; shares 166,224 and 0 on December 31, 2018 and 2017,

respectively

Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income

Total PQ Group Holdings Inc. equity

Noncontrolling interest

Total equity

Total liabilities and equity

December 31,
2018

December 31,
2017

$

57,854

$

196,770

264,748

39,244

558,616

468,211

1,208,979

1,254,929

728,436

108,254

4,327,425

7,237

148,365

100,009

255,611

$

$

$

$

66,195

193,456

262,388

26,929

548,968

469,276

1,230,384

1,305,956

786,144

74,727

4,415,455

45,166

149,326

93,917

288,409

2,106,720

2,185,320

196,124

104,825

189,336

120,471

2,663,280

2,783,536

1,358

1,352

—

1,674,703

25,523

(2,920)
(39,104)
1,659,560

4,585

—

1,655,114
(32,777)

—

4,311

1,628,000

3,919

1,664,145

1,631,919

$

4,327,425

$

4,415,455

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-6

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
(in thousands, except share data) 

Shares of
Common
stock

Common
stock

Additional
paid-in
capital

Retained 
earnings 
(accum. 
deficit)

Shares
of
Treasury
stock

Treasury
stock, at
cost 

Accum.
other
comp.
income
(loss)

Non-
control-
ling 
interest

Total

December 31, 2015

22,683,077

$

— $

245,279

$ (10,634)

— $

— $

648

$

— $ 235,293

Business Combination

83,169,873

73

912,127

Net income (loss)

Other comp. loss

Stock repurchases

Equity contribution

529,375

—

6,486

(79,746)

(207,546)

(2,540)

9,255

114

6,569

588

(54,359)

(1,053)

918,769

(79,158)

(55,412)

(2,540)

6,600

(1,040)

(1,040)

December 31, 2016 106,452,330

$

73

$ 1,167,137

$ (90,380) $ (21.569) $

(239) $ (53,711) $

5,064

$1,027,944

70,005

3,245

176,722

2,187

5,432

57,603

960

58,563

(232,571)

29,000,000

989

290

(1,228)

480,406

232,534

239

—

480,696

8,799

—

—

(211,015)

—

58,022

(1,112)

56,910

(993)

(993)

8,799

—

$

1,352

$ 1,655,114

$ (32,777) $

— $

— $ 4,311

$

3,919

$1,631,919

58,300

1,321

59,621

(166,224)

(2,920)

(2,920)

(43,415)

71

(43,344)

19,464

6

125

—

—

(726)

(726)

19,464

131

$

1,358

$ 1,674,703

$

25,523

(166,274) $

(2,920) $ (39,104) $

4,585

$1,664,145

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-7

Distributions to

noncontrolling
interests

Stock compensation

expense

Net income

Stock split and
conversion

Issuance of common

stock - IPO

Other comprehensive
income (loss)

Distributions to

noncontrolling
interests

Stock compensation

expense

Shares issued under
equity incentive
plan, net of
forfeitures
December 31, 2017 135,244,379

24,620

Net income

Other comprehensive
income (loss)

Stock repurchases

Distributions to

noncontrolling
interests

Stock compensation

expense

Shares issued under
equity incentive
plan, net of
forfeitures
December 31, 2018 135,758,269

513,890

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS 
(in thousands) 

Years ended
December 31,
2017

2016

2018

$

59,621

$

58,563

$

(79,158)

Cash flows from operating activities:

Net income (loss)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating

activities:

Depreciation
Amortization
Amortization of inventory step-up
Intangible asset impairment charge
Amortization of deferred financing costs and original issue discount
Debt extinguishment costs
Foreign currency exchange loss (gain)
Pension and postretirement healthcare benefit expense
Pension and postretirement healthcare benefit funding
Deferred income tax provision (benefit)
Net loss on asset disposals
Stock compensation
Equity in net (income) loss from affiliated companies
Dividends received from affiliated companies
Net interest income on swaps designated as net investment hedges
Gain on contract termination
Other, net
Working capital changes that provided (used) cash, excluding the effect

of business combinations:

Receivables
Inventories
Prepaids and other current assets
Accounts payable
Accrued liabilities

Cash flows from investing activities:

Net cash provided by operating activities

Purchases of property, plant and equipment
Investment in affiliated companies
Loan receivable under the New Markets Tax Credit Arrangement
Business combinations, net of cash acquired
Proceeds from sale of assets
Net interest proceeds on swaps designated as net investment hedges
Other, net

Net cash used in investing activities

Cash flows from financing activities:

132,640
52,594
1,603
—
6,119
5,627
13,810
1,073
(7,602)
3,445
6,574
19,464
(37,611)
40,195
(4,859)
(20,612)
(1,517)

(10,451)
(8,980)
(6,348)
(146)
4,005
248,644

(131,688)
(5,000)
—
(1,006)
12,380
4,859
1,165
(119,290)

Draw down of revolver
Repayments of revolver
Issuance of long-term debt, net of original issue discount and financing fees
Issuance of long-term notes, net of original issue discount and financing fees
Debt issuance costs
Repayments of long-term debt
Debt prepayment fees
IPO proceeds
IPO costs
Interest hedge premium
Equity contribution
Stock repurchases
Distributions to noncontrolling interests
Other

Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash
Net change in cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at beginning of period
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at end of period

$

141,764
(166,778)
1,267,000
—
(6,395)
(1,369,690)
—
—
—
—
—
(2,920)
(725)
519
(137,225)
354
(7,517)
67,243
59,726

$

For supplemental cash flow disclosures, see Note 28.
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
F-8

124,551
52,589
871
—
8,733
61,362
25,786
3,289
(7,887)
(140,212)
5,793
8,799
(38,772)
44,071
—
—
(4,061)

(11,463)
(21,200)
(3,434)
4,343
(6,548)
165,173

(140,482)
(9,000)
(6,221)
(41,572)
—
—
1,293
(195,982)

357,773
(334,180)
308,550
—
(4,666)
(739,472)
(47,875)
507,500
(26,804)
—
—
—
(993)
—
19,833
(6,858)
(17,834)
85,077
67,243

$

89,453
38,836
29,086
6,873
6,859
8,561
(3,558)
1,957
(2,887)
(138)
4,216
5,432
2,612
7,636
—
—
(7,091)

27,757
(2,305)
548
11,885
(23,866)
122,708

(121,421)
—
(15,598)
(1,777,740)
—
—
(1,004)
(1,915,763)

145,000
(167,000)
1,248,556
1,133,265
(23,786)
(479,059)
—
—
—
(1,551)
6,600
(2,540)
(1,040)
—
1,858,445
(5,886)
59,504
25,573
85,077

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

1. Background and Basis of Presentation: 

Description of Business 

PQ Group Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company” or “PQ Group Holdings”) conducts operations through two 
reporting segments: (1) Environmental Catalysts and Services: a leading global innovator and producer of silica catalysts 
used in the production of high-density polyethylene (“HDPE”), methyl methacrylate (“MMA”), specialty zeolite-based 
catalysts sold to the emission control industry, the petrochemical industry and other areas of the broader chemicals industry 
and a merchant sulfuric acid producer operating a network of plants serving a variety of end uses, including the oil refining, 
nylon, mining, general industrial and chemical industries; and (2) Performance Materials and Chemicals: a fully integrated, 
global leader in silicate technology, producing sodium silicate, specialty silicas, zeolites, spray dry silicates, magnesium 
silicate, and other high performance chemical products used in a variety of end-uses such as adsorbents for surface coatings, 
clarifying agents for beverages, cleaning and personal care products and engineered glass products for use in highway safety, 
polymer additives, metal finishing and electronics end uses.

Seasonal changes and weather conditions typically affect the Company’s performance materials and refining services 
product groups. In particular, the Company’s performance materials product group generally experiences lower sales and 
profit in the first and fourth quarters of the year because highway striping projects typically occur during warmer weather 
months. Additionally, the Company’s refining services product group typically experiences similar seasonal fluctuations as 
a result of higher demand for gasoline products in the summer months. As a result, working capital requirements tend to be 
higher in the first and fourth quarters of the year, which can adversely affect the Company’s liquidity and cash flows. Because 
of this seasonality associated with certain of the Company’s product groups, results for any one quarter are not necessarily 
indicative of the results that may be achieved for any other quarter or for the full year. 

Basis of Presentation 

PQ Merger with Eco Services

On August 17, 2015, the Company, PQ Holdings Inc. (“PQ Holdings”), Eco Services Operations LLC (“Eco Services”), 
certain  investment  funds  affiliated  with  CCMP  Capital Advisors,  LLC  (now  known  as  CCMP  Capital Advisors,  LP; 
“CCMP”), and stockholders of PQ Holdings and Eco Services entered into a reorganization and transaction agreement 
pursuant to which the companies consummated a series of transactions to reorganize and combine the businesses of PQ 
Holdings and Eco Services (the “Business Combination”), under a new holding company, PQ Group Holdings Inc. The 
Business Combination was consummated on May 4, 2016. 

In accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”), Eco Services is the 
accounting predecessor to PQ Group Holdings. Certain investment funds affiliated with CCMP held a controlling interest 
position in Eco Services prior to the Business Combination. In addition, certain investment funds affiliated with CCMP 
owned a non-controlling interest in PQ Holdings prior to the Business Combination and the merger with Eco Services 
constituted a change in control under the PQ Holdings credit agreements and bond indenture that were in place at the time 
of the Business Combination. Therefore, Eco Services is deemed to be the accounting acquirer. These consolidated financial 
statements are the continuation of Eco Services’ business prior to the Business Combination. 

Stock Split and Initial Public Offering

Prior to September 22, 2017, the Company had two classes of common stock designated as Class A and Class B 
common stock. On September 22, 2017, the Company reclassified its Class A common stock into common stock and then 
effected a 8.8275-for-1 split of its common stock. On September 28, 2017, the Company converted each outstanding share 
of Class B common stock into 8.8275 shares of common stock plus an additional number of shares determined by dividing 
the unreturned paid-in capital amount of such Class B common stock, or $113.74 per share, by $17.50, the price of a share 
of common stock in the Company’s initial public offering (“IPO”), rounded to the nearest whole share. Holders of Class B 
common stock did not receive any cash payments from the Company in connection with the conversion of the Class B 
common stock. As a result of the reclassification of Class A common stock into common stock, and the conversion of Class 
B common stock into common stock, all references to “Class A common stock” and “Class B common stock” have been 
changed to “common stock” for all periods presented. All previously reported per share and common share amounts in the 
accompanying financial statements and related notes have been restated to reflect the stock split.

F-9

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

On October 3, 2017, the Company completed its IPO whereby it issued 29,000,000 shares of its common stock at a 
price of $17.50 per share. The shares began trading on the New York Stock Exchange on September 29, 2017. The aggregate 
proceeds  received  by  the  Company  from  the  offering  were  $480,696,  net  of  underwriting  discounts,  commissions  and 
offering expenses. The net proceeds were used to repay existing indebtedness as further described in Note 16.

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies: 

Principles  of  Consolidation. The  consolidated  financial  statements  include  the  accounts  of  the  Company  and  its 
controlled  subsidiaries.  Investments  in  affiliated  companies  are  recorded  at  cost  plus  the  Company’s  equity  in  their 
undistributed earnings. All intercompany transactions have been eliminated. Noncontrolling interests represent third-party 
equity ownership in certain of the Company’s consolidated subsidiaries and are presented as a component of equity separate 
from the equity attributable to the Company’s shareholders. The noncontrolling interests’ share in the Company’s net earnings 
are included in net income attributable to the noncontrolling interest in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations, 
and their portion of the Company’s comprehensive income is included in comprehensive loss attributable to noncontrolling 
interests in the Company’s consolidated statements of comprehensive income (loss). The Company’s noncontrolling interests 
relate to third-party minority ownership interests held in certain of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries acquired as part of 
the Business Combination. 

Foreign Currency Translation. All assets and liabilities of foreign subsidiaries and affiliated companies are translated 
to U.S. dollars using exchange rates in effect at the balance sheet date. Adjustments resulting from translation of the balance 
sheets and intercompany loans, which are considered permanent, are included in stockholders’ equity as part of accumulated 
other comprehensive income (loss). Adjustments resulting from translation of certain intercompany loans, which are not 
considered  permanent  and  are  denominated  in  foreign  currencies,  are  included  in  other  (income)  expense,  net  in  the 
consolidated statements of operations. The Company considers intercompany loans to be of a permanent or long-term nature 
if management expects and intends that the loans will not be repaid. For the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 
2016, all intercompany loan arrangements were determined to be non-permanent based on management’s intention as well 
as actual lending and repayment activity. Therefore, the foreign currency transaction gains or losses associated with the 
intercompany loans were recorded in the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31, 2018, 
2017 and 2016.

Income and expense items are translated at average exchange rates during the year. Net foreign currency exchange 
(gains)  and  losses  included  in  other  expense  (income),  net  were  $13,810,  $25,786  and  $(3,558)  for  the  years  ended 
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. The net foreign currency losses realized in 2018 and 2017 and gain realized 
in 2016 were primarily driven by the Euro-denominated term loan (which was settled as part of the February 2018 term 
loan refinancing, see Note 16 to these consolidated financial statements for further information) and the non-permanent 
intercompany debt denominated in local currency and translated to U.S. dollars.

Cash and Cash Equivalents. Cash and cash equivalents include investments with original terms to maturity of 90 days 

or less from the time of purchase. 

Restricted Cash. Restricted cash, which is restricted as to withdrawal or usage, is classified separately from cash and 
cash equivalents on our consolidated balance sheets. The proceeds from the New Markets Tax Credit (“NMTC”) financing 
arrangements are restricted for use and are classified on the Company’s consolidated balance sheets as other current assets. 
See Note 16 to these consolidated financial statements for further information regarding the NMTC financing arrangements. 
The Company’s total restricted cash balances, including cash related to the NMTC financing arrangements, were $1,872
and $1,048 as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, and are included on the Company’s consolidated balance sheets 
as other current assets.

Accounts Receivable and Allowance for Doubtful Accounts. Trade accounts receivable are recorded at the invoiced 
amount and do not bear interest. The allowance for doubtful accounts is the Company’s best estimate of the amount of 
probable credit losses in its existing accounts receivable. A specific reserve for bad debt is recorded for known or suspected 
doubtful accounts receivable. For all other accounts, the Company recognizes a reserve for bad debt based on the length of 
time receivables are past due and historical write-off experience. Account balances are charged against the allowance when 
the Company believes it is probable that the associated receivables will not be recovered. If the financial condition of the 
Company’s customers were to deteriorate resulting in an impairment of their ability to make payments, additional allowances 

F-10

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

may  be  required.  The  Company  does  not  have  any  off-balance  sheet  credit  exposure  related  to  its  customers. As  of 
December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company’s allowance for doubtful accounts was not material. 

Inventories. Certain domestic inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market and valued using the last-in, first-
out (“LIFO”) method. All other inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value and valued using the 
weighted average cost or first-in, first-out (“FIFO”) methods.

Property, Plant and Equipment. Property, plant and equipment are carried at cost and include expenditures for new 
facilities, major renewals and betterments. The Company capitalizes the cost of furnace rebuilds as part of property, plant 
and equipment. Plant and equipment under capital leases are carried at the present value of minimum lease payments as 
determined at the beginning of the lease term. Maintenance, repairs and minor renewals are charged to expense as incurred. 
The Company capitalizes certain internal costs associated with the implementation of purchased software. When property, 
plant and equipment is retired or otherwise disposed of, the net carrying amount is eliminated with any gain or loss on 
disposition recognized in earnings at that time. The Company also leases property, plant and equipment, principally under 
operating leases. Rent expense for operating leases, which may have escalating rentals or rent holidays, is recorded on a 
straight-line basis over the respective lease terms. 

Depreciation is provided on the straight-line method based on the estimated useful lives of the assets, which generally 
range from 15 to 33 years for buildings and improvements and 3 to 10 years for machinery and equipment. Leasehold 
improvements are depreciated using the straight-line method based on the shorter of the useful life of the improvement or 
remaining lease term. 

The Company capitalizes the interest cost associated with the development and construction of significant new plant 
and equipment and depreciates that amount over the lives of the related assets. Capitalized interest recorded during the years 
ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016 was $3,542, $5,806 and $5,687, respectively.

Spare Parts. Spare parts are maintained by the Company’s facilities to keep machinery and equipment in working 
order.  Spare  parts  are  capitalized  and  included  in  other  long-term  assets.  Spare  parts  are  measured  at  cost  and  are  not 
depreciated or expensed until utilized; however, reserves may be provided on aged spare parts. When a spare part is utilized 
as part of an improvement to property, plant and equipment, the carrying value is depreciated over the applicable life once 
placed in service. Otherwise, the spare part is expensed and charged as a cost of production when utilized. 

Investments in Affiliated Companies. Investments in affiliated companies are accounted for using the equity method 
of accounting if the investment provides the Company with the ability to exercise significant influence, but not control, 
over the investee. Significant influence is generally deemed to exist if the Company’s ownership interest in the voting stock 
of the investee ranges between 20% and 50%, although other factors, such as representation on the investee’s board of 
directors and the impact of commercial arrangements, are considered in determining whether the equity method of accounting 
is appropriate. Under the equity method of accounting, the investments in equity-method investees are recorded in the 
consolidated balance sheets as investments in affiliated companies, and the Company’s share of the investees’ earnings or 
losses, together with other-than temporary impairments in value, is recorded as equity in net income (loss) from affiliated 
companies in the consolidated statements of operations. Any differences between the Company’s cost of an equity method 
investment and the underlying equity in the net assets of the investment, such as fair value step-ups resulting from acquisitions, 
are accounted for according to their nature and impact the amounts recognized as equity in net income (loss) from affiliated 
companies in the consolidated statements of operations. 

The Company evaluates all distributions received from its equity method investments using the nature of distribution 
approach.  Under this approach, the Company evaluates the nature of activities of the investee that generated the distribution. 
The distributions received are either classified as a return on investment, which is presented as a component of operating 
activities on the Company’s consolidated statements of cash flows, or as a return of investment, which is presented as a 
component of investing activities on the Company’s consolidated statements of cash flows.

The Company evaluates its equity method investments for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances 
indicate that the carrying amounts of such investments may be impaired. If a decline in the value of an equity method 
investment is determined to be other than temporary, a loss is recorded in earnings in the current period.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets. Goodwill is an asset representing the future economic benefits arising from other 
assets acquired in a business combination that are not individually identified and separately recognized. The Company is 

F-11

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

required to test goodwill associated with each of its reporting units for impairment at least annually and whenever events 
or circumstances indicate that it is more likely than not that goodwill may be impaired. The Company performs its annual 
goodwill impairment test as of October 1 of each year. 

Goodwill is tested for impairment at the reporting unit level. In performing tests for goodwill impairment, the Company 
is permitted to first perform a qualitative assessment about the likelihood of the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeding 
its fair value. If an entity determines that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its 
carrying amount based on the qualitative assessment, it is required to perform a two-step goodwill impairment test to identify 
the potential goodwill impairment and measure the amount of the goodwill impairment loss, if any, to be recognized for 
that reporting unit. However, if an entity concludes otherwise based on the qualitative assessment, the two-step goodwill 
impairment test is not required. The option to perform the qualitative assessment can be utilized at the Company’s discretion, 
and the qualitative assessment need not be applied to all reporting units in a given goodwill impairment test. For an individual 
reporting unit, if the Company elects not to perform the qualitative assessment, or if the qualitative assessment indicates 
that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, then the Company must 
perform the two-step goodwill impairment test for the reporting unit.  

In applying the two-step process, the first step used to identify potential impairment involves comparing the reporting 
unit’s estimated fair value to its carrying value, including goodwill. If the estimated fair value of a reporting unit exceeds 
its carrying value, goodwill is not impaired. If the carrying value exceeds the estimated fair value, there is an indication of 
potential impairment and the second step is performed to measure the amount of impairment, if any. The second step of the 
process involves the calculation of an implied fair value of goodwill for each reporting unit for which step one indicated 
potential impairment. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined in a manner similar to how goodwill is calculated 
in a business combination. That is, the estimated fair value of the reporting unit, as calculated in step one, is allocated to 
the individual assets and liabilities as if the reporting unit was being acquired in a business combination. If the implied fair 
value of goodwill exceeds the carrying value of goodwill assigned to the reporting unit, there is no impairment. If the 
carrying value of goodwill assigned to a reporting unit exceeds the implied fair value of the goodwill, an impairment charge 
is recorded to write down the carrying value. An impairment loss cannot exceed the carrying value of goodwill assigned to 
a reporting unit and the loss establishes a new basis in the goodwill. Subsequent reversal of an impairment loss is not 
permitted. 

For intangible assets other than goodwill, definite-lived intangible assets are amortized over their respective estimated 
useful lives. Intangible assets with indefinite lives are not amortized, but rather are tested for impairment at least annually 
or more frequently if events occur or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of the 
intangible asset below its carrying amount. The Company tests its indefinite-lived intangible assets as of October 1 of each 
year in conjunction with its annual goodwill impairment test. 

Impairment Assessment of Long-Lived Assets. The Company performs an impairment review of property, plant and 
equipment and definite-lived intangible assets when facts and circumstances indicate that the carrying value of an asset or 
asset  group  may  not  be  recoverable  from  its  undiscounted  future  cash  flows.  When  evaluating  long-lived  assets  for 
impairment, if the carrying amount of an asset or asset group is found not to be recoverable, a potential impairment loss 
may be recognized. An impairment loss is measured by comparing the carrying amount of the asset or asset group to its fair 
value. Fair value is determined using quoted market prices when available, or other techniques including discounted cash 
flows.  The  Company’s  estimates  of  future  cash  flows  involve  assumptions  concerning  future  operating  performance, 
economic conditions and technological changes that may affect the future useful lives of the assets. 

Derivative Financial Instruments. The Company utilizes certain derivative financial instruments to enhance its ability 
to manage risk, including exposure to interest rate, commodity price, and foreign currency fluctuations that exist as part of 
ongoing business operations. Derivative instruments are entered into for periods consistent with the related underlying 
exposures and do not constitute positions independent of those exposures. 

All derivatives designated as hedges are recognized on the consolidated balance sheets at fair value. The Company 
may designate a derivative as a hedge of the fair value of a recognized asset or liability or of an unrecognized firm commitment 
(fair value hedge), a hedge of a forecasted transaction or the variability of cash flows to be received or paid related to a 
recognized asset or liability (cash flow hedge), a foreign currency fair-value or cash-flow hedge (foreign currency hedge), 

F-12

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

or a hedge of a net investment in a foreign operation (net investment hedge). The Company’s hedging strategies include 
derivatives designated as cash flow hedges and net investment hedges.

Changes in the fair value of a derivative that is highly effective and that is designated and qualifies as a cash flow 
hedge are recorded in other comprehensive income and subsequently reclassified into earnings in the same period(s) in 
which the hedged transaction affects earnings. Changes in the fair value of a derivative that is highly effective and that is 
designated and qualifies as a hedge of a net investment in a foreign operation are recorded in the foreign currency translation 
adjustment account within accumulated other comprehensive income, where the associated gains and losses will remain 
until such time that the hedged net investment (foreign subsidiary) is sold or liquidated.

Changes in the fair value of a derivative that is not designated or does not qualify as a hedge are recorded in the 
consolidated statements of operations. Cash flows from derivative instruments are reported in the same cash flow category 
as the cash flows from the items being hedged. 

The Company formally documents all relationships between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as its 
risk-management objective and strategy for undertaking various hedge transactions. The Company also formally assesses 
whether each hedging relationship is highly effective in achieving offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of the 
hedged item during the period, both at the inception of the hedge and on an ongoing basis. If it is determined that a derivative 
is not highly effective as a hedge, or if a derivative ceases to be a highly-effective hedge, hedge accounting is discontinued 
with respect to that derivative prospectively. 

Fair Value Measurements. The Company measures fair value using the guidelines under GAAP. An asset’s fair value 
is defined as the price at which the asset could be exchanged in a current transaction between market participants. A liability’s 
fair value is defined as the amount that would be paid to transfer the liability to a market participant, not the amount that 
would be paid to settle the liability with the creditor. See Note 5 to these consolidated financial statements regarding the 
application of fair value measurements. 

The carrying values of cash, accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued liabilities approximate fair value due 
to the short-term nature of these items. See Note 16 to these consolidated financial statements regarding the fair value of 
debt. 

Revenue Recognition. In determining the appropriate amount of revenue to be recognized as the Company fulfills its 
obligations under its agreements, the Company performs the following steps: (i) identification of the contract with the 
customer; (ii) determination of whether the promised goods or services are performance obligations, including whether they 
are distinct in the context of the contract; (iii) measurement of the transaction price; (iv) allocation of the transaction price 
to the performance obligations based on estimated selling prices; and (v) recognition of revenue when (or as) the Company 
satisfies each performance obligation. 

The  Company  identifies  a  contract  when  an  agreement  with  a  customer  creates  legally  enforceable  rights  and 
obligations, which occurs when a contract has been approved by both parties, the parties are committed to perform their 
respective obligations, each party’s rights and payment terms are clearly identified, commercial substance exists and it is 
probable that the Company will collect the consideration to which it is entitled. 

The  Company  may  offer  rebates  to  customers  who  have  reached  a  specified  volume  of  optional  purchases. The 
Company recognizes rebates given to customers as a reduction of revenue based on an allocation of the cost of honoring 
rebates earned and claimed to each of the underlying revenue transactions that result in progress by the customer toward 
earning the rebate. Rebates are recognized at the time revenue is recorded. The Company measures the rebate obligation 
based on the estimated amount of sales that will result in a rebate at the adjusted sales price per the respective sales agreement. 

Shipping and Handling Costs. Amounts billed to a customer in a sale transaction related to shipping and handling, if 
any, represent revenues earned for the goods provided and are classified as revenue. Costs related to shipping and handling 
of products shipped to customers are classified as cost of goods sold. Refer to Note 4  for disclosures regarding the recognition 
of revenue for shipping and handling costs that are billed to customers.

Research and Development. Research and development costs of $15,565, $13,859 and $7,266 for the years ended 
December 31,  2018,  2017  and  2016,  respectively,  were  expensed  as  incurred  and  reported  in  selling,  general  and 
administrative expenses in the consolidated statements of operations.

F-13

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Income Taxes. Prior to the Business Combination, Eco Services was a single member limited liability company and 
was treated as a partnership for federal and state tax purposes. All income tax liabilities and/or benefits of the Company 
were passed through to the member. As such, no recognition of federal or state income taxes for the Company have been 
provided for tax periods prior to the Business Combination. As a result of the Business Combination, Eco Services had a 
change in tax status and is taxed as a C-Corporation.

The Company operates within multiple taxing jurisdictions and are subject to tax filing requirements and audit within 
these jurisdictions. The Company uses the asset and liability method in accounting for income taxes. Deferred tax assets 
and liabilities are recorded for temporary differences between the tax basis of assets and liabilities and their reported amounts 
in the financial statements, using statutory tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. 
The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in the results of operations in the period 
that includes the enactment date. The Company evaluates its deferred tax assets each period to ensure that estimated future 
taxable income will be sufficient in character (e.g., capital gain versus ordinary income treatment), amount and timing to 
result in their recovery. A valuation allowance is recorded to reduce the carrying amounts of deferred tax assets unless it is 
more likely than not that those assets will be realized. 

In determining the provision for income taxes, the Company provides deferred income taxes on income from foreign 
subsidiaries as such earnings are taxable upon remittance to the United States, to the extent that these earnings are considered 
to be available for repatriation. The Company does not provide income taxes on the cumulative unremitted earnings of 
foreign  subsidiaries  considered  permanently  reinvested.  The  Company  establishes  contingent  liabilities  for  possible 
assessments  by  taxing  authorities  resulting  from  uncertain  tax  positions  including,  but  not  limited  to,  transfer  pricing, 
deductibility of certain expenses and other state, local, and foreign tax matters. The Company recognizes a financial statement 
benefit for positions taken for tax return purposes when it will be more likely than not (greater than 50%) that the positions 
will be sustained upon tax examination, based solely on the technical merits of the tax positions, otherwise, no benefit is 
recognized. The tax benefits recognized are measured based on the largest benefit that has a greater than 50% likelihood 
of being realized upon ultimate settlement. The Company recognizes potential accrued interest and penalties related to 
unrecognized tax benefits in income tax expense. Tax examinations are often complex as tax authorities may disagree with 
the treatment of items reported by the Company and may require several years to resolve. These accrued liabilities represent 
a provision for taxes that are reasonably expected to be incurred on the basis of available information but which are not 
certain. 

Pursuant to the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) Staff Accounting Bulletin No.118 (“SAB 118”), the 
Company was allowed a measurement period of up to one year after the enactment date of the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act 
(“TCJA”) to finalize the recording of any related tax impacts with respect to its transition tax liability. As of December 31, 
2017, the Company’s accounting for these impacts was provisional. However, in accordance with SAB 118, the Company 
has finalized the impacts of the transition tax as of December 31, 2018 and has recorded a measurement period adjustment 
of $2,102 as a benefit to tax expense. There was no cash tax outlay associated with the final transition tax amount, as the 
Company elected to utilize net operating loss (“NOL”) carryforwards to offset the associated taxable income. 

Based on FASB guidance, the Company is permitted to make an accounting policy election to either (1) treat the 
taxes incurred as a result of the GILTI provision as a current-period expense when incurred or (2) factor such amounts into 
its measurement of deferred taxes. The Company has elected to treat any expense incurred as a current-period expense.

Asset Retirement Obligations. The Company records a liability when the fair value of any future obligation to retire 
a  long-lived  asset  as  a  result  of  an  existing  or  enacted  law,  statute,  ordinance  or  contract  is  reasonably  estimable. The 
Company  also  records  a  liability  for  the  fair  value  of  a  conditional  asset  retirement  obligation  if  the  fair  value  can  be 
reasonably estimated. When the liability is initially recorded, the Company capitalizes the cost by increasing the amount 
of the related long-lived asset. Over time, the Company adjusts the liability to its present value by recognizing accretion 
expense  as  an  operating  expense  in  the  consolidated  statements  of  operations  each  period,  and  the  capitalized  cost  is 
depreciated over the useful life of the related asset. Upon settlement of the liability, the Company records a gain or loss if 
the actual costs differ from the accrued amount. 

The Company has recorded asset retirement obligations (“AROs”) identified as part of the Business Combination in 
other long-term liabilities in order to recognize legal obligations associated with the retirement of tangible long-lived assets. 
The Company has assessed whether an ARO is required at each manufacturing facility and has recorded an obligation for 

F-14

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

those locations for which an obligation exists. The most significant of these are primarily attributable to environmental 
remediation liabilities associated with current operations that were incurred during the course of normal operations. The 
Company has AROs that are conditional in nature. The Company identified certain conditional AROs upon which it was 
able to reasonably estimate their fair value and recorded a liability. These AROs were triggered upon commitments by the 
Company to comply with local, state, and national laws to remove environmentally hazardous materials. The AROs have 
been recognized on a discounted basis using a credit adjusted risk free rate. Accretion of the AROs is recorded in other 
operating expense, net in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations. The following table includes the changes 
in the Company’s ARO liability during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017: 

Beginning balance

Accretion expense

Foreign exchange impact
Ending balance

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

$

$

4,094

$

287
(157)
4,224

$

3,700

232

162
4,094

Environmental Expenditures. Environmental expenditures that pertain to current operations or to future revenues are 
expensed or capitalized consistent with the Company’s capitalization policy for property, plant and equipment. Expenditures 
that result from the remediation of an existing condition caused by past operations and that do not contribute to current or 
future revenues are expensed. Liabilities are recognized for remedial activities when the remediation is probable and the 
cost can be reasonably estimated. Recoveries of expenditures for environmental remediation are recognized as assets only 
when recovery is deemed probable. See Note 23 to these consolidated financial statements regarding commitments and 
contingencies and Note 15 regarding the accrued environmental reserve. 

Deferred Financing Costs. Financing costs incurred in connection with the issuance of long-term debt are deferred 
and presented as a direct reduction from the related debt instruments on the Company’s consolidated balance sheets. Deferred 
financing costs are amortized as interest expense using the effective interest method over the respective terms of the associated 
debt instruments. 

Stock-Based Compensation. The Company applies the fair value based method to account for stock options, restricted 
stock awards and restricted stock units issued in connection with its equity incentive plans. Stock-based compensation 
expense is recognized on a straight-line basis over the vesting periods of the respective awards, and the Company accounts 
for  forfeitures  of  equity  incentive  awards  as  they  occur.  In  connection  with  the  vesting  of  restricted  stock  awards  and 
restricted stock units, shares of common stock may be delivered to the Company by employees to satisfy withholding tax 
obligations at the instruction of the employee award holders. These transactions when they occur are accounted for as stock 
repurchases by the Company, with the shares returned to treasury stock at a cost representing the payment by the Company 
of the tax obligations on behalf of the employees in lieu of shares for the vesting event. See Note 22 to these consolidated 
financial statements regarding compensation expense associated with the Company’s equity incentive awards. 

Pensions and Postretirement Benefits. The Company maintains qualified and non-qualified defined benefit pension 
plans that cover employees in the United States and Canada, as well as certain employees in other international locations. 
Benefits for a majority of the plans are based on average final pay and years of service. Our funding policy, consistent with 
statutory requirements, is based on actuarial computations utilizing the projected unit credit method of calculation. Not all 
defined benefit pension plans are funded. In the United States and Canada, the pension plans’ assets include equity and 
fixed income securities. In our other international locations, the pension plans’ assets include equity and fixed income 
securities, as well as insurance contracts. Certain assumptions are made regarding the occurrence of future events affecting 
pension costs, such as mortality, withdrawal, disablement and retirement, changes in compensation and benefits, and discount 
rates to reflect the time value of money. 

The major elements in determining pension income and expense are pension liability discount rates and the expected 
return on plan assets. The Company references rates of return on high-quality, fixed income investments when estimating 
the discount rate, and the expected period over which payments will be made based upon historical experience. The long-

F-15

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

term rate of return used to calculate the expected return on plan assets is the average rate of return estimated to be earned 
on invested funds for providing pension benefits. 

In  addition  to  pension  benefits,  the  Company  provides  certain  health  care  benefits  for  employees  who  meet  age, 
participation  and  length  of  service  requirements  at  retirement. The  Company  uses  explicit  assumptions  using  the  best 
estimates available of the plan’s future experience. Principal actuarial assumptions include: discount rates, present value 
factors, retirement age, participation rates, mortality rates, cost trend rates, Medicare reimbursement rates and per capita 
claims cost by age. Current interest rates as of the measurement date are used for discount rates in present value calculations. 

The  Company  also  has  defined  contribution  plans  covering  domestic  employees  of  the  Company  and  certain 

subsidiaries. 

Contingencies. Certain conditions may exist as of the date the financial statements are issued, which may result in a 
loss to the Company but which will only be resolved when one or more future events occur or fail to occur. The Company’s 
management and its legal counsel assess such contingent liabilities, and such assessment inherently involves an exercise 
of judgment. In assessing loss contingencies related to legal proceedings that are pending against the Company or unasserted 
claims that may result in such proceedings, the Company and legal counsel evaluate the perceived merits of any legal 
proceedings or unasserted claims as well as the perceived merits of the amount of relief sought or expected to be sought 
therein. If the assessment of a contingency indicates that it is probable that a loss has been incurred and the amount of the 
liability can be estimated, then the estimated liability is accrued in the Company’s financial statements. If the assessment 
indicates that a loss contingency is not probable, but is reasonably possible, or is probable but cannot be estimated, then the 
nature of the contingent liability, together with an estimate of the range of possible loss if determinable and material, would 
be disclosed. Loss contingencies considered remote are generally not disclosed unless they involve guarantees, in which 
case the nature of the guarantee would be disclosed, including the approximate term, how the guarantee arose, and the events 
or circumstances that would require the guarantor to perform under the guarantee. 

Use of Estimates. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make 
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and 
liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting 
period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. 

3. New Accounting Standards:

Recently Adopted Accounting Standards 

In August 2018, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued guidance which will align the requirements 
for capitalizing implementation costs incurred in a cloud computing arrangement (i.e., a hosting arrangement) that is a 
service contract with the requirements for capitalizing implementation costs incurred to develop or obtain internal-use 
software. Capitalized implementation costs related to a hosting arrangement that is a service contract will be amortized over 
the term of the hosting arrangement, beginning when the module or component of the hosting arrangement is ready for its 
intended use. The guidance is effective for public companies for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019, including 
all interim periods within that fiscal year. Early adoption is permitted, and the guidance can be applied either retrospectively 
or prospectively to all implementation costs incurred after the date of adoption. The Company early adopted the guidance 
effective  October  1,  2018  and  has  applied  the  guidance  on  a  prospective  basis  for  any  implementation  costs  incurred 
subsequent to the adoption date, with no significant impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In August 2017, the FASB issued amendments related to hedge accounting. The amendments expand hedge accounting 
for non-financial and financial risk components and revise the measurement methodologies to better align with an entity’s 
risk management activities. Separate presentation of hedge ineffectiveness is eliminated to provide greater transparency of 
the full impact of hedging by requiring presentation of the results of the hedged item and hedging instrument in a single 
financial statement line item. In addition, the amendments reduce complexity by simplifying the manner in which assessments 
of hedge effectiveness may be performed. The new guidance is effective for public companies for annual periods beginning 
after December 15, 2018, including interim periods within those years. Early adoption is permitted, and the guidance should 
be  applied  prospectively  for  the  amended  presentation  and  disclosure  requirements,  and  through  a  cumulative-effect 
adjustment to beginning retained earnings for any cash flow and net investment hedges existing at the date of adoption. The 
Company early adopted the guidance effective January 1, 2018. The Company’s cash flow hedges in place at the date of 

F-16

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

adoption yielded an immaterial amount of ineffectiveness; therefore, the Company did not reflect an adjustment to beginning 
retained earnings upon adoption. The amended presentation and disclosure requirements are reflected under the new guidance 
in Note 18 to these consolidated financial statements.

In May 2017, the FASB issued guidance to clarify which changes to the terms or conditions of a share-based payment 
award require an entity to apply modification accounting. Under the new guidance, an entity should account for the effects 
of a change in a share-based payment award using modification accounting unless the fair value, vesting conditions and 
classification as either a liability or equity are all the same with respect to the award immediately prior to modification and 
the modified award itself. The new guidance is effective for annual periods beginning after December 15, 2017, including 
interim periods within those years, and the new guidance should be applied prospectively to awards modified on or after 
the adoption date. The Company adopted the new guidance on January 1, 2018 as required, with no impact on the Company’s 
consolidated financial statements upon adoption.

In March 2017, the FASB issued guidance to improve the presentation of net periodic pension cost and net periodic 
postretirement benefit cost (collectively, “pension costs”). Under current GAAP, there are several components of pension 
costs which are presented net to arrive at pension costs as included in the income statement and disclosed in the notes. As 
part of this amendment to the existing guidance, the service cost component of pension costs will be bifurcated from the 
other components and included in the same line items of the income statement as compensation costs are reported. The 
remaining components will be reported together below operating income on the income statement, either as a separate line 
item or combined with another line item on the income statement and disclosed. Additionally, with respect to capitalization 
to inventory, fixed assets, etc., only the service cost component will be eligible for capitalization upon adoption of the 
guidance. The  new  guidance  is  effective  for  public  companies  for  annual  periods  beginning  after  December 15,  2017, 
including interim periods within those years. The amendments should be applied retrospectively upon adoption with respect 
to the presentation of the service and other cost components of pension costs in the income statement, and prospectively 
for the capitalization of the service cost component in assets. 

The Company adopted the new guidance on January 1, 2018 as required. Prior to the adoption of the guidance, the 
Company  reflected  its  pension  costs  within  cost  of  goods  sold  and  selling,  general  and  administrative  expenses  in  the 
consolidated  statements  of  operations,  depending  on  whether  the  costs  were  associated  with  employees  involved  in 
manufacturing or back office support functions. Under the new guidance, the service cost component of the Company’s 
pension costs remained in the same line items of the consolidated statements of operations, but the remaining components 
are now reported as part of nonoperating income in the other (income) expense, net line item of the consolidated statements 
of operations. Although the guidance requires retrospective application upon adoption, a practical expedient permits the 
Company to use the amounts disclosed in its pension and other post-retirement benefit plan note as its basis of estimation 
for the prior comparative periods. The Company utilized the practical expedient, and $1,616 and $2,651 of a net pension 
benefit for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively, was reclassified to other expense (income), net. For 
the year ended December 31, 2018, the amount of pension costs included in other expense (income), net was a net benefit 
of $3,625.

In January 2017, the FASB issued guidance that clarifies the definition of a business and provides revised criteria and 
a framework to determine whether an integrated set of assets and activities is a business. For public companies, the new 
guidance is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2017, including interim periods within those years. The 
Company adopted the new guidance on January 1, 2018 as required, with no impact on the Company’s consolidated financial 
statements upon adoption.

In November 2016, the FASB issued guidance which clarifies the classification and presentation of changes in restricted 
cash on the statement of cash flows. The updates in the guidance require that the statement of cash flows explain the change 
during the period in the total of cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash when reconciling the beginning-of-period and 
end-of-period total amounts. The updates also require a reconciliation between cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash 
presented  on  the  balance  sheet  to  the  total  of  the  same  amounts  presented  on  the  statement  of  cash  flows.  For  public 
companies, the new guidance is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2017 and interim periods within 
those years, and the new guidance should be applied retrospectively to each period presented. 

The Company adopted the new guidance on January 1, 2018 as required. As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the 
Company  had  $1,872  and  $1,048,  respectively,  of  restricted  cash  included  in  prepaid  and  other  current  assets  on  its 

F-17

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

consolidated balance sheets. Changes in the Company’s restricted cash balances prior to the adoption of the new guidance 
were reflected within cash flows from investing activities in the Company’s consolidated statements of cash flows. The 
prior comparative periods in the Company’s consolidated statements of cash flows have been updated to conform to the 
new guidance. See Note 28 to these consolidated financial statements for supplemental cash flow disclosures.

In August 2016, the FASB issued guidance which clarifies the classification of certain cash receipts and cash payments 
in the statement of cash flows, including debt prepayment or extinguishment costs and distributions from equity method 
investees. For public companies, the new guidance is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2017, and 
interim periods within those fiscal years, and the new guidance should be applied retrospectively to each period presented. 
The Company adopted the new guidance on January 1, 2018 as required. The Company applied the new guidance to the 
term loan refinancing that occurred during the year ended December 31, 2018; see Note 16 to these consolidated financial 
statements for further information on the debt refinancing transaction. 

The following is a summary of the impact of adopting the new statement of cash flows guidance on the Company’s 

consolidated statements of cash flows:

Year ended December 31, 2017
Net cash provided by operating activities(1)
Net cash used in investing activities(2)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities(1)
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash
Net change in cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash(2)
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at beginning of period(2)
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at end of period(2)

Previously 
Reported
$ 116,062
(182,695)
68,944
(6,858)
(4,547)
70,742

Adjustments
49,111
$
(13,287)
(49,111)
—
(13,287)
14,335

Revised
$ 165,173
(195,982)
19,833
(6,858)
(17,834)
85,077

$

66,195

$

1,048

$

67,243

Year ended December 31, 2016
Net cash provided by operating activities(1)
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities(2)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities(1)
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash
Net change in cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash(2)
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at beginning of period(2)
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at end of period(2)

Previously 
Reported
$ 119,720
(1,929,680)
1,861,433
(5,886)
45,587

25,155
70,742

$

$

Adjustments
2,988
$

Revised
$ 122,708
(1,915,763)
1,858,445
(5,886)
59,504

25,573
85,077

$

13,917
(2,988)
—

13,917

418
14,335

(1)   Adjustments include the reclassification of $47,875 in debt prepayment penalties for the year ended December 31, 
2017, which were paid in cash, that were associated with the Company’s repricing and refinancing activities. The 
adjustments  also  include  the  reclassification  of  $1,236  and  $2,988  in  third-party  lender  fees  for  the  years  ended 
December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively, associated with the Company’s repricing and refinancing activities that 
were paid in cash. In accordance with the August 2016 guidance which clarifies the classification of certain cash 
receipts and cash payments in the statement of cash flows, the amounts were reclassified from net cash provided by 
operating activities to net cash provided by (used in) financing activities.

(2)  

In  accordance  with  the  November  2016  guidance  that  clarified  the  classification  and  presentation  of  changes  in 
restricted cash on the statement of cash flows, the Company reclassified the changes in restricted cash for the respective 
periods from cash from investing activities to the cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash line item.

In May 2014, the FASB issued accounting guidance (with subsequent targeted amendments) to significantly enhance 
comparability of revenue recognition practices across entities, industries, jurisdictions and capital markets. The core principle 
F-18

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

of the guidance is that revenue recognized from a transaction or event that arises from a contract with a customer should 
reflect the consideration to which an entity expects to be entitled in exchange for goods or services provided. To achieve 
that core principle, the new guidance sets forth a five-step revenue recognition model that will need to be applied consistently 
to all contracts with customers, except those that are within the scope of other topics in the Accounting Standards Codification 
(“ASC”). Also required are enhanced disclosures to help users of financial statements better understand the nature, amount, 
timing  and  uncertainty  of  revenues  and  cash  flows  from  contracts  with  customers.  The  enhanced  disclosures  include 
qualitative and quantitative information about contracts with customers, significant judgments made in applying the revenue 
guidance, and assets recognized related to the costs to obtain or fulfill a contract. For public companies, the new requirements 
are effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2017, including interim periods within those years. 
The Company reviewed its key revenue streams and assessed the underlying customer contracts within the framework of 
the new guidance. The Company evaluated the key aspects of its revenue streams for impact under the new guidance and 
performed a detailed analysis of its customer agreements to quantify the changes under the guidance. The Company concluded 
that the guidance did not have a material impact on its existing revenue recognition practices upon adoption on January 1, 
2018. The Company implemented the guidance under the modified retrospective transition method of adoption. Comparative 
information has not been restated and continues to be reported under the accounting standards in effect for those periods. 
The impact of adoption of the new revenue recognition guidance was immaterial for the year ended December 31, 2018, 
and there was no transition adjustment required upon adoption. See Note 4 to these consolidated financial statements for 
additional disclosures required by the new guidance.

Accounting Standards Not Yet Adopted as of December 31, 2018 

In August 2018, the FASB issued guidance which modifies the disclosure requirements for employers that sponsor 
defined benefit pension or other postretirement plans. The guidance eliminates certain disclosure requirements, including 
the amounts in accumulated other comprehensive income expected to be recognized as components of net periodic benefit 
cost over the next fiscal year and the effects of a one-percentage point change in assumed health care cost trend rates. The 
guidance also requires additional disclosure of the reasons for significant gains and losses related to changes in the benefit 
obligation for the period. The guidance is effective for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2020 with early adoption 
permitted, and is required to be applied on a retrospective basis to all periods presented. The Company will modify its 
benefit plan disclosures in accordance with the new guidance upon adoption, and the guidance will not have a material 
impact on its consolidated financial statements.

In  August  2018,  the  FASB  issued  guidance  which  modifies  certain  disclosure  requirements  over  fair  value 
measurements. The guidance is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019, including all interim periods 
within that fiscal year. The Company believes that the new guidance will not have a material impact on its consolidated 
financial statements.

In June 2018, the FASB issued guidance which conforms the accounting for the issuance of all share-based payments 
using the same accounting model. Previously, the accounting for share-based payments to non-employees was covered 
under a different framework than those made to employees. Under the new guidance, awards to both employees and non-
employees will essentially follow the same model, with small variations related to determining the term assumption when 
valuing a non-employee award as well as a different expense attribution model for non-employee awards. The new guidance 
is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2018 and interim periods within those fiscal years. The Company 
is currently evaluating the effect that the new guidance would have on its consolidated financial statements.

In February 2018, the FASB issued guidance which will permit entities to make an election to reclassify income tax 
effects  stranded  in  accumulated  other  comprehensive  income  (“AOCI”)  to  retained  earnings  as  a  result  of  tax  reform 
legislation enacted by the U.S. government on December 22, 2017. The standard is effective for fiscal years beginning after 
December 15, 2018 and interim periods within those fiscal years, with early adoption permitted in any interim period for 
which the financial statements have not yet been issued. Prior to the enactment of the tax reform legislation on December 
22, 2017, the Company had amounts recorded in AOCI related to its domestic pension, postretirement and supplementary 
benefit plans and cash flow hedging relationships that were based on pre-enactment tax rates. The Company is evaluating 
the impact that the new guidance will have on its consolidated financial statements. If the Company makes the election to 
reclassify the stranded income tax effects from AOCI, it may do so using one of two transition methods: retrospectively, or 
at the beginning of the period of adoption.

F-19

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

In January 2017, the FASB issued guidance which eliminates the second step from the traditional two-step goodwill 
impairment test. Under current guidance, an entity performed the first step of the goodwill impairment test by comparing 
the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount; if an impairment loss was indicated, the entity computed the 
implied fair value of goodwill to determine whether an impairment loss existed, and if so, the amount to recognize. Under 
the new guidance, an impairment loss is recognized for the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the reporting 
unit’s fair value (the Step 1 test), with no further testing required. Any impairment loss recognized is limited to the amount 
of goodwill allocated to the reporting unit. The new guidance is effective for public companies that are Securities and 
Exchange Commission (“SEC”) registrants for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019, with early adoption permitted 
for goodwill impairment tests performed on testing dates after January 1, 2017. The Company will apply the guidance 
prospectively to goodwill impairment tests subsequent to the adoption date.

In June 2016, the FASB issued guidance that affects loans, trade receivables and any other financial assets that have 
the contractual right to receive cash. Under the new guidance, an entity is required to recognize expected credit losses rather 
than incurred losses for financial assets. The new guidance is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019 
and interim periods within those fiscal years. The Company believes that the new guidance will not have a material impact 
on its consolidated financial statements. 

In February 2016, the FASB issued guidance (with subsequent targeted amendments) that modifies the accounting 
for leases. Under the new guidance, a lessee will recognize assets and liabilities for most leases (including those classified 
under existing GAAP as operating leases, which based on current standards are not reflected on the balance sheet), but will 
recognize expenses similar to current lease accounting. The new guidance also requires companies to provide expanded 
disclosures regarding leasing arrangements. For public companies, the new guidance is effective for fiscal years beginning 
after December 15, 2018, including interim periods within those years, with early adoption permitted. The new guidance 
must be adopted using a modified retrospective transition method. The Company can choose to apply the new guidance at 
the beginning of the earliest period presented in the financial statements, or at the date of adoption, with a cumulative-effect 
adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings and no recast of prior period results presented within the Company’s 
consolidated financial statements. The Company has elected to apply the new guidance as of the date of adoption.

The Company has operating lease agreements for which it expects to recognize right of use assets and corresponding 
liabilities on its balance sheet upon adoption of the new guidance. The Company is currently finalizing its lease portfolio 
analysis which will result in a material increase in total assets and liabilities in its consolidated balance sheets. The Company 
does not believe that the new guidance will have a material impact on its results of operations or cash flows. In addition, 
the Company has implemented a lease technology software to assist in its ongoing lease data collection and analysis. The 
Company is also updating its processes, accounting policies and internal controls to ensure it will meet the requirements of 
the new guidance upon adoption. 

The  new  guidance  provides  practical  expedients,  which  the  Company  is  currently  finalizing  its  evaluation.  The 
Company has elected the short term lease accounting policy and will not record right of use assets or lease liabilities for 
leases with a term of twelve months or less. The Company has elected the package of practical expedients which provides 
for an entity not to reassess:  (1) whether any expired or existing contracts are, or contain, leases; (2) the lease clarification 
for any expired or existing leases; and (3) initial direct costs for any existing leases.

4. Revenue from Contracts with Customers: 

Revenue Recognition Model

As  described  in  Note  2,  the  Company  applies  the  five-step  revenue  recognition  model  to  each  contract  with  its 

customers. 

Evidence of a contract between the Company and its customers may take the form of a master service agreement 
(“MSA”), a MSA in combination with an underlying purchase order, a combination of a pricing quote with an underlying 
purchase order or an individual purchase order received from a customer. The Company and certain of its customers enter 
into MSAs that establish the terms, including prices, under which orders to purchase goods may be placed. In cases where 
the MSA contains a distinct order for goods or contains an enforceable minimum quantity to be purchased by the customer, 
the Company considers the MSA to be evidence of a contract between the Company and its customer as the MSA creates 
enforceable rights and obligations. In cases where the MSA does not contain a distinct order for goods, the Company’s 

F-20

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

contract with a customer is the purchase order issued under the MSA. Customers of the Company may also negotiate orders 
via pricing quotes, which typically detail product pricing, delivery terms and payment information. When a customer procures 
goods under this method, the Company considers the combination of the pricing quote and the purchase order to create 
enforceable rights and obligations. Absent either a MSA or pricing quote, the Company considers an individual purchase 
order remitted by a customer to create enforceable rights and obligations.

The Company identifies a performance obligation in a contract for each promised good that is separately identifiable 
from other promises in the contract and for which the customer can benefit from the good. The majority of the Company’s 
contracts have a single performance obligation, which is the promise to transfer individual goods to the customer. Single 
performance obligations are satisfied according to the shipping terms noted within the MSA or purchase order. The Company 
has  certain  contracts  that  include  multiple  performance  obligations  under  which  the  purchase  price  for  each  distinct 
performance obligation is defined in the contract. These distinct performance obligations may include stand-ready provisions, 
which  are  arrangements  to  provide  a  customer  assurance  that  they  will  have  access  to  output  from  the  Company’s 
manufacturing  facilities,  or  monthly  reservations  of  capacity  fees. The  Company  considers  stand-ready  provisions  and 
reservation of capacity fees to be performance obligations satisfied over time. Revenues related to stand-ready provisions 
and reservation of capacity fees are recognized on a ratable basis throughout the contract term and billed to the customer 
on a monthly basis.

As described above, the Company’s MSAs with its customers may outline prices for individual products or contract 
provisions. MSAs in the Company’s performance chemicals and refining services product groups may contain provisions 
whereby raw material costs are passed-through to the customer per the terms of their contract. The Company’s exposure to 
fluctuations in raw material prices is limited, as the majority of pass-through contract provisions reset based on fluctuations 
in the underlying raw material price. MSAs in the Company’s refining services product group also contain take-or-pay 
arrangements, whereby the customer would incur a penalty in the form of a volume shortfall fee. There have been no issues 
where in which customers failed to meet the contractual minimum. Revenue from product sales are recorded at the sales 
price, which includes estimates of variable consideration for which reserves are established and which result from discounts, 
returns or other allowances that are offered within contracts between the Company and its customers.

The Company recognizes revenues when performance obligations under the terms of a contract with its customer are 
satisfied, which generally occurs at a point in time by transferring control of a product to the customer. The Company 
determines the point in time when a customer obtains control of a product and the Company satisfies the performance 
obligation by considering factors including when the Company has a right to payment for the product, the customer has 
legal title to the product, the Company has transferred possession of the product, the customer has assumed the risks and 
rewards of ownership of the product and the customer has accepted the product. Revenue is measured as the amount of 
consideration the Company expects to receive in exchange for transferring goods. The Company does not have any significant 
payment terms as payment is received at, or shortly after, the point of sale.

Environmental Catalysts & Services Segment - Silica Catalysts

The Company’s silica catalysts product group sells highly customized products to its customers. Contracts between 
silica catalysts and its customers are typically evidenced by entering into a supply arrangement that outlines the specification 
of  the  products  to  be  sold  and  contains  terms  and  conditions  under  which  purchase  orders  are  issued.  These  supply 
arrangements typically have a duration from 1 to 10 years. Although the duration of these supply arrangements are in excess 
of one year, a contract is formed between the Company and its customer upon receipt of a purchase order. 

Certain silica catalysts supply arrangements contain performance guarantees whereby the goods sold under a purchase 
order can be returned if the goods are not compatible with the customer’s production process. In order to mitigate any risk 
of a customer returning goods, the Company will allow the customer to obtain a sample of the goods to ensure compliance 
with its production process before accepting any orders. Due to these mitigating factors, the Company has not experienced 
any returns and does not account for a separate performance obligation related to the performance guarantee in certain of 
its contracts.

Environmental Catalysts & Services Segment - Refining Services

Contracts between the Company’s refining services product group and its customers are typically evidenced by entering 
into  a  MSA  which  generally  have  a  term  in  excess  of  one  year. Though  each  MSA  is  unique,  the  terms  may  include 

F-21

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

performance obligations such as stand-ready provisions and minimum purchase requirements. Stand-ready provisions within 
these contracts are billed on a monthly basis, as the performance obligation resets on a monthly basis and does not carry-
over to the following month. Certain of the Company’s refining services MSA’s contain minimum purchase requirements 
that expire within the calendar year.  The Company reviews each contract with minimum purchase requirements to determine 
if the customer will meet the provisions within the current calendar year. The Company records revenues related to the 
minimum  purchase  requirements  when  it  becomes  evident  that  the  customer  will  not  meet  the  minimum  purchase 
requirements noted within the contract. Contracts within refining services may also contain raw material pricing adjustments 
which are typically based on a commodity index. These raw material pass-through provisions reset on a periodic basis and 
prospectively adjust the raw material cost component of the goods sold to the customer. The Company accounts for the raw 
material costs on a prospective basis, as the price changes affect the future consideration of the sale of goods. 

Performance Materials & Chemicals - Performance Chemicals

Contracts between the Company’s performance chemicals product group and its customers are typically evidenced 
by entering into a supply arrangement that outlines the specification of the products to be sold and contains terms and 
conditions under which purchase orders are issued. Certain performance chemicals supply arrangements may contain raw 
material pricing adjustments which are typically based on a commodity index. These raw material pass-through provisions 
reset on a periodic basis and prospectively adjust the raw material cost component of the goods sold to the customer. The 
Company accounts for the raw material pass-through costs on a prospective basis, as the price changes affect the future 
consideration of the sale of goods. 

Performance Materials & Chemicals - Performance Materials

Contracts between the Company’s performance materials reporting unit and its customers are typically evidenced by 
receipt of a purchase order from the customer which details the specification of the products to be sold. Revenue is recorded 
according to the shipping terms noted within the purchase order.

Contract Assets and Liabilities

A contract asset is a right to consideration in exchange for goods that the Company has transferred to a customer when 
that right is conditional on something other than the passage of time. A contract liability exists when the Company receives 
consideration in advance of performance obligations. The Company has not recorded any contract assets or contract liabilities 
on its consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2018.

Practical Expedients and Accounting Policy Elections

The Company has elected to use certain practical expedients and has made certain accounting policy elections as 
permitted under the new revenue recognition guidance. Certain of the Company’s contracts with customers are based on 
an individual purchase order; thus, the duration of these contracts are for one year or less. As described above, certain 
performance obligations reset either monthly or at the end of the calendar year. The Company has made an accounting 
policy election to omit certain disclosures related to remaining performance obligations for contracts which have an initial 
term of one year or less.

The Company uses an output method to recognize revenues related to performance obligations satisfied over time. 
These performance obligations, as described above, are satisfied within a calendar year. As such, the Company has elected 
to utilize the “as-invoiced” practical expedient, which permits the Company to recognize revenue in the amount to which 
it  has  a  right  to  invoice  the  customer,  provided  that  the  amount  corresponds  directly  with  the  value  provided  by  the 
performance obligation as completed to date.

When the Company performs shipping and handling activities after the transfer of control to the customer (e.g. when 
control transfers prior to delivery), they are considered fulfillment activities as opposed to separate performance obligations, 
and the Company recognizes revenue upon the transfer of control to the customer. Accordingly, the costs associated with 
these shipping and handling activities are accrued when the related revenue is recognized under the Company’s policy 
election. The Company expenses incremental costs of obtaining a contract as incurred if the expected amortization period 
of the asset that the Company would have recognized is one year or less. Sales, value added and other taxes the Company 
collects concurrent with revenue producing activities are excluded from revenues. 

F-22

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Disaggregated Revenue

The Company’s primary means of disaggregating revenues is by product group, which can be found in Note 13 to 

these consolidated financial statements.

The Company’s portfolio of products are integrated into a variety of end uses, which are described in the table below.

Key End Uses

Key Products

Industrial & process chemicals

• Silicate precursors for the tire industry

• Glass beads, or microspheres, for metal finishing end uses

Fuels & emission control

• Refinery catalysts

Packaging & engineered plastics

• Emission control catalysts

• Catalyst recycling services

• Silicate for catalyst manufacturing

• Catalysts for high-density polyethlene and chemicals syntheses
• Antiblocks for film packaging

• Solid and hollow microspheres for composite plastics

• Sulfur derivatives for nylon production

Highway safety & construction

• Reflective markings for roadways and airports

Consumer products

• Silica gels for edible oil and beer clarification

• Silica gels for surface coatings

Natural resources

• Silicates for drilling muds

• Precipitated silicas, silicates and zeolites for the dentifrice and

dishwasher and laundry detergent applications

• Hollow glass beads, or microspheres, for oil well cements

• Silicates and alum for water treatment mining

• Bleaching aids for paper

The following table disaggregates the Company’s sales, by segment and end use, for the year ended December 31, 

2018:

Environmental
Catalysts & Services

Performance Materials
& Chemicals

Total

$

77,952

$

279,678

$

Industrial & process chemicals
Fuels & emission control(1)
Packaging & engineered plastics
Highway safety & construction(1)
Consumer products

Natural resources

Total segment sales

Inter-segment sales eliminations

Total

$

246,452

131,181

—

—

72,076

527,661
(3,323)
524,338

—

130,996

320,134

272,576

80,432

1,083,816

—

$

1,083,816

$

357,630

246,452

262,177

320,134

272,576

152,508

1,611,477
(3,323)
1,608,154

(1)  As described in Note 1, the Company experiences seasonal sales fluctuations to customers in the fuels & emission 

control and highway safety & construction end uses.

F-23

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

5. Fair Value Measurements: 

Fair values are based on quoted market prices when available. When market prices are not available, fair values are 
generally estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, incorporating current market inputs for similar financial instruments 
with comparable terms and credit quality. In instances where there is little or no market activity for the same or similar 
instruments,  the  Company  estimates  fair  values  using  methods,  models  and  assumptions  that  management  believes  a 
hypothetical market participant would use to determine a current transaction price. These valuation techniques involve some 
level of management estimation and judgment that becomes significant with increasingly complex instruments or pricing 
models. Where appropriate, adjustments are included to reflect the risk inherent in a particular methodology, model or input 
used. 

The Company’s financial assets and liabilities carried at fair value have been classified based upon a fair value hierarchy. 
The hierarchy gives the highest ranking to fair values determined using unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for 
identical assets and liabilities (Level 1) and the lowest ranking to fair values determined using methodologies and models 
with unobservable inputs (Level 3). The classification of an asset or a liability is based on the lowest level input that is 
significant to its measurement. For example, a Level 3 fair value measurement may include inputs that are both observable 
(Levels 1 and 2) and unobservable (Level 3). The levels of the fair value hierarchy are as follows: 

•  

• 

• 

Level 1—Values are unadjusted quoted prices for identical assets and liabilities in active markets accessible at 
the measurement date. Active markets provide pricing data for trades occurring at least weekly and include 
exchanges and dealer markets. 

Level 2—Inputs include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, quoted prices from those 
willing to trade in markets that are not active, or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by market 
data for the term of the instrument. Such inputs include market interest rates and volatilities, spreads and yield 
curves. 

Level 3—Certain inputs are unobservable (supported by little or no market activity) and significant to the fair 
value  measurement.  Unobservable  inputs  reflect  the  Company’s  best  estimate  of  what  hypothetical  market 
participants would use to determine a transaction price for the asset or liability at the reporting date. 

F-24

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following table presents information about the Company’s assets and liabilities that were measured at fair value 
on a recurring basis as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, and indicates the fair value hierarchy of the valuation techniques 
the Company utilized to determine such fair value.

Assets:

Derivative contracts

Restoration plan assets

Total

Liabilities:

Derivative contracts

Assets:

Derivative contracts

Restoration plan assets

Total

Liabilities:

Derivative contracts

December 31,
2018

Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
(Level 1)

Significant Other
Observable Inputs
(Level 2)

Significant
Unobservable Inputs
(Level 3)

20,768

4,244

25,012

$

$

— $

4,244

4,244

$

20,768

—

20,768

$

$

2,026

$

— $

2,026

$

—

—

—

—

December 31,
2017

Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
(Level 1)

Significant Other
Observable Inputs
(Level 2)

Significant
Unobservable Inputs
(Level 3)

1,043

5,576

6,619

$

$

— $

5,576

5,576

$

1,043

—

1,043

$

$

448

$

— $

448

$

—

—

—

—

$

$

$

$

$

$

The following table presents information about the Company’s assets and liabilities that were measured at fair value 
on a non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2016. The Company performed its annual impairment test on its indefinite-
lived intangible assets on October 1, 2018 and 2017, respectively, and determined that no impairment existed. Refer to Note 
14 to these consolidated financial statements for a description of the valuation techniques the Company utilized to determine 
such fair value and for the results of the impairment testing procedures performed during the October 1, 2016 testing period.

As of
December 31,
2016

Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
(Level 1)

Significant Other
Observable Inputs
(Level 2)

Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)

Total
Losses 

Assets:

Indefinite-lived trade names(1)  $

153,922

$

— $

— $

153,922

$

(6,873)

(1)   

Indefinite-lived trade names with a carrying amount of $160,795 were written down to their implied fair value of 
$153,922 as part of the Company’s annual impairment assessment on October 1, 2016. This resulted in an impairment 
charge of $6,873, which was recorded to other operating expense, net, on the consolidated statements of operations.

F-25

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Restoration plan assets 

The fair values of the Company’s restoration plan assets are determined through quoted prices in active markets. 
Restoration plan assets are assets held in a Rabbi trust to fund the obligations of the Company’s defined benefit supplementary 
retirement plans and include various stock and fixed income mutual funds. See Note 20 to these consolidated financial 
statements regarding defined benefit supplementary retirement plans. The Company’s restoration plan assets are included 
in other long-term assets on its consolidated balance sheets. Gains and losses related to these investments are included in 
other expense, net in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations. Unrealized gains and losses associated with the 
underlying  stock  and  fixed  income  mutual  funds  were  immaterial  as  of  December 31,  2018  and  December 31,  2017, 
respectively.

Derivative contracts 

Derivative assets and liabilities can be exchange-traded or traded over-the-counter (“OTC”). The Company generally 
values exchange-traded derivatives using models that calibrate to market transactions and eliminate timing differences 
between the closing price of the exchange-traded derivatives and their underlying instruments. OTC derivatives are valued 
using market transactions and other market evidence whenever possible, including market-based inputs to models, model 
calibration to market transactions, broker or dealer quotations or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price 
transparency. When models are used, the selection of a particular model to value an OTC derivative depends on the contractual 
terms of, and specific risks inherent in, the instrument as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. The 
Company generally uses similar models to value similar instruments. Valuation models require a variety of inputs, including 
contractual terms, market prices and rates, forward curves, measures of volatility, and correlations of such inputs. For OTC 
derivatives  that  trade  in  liquid  markets,  such  as  forward  contracts,  swaps  and  options,  model  inputs  can  generally  be 
corroborated by observable market data by correlation or other means, and model selection does not involve significant 
management judgment. 

The Company has interest rate caps, natural gas swaps and cross currency swaps that are fair valued using Level 2 
inputs. In addition, the Company applies a credit valuation adjustment to reflect credit risk which is calculated based on 
credit default swaps. To the extent that the Company’s net exposure under a specific master agreement is an asset, the 
Company utilizes the counterparty’s default swap rate. If the net exposure under a specific master agreement is a liability, 
the Company utilizes a default swap rate comparable to PQ Group Holdings. The credit valuation adjustment is added to 
the discounted fair value to reflect the exit price that a market participant would be willing to receive to assume the Company’s 
liabilities or that a market participant would be willing to pay for the Company’s assets. 

6. Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss): 

The following table presents the components of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax, as of 

December 31, 2018 and 2017: 

Amortization and unrealized gains (losses) on pension and postretirement plans, net

of tax of ($2,362) and ($4,761)

Net changes in fair values of derivatives, net of tax of ($474) and ($584)

Foreign currency translation adjustments, net of tax of $5,154 and $790

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

December 31,

2018

2017

$

$

(546) $
637
(39,195)
(39,104) $

7,412

967
(4,068)
4,311

F-26

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following table presents the tax effects of each component of other comprehensive income (loss) for the years 

ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016:

2018

Tax 
benefit/
(expense)

Pre-tax
amount

After-tax
amount

Pre-tax
amount

Years ended
December 31,

2017

Tax 
benefit/
(expense)

After-tax
amount

Pre-tax
amount

2016

Tax 
benefit/
(expense)

After-tax
amount

Defined benefit and other
postretirement plans:

Amortization and

unrealized gains
(losses)

$ (10,357) $

2,399

$

(7,958) $

(139) $

Benefit plans, net

(10,357)

2,399

(7,958)

(139)

38

38

$

(101) $

11,664

$

(4,799) $

(101)

11,664

(4,799)

6,865

6,865

Net gain (loss) from

hedging activities

Foreign currency
translation

Other comprehensive
income (loss)

(441)

110

(331)

(5,799)

2,209

(3,590)

7,350

(2,793)

4,557

(39,419)

4,364

(35,055)

66,438

(5,837)

60,601

(73,461)

6,627

(66,834)

$ (50,217) $

6,873

$ (43,344) $

60,500

$

(3,590) $

56,910

$ (54,447) $

(965) $ (55,412)

The following table presents the change in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax, by component 

for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017: 

Defined benefit
and other
postretirement
plans 

Net gain (loss)
from hedging
activities

Foreign
currency
translation 

Total 

December 31, 2016 $

7,513

$

4,557

$

(65,781) $

(53,711)

6

(3,797)

61,713

57,922

Other comprehensive income (loss) before

reclassifications

Amounts reclassified from accumulated 
other comprehensive income (loss)(1)   
Net current period other comprehensive income

(loss)

(107)

(101)

207

(3,590)

December 31, 2017 $

7,412

$

967

$

Other comprehensive loss before

reclassifications

Amounts reclassified from accumulated 
other comprehensive income (loss)(1)   

Net current period other comprehensive loss

December 31, 2018

(7,874)

(84)

(7,958)

(546)

(257)

(73)

(330)

637

—

61,713
(4,068) $

100

58,022

4,311

(35,127)

(43,258)

—

(35,127)

(39,195)

(157)

(43,415)

(39,104)

(1) 

See the following table for details about these reclassifications. Amounts in parentheses indicate credits to profit/loss. 

F-27

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following table presents the reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for the years 

ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.

Details about Accumulated Other
Comprehensive Income (Loss) Components

Defined benefit and other postretirement plans:

Amortization of prior service credit

Amortization of net (gain) loss

Net (gain) loss from hedging activities:

Interest rate caps

Natural gas swaps

Total reclassifications for the period

Amount Reclassified from 
Accumulated Other 
Comprehensive Income (Loss)(a)

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

Affected Line Item in the
Statements of Operations

$

$

$

$

$

(112) $
12
(100)
16
(84) $

$

256
(353)
(97)
24
(73) $

(157) $

(b)

(78)
(54)
(132) Total before tax

(b)

25 Tax expense (benefit)

(107) Net of tax

40

Interest expense

222 Cost of goods sold

262 Total before tax
(55) Tax expense (benefit)
207 Net of tax

100 Net of tax

(a)  Amounts in parentheses indicate credits to profit/loss.

(b) 

These accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) components are included in the computation of net periodic 
pension and other postretirement cost (see Note 20 to these consolidated financial statements for additional details).

7. Business Combination: 

As described in Note 1 to these consolidated financial statements, on May 4, 2016, the Company, PQ Holdings, Eco 
Services, certain investment funds affiliated with CCMP and certain other stockholders of PQ Holdings and Eco Services 
completed  the  Business  Combination.  The  Business  Combination  was  accounted  for  using  the  acquisition  method  of 
accounting. Under the acquisition method, the purchase price is allocated to the net assets acquired based on the fair values 
of assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date. The excess of the purchase price over the fair values 
of these net assets is recorded as goodwill. 

F-28

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following table sets forth the calculation and allocation of the purchase price to the net assets acquired of PQ 

Holdings with respect to the Business Combination, which was complete as of December 31, 2016.

Total consideration, net of cash acquired

Recognized amounts of identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed:

Receivables

Inventories

Prepaid and other current assets

Investments in affiliated companies

Property, plant and equipment

Other intangible assets

Other long-term assets

Fair value of assets acquired

Revolver, notes payable & current debt

Accounts payable

Accrued liabilities

Long-term debt

Deferred income taxes

Other long-term liabilities

Noncontrolling interest

Fair value of net assets acquired

Goodwill

$

$

$

2,689,941

161,110

254,770

19,295

472,994

683,673

754,000

48,127

2,393,969

(2,441)
(93,222)
(98,621)
(20,470)
(327,296)
(113,936)
(6,569)
1,731,414

958,527

2,689,941

Total consideration for the Business Combination included $1,777,740 of cash, $910,800 of equity in the acquired 
PQ Holdings entities and $1,400 of assumed stock awards of PQ Holdings. The fair value of the equity consideration was 
determined based on an estimated enterprise value using a market approach as of the date of the Business Combination, 
reduced by borrowings to arrive at the fair value of equity. The existing PQ Holdings credit facilities were not legally 
assumed as part of the Business Combination, and the extinguishment of the debt concurrent with the Business Combination 
was included as part of the consideration transferred (see Note 16 to these consolidated financial statements for further 
information). Acquisition  costs  of  $1,583  are  included  in  other  operating  expense,  net  in  the  Company’s  consolidated 
statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2016. 

The  Company  believes  that  its  diverse  range  of  industrial,  consumer  and  governmental  applications  in  which  its 
products are used were the primary reasons that contributed to a total purchase price that resulted in the recognition of 
goodwill. The goodwill associated with the Business Combination is not deductible for tax purposes. 

F-29

 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The valuation of the intangible assets acquired and the related weighted-average amortization periods are as follows: 

Intangible assets subject to amortization:

Trademarks

Technical know-how

Contracts

Customer relationships

In-process research and development

Total intangible assets subject to amortization

Trade names, not subject to amortization

Trademarks, not subject to amortization

Total

Amount  

Weighted-Average
Expected Useful Life
(in years)  

$

$

35,400

189,300

19,800

268,700

6,800

520,000

151,100

82,900

754,000

15.0

20.0

5.3

10.6

Indefinite

Indefinite

In accordance with the requirements of the purchase method of accounting for acquisitions, inventories were recorded 
at fair market value (which is defined as estimated selling prices less the sum of (a) costs of disposal and (b) a reasonable 
profit  allowance  for  the  selling  effort  of  the  acquiring  entity),  which  was  $58,683  higher  than  the  historical  cost. The 
Company’s cost of goods sold includes a pre-tax charge of $871 and $29,086 for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 
2016, respectively, relating to the portion of the step-up on inventory sold during the period. A separate portion of the fair 
value step-up related to the domestic inventory accounted for under the LIFO method was included in inventory on the 
consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2016 as part of the new LIFO base layer on the acquired inventory (see Note 
10 to these consolidated financial statements for further information). 

The Company’s consolidated financial statements include PQ Holdings results of operations from May 4, 2016 through 
December 31,  2016.  Sales  and  net  loss  attributable  to  PQ  Holdings  during  this  period  are  included  in  the  Company’s 
consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2016 and total $690,459 and $17,991, respectively. 

Pro Forma Financial Information 

The unaudited pro forma information has been derived from the Company’s historical consolidated financial statements 
and has been prepared to give effect to the Business Combination, assuming that the Business Combination occurred on 
January 1,  2015.  These  pro  forma  adjustments  primarily  relate  to  depreciation  expense  on  stepped  up  fixed  assets, 
amortization of acquired intangibles, cost of goods sold expense related to the sale of stepped up inventory, interest expense 
related  to  additional  debt  that  would  be  needed  to  fund  the  Business  Combination,  and  the  estimated  impact  of  these 
adjustments on the Company’s tax provision. The unaudited pro forma consolidated results of operations are provided for 
illustrative  purposes  and  are  not  indicative  of  the  Company’s  actual  consolidated  results  of  operations  or  consolidated 
financial position. The unaudited pro forma results of operations do not reflect any operating efficiencies or potential cost 
savings which may result from the acquisitions.

Pro forma sales

Pro forma net loss

Year ended
December 31, 2016

$

1,403,041
(76,994)

The pro forma net loss for the year ended December 31, 2016 excludes certain charges that were allocated to the pro 
forma results for the year ended December 31, 2015. These non-recurring charges include a debt prepayment penalty of 
$26,250, one-time refinancing charges of $4,747 and transaction fee charges of $1,795.

F-30

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

8. Acquisition:

Acquisitions are accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. Under the acquisition method, the purchase 
price is allocated to the identifiable net assets acquired based on the fair values of the identifiable assets acquired and 
liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date. The excess of the purchase price over the fair values of the identifiable net 
assets acquired is recorded to goodwill. 

On June 12, 2017 (the “Acquisition Date”), the Company acquired the facilities of Sovitec Mondial S.A. (“Sovitec”) 
located in Belgium, Spain, Argentina and France as part of a stock transaction (the “Acquisition”) for $41,572 in cash, 
excluding assumed debt. Based in Fleurus, Belgium, Sovitec is a high quality producer of engineered glass products used 
in transportation safety, metal finishing and polymer additives. The results of operations of Sovitec have been included in 
the Company’s consolidated financial statements since the Acquisition Date.

The following table sets forth the calculation and allocation of the purchase price to the identifiable net assets acquired 

with respect to the Acquisition, which was complete as of March 31, 2018: 

Provisional Purchase
Price Allocation

Adjustments

Purchase
Price Allocation

41,572

$

— $

41,572

$

$

Total consideration, net of cash acquired

Recognized amounts of identifiable assets acquired

and liabilities assumed:

Receivables

Inventories

Prepaid and other current assets

Property, plant and equipment

Other intangible assets

Other long-term assets

Fair value of assets acquired

Current debt

Accounts payable

Long-term debt

Deferred income taxes

Other long-term liabilities

Fair value of net assets acquired

Goodwill

14,305

$

— $

7,645

400

9,020

—

129

31,499

(6,420)
(10,748)
(10,189)
—
(154)

3,988

37,584

1,603

—

15,960

5,753

15,921

39,237

—

—

—
(4,426)
—

34,811
(34,811)

14,305

9,248

400

24,980

5,753

16,050

70,736

(6,420)
(10,748)
(10,189)
(4,426)
(154)

38,799

2,773

41,572

$

41,572

$

— $

As of the Acquisition Date, the fair value of accounts receivable approximated historical cost. The gross contractual 
amount of accounts receivable at the Acquisition Date was $14,607, of which $302 was deemed uncollectible. The fair 
value of inventory is defined as estimated selling prices less the sum of (a) costs of disposal and (b) a reasonable profit 
allowance for the selling effort of the acquiring entity, which was $1,603 higher than the historical cost.  

F-31

 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The Company’s cost of goods sold for the year ended December 31, 2018 includes a pre-tax charge of $1,603 relating 
to the step-up on inventory, $108 of additional amortization expense related to identified intangible assets and $421 of 
additional  depreciation  expense,  which  would  have  been  recorded  during  the  year  ended  December  31,  2017  if  the 
adjustments to the provisional amounts had been recognized as of the Acquisition Date. The Company’s other expense, net 
for the year ended December 31, 2018 includes additional amortization expense related to identified intangible assets of 
$101 which would have been recorded during the year ended December 31, 2017 if the adjustments to the provisional 
amounts had been recognized as of the Acquisition Date. The Company’s provision for income taxes for the year ended 
December 31, 2018 includes an additional $990 tax benefit associated with the year ended December 31, 2017, to reflect 
impacts as if the adjustments to the provisional amounts had been recognized as of the Acquisition Date. This amount is 
primarily a result of opening balance sheet adjustments recorded during the year ended December 31, 2018, which needed 
to  be  re-measured  through  the  income  statement  because  of  income  tax  rate  changes  that  occurred  subsequent  to  the 
Acquisition Date.

The Company believes that the Acquisition will enable it to offer a more comprehensive, cost-effective and high-
quality portfolio of products and services to its customers worldwide when, combined with anticipated synergies within its 
existing business, contributed to a total purchase price that resulted in the recognition of goodwill. All of the goodwill was 
assigned to the Company’s PM&C reporting segment. The goodwill associated with the Acquisition is not deductible for 
tax purposes.

The valuation of the intangible assets acquired and the related weighted-average amortization periods are as follows:

Intangible assets subject to amortization:

Trademarks

Technical know-how

Total intangible assets subject to amortization

Trade names, not subject to amortization

Total

Amount

Weighted-Average
Expected Useful Life
(in years)

$

$

1,767

1,892

3,659

2,094

5,753

11

11

Indefinite

The Company’s consolidated financial statements include Sovitec’s results of operations from June 12, 2017 through 
December  31,  2017.  Sales  and  net  income  attributable  to  Sovitec  during  this  period  are  included  in  the  Company’s 
consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2017 and total $26,257 and $1,370, respectively.

Acquisition costs were immaterial for the year ended December 31, 2018 and were $2,515 for the year ended December 
31,  2017. Acquisition  costs  are  included  in  other  operating  expense,  net  in  the  Company’s  consolidated  statements  of 
operations.

Pro Forma Financial Information

The unaudited pro forma financial information for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016 has been derived 
from the Company’s historical consolidated financial statements and prepared to give effect to the Acquisition, assuming 
that the Acquisition occurred on January 1, 2016. The unaudited pro forma consolidated results of operations are provided 
for illustrative purposes only and are not indicative of the Company’s actual consolidated results of operations had the 
Acquisition been made as of January 1, 2016. The unaudited pro forma results of operations do not reflect any operating 
efficiencies or potential cost savings which may result from the Acquisition. 

F-32

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Pro forma sales

Pro forma net income (loss)

Pro forma net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.

Pro forma basic income (loss) per share

Pro forma diluted income (loss) per share

Years ended
December 31,

2017

2016

1,488,528

$

58,774

57,814

0.52

0.52

$

$

1,105,479
(78,234)
(78,822)
(1.01)
(1.01)

$

$

$

The results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2018 include the operating results of the combined 
company for the full period and therefore, there is no pro forma presentation for such periods included in the table above.

Certain non-recurring charges included in the Company’s results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2017 
were allocated to the respective prior year periods for pro forma purposes. For the year ended December 31, 2017, non-
recurring charges allocated to the prior year period include transaction fee charges of $2,515 which were excluded from 
the pro forma net income for the year ended December 31, 2017. Included in pro forma net income for the year ended 
December 31, 2017 is amortization expense of $367 and depreciation expense of $760 associated with the fair value step-
up of identifiable intangible assets and property, plant and equipment, respectively. Included in pro forma net loss for the 
year ended December 31, 2016 is amortization expense of $364 and depreciation expense of $467 associated with the fair 
value step-up of identifiable intangible assets and property, plant and equipment, respectively.

9. Other Operating Expense, Net: 

A summary of other operating expense, net is as follows: 

Amortization expense
Transaction and other related costs(1)
Restructuring and other related costs (Note 24)

Net loss on asset disposals

Intangible asset impairment charge (Note 14)

Management advisory fees (Note 26)
Insurance recoveries(2)
Write-off of long-term supply contract obligation (Note 25)

Other, net

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

$

35,025

$

32,010

$

776

6,208

6,574

—

—
(5,480)
(20,612)
6,959

7,415

8,490

5,793

—

3,777

—

—

6,740

$

29,450

$

64,225

$

25,263

4,952

12,630

4,216

6,873

3,584

—

—

4,783

62,301

(1) 

Transaction and other related costs for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 primarily include transaction 
costs associated with the Company’s IPO, exclusive of the direct costs recorded in stockholders’ equity net of the 
proceeds from the offering (see Note 1 to these consolidated financial statements for further information) and the 
Acquisition (see Note 8). Transaction and other related costs for the year ended December 31, 2016 primarily include 
transaction costs directly attributable to the Business Combination (see Note 7) as well as other business development 
costs.

(2)  During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company recognized $6,450 of insurance recoveries in its consolidated 
statement of operations related to the Company’s claim for losses sustained during Hurricane Harvey in August 2017. 
For the year ended December 31, 2018, $5,480 was recorded as a gain in other operating expense, net, as reimbursement 

F-33

of expenses, $207 was recorded as a gain in net loss on asset disposals within other operating expense, net, for the 
Company’s  previously  recognized  property  losses,  and  $813  represented  recoveries  in  excess  of  the  Company’s 
property losses which was recorded as a non-operating gain in other expense, net, in the Company’s consolidated 
statement of operations.

10. Inventories:

Inventories are classified and valued as follows:

Finished products and work in process

Raw materials

Valued at lower of cost or market:

LIFO basis

Valued at lower of cost and net realizable value:

FIFO or average cost basis

December 31,

2018
206,188

58,560

264,748

$

$

2017
199,919

62,469

262,388

160,863

$

162,315

103,885

264,748

$

100,073

262,388

$

$

$

$

The domestic inventory acquired as part of the Business Combination is valued based on the LIFO method. Therefore, 
the fair value allocated to the acquired LIFO inventory was treated as the new base inventory value. If inventories valued 
under the LIFO basis had been valued using the FIFO method, inventories would have been $18,263 and $26,630 lower 
than reported as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, driven primarily by the purchase accounting fair value step-
up  of  the  LIFO  inventory  base  value  associated  with  the  Business  Combination. As  of  December  31,  2016,  inventory 
quantities for one of the Company’s LIFO pools were reduced below their levels at the Business Combination date. As a 
result of this reduction, LIFO inventory costs charged to cost of goods sold were computed based on the lower base layer 
costs at the Business Combination date. The impact on cost of goods sold and net loss for the year ended December 31, 
2016 was not material.

F-34

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

11. Investments in Affiliated Companies: 

As a result of the Business Combination, the Company acquired investments in affiliated companies accounted for 
under the equity method. Affiliated companies accounted for on the equity method as of December 31, 2018 are as follows: 

Company 
PQ Silicates Ltd.

Zeolyst International
Zeolyst C.V.

Quaker Holdings

Asociacion para el Estudio de las Tecnologias de Equipamiento de

Carreteras, S.A. (“Aetec”)

Following is summarized information of the combined investments(1):

Country 
Taiwan

USA

Netherlands

South Africa

Spain

Percent
Ownership 
50%

50%

50%

49%

20%

Current assets

Noncurrent assets

Current liabilities

Noncurrent liabilities

Sales

Gross profit

Operating income

Net income

December 31,

2018

2017

$

215,416

$

248,288

40,536

56

Years ended December 31,

2018

2017

2016

$

352,599

$

317,197

$

126,945

88,508

88,622

132,812

91,224

94,740

213,815

235,440

37,018

1,417

206,072

91,761

67,098

67,332

(1) 

Summarized information of the combined investments is presented at 100%; the Company’s share of the net assets 
and net income of affiliates is calculated based on the percent ownership specified in the table above.

The Company’s investments in affiliated companies balance as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 includes net purchase 
accounting fair value adjustments of $258,066 and $264,700, respectively, related to the Business Combination, consisting 
primarily  of  goodwill  and  intangible  assets  such  as  customer  relationships,  technical  know-how  and  trade  names. 
Consolidated equity in net income (loss) from affiliates is net of $6,634, $8,599 and $36,296 of amortization expense related 
to purchase accounting fair value adjustments for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

F-35

 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following table summarizes the activity related to the Company’s investments in affiliated companies balance on 

the consolidated balance sheets: 

Balance at beginning of period

Acquisition

Investments in affiliated companies

Equity in net income of affiliated companies

Charges related to purchase accounting fair value adjustments

Dividends received

Foreign currency translation adjustments

Balance at end of period

$

$

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

469,276

$

—

5,000

44,245
(6,634)
(40,890)
(2,786)
468,211

$

459,406

119

9,000

47,371
(8,599)
(44,071)
6,050

469,276

The  Company  had  net  receivables  due  from  affiliates  of  $4,775  and  $4,910  as  of  December 31,  2018  and  2017, 
respectively, which are included in prepaid and other current assets. Net receivables due from affiliates are generally non-
trade receivables. Sales to affiliates were $2,823, $2,853 and $1,587 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 
2016, respectively. The Company purchased goods of $645, $2,475 and $1,147 from affiliates, which is included in cost of 
goods sold during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

On December 18, 2013, PQ Holdings and its joint venture, Zeolyst International, entered into a ten year real estate 
tax abatement agreement with the Unified Government of Wyandotte County, Kansas. The agreement utilizes an Industrial 
Revenue Bond financing structure to achieve a 75% real estate tax abatement on the value of the improvements that were 
constructed during the expansion of PQ Holdings and Zeolyst International’s facilities at the jointly-operated Kansas City, 
Kansas plant. A similar tax abatement agreement has been executed on an annual basis since December 18, 2013 with respect 
to additional plant expansions during those years. The financing obligations and the industrial bonds receivable have been 
presented net, as the financing obligations and the industrial bonds meet the criteria for right of setoff conditions under 
GAAP.

12. Property, Plant and Equipment: 

A summary of property, plant and equipment, at cost, and related accumulated depreciation is as follows: 

Land

Buildings

Machinery and equipment

Construction in progress

Less: accumulated depreciation

December 31,

2018
190,772

212,284

1,125,117

102,185

1,630,358
(421,379)
1,208,979

$

$

2017
191,006

200,054

1,005,025

145,414

1,541,499
(311,115)
1,230,384

$

$

Depreciation expense was $132,640, $124,551 and $89,453 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, 

respectively.

F-36

 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

13. Reportable Segments: 

The Company has organized its business around two operating segments based on the review of discrete financial 
results for each of the operating segments by the Company’s chief operating decision maker (the Company’s President and 
Chief Executive Officer), or CODM, for performance assessment and resource allocation purposes. Each of the Company’s 
operating segments represents a reportable segment under GAAP. The Company’s reportable segments are organized based 
on  the  nature  and  economic  characteristics  of  the  Company’s  products.  The  Company’s  two  reportable  segments  are 
Environmental Catalysts and Services (“EC&S”) and Performance Materials and Chemicals (“PM&C”). 

The PM&C segment is a silicates and specialty materials producer with leading supply positions for the majority of 
its products sold in North America, Europe, South America, Australia and Asia (excluding China) serving end uses such as 
personal and industrial cleaning products, fuel efficient tires (or green tires), surface coatings, and food and beverage. The 
two product groups included in the PM&C segment are performance materials and performance chemicals. The EC&S 
segment is a leading global innovator and producer of catalysts for the refinery, emission control, and petrochemical industries 
and is also a leading provider of catalyst recycling services to the North American refining industry. The three product 
groups included in the EC&S segment are silica catalysts, zeolyst catalysts, and refining services. The EC&S segment 
includes equity in net income from Zeolyst International and Zeolyst C.V. (collectively, the “Zeolyst Joint Venture”), each 
of which are 50/50 joint ventures with CRI Zeolites Inc. (a wholly-owned subsidiary of Royal Dutch Shell). The Zeolyst 
Joint Venture is accounted for using the equity method in the Company’s consolidated financial statements (see Note 10 to 
these consolidated financial statements for further information). Company management evaluates the EC&S segment’s 
performance, including the Zeolyst Joint Venture, on a proportionate consolidation basis. Accordingly, the revenues and 
expenses used to compute the EC&S segment’s adjusted earnings before interest, income taxes, depreciation and amortization 
(“Adjusted  EBITDA”)  include  the  Zeolyst  Joint Venture’s  results  of  operations  on  a  proportionate  basis  based  on  the 
Company’s 50% ownership level. Since the Company uses the equity method of accounting for the Zeolyst Joint Venture, 
these items are eliminated when reconciling to the Company’s consolidated results of operations.

The Company’s management evaluates the operating results of each reportable segment based upon Adjusted EBITDA. 
Adjusted EBITDA consists of EBITDA, which is a measure defined as net income before depreciation and amortization, 
interest expense and income taxes (each of which is included in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations), and 
adjusted for certain items as discussed below. 

F-37

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Summarized financial information for the Company’s reportable segments and product groups is shown in the following 

table: 

Sales:

Silica Catalysts

Refining Services

Environmental Catalysts & Services(1)

Performance Chemicals

Performance Materials

Eliminations

Performance Materials & Chemicals

Inter-segment sales eliminations(2)

Total

Segment Adjusted EBITDA:(3)

Environmental Catalysts & Services(4)   
Performance Materials & Chemicals

Total Segment Adjusted EBITDA(5)

2018

Years ended
December 31,

2017

2016

72,099

$

75,333

$

455,562

527,661

398,342

473,675

717,335

$

687,645

$

378,279
(11,798)
1,083,816

(3,323)

324,225
(10,021)
1,001,849

(3,423)

53,029

373,718

426,747

437,523

206,522
(5,094)
638,951

(1,521)

1,608,154

$

1,472,101

$

1,064,177

257,566

243,357

500,923

$

$

243,587

240,128

483,715

$

$

196,825

158,679

355,504

$

$

$

$

$

(1)    Excludes the Company’s proportionate share of sales from the Zeolyst International and Zeolyst C.V. joint ventures 
(collectively, the “Zeolyst Joint Venture”) accounted for using the equity method (see Note 11 to these consolidated 
consolidated financial statements for further information). The proportionate share of sales is $156,687, $143,774 and 
$94,516 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

(2)   The Company eliminates intersegment sales when reconciling to the Company’s consolidated statements of operations. 

(3)    The Company defines Adjusted EBITDA as EBITDA adjusted for certain items as noted in the reconciliation below. 
Management evaluates the performance of its segments and allocates resources based on several factors, of which the 
primary measure is Adjusted EBITDA. Adjusted EBITDA should not be considered as an alternative to net income 
as an indicator of the Company’s operating performance. Adjusted EBITDA as defined by the Company may not be 
comparable with EBITDA or Adjusted EBITDA as defined by other companies. 

(4)   The Adjusted EBITDA from the Zeolyst Joint Venture included in the Environmental Catalysts and Services segment 
is $56,663 for the year ended December 31, 2018, which includes $42,854 of equity in net income plus $6,634 of 
amortization of investment in affiliate step-up plus $12,592 of joint venture depreciation, amortization and interest.

The Adjusted EBITDA from the Zeolyst Joint Venture included in the Environmental Catalysts and Services segment 
is $58,156 for the year ended December 31, 2017, which includes $46,252 of equity in net income plus $8,600 of 
amortization of investment in affiliate step-up plus $11,070 of joint venture depreciation, amortization and interest.

The Adjusted EBITDA from the Zeolyst Joint Venture included in the Environmental Catalysts and Services segment 
is  $39,903  for  the  year  ended  December 31,  2016,  which  includes  $3,313  of  equity  in  net  loss  plus  $36,296  of 
amortization of investment in affiliate step-up plus $6,920 of joint venture depreciation, amortization and interest.

(5)   Total Segment Adjusted EBITDA differs from the Company’s consolidated Adjusted EBITDA due to unallocated 

corporate expenses. 

F-38

 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

A reconciliation of net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings to Segment Adjusted EBITDA is as follows: 

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

Reconciliation of net income attributable to PQ Group

Holdings Inc. to Segment Adjusted EBITDA

Net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.

$

58,300

$

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

Interest expense, net

Depreciation and amortization

Segment EBITDA

Unallocated corporate expenses

Joint venture depreciation, amortization and interest

Amortization of investment in affiliate step-up

Amortization of inventory step-up

Impairment of fixed assets, intangibles and goodwill

Debt extinguishment costs

Net loss on asset disposals

Foreign currency exchange loss (gain)

LIFO expense

Management advisory fees

Transaction and other related costs

Equity-based compensation

Restructuring, integration and business optimization

expenses

Defined benefit pension plan cost
Gain on contract termination(1)
Other

28,995

113,723

185,234

386,252

36,970

12,592

6,634

1,603

—

7,751

6,574

13,810

8,366

—

893

19,464

14,019
(796)
(20,612)
7,403

$

57,603
(119,197)
179,044

177,140

294,590

30,422

11,070

8,600

871

—

61,886

5,793

25,786

3,708

3,777

7,425

8,799

13,174

2,940

—

4,874

(79,746)
10,041

140,315

128,288

198,898

23,971

6,920

36,296

29,086

6,873

13,782

4,216
(3,558)
1,310

3,583

4,664

7,042

16,258

1,375

—

4,788

Segment Adjusted EBITDA

$

500,923

$

483,715

$

355,504

(1) 

Includes the non-cash write-off of a long-term supply contract obligation (see Note 25), which was recorded as a 
reduction in other operating expense, net in the consolidated statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 
2018.

The Company’s consolidated results include equity in net income from affiliated companies of $37,611 and $38,772
for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, and equity in net loss from affiliated companies of $2,612
for the year ended December 31, 2016. This is primarily comprised of equity in net income of $42,854, $46,252 and $3,313
in the EC&S segment from the Zeolyst Joint Venture for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. 
The remaining equity in net income (loss) for the Company is included in the PM&C segment, which is attributed to smaller 
investments and was not material. The Company’s equity in net income from affiliates was more than offset by $36,296 of 
amortization expense related to purchase accounting fair value adjustments associated with the Zeolyst Joint Venture for 
the year ended December 31, 2016 as a result of the Business Combination valuation.

F-39

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Capital expenditures for the Company’s reportable segments are shown in the following table: 

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

Capital expenditures:

Environmental Catalysts & Services(1)
Performance Materials & Chemicals
Corporate(2)

Capital expenditures per the consolidated statements of cash

flows

$

$

55,007

$

53,145

$

75,476

1,205

84,783

2,554

57,803

71,293
(7,675)

131,688

$

140,482

$

121,421

(1) 

(2) 

Excludes the Company’s proportionate share of capital expenditures from the Zeolyst Joint Venture. 

Includes corporate capital expenditures, the cash impact from changes in capital expenditures in accounts payable and 
capitalized interest.

Total assets by segment are not disclosed by the Company because the information is not prepared or used by the 

CODM to assess performance and to allocate resources. 

Sales and long-lived assets by geographic area are presented in the following tables. Sales are attributed to countries 

based upon location of products shipped. 

Sales(1):

United States

Netherlands

United Kingdom

Other foreign countries

Total

(1) 

2018

Years ended
December 31,

2017

$

$

963,722

$

874,764

$

127,803

119,586

397,043

118,567

116,410

362,360

1,608,154

$

1,472,101

$

2016

705,348

79,821

67,494

211,514

1,064,177

Except for the United States, no sales in an individual country exceeded 10% of the Company’s total sales.

F-40

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Long-lived assets(1):
United States

Netherlands

United Kingdom

Other foreign countries

Total

December 31,

2018

2017

$

$

865,799

$

52,461

90,095

200,624

1,208,979

$

891,861

52,882

90,536

195,105

1,230,384

(1) 

Long-lived assets include property, plant and equipment, net.

14. Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets:

The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 is summarized as 

follows: 

Balance as of December 31, 2016

Goodwill recognized

Foreign exchange impact

Balance as of December 31, 2017

Goodwill recognized
Goodwill adjustments(1)
Foreign exchange impact and other

Balance as of December 31, 2018

Environmental
Catalysts &
Services

Performance
Materials &
Chemicals

Total 

388,923

$

852,506

$

1,241,429

—

2,410

37,584

24,533

391,333

$

914,623

$

—

—
(1,682)
389,651

$

649
(34,811)
(15,183)
865,278

$

37,584

26,943

1,305,956

649
(34,811)
(16,865)
1,254,929

$

$

$

(1)  Represents the measurement period adjustments on the net assets acquired as part of the Acquisition (see Note 8 to 

these consolidated financial statements for further information regarding the Acquisition).

The Company completed its annual goodwill impairment assessments as of October 1, 2018 and 2017. For the annual 
assessments, the Company bypassed the option to perform the qualitative assessment and proceeded directly to performing 
the first step of the two-step goodwill impairment test for each of its reporting units. For each of the October 1, 2018 and 
2017 assessments, the Company identified four reporting units, two in each of its operating segments (EC&S and PM&C). 

The Company determined the fair value of its reporting units using a split between a market approach and an income, 
or discounted cash flow, approach. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer 
a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. Estimating the fair value of a 
reporting unit requires various assumptions including the use of projections of future cash flows and discount rates that 
reflect the risks associated with achieving those cash flows. The key assumptions used in estimating the fair value were the 
operating margin growth rates, revenue growth rates from implementation of strategic plans, the weighted average cost of 
capital, the perpetual growth rate, and the estimated earnings market multiples of each reporting unit. The market value was 
estimated using publicly traded comparable company values by applying their most recent annual EBITDA multiples to 
the reporting unit’s trailing twelve months EBITDA. The income approach value was estimated using a discounted cash 
flow approach. The assumptions about future cash flows and growth rates are based on management’s assessment of a 
number of factors including the reporting unit’s recent performance against budget as well as management’s ability to 
F-41

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

execute on planned future strategic initiatives. Discount rate assumptions are based on an assessment of the risk inherent 
in those future cash flows. 

As of October 1, 2018 and 2017, the fair values of each of the Company’s reporting units exceeded their respective 

carrying values and therefore, the second step of the two-step goodwill impairment test was not required. 

In addition to the annual goodwill impairment assessment, the Company also performed the annual impairment test 
over its other indefinite-lived intangible assets as of October 1, 2018 and 2017. The fair values of these intangible assets 
were in excess of their carrying amounts as of the respective testing dates, and as such, there was no impairment of the 
Company’s indefinite-lived intangible assets for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017. 

As a result of the Company’s 2016 test, the Company determined that the trade names related to its performance 
chemicals reporting unit within the PM&C segment and its catalysts reporting unit within the EC&S segment were impaired 
as of October 1, 2016. The impaired intangibles related to those identified as part of the Business Combination. The fair 
value of the respective trade names was determined using the relief-from-royalty method based on the discounted cash 
flows used in the goodwill impairment test. Slower sales growth rates for both reporting units led to the recognition of the 
impairment charges. Based on the testing performed, the Company recorded non-cash impairment charges of $5,350 related 
to trade names within the performance chemicals reporting unit and $1,523 related to trade names within the catalysts 
reporting unit for the year ended December 31, 2016. The impairment charges are included in the other operating expense, 
net line item of the Company’s consolidated statement of operations.

Gross carrying amounts and accumulated amortization for intangible assets other than goodwill are as follows: 

Technical know-how
Customer relationships
Contracts
Trademarks
Permits
Total definite-lived intangible assets
Indefinite-lived trade names
Indefinite-lived trademarks
In-process research and development
Total intangible assets

December 31, 2018

December 31, 2017

Gross
Carrying 
Amount

Accumulated
Amortization

Net
Balance

Gross
Carrying 
Amount

Accumulated
Amortization

Net 
Balance

$

$

211,067 $
361,150
19,800
36,657
9,100
637,774
157,813
80,582
6,800
882,969 $

(32,112) $
(95,399)
(13,139)
(6,451)
(7,432)
(154,533)
—
—
—

(154,533) $

178,955
265,751
6,661
30,206
1,668
483,241
157,813
80,582
6,800
728,436

$

$

212,599 $
366,021
19,800
35,202
9,100
642,722
158,059
82,289
6,800
889,870 $

(21,138) $
(63,860)
(9,205)
(3,911)
(5,612)
(103,726)
—
—
—

(103,726) $

191,461
302,161
10,595
31,291
3,488
538,996
158,059
82,289
6,800
786,144

The  Company  amortizes  technical  know-how  over  periods  that  range  from  eleven  to  twenty  years,  customer 
relationships over periods that range from seven to fifteen years, trademarks over an eleven to fifteen year period, contracts 
over periods that range from two to sixteen years, and permits over five years. 

Amortization of intangibles included in cost of goods sold on the consolidated statements of operations was $17,569, 
$20,579 and $13,573 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Amortization of intangibles 
included in other operating expense, net on the consolidated statements of operations was $35,025, $32,010 and $25,263
for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. 

F-42

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Estimated future aggregate amortization expense of intangible assets is as follows: 

Year 
2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

Thereafter

Total estimated future aggregate amortization expense

15. Accrued Liabilities:

$

$

Amount 

50,652

47,101

46,159

46,092

42,175

251,062

483,241

The following table summarizes the components of accrued liabilities as follows: 

Compensation and bonus

Interest

Property tax

Environmental reserves (see Note 23)

Supply contract obligation (see Note 25)

Income taxes

Commissions and rebates

Pension, postretirement and supplemental retirement plans (see Note 20)

Other

December 31,

2018

2017

$

52,296

$

21,933

3,018

4,693

—

2,123

1,798

2,439

11,709

$

100,009

$

49,988

15,936

1,622

5,790

1,638

1,166

1,820

2,192

13,765

93,917

F-43

 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

16. Long-term Debt:

The summary of long-term debt is as follows: 

Term Loan Facility (U.S. dollar denominated)

Term Loan Facility (Euro denominated)

New Term Loan Facility

6.75% Senior Secured Notes due 2022

5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025

ABL Facility

Other

Total debt

Original issue discount

Deferred financing costs

Total debt, net of original issue discount and deferred financing costs

Less: current portion

Total long-term debt, excluding current portion

Senior Secured Credit Facilities

December 31,

2018

2017

— $

—

1,157,498

625,000

300,000

—

65,925

2,148,423
(18,584)
(15,882)
2,113,957
(7,237)
2,106,720

$

916,153

335,808

—

625,000

300,000

25,000

68,318

2,270,279
(18,390)
(21,403)
2,230,486
(45,166)
2,185,320

$

$

Concurrent with the Business Combination, the Company entered into senior secured credit facilities (collectively, 
the “Senior Secured Credit Facilities”) comprised of a $1,200,000 term loan facility, which consisted of a $900,000 U.S. 
dollar-denominated tranche and a $300,000 Euro-denominated (or €265,000) tranche (the “Term Loan Facility”), and a 
$200,000 asset-based revolving credit facility (the “ABL Facility”). The Term Loan Facility was issued at 99.0% of the 
principal amount. Borrowings under the Term Loan Facility bore interest at a rate equal to the LIBOR rate (or EURIBOR 
rate, as applicable) or the base rate elected by the Company at the time of the borrowing plus a margin of 4.75% or 3.75%, 
respectively. Further, the LIBOR rate and base rate elected under the facilities were subject to a floor of 1.00% and 2.00%, 
respectively. The Term Loan Facility required minimum scheduled quarterly principal payments equal to 0.25% of the 
original principal amount of the term loans made on the closing date of the Business Combination. The Term Loan Facility 
had a maturity date of November 4, 2022. The existing PQ Holdings credit facilities were not legally assumed as part of 
the Business Combination, and the extinguishment of the debt was included as part of the consideration transferred for the 
Business Combination (see Note 7 to these consolidated financial statements for further information).

Concurrent with entering into the Senior Secured Credit Facilities, the Company recorded $4,747 of new creditor and 
third-party financing costs as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, previous unamortized deferred financing costs of 
$6,252  and  original  issue  discount  of  $989  associated  with  the  previously  outstanding  debt  were  written  off  as  debt 
extinguishment costs.

On  November 14,  2016  (the  “First Amendment  Closing  Date”),  the  Company  entered  into  the  First Amendment 
Agreement  to  the Term  Loan  Facility  (the  “First Amendment”)  pursuant  to  which  the  Company,  among  other  things: 
(a) refinanced the existing $900,000 U.S. dollar-denominated tranche by issuing a U.S. dollar-denominated replacement 
term loan in the amount of $927,750 and (b) refinanced the existing €265,000 (or $300,000) Euro-denominated tranche by 
issuing a Euro-denominated replacement term loan in the amount of €283,338. Included in the U.S. dollar-denominated 
replacement  term  loan  was  an  additional  $30,000  principal  amount  of  borrowings.  Included  in  the  Euro-denominated 
replacement  term  loan  was  an  additional  €19,000  principal  amount  of  borrowings.  The  borrowings  under  the  First 
Amendment bore interest at a rate equal to the LIBOR rate plus a margin of 4.25% for U.S. dollar-denominated LIBOR 
Rate loans, the EURIBOR rate plus a margin of 4.00% for Euro-denominated LIBOR Rate loans, or the base rate plus a 
margin of 3.25% for base rate loans elected by the Company at the time of borrowing. These new replacement term loans 
had substantially the same terms under the original Term Loan Facility subject to the amendments contained in the First 
Amendment. 

F-44

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Concurrent with the First Amendment, the Company recorded $474 of new creditor and third-party financing costs 
as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, previous unamortized deferred financing costs of $564 and original issue discount 
of $756 associated with the previously outstanding debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs. 

On August 7, 2017, the Company entered into the Second Amendment Agreement to the Term Loan Facility (the 
“Second Amendment”) and re-priced the then existing $927,750 U.S. dollar-denominated tranche and the then existing 
€283,338 Euro-denominated tranche of its term loans to reduce the applicable interest rates. The terms of the facilities were 
substantially consistent following the re-pricing, except that borrowings under the term loans bore interest at a rate equal 
to the LIBOR rate plus a margin of 3.25% with respect to U.S. dollar-denominated LIBOR rate loans and the EURIBOR 
rate plus a margin of 3.25% with respect to Euro-denominated EURIBOR rate loans. In addition, the LIBOR rate elected 
under the facilities was subject to a floor of 0% and the EURIBOR rate elected under the facilities was subject to a floor of 
0.75%.

Concurrent with the Second Amendment, the Company recorded $199 of new creditor and third-party financing costs 
as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, previous unamortized deferred financing costs of $105 and original issue discount 
of $162 associated with the previously outstanding debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs.

On February 8, 2018 (the “Third Amendment Closing Date”), PQ Corporation (the “Borrower”), an indirect, wholly 
owned subsidiary of the Company, refinanced its existing U.S. Dollar and Euro denominated senior secured term loan 
facilities with a new $1,267,000 senior secured term loan facility (the “New Term Loan Facility”) by entering into the Third 
Amendment Agreement to the Term Loan Facility (the “Third Amendment”), which amended and restated the Term Loan 
Credit Agreement dated as of May 4, 2016, among the Borrower, CPQ Midco I Corporation, Credit Suisse AG, Cayman 
Island Branch, as administrative agent and collateral agent, and the lenders and the other parties party thereto from time to 
time (as amended prior to the Third Amendment, the “Existing Credit Agreement” and as amended and restated by the 
Amendment, the “New Credit Agreement”).

The New Term Loan Facility bears interest at a floating rate of LIBOR plus 2.50% per annum and matures in February 
2025, effectively lowering the interest rate margins compared to the refinanced term loan facilities, eliminating the interest 
rate floor that existed on the Euro-denominated tranche prior to refinancing, and extending the maturity of its senior secured 
term loan facility. The New Term Loan Facility requires scheduled quarterly amortization payments, each equal to 0.25%
of the original principal amount of the loans under the New Term Loan Facility. Concurrent with the Third Amendment, 
the Company recorded $2,124 of new creditor and third-party financing costs as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, 
previous unamortized deferred financing costs of $1,403 and original issue discount of $2,352 associated with the previously 
outstanding debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs. 

On the Third Amendment Closing Date, the Company also entered into multiple cross currency swap arrangements 
to hedge foreign currency risk. The swaps are designed to enable the Company to effectively convert a portion of its fixed-
rate U.S. dollar denominated debt obligations into approximately €280,000 equivalent ($320,404 as of December 31, 2018). 
The swaps are expected to mature in February 2023.

The Company may at any time or from time to time voluntarily prepay loans under the New Term Loan Facility in 

whole or in part without premium or penalty. 

The New Term Loan Facility requires mandatory prepayments from (i) 50% of “Excess Cash Flow” (as defined in 
the New Credit Agreement) on an annual basis with step downs to lower percentages based on the Borrower’s leverage 
ratio, if applicable, (ii) net cash proceeds from the issuance or incurrence of certain indebtedness and (iii) net cash proceeds 
received from certain non-ordinary course disposition of assets and casualty events to the extent such net cash proceeds 
were not reinvested in the Company’s business within a certain specified time period. Prepayments are applied to remaining 
amortization installments in direct order of maturity. The remaining principal balance of the term loans are due upon maturity. 

In addition, the New Credit Agreement contains customary affirmative and negative covenants and events of default, 

all of which are substantially the same as under the Existing Credit Agreement.

The Borrower and certain Canadian and European subsidiaries of the Borrower also have a $200,000 asset-based 
revolving credit facility (the “ABL Facility”) which provides for $150,000 in U.S. available borrowings, up to $10,000 in 
Canadian available borrowings and up to $40,000 of European available borrowings. Borrowings under the ABL Facility 
bear interest at a rate equal to the LIBOR rate or the base rate elected by the Company at the time of the borrowing plus a 

F-45

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

margin  of  between  1.50%-2.00%  or  0.50%-1.00%,  respectively,  depending  on  availability  under  the ABL  Facility.  In 
addition, there is an annual commitment fee equal to 0.375%, with a step-down to 0.25% based on the average usage of the 
revolving credit borrowings available. As of December 31, 2018, there were no revolving credit borrowings under the ABL 
Facility. Revolving credit borrowings are payable at the option of the Company throughout the term of the ABL Facility 
with the balance due May 4, 2021. 

The Company has the ability to request letters of credit under the ABL Facility. The Company had $19,796 of letters 
of credit outstanding as of December 31, 2018, which reduce available borrowings under the ABL Facility by such amounts. 

The New Term Loan Facility is guaranteed by CPQ Midco I Corporation, a subsidiary of the Company and the direct 
parent of the Borrower (“Holdings”) and substantially all of the Borrower’s wholly owned U.S. subsidiaries.  The obligations 
under the New Term Facility are secured (i) by a first-priority security interest in, among other things, a pledge substantially 
all of the Borrower’s and the guarantors’ assets (other than collateral securing the ABL Facility on a first-priority basis) and 
(ii) by a second-priority security interest in receivables, inventory, deposit accounts and other collateral of the Borrower 
and the U.S. subsidiary guarantors securing the ABL Facility. The liens securing the Term Loan Facility and the guarantees 
are pari passu with the liens securing the Senior Secured Notes subject to the pari passu intercreditor agreement.

The obligations of the Borrower under the ABL Facility are guaranteed by Holdings and the same U.S. subsidiary 
guarantors that guarantee the New Term Loan Facility, the obligations of the Canadian Borrowers under the ABL Facility 
are guaranteed by certain other Canadian subsidiaries of the Borrower and the obligations of the European Borrowers under 
the ABL Facility are guaranteed by certain other European subsidiaries of the Borrower.  The obligations of the borrowers 
and guarantors under the ABL Facility are secured (i) by a first-priority security interest in, among other things, substantially 
all of their receivables, inventory, deposit accounts and other collateral securing the ABL Facility on a first-priority basis 
and (ii) by a second-priority security interest in the property and assets of Holdings, the Borrower and the U.S. subsidiary 
guarantors  that  secure  the Term  Loan  Facility.  In  addition,  the ABL  Facility  is  secured  by  the  equity  interests  in,  and 
substantially all of the assets of, certain foreign guarantors in connection with the Canadian dollar-denominated and Euro-
denominated availability.

The Term Loan Facility and the ABL Facility contain various non-financial restrictive covenants. Each limits the 
ability of PQ Corporation and its restricted subsidiaries to incur certain indebtedness or liens, merge, consolidate or liquidate, 
dispose of certain property, make investments or declare or pay dividends, make optional payments, modify certain debt 
instruments, enter into certain transactions with affiliates, enter into certain sales and leasebacks, and certain other non-
financial  restrictive  covenants.  The ABL  Facility  also  contains  one  financial  covenant  which  applies  when  minimum 
availability under the ABL Facility exceeds a certain threshold. During such time, the Company is required to maintain a 
fixed-charge coverage ratio of at least 1.0 to 1.0. The Company is in compliance with all debt covenants as of December 31, 
2018 and 2017, respectively.

In September 2018, the Company prepaid $45,000 of outstanding principal balance on the New Term Loan Facility. 
The Company wrote off $258 of previously unamortized deferred financing costs and original issue discount of $606 as 
debt extinguishment costs. In December 2018, the Company prepaid $55,000 of outstanding principal balance on the New 
Term Loan Facility. The Company wrote off $301 of previously unamortized deferred financing costs and original issue 
discount of $707 as debt extinguishment costs. The prepayments were applied against the remaining scheduled installments 
of principal due in respect of the loans under the New Term Loan Facility in direct order of maturity.

6.75% Senior Secured Notes due 2022

Concurrent  with  the  Business  Combination,  the  Borrower  issued  $625,000  of  6.750%  Senior  Secured  Notes  due 
November 2022 (the “6.75% Senior Secured Notes”) in transactions exempt from or not subject to registration under the 
Securities Act pursuant to Rule 144A and Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933. The 6.75% Senior Secured Notes 
are guaranteed by guaranteed by PQ Holdings Inc. and by the U.S. subsidiary guarantors that guarantee the New Term Loan 
Facility and are secured by liens on the assets of the Borrower and the U.S. subsidiary guarantors on a pari passu with the 
liens securing the New Term Loan Facility subject to the pari passu intercreditor agreement.  The guarantee by PQ Holdings 
Inc. is unsecured. The indenture relating to the 6.75% Senior Secured Notes contains various limitations on the Company’s 
and its restricted subsidiaries’ ability to incur additional indebtedness, pay dividends or repay certain debt, make loans and 
investments, sell assets, create liens, enter into transactions with affiliates, enter into agreements restricting the Borrower’s 
subsidiaries ability to pay dividends, and merge and consolidate with other companies, among other things. Interest on the 

F-46

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

6.75% Senior Secured Notes is payable on May 15 and November 15 of each year, commencing November 15, 2016. No 
principal payments are required with respect to the 6.75% Senior Secured Notes prior to their final maturity. The 6.75% 
Senior Secured Notes mature on November 15, 2022. 

If any Event of Default (other than a default relating to certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency of PQ Corporation 
or certain of its subsidiaries) occurs and is continuing under the Indenture, the Trustee or the Holders of at least 30% in 
principal amount of the then total outstanding notes by notice to the Company may declare the principal, premium, if any, 
interest and any other monetary obligations on all the then outstanding notes to be due and payable immediately. If an event 
of default arising from certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency of the Company occurs, the principal of, premium, if any, 
and interest on all the 6.75% Senior Secured Notes shall become immediately due and payable without any declaration or 
other act on the part of the trustee or any holders. 

The 6.75% Senior Secured Notes are redeemable, in whole or in part, at the redemption prices (expressed as percentages 
of principal amount of the 6.75% Senior Secured Notes to be redeemed) set forth below, plus accrued and unpaid interest, 
if any, to, but not including, the redemption date, if redeemed on or after any of the dates below until the subsequent date 
below:

Year
May 15, 2019

May 15, 2020

May 15, 2021 and thereafter

Percentage
103.375%

101.688%

100.000%

Upon the occurrence of a change of control, as defined, each holder will have the right to require the Company to 
purchase all or any part of such holder’s 6.75% Senior Secured Notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the 
principal amount, plus accrued and unpaid interest.

Senior Unsecured Notes - Redeemed in 2017

Concurrent with the Business Combination, the Borrower issued $525,000 aggregate principal amount of floating rate 
Senior Unsecured Notes due 2022 (the “Senior Unsecured Notes”) in a concurrent private placement exempt from the 
registration requirements of the Securities Act. The notes were issued at 98.0% of the principal amount. The Senior Unsecured 
Notes were to mature on May 1, 2022. 

In conjunction with the Company’s IPO, on October 3, 2017, the Borrower redeemed $446,208 in aggregate principal 
of the $525,000 of its Senior Unsecured Notes using the proceeds from the IPO. Following the redemption, $78,792 aggregate 
principal amount of the Senior Unsecured Notes remained outstanding. The Borrower paid a redemption premium of $32,284, 
which was recorded as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, previous unamortized deferred financing costs of $696 and 
original issue discount of $7,555 associated with the previously outstanding debt were written off as debt extinguishment 
costs.

On December 11, 2017, the Borrower redeemed the remaining $78,792 aggregate principal amount of the Senior 
Unsecured Notes with the proceeds from its issuance of the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025. The Borrower paid 
a redemption premium of $7,091, of which $6,043 was recorded as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, unamortized 
deferred financing costs of $108 and original issue discount of $1,176 associated with the previously outstanding debt were 
written off as debt extinguishment costs. Refer to the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025 section of this note for 
further information. 

8.50% Senior Notes due 2022 - Redeemed in 2017

In December 2014, Eco Services issued $200,000 aggregate principal amount of 8.50% senior notes due 2022 (the 
“2022 Notes”) under an indenture dated October 24, 2014. The 2022 Notes were issued in a private transaction exempt 
from the registration requirements of the Securities Act. Pursuant to the indenture governing the 2022 Notes, PQ Group 
Holdings assumed the obligations of Eco Services under the 2022 Notes following the Business Combination. The 2022 
Notes were to mature on November 1, 2022 and were issued at 100% of the principal amount. On December 11, 2017, the 
Borrower redeemed the $200,000 aggregate principal amount of the 2022 Notes with the proceeds from its issuance of the 
5.75%  Senior  Unsecured  Notes  due  2025. The  Borrower  paid  a  redemption  premium  of  $8,500,  of  which  $7,996  was 
F-47

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

recorded as debt extinguishment costs. In addition, unamortized deferred financing costs of $5,207 associated with the 
previously outstanding debt were written off as debt extinguishment costs. Refer to the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes due 
2025 section of this note for further information.

5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025

On December 11, 2017, the Borrower issued $300,000 aggregate principal amount of floating rate Senior Unsecured 
Notes due 2025 (the “5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes”) in a private placement exempt from the registration requirements 
of the Securities Act. The 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes mature on December 15, 2025. Interest on the 5.75% Senior 
Unsecured Notes is to be paid semi-annually on February 15 and August 15, commencing August 15, 2018, at an annual 
rate of 5.75%. The indenture relating to the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes contained various limitations on the Borrower’s 
and its restricted subsidiaries’ ability to incur additional indebtedness, pay dividends or repay certain debt, make loans and 
investments, sell assets, create liens, enter into transactions with affiliates, enter into agreements restricting the Borrower’s 
subsidiaries ability to pay dividends, and merge and consolidate with other companies, among other things. No principal 
payments are required with respect to the Senior Secured Notes prior to their final maturity. 

The obligations of the Borrower under the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes and the related indenture are guaranteed 
by its U.S. subsidiary guarantors that guarantee the New Term Loan Facility. The obligations of the Company under the 
5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes and the indenture are unsecured. 

If any Event of Default (other than a default relating to certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency of PQ Corporation 
or certain of its subsidiaries) occurs and is continuing under the Indenture, the Trustee or the Holders of at least 30% in 
principal amount of the then total outstanding notes by notice to the Company may declare the principal, premium, if any, 
interest and any other monetary obligations on all the then outstanding notes to be due and payable immediately. If an event 
of default arising from certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency of the Company occurs, the principal of, premium, if any, 
and interest on all the Senior Secured Notes shall become immediately due and payable without any declaration or other 
act on the part of the trustee or any holders. 

At any time prior to December 15, 2020, the Borrower may, at its option and on one more occasions, redeem (a) up 
to 40% of the aggregate principal amount of the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes with the cash proceeds from certain equity 
offerings at a redemption price equal to the sum of 105.75% of the aggregate principal amount thereof plus accrued and 
unpaid interest thereon, and (b) all or part of the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes at 100.00% of the aggregate principal 
amount redeemed plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon and a make-whole premium (the “Applicable Premium”). The 
Applicable Premium is equal to the greater of: (a) 1% of the principal amount of notes redeemed, or (b) the excess, if any, 
of: 

(1) the present value at the redemption date of (i) the redemption price of such notes at December 15, 2020 (as set 
forth  in  the  table  below), plus (ii) all  required  remaining  scheduled  interest  payments  due  on  such  notes  through 
December 15, 2020 (excluding accrued but unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date), computed using a discount 
rate equal to the applicable United States Treasury rate as of such redemption date plus 50 basis points; over 

(2) the outstanding principal amount of such notes on the redemption date.

On or after December 15, 2020, the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes are redeemable, in whole or in part, at the redemption 
prices (expressed as percentages of principal amount of the 5.75% Senior Unsecured Notes to be redeemed) set forth below, 
plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to, but not including, the redemption date, if redeemed on or after any of the dates 
below until the subsequent date below:

Year
December 15, 2020

December 15, 2021

December 15, 2022 and thereafter

Percentage
102.875%

101.438%

100.000%

Upon the occurrence of a change of control, as defined, each holder will have the right to require the Company to 
purchase all or any part of such holder’s Senior Secured Notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the principal 
amount, plus accrued and unpaid interest. 

F-48

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Other Debt 

New Markets Tax Credit Financing 

On October 24, 2013, PQ Holdings’ (and now the Company’s) subsidiary Potters Industries, LLC (“Potters”) entered 
into a NMTC financing arrangement with JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A. and several of its affiliates (“Chase”) and TX CDE 
V LLC, an affiliate of Texas LIC Development Company LLC d/b/a Texas Community Development Capital (“TX CDE”) 
to fund the expansion of Potters’ manufacturing facility in Paris, Texas (the “2013 NMTC Agreement”). The NMTC program, 
which is administered by the United States Treasury Department, requires certain balance sheet commitments. The 2013 
NMTC Agreement will provide the Company with certain monetary benefits as an offset to specifically identified capital 
expenditures. The 2013 NMTC Agreement requires that certain commitments and covenants be maintained over a period 
of seven years in order to legally recognize the benefit. Chase agreed to contribute $6,634 and an additional $15,632 in 
funds lent to Chase by Potters Holdings II, L.P. to TX CDE. TX CDE, in turn, lent $21,000 in the form of $5,368 and $15,632
of notes to Potters, which used the proceeds to finance the expansion of Potters’ manufacturing facility in Paris, Texas. The 
capital expenditures associated with the 2013 NMTC Agreement were completed in 2014. The $21,000 of debt related to 
the 2013 NMTC was assumed as part of the Business Combination and was outstanding as of December 31, 2018. 

On May 17, 2016, Potters entered into a NMTC financing arrangement with U.S. Bank N.A. and several of its affiliates 
(“USB”) and MRC XX LLC, an affiliate of Midwest Renewable Capital, LLC (“MRC”), to fund the expansion of Potters’ 
manufacturing facility in Augusta, Georgia (the “May 2016 NMTC Agreement”). The May 2016 NMTC Agreement provides 
the Company with certain monetary benefits as an offset to specifically identified capital expenditures. The May 2016 
NMTC Agreement requires that certain commitments and covenants be maintained over a period of seven years in order 
to legally recognize the benefit. USB agreed to contribute $3,732 and an additional $7,822 in funds lent to USB by Potters 
Holdings II, L.P. to MRC. MRC, in turn, lent $11,000 in the form of $7,823, $1,311 and $1,866 of notes to Potters, which 
used  the  proceeds  to  finance  the  expansion  of  Potters’  manufacturing  facility  in Augusta,  Georgia.  The  $11,000  was 
outstanding as of December 31, 2018. The capital expenditures associated with the May 2016 NMTC Agreement were 
completed in 2017. 

On December 29, 2016, Potters entered into a second NMTC financing arrangement with USB and MRC whereby 
USB agreed to contribute $3,815 and an additional $7,775 in funds lent to USB by Potters Holdings II, L.P. to MRC. MRC, 
in turn, lent $11,000 in the form of $7,775, $1,402 and $1,823 of notes to Potters, which will use the proceeds as working 
capital for another expansion of Potters’ manufacturing facility in Paris, Texas (the “December 2016 NMTC Agreement”). 
The $11,000 was outstanding as of December 31, 2018. Potters expended the proceeds of the notes as working capital in 
2017. 

On June 22, 2017, Potters, entered into a NMTC financing arrangement with U.S. Bank N.A. (“USB”), one of USB’s 
affiliates (“USB Investment Fund”) and Business Conduit No. 28, LLC, an affiliate of Community Reinvestment Fund, 
Inc. (“CRF”). USB contributed $3,054 to USB Investment Fund, and Potters Leveraged Lender LLC, an indirect subsidiary 
of the Company, lent USB Investment Fund $6,221. USB Investment Fund then contributed $9,000 to CRF, which in turn 
lent $8,820 to Potters pursuant to a credit agreement (the “June 2017 NMTC Agreement”). Potters used the $8,820 in 
proceeds to acquire equipment for the expansion of Potters’ manufacturing facility in Paris, Texas. The June 2017 NMTC 
Agreement provides the Company with certain monetary benefits as an offset to specifically identified capital expenditures. 
The June 2017 NMTC Agreement requires that certain commitments and covenants are maintained over a period of seven 
years in order to legally recognize the benefit. The $8,820 was outstanding as of December 31, 2018. The capital expenditures 
associated with the June 2017 NMTC Agreement were completed in 2018. 

In  connection  with  the  aforementioned  NMTC  financing  arrangements,  the  Company  provided  indemnifications 
related to its actions or inactions which cause either a NMTC disallowance or recapture event. In the event that the Company 
causes either a recapture or disallowance of the tax credits expected to be generated under this program, then the Company 
will be required to repay the disallowed or recaptured tax credits plus an amount sufficient to pay the taxes on such repayment 
to the counterparty of the agreement. This indemnification covers the Company’s actions and inactions prior the end of the 
seven-year  term  of  each  agreement. The  maximum  potential  amount  of  future  payments  under  this  indemnification  is 
approximately $24,649. The Company currently believes that the likelihood of a required payment under this indemnification 
is remote.

F-49

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Sovitec Credit Line

On June 12, 2017, the Company acquired Sovitec and assumed its obligations to Belfius Bank NV (“Belfius”). On 
June 8, 2017, Sovitec entered into a credit agreement with Belfius governing a €14,500 credit line which is divided into 
four tranches. Tranche A was issued in the amount of €7,500 in the form of a Euro roll-over credit with a maturity date of 
December 31, 2021. Tranche B was issued in the amount of €3,000 in the form of a Euro roll-over credit with a full principal 
payment due on its maturity date of September 30, 2022. A working capital line of credit (“Working Capital”) of €3,000
was issued under the form of straight loans with a maturity date up to 90 days after borrowings are made on the line. A 
capital expenditure line of credit (“CAPEX line”) of €1,000 was issued under the form of straight loans with a maturity 
date of September 30, 2021. Tranche A is subject to principal payments of €750 made on September 30 and December 31 
of each year. Borrowings under the credit agreement bear rates based on Sovitec’s ratio of net debt to Normalized EBITDA. 
Normalized EBITDA is defined as the Sovitec consolidated operating profit before non-recurring items (i.e. items non-
related to normal operations of the last twelve month period and provided an acceptable description of the one-off character 
of those items is given) and before taxation, depreciation and amortization. Interest rate margins are subject to being reset 
on June 30 of each year.  Interest rates reset based on three net debt to Normalized EBITDA ratio ranges of less than 2, 
between 2 and 3 or greater than 3. Rates for each tranche of debt reset based on 1 to 9 month EURIBOR rates (not lower 
than zero) plus a margin that can range between 1.10% to 1.55% for Tranche A, 1.85% to 2.15% for Tranche B, 0.90% and 
1.20% for Working Capital and 1.25% and 1.80% for the CAPEX line.

As of December 31, 2018, the interest rate on the credit agreements are as follows:  Tranche A, 1.10%, Tranche B, 
1.85%,  Working  Capital,  0.90%  and  CAPEX  1.25%. As  of  December 31,  2018,  the  following  principal  balances  are 
outstanding on each debt instrument:   Tranche A, $5,148, Tranche B, $3,433, Working Capital, $1,945 and CAPEX $1,144.

Loans and guarantees under the credit agreement are secured by (1) a first priority security interest on the Sovitec 
properties located Fleurus, Belgium and Florange, France and (2) 100% of the nominative shares in Sovitec’s wholly owned 
parent company, Sovitec International B.V.  The credit agreement contains various non-financial and financial covenants.  
Each limits the ability of Sovitec and its restricted subsidiaries to incur certain indebtedness or liens, merge, consolidated 
or liquidate, dispose of certain property, make investments or declare or pay dividends. The credit agreement also contains 
one financial covenant which requires maintaining a maximum net debt/EBITDA ratio of 3:1 during the first three years of 
the  agreement  and  afterwards  a  maximum  2.5:1  ratio.  The  Company  is  in  compliance  with  all  debt  covenants  as  of 
December 31, 2018.

Notes Payable

The Company also has several note payable agreements denominated in Japanese Yen which enables the Company 
to borrow up to a total of 260,000 Japanese Yen, or $2,358. Borrowings bear interest at either TIBOR (“Tokyo Interbank 
Offered  Rate”)  plus  a  margin  or  the  short-term  prime  rate. The  terms  of  the  agreements  vary  and  are  renewable  upon 
expiration of the term with the balances due in 2019. Borrowings under the agreement are payable at the option of the 
Company throughout the term of the agreements. Borrowings outstanding under these agreements were $2,358 and $2,306
as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

Certain of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries maintain other note payable agreements. These agreements are not 

further described as they are not significant to the consolidated financial statements. 

Fair Value of Debt

The fair value of a financial instrument is defined as the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to 
transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction 
between market participants. As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the fair value of the senior secured term loans and senior 
secured and unsecured notes was $2,010,023 and $2,236,280, respectively. The fair value is classified as Level 2 based 
upon the fair value hierarchy (see Note 5 to these consolidated financial statements for further information on fair value 
measurements).

F-50

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Aggregate Long-term Debt Maturities

The aggregate long-term debt maturities are:

Year 
2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

Thereafter

Amount 

7,237

1,718

1,717

628,433

3,689

1,505,629

2,148,423

$

$

17. Other Long-term Liabilities: 

The following table summarizes the components of other long-term liabilities as follows:

Pension benefits

Supply contract (see Note 25)

Other postretirement benefits

Supplemental retirement plans

Reserve for uncertain tax positions

Asset retirement obligation

Other

18. Financial Instruments:

December 31,

2018

2017

$

75,430

$

—

3,233

10,763

3,176

4,224

7,999

69,914

20,612

4,051

11,667

4,244

4,094

5,889

$

104,825

$

120,471

The Company uses (1) interest rate related derivative instruments to manage its exposure related to changes in interest 
rates on its variable-rate debt instruments (2) commodity derivatives to manage its exposure to commodity price fluctuations, 
and (3) foreign currency related derivative instruments to manage its foreign currency exposure to its net investments in 
certain foreign operations. The Company does not speculate using derivative instruments. 

By using derivative financial instruments to hedge exposures to changes in interest rates, commodity prices and foreign 
currency, the Company exposes itself to credit risk and market risk. Credit risk is the failure of the counterparty to perform 
under the terms of the derivative contract. When the fair value of a derivative contract is an asset, the counterparty owes 
the Company, which creates credit risk for the Company. When the fair value of a derivative contract is a liability, the 
Company  owes  the  counterparty  and,  therefore,  the  Company  is  not  exposed  to  the  counterparty’s  credit  risk  in  those 
circumstances. The Company minimizes counterparty credit risk in derivative instruments by entering into transactions 
with high quality counterparties. The derivative instruments entered into by the Company do not contain credit-risk-related 
contingent features. 

Market risk is the adverse effect on the value of a derivative instrument that results from a change in interest rates, 
currency exchange rates or commodity prices. The market risk associated with interest rate and commodity price contracts 
is managed by establishing and monitoring parameters that limit the types and degree of market risk that may be undertaken. 

Use of Derivative Financial Instruments to Manage Commodity Price Risk. The Company is exposed to risks in energy 
costs due to fluctuations in energy prices, particularly natural gas. The Company has a hedging program in the United States 

F-51

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

which allows the Company to mitigate exposure to natural gas volatility with natural gas swap agreements. Fair value is 
determined based on estimated amounts that would be received or paid to terminate the contracts at the reporting date based 
on quoted market prices of comparable contracts. The respective current and non-current liabilities are recorded in accrued 
liabilities and other long-term liabilities and the respective current and non-current assets are recorded in prepaid and other 
current assets and other long-term assets, as applicable, in the Company’s consolidated balance sheet. As the derivatives 
are designated and qualify as cash-flow hedges, the gains or losses on the natural gas swaps are recorded in stockholders’ 
equity as a component of other comprehensive income (loss) (“OCI”), net of tax. Reclassifications of the gains and losses 
on natural gas hedges into earnings are included in production cost and subsequently charged to cost of goods sold in the 
consolidated statements of operations in the period in which the associated inventory is sold. As of December 31, 2018, the 
Company’s  natural  gas  swaps  had  a  remaining  notional  quantity  of  3.9  million  MMBTU  to  mitigate  commodity  price 
volatility through December 2021.

Use of Derivative Financial Instruments to Manage Interest Rate Risk. The Company is exposed to fluctuations in 
interest rates on its senior secured credit facilities. Changes in interest rates will not affect the market value of such debt 
but will affect the amount of the Company’s interest payments over the term of the loans. Likewise, an increase in interest 
rates could have a material impact on the Company’s cash flow. The Company hedges the interest rate fluctuations on debt 
obligations through interest rate cap agreements. The Company records these agreements at fair value as assets or liabilities 
in its consolidated balance sheet. As the derivatives are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges, the gains or losses on 
the interest rate cap agreements are recorded in stockholders’ equity as a component of OCI, net of tax. Reclassifications 
of the gains and losses on the interest rate cap agreements into earnings are recorded as part of interest expense in the 
consolidated statements of operations as the Company makes its interest payments on the hedged portion of its senior secured 
credit facilities. Fair value is determined based on estimated amounts that would be received or paid to terminate the contracts 
at the reporting date based on quoted market prices.

In July 2016, the Company entered into interest rate cap agreements, paying a premium of $1,551 to mitigate interest 
rate volatility from July 2016 through July 2020 by employing varying cap rates, ranging from 1.50% to 3.00% on $1,000,000
of notional variable-rate debt. The cap rate in effect at December 31, 2018 was 2.50%. In November 2018, the Company 
entered into additional interest rate cap agreements to mitigate interest rate volatility from July 2020 through July 2022, 
with a cap rate of 3.50% on $500,000 of notional variable-rate debt.

Use of Derivative Financial Instruments to Manage Foreign Currency Risk. The Company is exposed to risks related 
to its net investments in foreign operations due to fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates, particularly between the 
United  States  dollar  and  the  Euro.  In  connection  with  the  February  2018  term  loan  refinancing  (see  Note  16  to  these 
consolidated financial statements), the Company entered into multiple cross currency interest rate swap arrangements with 
an aggregate notional amount of €280,000 ($320,404 as of December 31, 2018) to hedge this exposure on the net investments 
of certain of its Euro-denominated subsidiaries. The Company records these swap agreements at fair value as assets or 
liabilities in its consolidated balance sheet. As the derivatives are designated and qualify as net investment hedges, changes 
in the fair value of the swaps attributable to changes in the spot exchange rates are recognized in cumulative translation 
adjustment (“CTA”) within OCI and are held there until the hedged net investments are sold or substantially liquidated. 
Changes in the fair value of the swaps attributable to the cross currency basis spread are excluded from the assessment of 
hedge effectiveness and are recorded in current period earnings. Upon such sale or liquidation, the amount recognized in 
CTA is reclassified to earnings and reported in the same line item as the gain or loss on the liquidation of the net investments.

F-52

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The fair values of derivative instruments held as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 are shown below: 

Derivative assets:

Derivatives designated as cash flow hedges:

Natural gas swaps

Interest rate caps

Interest rate caps

Derivatives designed as net investment hedges:

Cross currency swaps

Cross currency swaps

Total derivative assets

Derivative liabilities:

Derivatives designated as cash flow hedges:

Natural gas swaps

Natural gas swaps

Interest rate caps
Total derivative liabilities

Balance sheet location 

2018

2017

December 31,

Prepaid and other current assets

$

21

$

Prepaid and other current assets

Other long-term assets

Prepaid and other current assets

Other long-term assets

1,358

546

1,925

5,499

13,344
18,843

—

44

999

1,043

—

—
—

$

20,768

$

1,043

Accrued liabilities

Other long-term liabilities

Other long-term liabilities

$

$

36

$

148

1,842

2,026

$

318

130

—

448

F-53

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following table shows the effect of the Company’s derivative instruments designated as hedges on accumulated 
other comprehensive income (loss) (“AOCI”) and the statements of operations for the years ended December 31, 2018,  
2017 and 2016:

2018

2017

2016

Years ended December 31,

Location of gain
(loss) reclassified
from AOCI into
income

Interest (expense)
income

Cost of goods sold

Interest rate
caps

Natural gas
swaps

Amount of gain
(loss) recognized in
OCI on derivatives

Amount of gain
(loss) reclassified
from AOCI into
income

Amount of gain
(loss) recognized 
in OCI on
derivatives

Amount of gain
(loss) reclassified
from AOCI into
income

Amount of gain
(loss) recognized 
in OCI on
derivatives

Amount of gain
(loss) reclassified
from AOCI into
income

$

$

$

(981)

637

(344)

$

$

$

(256)

353

97

$

$

$

(4,760)

(1,300)

(6,060)

$

$

$

(40)

(222)

(262)

$

$

$

4,250

(802)

3,448

$

$

$

—

(1,433)

(1,433)

The following table shows the effect of the Company’s cash flow hedge accounting on the consolidated statements 

of operations for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016:

Location and amount of gain (loss) recognized in income on cash flow hedging relationships

Years ended December 31,

2018

2017

2016

Cost of goods
sold

Interest
(expense)
income

Cost of goods
sold

Interest
(expense)
income

Cost of goods
sold

Interest
(expense)
income

$ (1,226,520) $

(113,723) $ (1,095,265) $

(179,044) $

(810,085) $

(140,315)

—

(256)

—

(40)

—

353

—

(222)

—

(1,433)

—

—

Total amounts of income and

expense line items presented in
the statement of operations in
which the effects of cash flow
hedges are recorded

The effects of cash flow hedging:

Gain (loss) on cash flow hedging

relationships:

Interest contracts:

Amount of gain (loss)

reclassified from AOCI
into income

Commodity contracts:

Amount of gain (loss)

reclassified from AOCI
into income

F-54

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following table shows the effect of the Company’s net investment hedges on AOCI and the consolidated statements 

of operations for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016:

Amount of gain (loss)
recognized in OCI on
derivative

Years ended 
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

Amount of (gain) loss
reclassified from AOCI
into income

Years ended 
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

Location of gain
(loss) recognized
in income on
derivative
(amount excluded
from effectiveness
testing)

Location of (gain)
loss reclassified
from AOCI into
income

Amount of gain (loss)
recognized in income on
derivative (amount
excluded from
effectiveness testing)

Years ended 
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

Cross currency

swaps

$ 18,843 $ — $ —

(Gain) loss on sale
of subsidiary

$ — $ — $ —

Interest (expense)
income

$ 7,898 $ — $ —

Amounts of unrealized losses in AOCI that are expected to be reclassified to the consolidated statement of operations 

over the next twelve months are $640 as of December 31, 2018.

19. Income Taxes: 

The Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (the “TCJA”) was enacted on December 22, 2017 and certain provisions became effective 
January 1, 2018. The TCJA imposed significant changes to U.S. tax law, such as lowering U.S. corporate income tax rates, 
implementing  a  territorial  tax  system  and  levying  a  one-time  transition  tax  on  deemed  repatriated  earnings  of  foreign 
subsidiaries.

In response to the TCJA, the SEC staff issued Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 118 (“SAB 118”) to address the application 
of  U.S.  GAAP  in  situations  when  a  registrant  did  not  have  the  necessary  information  available,  prepared,  or  analyzed 
(including computations) in reasonable detail to complete the accounting for certain income tax effects of the TCJA. As 
amounts were refined, SAB 118 allowed registrants to record provisional adjustments during a measurement period that 
extended beyond one year of the TCJA enactment date. In accordance with SAB 118, the Company has finalized the impacts 
of the transition tax as of December 31, 2018 and has recorded a measurement period adjustment of $2,102 as a benefit to 
tax expense. There was no cash tax outlay associated with the final transition tax amount, as the Company elected to utilize 
NOL carryforwards to offset the associated taxable income.

The TCJA also established other new provisions that became effective in 2018. These include, but are not limited 
to,  (1)  a  new  provision  designed  to  tax  low-taxed  income  of  foreign  subsidiaries  (i.e.,  “GILTI”),  which  allows  for  the 
possibility of using foreign tax credits ("FTCs") and a deduction of up to 50% to offset any resulting income tax liability 
(subject  to  some  limitations);  (2)  limitations  on  the  deductibility  of  certain  executive  compensation  (“162(m)”);  (3) 
limitations on the deductibility of interest expense (“163(j)”); and (4) limitations on the use of FTCs to reduce the U.S. 
income tax liability. While many of these provisions are expected to have an impact on the Company’s tax expense and 
deferred taxes for the year ended December 31, 2018 and future periods, the Company expects the GILTI provisions and 
163(j) to have the most significant impact. While significant additional guidance regarding U.S. tax reform has been put 
forth during the year ended December 31, 2018, at this time the overall impact of the TCJA on the Company’s future income 
tax provision continues to remain uncertain.

With  respect  to  GILTI,  the  Company  has  experienced  significant  impact  to  tax  expense  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2018 because of its substantial U.S. NOL balance and being unable to avail itself of both U.S. foreign tax 
credits and the GILTI special deduction (“Section 250 Deduction”). The December 31, 2018 impact to tax expense with 
respect to GILTI is $15,444. Based on FASB guidance, the Company is permitted to make an accounting policy election to 
either (1) treat the taxes incurred as a result of the GILTI provision as a current-period expense when incurred or (2) factor 
such amounts into its measurement of deferred taxes. The Company has elected to treat any expense incurred as a current-
period expense.

With respect to 163(j), the Company has experienced a significant disallowance with respect to its current year interest 
expense. The Company’s 163(j) interest disallowance is $57,705 for the year ended December 31, 2018. This disallowance 
has no impact to overall tax expense, given that any disallowed interest deductions are permitted to be carried forward 

F-55

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

indefinitely and, as such, are set up as deferred tax assets. The Company has evaluated the realizability of this deferred tax 
asset, and believes it is more-likely-than-not that it will be realized, using reversal of existing taxable temporary differences.

Income (loss) before income taxes and noncontrolling interest within or outside the United States are shown below: 

Domestic

Foreign

Total

Years ended
December 31,

2018

3,935

84,681

88,616

$

$

2017
(137,147) $
76,513
(60,634) $

2016
(84,094)
14,977
(69,117)

$

$

The provision (benefit) for income taxes as shown in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations consists 

of the following:

Current:

Federal

State

Foreign

Deferred:

Federal

State

Foreign

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

$

— $

— $

2,470

23,080

25,550

12,854
(784)
(8,625)
3,445

806

20,209

21,015

(135,970)
(1,817)
(2,425)
(140,212)

—

91

10,088

10,179

8,654

292
(9,084)
(138)

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

$

28,995

$

(119,197) $

10,041

F-56

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

A reconciliation of income tax expense (benefit) at the U.S. federal statutory income tax rate to actual income tax 

expense is as follows: 

Tax at statutory rate

State income taxes, net of federal income tax benefit

Repatriation of non-US earnings

Change in tax status-Eco Services-Passthrough to C-Corporation

Changes in uncertain tax positions

Change in valuation allowances

Rate changes

Change in state effective rates

Foreign withholding taxes

Foreign tax rate differential

Non-deductible transaction costs

Permanent difference created by foreign exchange gain or loss

Research and development tax credits

Other, net

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

$

2018

$

18,610

$

Years ended
December 31,

2017
(21,222) $
(7,754)
(24,912)
—

974

6,771
(63,319)
(340)
978
(13,634)
1,679

3,503

—
(1,921)
(119,197) $

$

1,203

14,187

—
(996)
5,075
(4,016)
691

1,828

2,191

84
(7,550)
(1,173)
(1,139)
28,995

2016
(24,191)
(4,110)
4,576

33,891
(2,383)
2,577

—
(290)
1,505
(3,040)
667

1,686

—
(847)
10,041

The total tax provision (benefit) of $28,995, $(119,197) and $10,041 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017
and 2016, respectively, on the Company’s consolidated pre-tax income (loss) for the period differs from the U.S. statutory 
tax rate of 21%. This difference is principally due to the impacts of U.S. tax reform (including GILTI), the effect of permanent 
differences related to foreign currency exchange gain or loss, foreign income tax in jurisdictions with statutory rates different 
than the U.S. rate, state taxes, non-deductible transaction costs, foreign withholding taxes, changes in valuation allowance, 
and changes in uncertain tax positions. 

Prior to the Business Combination on May 4, 2016, Eco Services was a single member limited liability company and 
taxed as a partnership for federal and state income tax purposes. As such, all income tax liabilities and/or benefits of Eco 
Services were passed through to their members. Because Eco Services was taxed as a partnership, it did not record deferred 
taxes  on  the  basis  difference  on  their  financial  statements.  Following  the  Business  Combination  on  May  4,  2016,  Eco 
Services had a change in tax status and is now taxed as a C-Corporation subject to federal and state corporate level income 
taxes at prevailing corporate tax rates. As Eco Services had not previously recorded deferred taxes on the basis difference, 
the Company recognized net deferred tax liabilities of $33,891 for the year ended December 31, 2016 primarily related to 
basis differences in depreciable fixed assets and intangible assets based upon prevailing corporate tax rates.

Deferred incomes taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the financial statement carrying 
amounts of assets and liabilities and the amounts recognized for income tax purposes. U.S. GAAP requires that deferred 
tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to be applied to taxable income in the years in which 
those temporary differences are expected to reverse in the future. As a result of the reduction in the U.S. corporate income 
tax rate from 35% to 21%, the Company was required to remeasure existing deferred tax balances using the new U.S. 
statutory tax rate in 2017. 

F-57

 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Deferred tax assets (liabilities) are comprised of the following:

December 31,

2018

2017

Deferred tax assets:

Net operating loss carryforwards

$

116,607

$

Section 163j interest disallowance carryforward

Pension

Post retirement health

Transaction costs

Natural gas contracts and interest rate swaps

Unrealized translation losses

US research and development credits

Other

Valuation allowance

Deferred tax liabilities:

Depreciation

Undistributed earnings of non-US subsidiaries

Inventory

Intangible assets

Cross currency swaps

Other

Net deferred tax liabilities

$

$

$

$

13,387

16,397

1,385

708

335

3,737

1,173

38,855
(48,711)
143,873

$

(92,911) $
(6,648)
(10,432)
(174,327)
(4,654)
(32,230)
(321,202) $

144,267

—

16,255

561

1,183

225

5,065

—

38,290
(64,945)
140,901

(86,532)
(8,334)
(11,324)
(184,937)
—
(36,810)
(327,937)

(177,329) $

(187,036)

Included in the 2018 and 2017 deferred tax asset and liability amounts for depreciation, intangible assets, inventory, 
natural gas contracts, unrealized transaction losses, and other above is $45,251 and $45,873, respectively, of a net deferred 
tax liability related to the Company’s investment in Potters, which is a partnership for federal income tax purposes. The 
Company and one of its subsidiaries own in aggregate 100% of Potters and the assets and liabilities of Potters are included 
in the consolidated financial statements of the Company. 

The $177,329 in net deferred tax liabilities as of December 31, 2018 consists of $18,795 in non-current deferred tax 
assets and $196,124 in net non-current deferred tax liabilities. The $187,036 in net deferred tax liabilities as of December 31, 
2017 consists of $2,300 in non-current deferred tax assets and $189,336 in net non-current deferred tax liabilities. 

The change in net deferred tax liabilities for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 was primarily related to 
the decrease in deferred tax liabilities resulting from the revaluing of domestic deferred tax amounts, pursuant to U.S. tax 
reform lowering the statutory tax rate, establishing a deferred tax asset with respect to 163(j), as well as the change in book 
amortization of intangibles with no corresponding tax basis and movement in valuation allowances with respect to acquired 
Sovitec entities. 

F-58

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following are changes in the deferred tax valuation allowance during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 

2017: 

Beginning Balance

Additions

Reductions

Ending Balance

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

$

$

64,945

$

5,314
(21,548)
48,711

$

38,271

34,863
(8,189)
64,945

Included in the additions line above is $20,753 related to fair value adjustments recorded to goodwill as part of the 
initial Acquisition purchase accounting analysis for the year ended December 31, 2017. Included in the reductions line 
above is $20,038 related to fair value adjustments recorded to goodwill as part of the finalization of the Acquisition purchase 
accounting for the year ended December 31, 2018.

The  net  change  in  the  total  valuation  allowance  was  a  decrease  of  $16,234  in  2018. The  valuation  allowance  at 
December 31, 2018 was primarily related to foreign and state net operating loss carryforwards and tax credits that, in the 
judgment of management, are not more likely than not to be realized. In assessing the ability to realize deferred tax assets, 
management considered whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be 
realized. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during 
the periods in which those temporary differences become deductible. Management considered the scheduled reversal of 
deferred tax liabilities (including the impact of available carryback and carryforward periods), projected future taxable 
income, and tax-planning strategies that are prudent in making this assessment. In order to fully realize deferred tax assets, 
the  Company  will  need  to  generate  future  taxable  income  prior  to  the  expiration  of  the  net  operating  loss  and  credit 
carryforwards. The amount of the deferred tax assets considered realizable, however, could be reduced in the near term if 
estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced. 

Management considered certain earnings in non-U.S. subsidiaries to be available for repatriation in the future. The 
tax cost associated with non-U.S. subsidiary earnings and distributions for the year ended December 31, 2018 has been 
recorded as tax expense for the period. In this regard the Company expects to deduct, rather than credit, foreign tax expense 
in computing the U.S. tax effects of repatriation from non-U.S. subsidiaries in 2018. The unremitted earnings of non-U.S. 
subsidiaries and affiliates that have not been permanently reinvested amount to $168,304 and $210,979 as of December 31, 
2018 and 2017, respectively. The deferred foreign withholding tax liability on these undistributed earnings is estimated to 
be $6,648 and $8,334 as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. As a result of U.S. tax reform, the liability on 
unremitted earnings as of December 31, 2018 is only related to foreign withholding taxes, as all earnings and profits were 
deemed to be repatriated for U.S. income tax purposes as a result of U.S. Tax Reform.

The cumulative unremitted earnings of foreign subsidiaries outside the United States in excess of the $168,304 are 
considered permanently reinvested, for which no withholding taxes have been provided. Such earnings are expected to be 
reinvested  indefinitely  and,  as  a  result,  no  deferred  tax  liability  has  been  recognized  with  regard  to  such  earnings. 
Determination of the deferred withholding tax liability on these unremitted earnings is not practicable, principally because 
such liability, if any, is dependent on circumstances existing if and when remittance occurs.

F-59

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following table summarizes the activity related to the Company’s gross unrecognized tax benefits: 

Balance at beginning of period

Increases related to prior year tax positions

Decreases related to prior year tax positions

Increases related to current year tax positions

Balance at end of period

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

11,431

$

—
(1,538)
282

10,175

$

16,128

68
(5,508)
743

11,431

$

$

The total unrecognized tax benefits of $10,175 and $11,431 were generated from legacy PQ Corporation. If these 
amounts are recognized in future periods, it would affect the effective tax rate on income from continuing operations for 
the years in which they are recognized. 

Interest and penalties recognized related to uncertain tax positions amounted to $42 and $52 for the years ended 
December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. To the extent interest and penalties are not assessed with respect to uncertain 
tax positions, amounts accrued will be reduced and reflected as a reduction of the overall income tax provision in the period 
for  which  the  event  occurs  requiring  the  adjustment.  The  $1,088  and  $1,270  in  accrued  interest  and  penalties  as  of 
December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, is recorded in other long-term liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets.

Due to the Business Combination, the Company files numerous consolidated and separate income tax returns in the 
U.S. federal jurisdiction and in many state and foreign jurisdictions. The following describes the open tax years, by major 
tax jurisdiction, as of December 31, 2018: 

Jurisdiction 
United States-Federal

United States-State
Canada(1)
Germany

Netherlands

Mexico

United Kingdom

Brazil

Period 
2007-Present

2007-Present

2010-Present

2015-Present

2012-Present

2014-Present

2012-Present

2014-Present

(1)  

Includes federal as well as local jurisdictions 

Given  that  certain  U.S.  companies  have  net  operating  loss  carryforwards,  the  statute  for  examination  by  taxing 
authorities in the United States, and certain state jurisdictions, will remain open for a period following the use of such net 
operating loss carryforwards, extending the period for examination beyond the years indicated above.

The Company has subsidiaries in various states, provinces and countries that are currently under audit for years 
ranging from 2007 through 2017. To date, no material adjustments have been proposed as a result of these audits. As of 
December 31, 2018, the Company does not believe that there are any positions for which it is reasonably possible that the 
total amount of unrecognized tax benefits will significantly increase or decrease within the next 12 months.

The Company has a NOL available of $284,237 to reduce future federal taxes payable. The current federal carry-
forward period for those NOL’s is 20 years because they were generated prior to U.S. tax reform being enacted. In light of 
tax reform, any net operating losses incurred after December 31, 2017 will be allowed to carry forward indefinitely. As a 
result of the 2014 change in control, $144,357 of the $284,237 are subject to the limitations of Section 382 of the Internal 

F-60

 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Revenue Code (“IRC”). Although subject to the limitations of IRC §382, management believes it is more likely than not 
that the Company will realize the entire $144,357 in pre-transaction NOLs in future years. The remaining $139,880 relates 
to periods after the 2014 change in control and would not be subject to limitation under IRC §382.

For state income tax purposes, the Company incurred net operating losses of $21,594 for 2018 that may be carried 
forward at a minimum period of 5 years, and in certain circumstances indefinitely, among the states in which the Company 
is subject to tax to reduce future state income taxes payable. Cumulative state net operating losses carrying forward into 
2019 are $681,010. A valuation allowance of $17,718 has been applied against the total $33,179 of state net operating loss 
deferred tax assets, leaving losses of $15,461 that have been recognized for financial accounting purposes for the portion 
of those losses that the Company believes, on a more likely than not basis, will be realized.

Foreign net operating losses of $131,453, of which $586 will begin to expire in 2019, $2,205 will begin to expire in 
2026, $92 will begin to expire in 2028, $7,616 will begin to expire in 2029 with the remaining $120,954 carrying forward 
indefinitely, are available to reduce future foreign income taxes payable. A valuation allowance of $11,940 has been applied 
to $31,431 of deferred tax assets related to foreign net operating loss carry-forwards, leaving a net deferred tax asset relating 
to foreign net operating losses of $19,491 that has been recognized for financial accounting purposes.

Cash payments for income taxes, net of refunds, are as follows: 

Domestic

Foreign

$

$

2018

2,160

21,682

23,842

$

$

Years ended
December 31,

2017

1,647

27,552

29,199

$

$

2016

373

16,608

16,981

F-61

 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

20. Benefit Plans: 

The Company sponsors defined benefit pension plans covering employees in the United States and certain employees 
at its foreign subsidiaries. Benefits for a majority of the plans are based on average final pay and years of service. The 
Company’s funding policy is to fund the minimum required contribution under local statutory requirements. 

The Company sponsors unfunded plans to provide certain health care benefits to retired employees in the United States 
and Canada. The plans pay a stated percentage of medical expenses reduced by deductibles and other coverage. The plans 
are unfunded and obligations are paid out of the Company’s operations. 

The  Company  also  has  defined  benefit  supplementary  retirement  plans  which  provide  benefits  for  certain  U.S. 
employees in excess of qualified plan limitations. The obligations are paid out of the Company’s general assets, including 
assets held in a Rabbi trust, or restoration plan assets. 

The Company uses a December 31 measurement date for all of its defined benefit pension, postretirement medical 
and supplementary retirement plans. The following discussion includes information for the Eco Services benefit plans for 
all periods presented, and the acquired PQ Holdings benefit plans beginning on the date of the Business Combination. 

The Eco Services benefit plans include two defined benefit pension plans and one retiree health plan, all based in the 
U.S. The PQ Holdings benefit plans include a U.S. defined benefit pension plan as well as the defined benefit pension plans 
for all of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries, two retiree health plans (one each in the U.S and Canada), and the Company’s 
defined benefit supplementary retirement plans. 

Of the Company’s three defined benefit pension plans covering employees in the U.S., only the Eco Services Hourly 
Pension Plan continues to accrue benefits for certain participants. All future accruals were frozen for the PQ Corporation 
Retirement Plan as of December 31, 2006 and for the Eco Services Pension Equity Plan as of December 31, 2016. With 
respect to the Company’s three retiree health plans, the PQ Holdings plans in the U.S. and Canada were closed to new 
retirees as of December 31, 2006. The Eco Services Postretirement Life and Dental Plan was closed to new retirees effective 
July 1,  2017.  The  Company’s  defined  benefit  supplementary  retirement  plans  were  frozen  to  future  accruals  as  of 
December 31, 2006. 

F-62

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Defined Benefit Pension Plans 

The following tables summarize changes in the benefit obligation, plan assets and funded status of the Company’s 
significant defined benefit pension plans as well as the components of net periodic benefit cost, including key assumptions: 

Change in benefit obligation:

Benefit obligation at beginning of period

$

261,102

$

247,418

$

119,710

$

106,025

U.S.  

December 31,

Foreign  

December 31,

2018

2017

2018

2017

Service cost

Interest cost

Participant contributions

Plan amendments

Plan curtailments

Plan settlements

Benefits paid

Expenses paid

Net transfer in

Actuarial (gains) losses

Translation adjustment

Benefit obligation at end of the period

Change in plan assets:

Fair value of plan assets at beginning of period

Actual return on plan assets

Employer contributions

Employee contributions

Plan settlements

Benefits paid

Expenses paid

Acquisitions

Translation adjustment

Fair value of plan assets at end of the period

Funded status of the plans (underfunded)

1,019

9,599

—

—
(952)
—
(11,453)
—

—
(13,004)
—

1,219

10,115

—

—

—
(2,264)
(9,591)
—

—

14,205

—

246,311

$

261,102

$

218,374
(12,854)
1,688

—

—
(11,453)
—

—

—

$

198,915

$

27,554

3,760

—
(2,264)
(9,591)
—

—

—

195,755

$

218,374

$

3,566

3,340

570

179
(340)
(1,071)
(2,569)
(363)
1,535
(5,432)
(7,022)
112,103

96,518
(540)
4,249

570
(1,071)
(2,569)
(363)
1,013
(6,020)
91,787

$

$

$

3,686

3,271

493

—

—

—
(2,967)
(319)
—
(2,169)
11,690

119,710

86,145

217

3,781

493

—
(2,967)
(319)
—

9,168

96,518

(50,556) $

(42,728) $

(20,316) $

(23,192)

$

$

$

$

F-63

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets consist of:

Noncurrent asset

Current liability

Noncurrent liability

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

Net amount recognized

U.S.  

December 31,

Foreign  

December 31,

2018

2017

2018

2017

$

$

— $

— $

—
(50,556)
1,218
(49,338) $

—
(42,728)
10,499
(32,229) $

$

4,670
(748)
(24,238)
(1,829)
(22,145) $

3,503
(673)
(26,022)
(2,871)
(26,063)

Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) consist of: 

Prior service cost

Net gain (loss)

Gross amount recognized

Deferred income taxes

Net amount recognized

Components of net periodic benefit cost consist of: 

U.S.  

December 31,

Foreign  

December 31,

2018

2017

2018

2017

$

$

— $

— $

1,618

1,618
(400)
1,218

$

13,943

13,943
(3,444)
10,499

$

(170) $

(2,133)
(2,303)
474
(1,829) $

—
(3,923)
(3,923)
1,052
(2,871)

Service cost

Interest cost

Expected return on plan assets

Amortization of net (gain) loss

Curtailment gain recognized

Settlement (gain) loss

recognized

U.S.  

Years ended
December 31,

Foreign  

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

$

1,019

$

1,219

$

2,130

$

3,566

$

3,686

$

2,106

9,599

(12,851)

10,115

(12,277)

—

(576)

—

—

—

(48)

7,680
(9,293)
—
(1,311)

152
(642) $

3,340
(3,311)
49
(340)

(11)
3,293

3,271
(3,208)
(9)
—

2,224
(2,038)
(10)
(517)

—

—

$

3,740

$

1,765

Net periodic expense (benefit)

$

(2,809) $

(991) $

All components of net periodic benefit cost other than service cost are presented within other expense (income), net 
in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations. There is a nominal amount of estimated net actuarial gains and 
prior  service  costs  for  the  Company’s  defined  benefit  pension  plans  that  will  be  amortized  from  accumulated  other 
comprehensive income (loss) into net periodic benefit cost in 2019.

The total accumulated benefit obligation as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 for the Company’s U.S. pension plans 
was $244,580 and $257,882, respectively. The total accumulated benefit obligation as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 for 
the Company’s foreign pension plans was $107,910 and $114,095, respectively. 

F-64

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The  following  table  presents  selected  information  about  the  Company’s  pension  plans  with  accumulated  benefit 

obligations in excess of plan assets:

Projected benefit obligation

Accumulated benefit obligation

Fair value of plan assets

U.S.  

December 31,

$

$

2018
246,311

244,580

195,755

$

2017
261,102

257,882

218,374

Foreign  

December 31,

2018

2017

82,656

78,862

57,670

67,750

64,526

42,632

Significant weighted average assumptions used in determining the pension obligations include the following: 

Discount rate
Rate of compensation increase(1) 

U.S.  

December 31,

Foreign 

December 31,

2018

2017

2018

2017

4.32%

3.00%

3.74%

3.00%

3.01%

2.44%

2.91%

2.57%

Significant weighted average assumptions used in determining net periodic benefit cost include the following:

Discount rate

Rate of compensation 

increase(1)

Expected return on assets

U.S.  

Years ended
December 31,

Foreign  

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

3.74%

3.00%

6.00%

4.24%

3.00%

6.37%

4.02%

3.10%

6.34%

2.91%

2.57%

3.52%

2.99%

2.97%

3.58%

5.16%

3.95%

5.62%

(1) 

Includes only plans not frozen to benefit accruals for the respective periods. 

The discount rate for each of the U.S. plans was determined by utilizing a yield curve model. The model develops a 
spot rate curve based on the yields available from a broad-based universe of high quality corporate bonds. The discount 
rate is then set as the weighted average spot rate, using the respective plan’s expected benefit cash flows as the weights. 

In determining the expected return on U.S. plan assets, the Company considers the relative weighting of plan assets, 
the historical performance of total plan assets and individual asset classes, and expected future performance. In addition, 
the  Company  may  consult  with  and  consider  the  opinions  of  our  external  advisors  in  developing  appropriate  return 
benchmarks. 

F-65

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The investment objective for the U.S. plans is to generate returns sufficient to meet future obligations. The strategy 
to  meet  the  objective  includes  generating  attractive  returns  using  higher  returning  assets  such  as  equity  securities  and 
balancing risk using less volatile assets such as fixed income securities. The U.S. plans invest in an allocation of assets 
across the two broadly-defined financial asset categories of equity and fixed income securities. The target allocations for 
the plan assets across the three U.S. plans are as follows: 45% equity securities and 55% fixed income investments for the 
PQ Corporation Retirement Plan; 40% equity securities and 60% fixed income investments for the Eco Services Pension 
Equity Plan; and 45% equity securities and 55% fixed income investments for the Eco Services Hourly Pension Plan.

Similar considerations are applied to the investment objectives of the non-U.S. plans as well as the asset classes 

available in each location and any legal restrictions on plan investments. 

The Company classifies plan assets based upon a fair value hierarchy (see Note 5 to these consolidated financial 
statements for further information). The classification of each asset within the hierarchy is based on the lowest level input 
that is significant to its measurement. The fair value hierarchy consists of three levels as follows: 

•  Level 1—Values are unadjusted quoted prices for identical assets and liabilities in active markets accessible at 
the measurement date. Active markets provide pricing data for trades occurring at least weekly and include 
exchanges and dealer markets. Level 1 assets primarily include investments in publicly traded equity securities 
and mutual funds. These securities (or the underlying investments of the funds) are actively traded and valued 
using quoted prices for identical securities from the market exchanges. 

•  Level 2—Inputs include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, quoted prices from those 
willing to trade in markets that are not active, or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by market 
data for the term of the instrument. Such inputs include market interest rates and volatilities, spreads and yield 
curves. Level 2 assets primarily consist of fixed-income securities and comingled funds that are not actively 
traded or whose underlying investments are valued using observable marketplace inputs. The fair value of plan 
assets invested in fixed-income securities is generally determined using valuation models that use observable 
inputs such as interest rates, bond yields, low-volume market quotes and quoted prices for similar assets. Plan 
assets that are invested in comingled funds are valued using a unit price or net asset value (“NAV”) that is based 
on the underlying investments of the fund. 

•  Level 3—Certain inputs are unobservable (supported by little or no market activity) and significant to the fair 
value  measurement.  Unobservable  inputs  reflect  the  Company’s  best  estimate  of  what  hypothetical  market 
participants would use to determine a transaction price for the asset or liability at the reporting date. Level 3 
assets  include  investments  covered  by  insurance  contracts  and  real  estate  funds  valued  using  significant 
unobservable inputs. 

F-66

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following tables set forth by level, within the fair value hierarchy, plan assets at fair value:

Cash and cash equivalents(1)
Equity securities:

U.S. investment funds

International investment funds

Fixed income securities:

Government securities

Corporate bonds

Investment fund bonds

Other:

Insurance contracts

Total

Cash and cash equivalents

Equity securities:

U.S. investment funds

International investment funds

Fixed income securities:

Government securities

Corporate bonds

Investment fund bonds

Other:

Insurance contracts

Total

December 31, 2018

Total

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

$

57,000

$

56,925

$

75

$

35,103

44,508

10,121

77,229

25,152

38,429

35,103

24,040

—

72,216

7,665

—

20,468

10,121

5,013

17,487

—

33,408

$

287,542

$

195,949

$

86,572

$

December 31, 2017

Total

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

$

1,072

$

934

$

138

$

56,309

70,308

11,433

82,585

54,263

38,922

43,625

28,827

—

77,685

7,719

12,684

41,481

11,433

4,900

46,544

—

34,772

$

314,892

$

158,790

$

151,952

$

5,021

5,021

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

4,150

4,150

(1)    Level 1 balance includes $55,905 of cash and cash equivalents held by two of the Company’s U.S. defined benefit 
pension plans. The investments in equity securities and fixed income securities previously held by these plans were 
liquidated into cash and cash equivalents in December 2018 in preparation for a transfer of plan assets to a new 
custodian. This transfer was completed in January 2019.

The changes in the Level 3 pension plan assets are as follows for the years ended December 31:

F-67

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Beginning balance

Actual return on plan assets

Benefits paid

Contributions

Exchange rate changes and other

Ending balance

Insurance Contracts

2018

2017

$

$

4,150

$

10
(385)
461

785

5,021

$

3,286
(41)
(48)
466

487

4,150

The Company expects to contribute $972 to the U.S. pension plans and $4,334 to the foreign pension plans in 2019. 

The following benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, are expected to be paid:

Year
2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

Years 2024-2028

U.S.

Foreign 

$

15,369

$

16,253

16,966

15,894

15,823

78,304

3,115

2,769

2,952

3,366

3,630

23,111

Certain of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries maintain other defined benefit plans that are consistent with statutory 
practices. These plans are not included in the disclosures above as they are not significant to the Company’s consolidated 
financial statements. 

Supplemental Retirement Plans 

The following tables summarize changes in the benefit obligation, plan assets and funded status of the Company’s 
defined  benefit  supplementary  retirement  plans,  as  well  as  the  components  of  net  periodic  benefit  cost,  including  key 
assumptions:

Change in benefit obligation:

Benefit obligation at beginning of period

Interest cost

Benefits paid

Actuarial (gains) losses

Benefit obligation at end of period

Change in plan assets:

Fair value of plan assets at beginning of period

Employer contributions

Benefits paid

Fair value of plan assets at end of period

Funded status of the plans (underfunded)

December 31,

2018

2017

12,781

$

450
(1,070)
(293)
11,868

$

— $

1,070
(1,070)

— $

13,225

489
(1,179)
246

12,781

—

1,179
(1,179)
—

(11,868) $

(12,781)

$

$

$

$

$

F-68

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets consist of:

Current liability

Noncurrent liability

Accumulated other comprehensive income

Net amount recognized

December 31,

2018

2017

$

$

(1,105) $
(10,763)
795
(11,073) $

Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income consist of:

Net gain

Gross amount recognized

Deferred income taxes

Net amount recognized

Components of net periodic benefit cost consist of:

December 31,

2018

2017

$

$

1,055

$

1,055
(260)
795

$

(1,115)
(11,667)
573
(12,209)

761

761
(188)
573

Interest cost

Net periodic expense

$

$

2018

450

450

$

$

Years ended
December 31,

2017

489

489

$

$

2016

328

328

Interest cost is presented within other expense (income), net in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations. 
There are no estimated net actuarial gains for the Company’s defined benefit supplementary retirement plans that will be 
amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income into net periodic benefit cost in 2019. 

The  accumulated  benefit  obligation  of  the  Company’s  defined  benefit  supplemental  retirement  plans  as  of 

December 31, 2018 and 2017 was $11,868 and $12,781, respectively. 

The discount rate used in determining the defined benefit supplemental retirement plan obligation was 4.20% and 
3.60% as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. The discount rate used in determining net periodic benefit cost was 
3.60%,  3.90%  and  3.40%  for  the  years  ended  December 31,  2018,  2017  and  2016,  respectively. There  was  no  rate  of 
compensation  increase  for  any  of  the  periods  presented,  as  all  future  accruals  were  frozen  for  the  defined  benefit 
supplementary retirement plans as of December 31, 2006. 

The Company expects to contribute $1,105 to the defined benefit supplementary retirement plans in 2019. 

F-69

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, are expected to be paid: 

Year 
2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

Years 2024-2028

Amount

$

1,105

1,076

1,045

1,009

970

4,276

Other Postretirement Benefit Plans 

The following tables summarize changes in the benefit obligation, plan assets and funded status of the Company’s 

other postretirement benefit plans as well as the components of net periodic benefit cost, including key assumptions:

Change in benefit obligation:

Benefit obligation at beginning of period

$

4,612

$

4,620

December 31,

2018

2017

Service cost

Interest cost

Employee contributions

Plan amendments

Benefits paid

Medical subsidies received

Premiums paid

Actuarial (gains) losses

Translation adjustment

Benefit obligation at end of period

Change in plan assets:

Fair value of plan assets at beginning of period

Employer contributions

Employee contributions

Benefits paid

Medical subsidies received

Premiums paid

Fair value of plan assets at end of period

Funded status of the plans (underfunded)

$

$

$

F-70

16

150

251
(271)
(1,061)
74
(66)
172
(63)
3,814

21

174

251

—
(923)
—
(3)
418

54

$

4,612

—

802

251
(1,061)
74
(66)
— $

(3,814) $

—

675

251
(923)
—
(3)
—

(4,612)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets consist of:

Current liability

Noncurrent liability

Accumulated other comprehensive income

Net amount recognized

December 31,

2018

2017

$

$

(581) $

(3,233)
830
(2,984) $

Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income consist of: 

Prior service credit

Net gain

Gross amount recognized

Deferred income taxes

Net amount recognized

Components of net periodic benefit cost consist of:

December 31,

2018

2017

$

$

525

500

1,025
(195)
830

$

$

(561)
(4,051)
885
(3,727)

366

719

1,085
(200)
885

Service cost

Interest cost

Amortization of prior service credit

Amortization of net gain

Net periodic expense

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

16

$

21

$

150
(112)
(26)
28

$

174
(78)
(45)
72

$

37

151

—
(17)
171

$

$

All components of net periodic benefit cost other than service cost are presented within other expense (income), net 
in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations. The estimated prior service credit for the Company’s retiree health 
plans that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income into net periodic benefit cost in 2019 is $130. 
The estimated net actuarial gain for the Company’s retiree health plans that will be amortized from accumulated other 
comprehensive income into net periodic benefit cost in 2019 is $32. 

The discount rate used in determining the other postretirement benefit plan obligation was 3.53% and 3.74% as of 
December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. The discount rate used in determining net periodic benefit cost was 3.53%, 
3.74% and 3.92% for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

F-71

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Assumed health care cost trend rates were as follows:

Immediate trend rate

Ultimate trend rate

Year that the rate reaches ultimate trend rate

2018
6.59%

4.50%

2035

December 31,

2017
6.84%

4.50%

2035

A 1% change in the assumed health care cost trend would have increased (decreased) the accumulated postretirement 
benefit obligation as of December 31, 2018 and the periodic postretirement benefit cost for the year then ended as follows:

Accumulated postretirement benefit obligation

$

Periodic postretirement benefit cost

1% Increase

1% Decrease

157

$

6

(138)
(5)

The Company expects to contribute $581 to the retiree health plans in 2019. 

The following benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, are expected to be paid:

Year 
2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

Years 2024-2028

Amount

$

581

514

388

313

272

915

There are no expected Medicare subsidy receipts expected in future periods. 

Certain of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries maintain other postretirement benefit plans that are consistent with 
statutory practices. These plans are not included in the disclosures above as they are not significant to the Company’s 
consolidated financial statements. 

Defined Contribution Plans 

The  Company  also  has  defined  contribution  plans  covering  domestic  employees  of  the  Company  and  certain 
subsidiaries. The Company recorded expenses of $12,585, $13,103 and $6,864 related to these plans for the years ended 
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

21. Earnings per Share:

During the period January 1, 2016 to May 4, 2016, the date of the Business Combination, the Company was structured 
as  a  single  member  LLC,  with  capital  contributions  from  affiliates  of  CCMP,  the  Company’s  board  of  managers  and 
management represented by a class of membership units (“Eco Services Class A Units” or “Eco Services membership 
units”). During this period, Eco Services also granted incentive awards to certain employees, directors and affiliates in the 
form of Class B Units of Eco Services (the “Eco Services Class B Units”), which provided recipients with the option to 
purchase Eco Services Class A Units upon the attainment of certain vesting and other restrictions (see Note 22 to these 
consolidated financial statements for further information regarding the Company’s equity incentive plans). At the date of 
the Business Combination, the existing Eco Services Class A Units and legacy PQ Holdings equity were converted to 
common stock of PQ Group Holdings. None of the Eco Class B Units had been exercised prior to the Business Combination, 

F-72

 
 
 
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

and all Eco Class B Units converted to common stock options of PQ Group Holdings at the date of the Business Combination 
(see Note 22).

Basic earnings per share is calculated as income (loss) available to common stockholders, divided by the weighted 
average  number  of  common  shares  outstanding  during  the  period.  The  weighted  average  number  of  common  shares 
outstanding during the period for the computation of basic earnings per share excludes restricted stock awards that have 
legally been issued but are nonvested during the period, as the sale of these shares is prohibited pending satisfaction of 
certain vesting conditions by the award recipients in order to earn the rights to the shares (see Note 22 to these consolidated 
financial statements for further information regarding outstanding nonvested restricted stock awards). 

Diluted earnings per share is calculated as income (loss) available to common stockholders, divided by the weighted 
average number of common and potential common shares outstanding during the period for each class of common stock, 
if dilutive. Potential shares reflect unvested restricted stock awards and restricted stock units with service conditions as well 
as options to purchase common stock, which have been included in the diluted earnings per share calculation using the 
treasury stock method.

For both the basic and dilutive weighted average shares calculations, as a result of the Business Combination, the 
number of Eco Services membership units outstanding from January 1, 2016 through May 4, 2016, the date of the Business 
Combination, were computed on the basis of the weighted average units outstanding for Eco Services during the respective 
periods multiplied by the exchange ratio established for common stock as part of the Business Combination.

The reconciliation from basic to diluted weighted average shares outstanding is as follows:

Weighted average shares outstanding – Basic

Dilutive effect of unvested common shares and restricted stock
units with service conditions and assumed stock option
exercises and conversions

Weighted average shares outstanding – Diluted

2018
133,380,567

Years ended
December 31,

2017
111,299,670

2016
78,016,005

1,304,364

369,367

—

134,684,931

111,669,037

78,016,005

F-73

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Basic and diluted earnings per share are calculated as follows:

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

Numerator:

Net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.

$

58,300

$

57,603

$

(79,746)

Denominator:

Weighted average shares outstanding – Basic

Weighted average shares outstanding – Diluted
Net income (loss) per share:

Basic income (loss) per share

Diluted income (loss) per share

133,380,567

111,299,670

78,016,005

134,684,931

111,669,037

78,016,005

$

$

0.44

0.43

$

$

0.52

0.52

$

$

(1.02)
(1.02)

The table below presents the details of the Company’s equity-based awards outstanding at the end of each respective 

year that were excluded from the calculation of diluted earnings per share:

Restricted stock awards with performance only targets not yet achieved

Stock options with performance only targets not yet achieved

Anti-dilutive restricted stock awards and restricted stock units

Anti-dilutive stock options

2018
1,643,760

586,253

10,296

863,063

December 31,

2017
1,769,447

586,523

—

2016
1,731,522

417,086

751,410

621,747

1,381,352

Restricted stock awards and stock options with performance only vesting conditions are not included in the dilution 
calculation, as the performance targets have not been achieved as of the end of the respective years. Anti-dilutive awards 
are not included in the dilution calculation, as their inclusion would have the effect of increasing diluted income per share.

22. Stock-Based Compensation:

Eco Services Class B Units 

Prior to the Business Combination, the Company recognized stock-based compensation expense for incentive awards 
issued under the Eco Services Group Holdings Incentive Unit Agreement dated December 29, 2014 (the “Incentive Unit 
Agreement”). Under the Incentive Unit Agreement, the Company granted Eco Services Class B Units to certain employees, 
directors  and  affiliates  of  the  Company. As  of  December  31,  2015  and  immediately  prior  to  the  date  of  the  Business 
Combination on May 4, 2016, there were 25,093 of Eco Services Class B Units outstanding with an exercise price of $1,000/
unit. 

Of this total, 10,674 Eco Services Class B Units granted to employees (the “Management Awards”) had two vesting 
criteria, in which 50% were subject to a service (time-based) vesting condition and 50% were subject to a performance 
condition based upon the occurrence of specific liquidity events. The Eco Services Class B Units subject to the service 
condition vested 25% annually, with the first annual vesting date of December 1, 2015. The remaining 14,419 of Eco Services 
Class B Units awarded to directors and affiliates (the “Director Awards”) were subject to a service vesting condition only, 
consistent  with  that  of  the  Management Awards. The  Eco  Services  Class B  Units  did  not  have  a  contractually  defined 
maximum term.

F-74

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

PQ Group Holdings Awards 

In conjunction with the Business Combination, the Company adopted an equity incentive plan, namely the PQ Group 
Holdings Inc. Stock Incentive Plan (“2016 Plan”). Under the terms of the 2016 Plan, the Company is authorized to issue a 
total of 8,017,038 shares for common stock awards to employees, directors and affiliates of the Company. Immediately 
preceding the IPO as of September 30, 2017, awards with respect to 7,644,518 shares of common stock had been issued 
under the 2016 Plan. In connection with the IPO, the Company’s board of directors adopted the PQ Group Holdings Inc. 
2017 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “2017 Plan”). Subsequent to the IPO, all equity incentive awards are granted under the 
2017 Plan. The number of shares of common stock reserved for issuance under the 2017 Plan is 7,344,000 shares, which 
amount is increased by the 372,520 shares remaining available for grant under the 2016 Plan as of the 2017 Plan adoption. 
Shares that become available for issuance pursuant to the 2016 Plan as a result of forfeiture, cancellation or termination for 
no consideration will be available for future awards under the 2017 Plan. Shares underlying awards granted under the 2017 
Plan that are forfeited, canceled, terminated for no consideration, settled in cash or are withheld for exercise, taxes, etc. will 
not be deemed as delivered and will also be available for future issuance under the 2017 Plan. At December 31, 2018, 
5,396,119 shares of common stock were available for issuance under the 2017 Plan.

Stock Options

As part of the Business Combination, the 25,093 of outstanding Eco Services Class B Units at the date of the Business 
Combination were canceled and replaced with 1,378,302 of options to purchase PQ Group Holdings common stock at an 
exercise price of $8.04/share. The Eco Services Class B Units were replaced by common stock options in accordance with 
a formula to convert such awards, plus a vested cash component. The terms of the new awards were substantially identical 
to those in effect prior to the Business Combination, except for adjustments to the underlying number of shares (based on 
the conversion ratio) and the exercise price, which was based on PQ Group Holdings common stock. Additionally, although 
the Eco Services Class B Units did not have a contractually defined maximum term, the maximum term of the common 
stock options is ten years. 

The Company accounted for the cancellation and replacement (including a cash component) as a combination of a 
modification  and  a  cash  settlement.  This  resulted  in  no  incremental  compensation  cost  recognized  at  the  time  of  the 
modification, but led to an acceleration of $1,174 of previously measured but unrecognized compensation cost. 

In addition to the Eco Services Class B Units that were canceled and replaced at the time of the Business Combination, 
the Company exchanged the outstanding option awards of PQ Holdings for options of PQ Group Holdings in connection 
with the merger. The terms of the PQ Group Holdings awards were substantially identical to those of the PQ Holdings 
awards, including the number of underlying shares and vesting conditions, with the exception of an exercise price of $8.04/
share for the common stock options. There are various vesting conditions associated with the exchanged awards, including 
satisfaction of certain service and performance based conditions.

Beginning with the date of the Business Combination of May 4, 2016 through the Company’s IPO, the Company 
granted common stock options with either service or performance vesting conditions, all with a maximum contractual term 
of ten years. Starting on October 2, 2017 in connection with the Company’s IPO and subsequent to this date, the Company’s 
stock option grants have been subject to graded vesting conditions based on service and a maximum contractual term of 
ten years. 

F-75

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

The following table summarizes the activity of common stock options for the period from the date of the Business 
Combination of May 4, 2016 through the year ended December 31, 2018, which includes both the Eco Services Class B 
Units that were canceled and replaced, as well as the PQ Holdings options that were exchanged as part of the Business 
Combination:

Number of
Options

Weighted
Average
Exercise Price

Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term (in years)

Aggregate 
Intrinsic Value 
(in thousands)

Granted/assumed on May 4, 2016 in connection with

the Business Combination

Granted

Forfeited

Outstanding at December 31, 2016

Granted

Exercised

Forfeited

Outstanding at December 31, 2017

Granted

Exercised

Outstanding at December 31, 2018

Exercisable at December 31, 2018

1,738,527

$

$
538,908
(478,997) $
$
1,798,438

1,051,496

$
(32,366) $
(102,398) $
$
2,715,170

241,316
$
(15,332) $
$

2,941,154

1,629,969

$

7.80

8.05

7.49

7.96

13.70

8.04

7.98

10.18

17.50

8.51

10.79

10.19

7.71

7.71

$

$

14,452

8,748

The aggregate intrinsic value per the above table represents the difference between the fair value the Company’s 
common stock on the last trading day of the reporting period (determined in accordance with the plan terms) and the exercise 
price of in-the-money stock options multiplied by the respective number of stock options as of that date. The total intrinsic 
value of stock options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 and the resulting tax benefits recognized 
by the Company were not material for either year. Additionally, cash proceeds received by the Company during the year 
ended December 31, 2018 were not material. The Company did not receive any cash proceeds from the exercise of stock 
options during the year ended December 31, 2017, as the Company withheld shares in satisfaction of the exercise price and 
taxes due. 

The fair values of PQ Group Holdings common stock options granted during the years ended December 31, 2018, 
2017 and 2016 were determined on the respective grant dates using a Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following 
weighted-average assumptions:

2018

2017

2016

Expected term (in years)

Expected volatility

Risk-free interest rate

Expected dividend yield

5.75

26.38%

2.86%

0.00%

5.85

34.85%

2.00%

0.00%

Weighted average grant date fair value of options granted

$

5.47

$

4.71

$

5.00

45.79%

1.54%

0.00%

3.33

With the limited experience of the Company with respect to historical exercise and forfeiture rates or patterns, the 
expected term for stock option grants in 2016 was estimated in the context of the service award vesting period as well as 
the timeframe for a liquidity event for the performance awards, along with the ten-year contractual maximum term, while 
the Company was still privately held. Beginning in 2017, the Company used the simplified method for plain vanilla 
stock options to estimate the expected term assumption, since the Company lacks sufficient historical exercise data to 
provide a reasonable basis upon which to estimate the expected term due to the limited period of time its common stock 
F-76

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

has been publicly traded. The application of the simplified method involves calculating the average of the time-to-
vesting period and the total contractual life of the options. 

The Company applied a consistent methodology for the remainder of the assumptions in the Black-Scholes option 
pricing model for stock option grants during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016. The expected volatility 
was compared to a range of the actual stock price volatility of a peer group of companies. The risk-free interest rate was 
based on U.S. Treasury rates in effect at the time of the grant commensurate with the expected term. There was no dividend 
yield assumption since the Company has not paid dividends nor does it have an expectation of future dividend payouts. 

Restricted Stock Awards and Restricted Stock Units

In addition to the exchange of the PQ Holdings options at the date of the Business Combination on May 4, 2016, the 
Company also exchanged unvested PQ Holdings restricted stock awards for 2,444,070 shares of restricted stock awards of 
PQ Group Holdings. The restricted stock awards were issued at substantially identical terms to the original PQ Holdings 
awards, with the exception of a new price ascribed to the shares.

The restricted stock awards were subject to the same vesting requirements as the original awards, which included 
awards  with  vesting  conditions  based  on  (1)  service  only,  (2)  performance  only,  or  (3)  a  combination  of  service  and 
performance conditions, dependent on which event occurs first. The vesting requirements for the majority of these awards 
were based upon the achievement of a performance condition. As defined in the award agreements, each award subject to 
the performance condition fully vests upon the occurrence of a defined liquidity event upon which certain investment funds 
affiliated with CCMP receive proceeds exceeding certain thresholds. Although achievement of the performance condition 
is subject to continued service with the Company, the terms of awards issued with performance conditions stipulate that the 
performance vesting condition can be attained for a period of six months following separation from service. The same 
performance vesting condition for the Company’s restricted stock awards also governs the achievement of the performance 
vesting condition for the Company’s stock options. With the exception of 14,498 and 21,067 of restricted stock awards 
granted on December 27, 2018 and October 2, 2017, respectively, both of which immediately vested and were valued based 
on the average of the high and low trading prices of the Company’s common stock on the NYSE on the preceding trading 
day, based on the Company’s policy for valuing such awards, all of the Company’s restricted stock awards were granted 
prior to the IPO. As a result, the Company valued the pre-IPO restricted stock awards at grant using multiples of EBITDA 
and the income approach, based on a discounted free cash flow model.

In addition to restricted stock awards, the Company has granted restricted stock units as part of its equity incentive 
compensation program. The value of the restricted stock unit grants were based on the average of the high and low trading 
prices of the Company’s common stock on the NYSE on the preceding trading day, based on the Company’s policy for 
valuing such awards, and have graded vesting conditions based on service.

The following table summarizes the activity of restricted stock awards and restricted stock units for the period from 
the date of the Business Combination of May 4, 2016 through the year ended December 31, 2018, which includes the PQ 
Holdings restricted stock awards that were exchanged as part of the Business Combination:

F-77

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Granted/assumed on May 4, 2016 in connection with

the Business Combination

Granted

Vested

Forfeited

Nonvested as of December 31, 2016

Granted

Vested

Forfeited

Nonvested as of December 31, 2017

Granted

Vested

Forfeited

Nonvested as of December 31, 2018

Business Combination and Equity Restructuring

Restricted Stock Awards

Restricted Stock Units

Number of
Shares

Weighted
Average Grant
Date Fair Value
(per share)

Number of
Units

Weighted
Average Grant
Date Fair Value
(per share)

2,444,070

$

$
266,955
(207,915) $
(20,178) $
$

2,482,932

51,907
$
(187,837) $
(250,365) $
$
2,096,637

14,498
$
(223,298) $
(117,177) $
$
1,770,660

9.27

12.32

12.32

10.52

9.34

16.11

12.84

12.03

8.87

13.80

12.18

8.04

8.39

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

—

—

—

—

—

1,654,690

$

16.97

— $

— $

1,654,690

$

161,598
$
(797,859) $
(19,643) $
$
998,786

—

—

16.97

16.12

16.97

16.97

16.83

The exchange of the PQ Holdings stock options and restricted stock awards for similar awards of PQ Group Holdings 
in the context of the Business Combination was accounted for as a modification of the awards. As a result, the cost of the 
replacement awards of PQ Group Holdings represented a combination of both pre- and post-merger services. The amount 
attributable to services prior to the Business Combination in connection with the modification was $1,400, and is considered 
part of the consideration transferred in the Business Combination (see Note 7 to these consolidated financial statements for 
further  information). The  remainder  of  the  cost  is  attributed  to  post-merger  services  and  is  being  recognized  over  the 
respective remaining vesting periods. 

The Company’s equity restructuring which occurred prior the IPO (see Note 1 to these consolidated financial statements 
for further information) also constituted an event subject to modification accounting for stock-based compensation awards. 
However, the change to the equity incentive awards of the Company was designed to preserve the fair value of the awards 
before and after the reclassification and stock split (based on the existing antidilution provisions of the 2016 Plan), and 
included the same terms and were classified in the same manner as the equity awards preceding the modification. As a 
result, no incremental compensation cost was recognized by the Company.

Total Stock-Based Compensation Expense

For the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, total stock-based compensation expense for the Company 
(inclusive of both the Eco Services Class B Units prior to the Business Combination and the awards replaced or exchanged 
at the consummation of the Business Combination) was $19,464, $8,799 and $7,029, respectively. The income tax benefit 
recognized in the statements of operations for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016 was $4,809, $3,345 and 
$2,660.

As of December 31, 2018, there was $2,484,141 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested stock 
options  subject  to  service  vesting  conditions.  As  of  December 31,  2018,  there  was  $342,724  of  total  unrecognized 
compensation cost related to nonvested restricted stock awards subject to service vesting conditions. As of December 31, 
2018, there was $13,945,550 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested restricted stock units. No expense 
has been recognized for any stock-based compensation awards subject to the performance condition for the years ended 
December 31,  2018,  2017  and  2016,  as  the  performance-based  criteria  was  not  achieved  nor  considered  probable  of 
achievement. 

F-78

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Awards issued with performance conditions vest based on the occurrence of a defined liquidity event upon which 
certain investment funds affiliated with CCMP receive proceeds exceeding certain thresholds. All of the Company’s equity 
incentive awards with performance-based vesting, whether in the form of stock options or restricted stock awards, are subject 
to achievement of the same performance condition. If an exit event occurs that exceeds the defined threshold, then all 
performance-based awards of the Company vest 100%, with no potential for partial vesting or excess achievement. If an 
exit event or events occur with no further possibility of meeting the defined threshold, then all of the Company’s awards 
subject to the performance vesting condition will be forfeited. In addition to the defined liquidity event, subsequent to the 
Company’s IPO, the performance vesting condition can also be achieved if the average closing trading price of the Company’s 
common stock on the NYSE over any consecutive ten-day trading period equals or exceeds a price that would be equivalent 
to the achievement of the threshold proceeds to CCMP. See Note 21 to these consolidated financial statements for further 
information on the number of awards outstanding subject to performance-based vesting.

23. Commitments and Contingent Liabilities:

Environmental Contingencies

There is a risk of environmental impact in chemical manufacturing operations. The Company’s environmental policies 
and practices are designed to comply with existing laws and regulations and to minimize the possibility of significant 
environmental impact. The Company is also subject to various other lawsuits and claims with respect to matters such as 
governmental regulations, labor and other actions arising out of the normal course of business. While management believes 
that the liabilities resulting from such lawsuits and claims are not probable or reasonably estimable, certain accruals have 
been reflected in the Company’s consolidated financial statements, some of which are described in detail within this note.

The Company has recorded a reserve of $873 and $1,245 as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, to address 
remaining subsurface remedial and wetlands/marsh management activities at the Company’s Martinez, CA site. Although 
currently a sulfuric acid regeneration plant, the site originally was operated by Mountain Copper Company (“Mococo”) as 
a copper smelter. Also, the site sold iron pyrite to various customers and allowed their customers to deposit waste iron pyrite 
cinder and slag on the site. The property is adjacent to Peyton Slough, where Mococo had a permitted discharge point from 
its process. In 1997, the San Francisco Bay Regional Water Quality Control Board (“RWQCB”) required characterization 
and remediation of Peyton Slough for Copper, Zinc and Acidic Soils. Various remediation activities were undertaken and 
completed, and the site has received final concurrence from the Army Corps with respect to the completed work. The 
RWQCB has agreed that Eco Services has achieved the goals for vegetative cover, but the current marsh condition is not 
sustainable without continued operation of the tide gates. The Company is continuing to work with the RWQCB on a plan 
to involve the County and work towards development of an alliance for operating, maintaining and funding the tide gates 
in the future. 

As  of  December 31,  2018  and  2017,  the  Company  has  recorded  a  reserve  of  $984  and  $1,220,  respectively,  for 
subsurface remediation and the Soil Vapor Extraction Project at the Company’s Dominguez, CA site. In the 1980s and 
1990s, the EPA and the Los Angeles Regional Water Quality Control Board conducted investigations of the site due to 
historic chlorinated pesticide and chlorinated solvent use. Soil and groundwater beneath the site were impacted by chlorinated 
solvents  and  associated  breakdown  products,  petroleum  hydrocarbons,  chlorinated  pesticides  and  metals. A  Corrective 
Measures  Plan  approved  in  October  2011  requires  (1) soil  vapor  extraction  (“SVE”)  in  affected  areas,  (2) covering  of 
unpaved areas containing pesticide impacted soil, and (3) annual groundwater monitoring of the perched water-bearing 
zone.  Installation  of  the  SVE  unit  has  been  completed  and  startup  has  occurred.  The  California  Department  of  Toxic 
Substances Control (“DTSC”) has granted conditional approval of the Company’s soil management, and monitoring and 
maintenance plans. Most recently, the DTSC is requiring the Company to delineate the PCE plume on the eastern boundary 
of the site. The Company has submitted an action plan to address this matter and is awaiting comments from the DTSC.

F-79

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Leases

The Company has entered into various lease agreements for the rental of office and plant facilities, railcars, machinery 
and equipment, substantially all of which are classified as operating leases. Total rent expense under these agreements was 
$25,082, $22,704 and $16,315 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

Total rent due under non-cancelable operating lease commitments as of December 31, 2018 is: 

Year
2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

Thereafter

Amount

18,457

14,344

11,432

8,354

6,198

17,477

76,262

$

$

Purchase Commitments 

The Company has entered into short and long-term purchase commitments for various key raw materials and energy 
requirements. The purchase obligations include agreements to purchase goods that are enforceable and legally binding, and 
that specify all significant terms. The purchase commitments covered by these agreements are with various suppliers and 
total approximately $56,642 as of December 31, 2018. Purchases under these agreements are expected to be as follows:

Year
2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

Thereafter

Amount

28,485

19,820

2,039

1,450

1,305

3,543

56,642

$

$

Letters of Credit

At December 31, 2018, the Company had outstanding letters of credit of $19,796. Letters of credit are guarantees of 
payment  to  third  parties. The  Company’s  letters  of  credit  are  used  primarily  as  collateral  for  various  items,  including 
environmental, energy and insurance payments. The letters of credit are supported by the Company’s ABL facility.

F-80

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

24. Restructuring and Other Related Costs:

The following table presents the components of restructuring and other related costs for the years ended December 31, 
2018, 2017 and 2016 included in other operating expense, net, in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations:

Severance and other employee costs related to Eco

Services restructuring plan

Severance and other employee costs related to

performance materials plant closure

Other related costs

Eco Services Restructuring Plan 

2018

Years ended
December 31,

2017

2016

$

$

— $

830

$

5,093

885

5,323

4,711

2,949

6,208

$

8,490

$

—

7,537

12,630

On July 30, 2014, Eco Services, a newly formed Delaware limited liability company and indirect subsidiary of certain 
investment funds affiliated with CCMP, entered into an Asset Purchase Agreement with Solvay USA, Inc. (“Solvay”), a 
Delaware corporation, which provided for the sale, transfer and assignment by Solvay and the acquisition, acceptance and 
assumption by Eco Services, of substantially all of the assets of Solvay’s Eco Services business unit of Solvay’s regeneration 
and virgin sulfuric acid production business operations in the United States (the “2014 Acquisition”). Prior to the Asset 
Purchase Agreement with Solvay, Eco Services operated as a business unit within Solvay, which is an indirect, wholly 
owned subsidiary of Solvay SA. 

Subsequent to the 2014 Acquisition, the Company initiated a restructuring plan designed to improve organizational 
efficiency and streamline the operations of Eco Services as a stand-alone company. The primary impact of the plan to the 
Company’s consolidated results of operations was the recognition of severance costs related to a reduction-in-force. These 
costs included benefits payable under ongoing Company severance plan arrangements, whereby payments are attributable 
to employee services rendered with benefits that accumulate over time. The liabilities and associated charges related to 
these severance costs are recognized by the Company when payment of the benefits becomes probable and estimable. The 
restructuring plan was substantially complete in early 2017.

Costs related to the restructuring plan affected employees in the Company’s EC&S segment, although these costs are 
excluded from the segment’s measure of profitability of Adjusted EBITDA (see Note 13 to these consolidated financial 
statements for further information).

Performance Materials Plant Closure

In September 2017, the Company approved and announced a plan to consolidate its manufacturing operations in 
Europe for the performance materials product group and close its facility in Kirchheimbolanden, Germany, and subsequently 
reduced production. The plan was part of the Company’s overall strategy with respect to the Acquisition (see Note 8 to these 
consolidated financial statements) and the realization of cost and other synergies in connection with the transaction.

As a result of a change in the market and increased customer demand for the products produced at this facility, the 
Company intends to keep the facility open and expanded production at this facility during the third quarter of 2018 from 
the previously reduced levels. However, the Company continues to pay its obligations to the individuals originally separated 
from service as part of the reorganization, with additional payments anticipated through 2019, primarily for individuals 
who extended their separation dates as a result of the decision to continue operations at the facility. Costs related to the 
restructuring  plan  affected  employees  in  the  Company’s  PM&C  segment,  although  these  costs  are  excluded  from  the 
segment’s measure of profitability of Adjusted EBITDA (see Note 13 to these consolidated financial statements for further 
information). The Company considers the restructuring plan related to the original decision to close the facility substantially 
complete, with no additional restructuring charges anticipated. 

F-81

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

Rollforward of Restructuring Liabilities

The activity in the accrued liability balance associated with the Company’s restructuring plans, all of which related 

to severance and other employee costs, was as follows for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016: 

Balance at December 31, 2015

Restructuring charges

Cash payments

Balance at December 31, 2016

Restructuring charges

Cash payments

Balance at December 31, 2017

Restructuring charges

Other adjustments

Cash payments

Balance at December 31, 2018

Other Related Costs 

Eco Services 
Restructuring Plan
1,293
$

Performance 
Materials 
Plant Closure

Total Restructuring 
Charges

— $

—

—

— $

4,711
(1,588)
3,123

581

304
(2,738)
1,270

$

$

1,293

5,093
(4,743)
1,643

5,541
(3,846)
3,338

581

304
(2,953)
1,270

$

$

$

5,093
(4,743)
1,643

830
(2,258)
215

—

—
(215)

— $

$

$

$

The Company incurred severance and other costs of $5,323, $2,949 and $7,537 for the years ended December 31, 
2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. These costs were not associated with formal restructuring plans and primarily related 
to severance charges for certain executives and employees, transition/duplicate staffing, professional fees and other expenses 
related to the Company’s organizational changes.

25. Long-term Supply Contract:

As part of Solvay’s 2004 sale of its Specialty Phosphates business, Solvay agreed to continue to supply sulfuric acid 
to a customer in support of the phosphoric acid production for its specialty phosphates business under a preexisting supply 
agreement. This non-cancelable agreement extends to 2031, and was assumed by the Company in connection with the 2014 
Acquisition. 

The liability associated with this unfavorable supply agreement was recorded at a fair value of $27,300 in connection 
with the 2014 Acquisition. The fair value was determined using the income method based on the differential of the estimated 
margin over the cost of the sulfuric acid per the market as compared to the below market margin included in the supply 
agreement, and the application of this excess differential to the anticipated volumes over the term of the agreement using 
a commensurate discount rate. In December 2018, the customer to the supply agreement ceased production and closed the 
facility which utilized the Company’s sulfuric acid under the agreement. As such, all orders for sulfuric acid under the 
agreement were discontinued in December 2018. Although the agreement is not cancelable, the likelihood is remote that 
the Company will be further obligated to supply the customer under the agreement since this is the only facility subject to 
the agreement, and there are no transfer or substitution rights under the agreement to another facility. As a result, the Company 
wrote-off the remaining supply contract liability of $20,612 at December 31, 2018 and recorded a corresponding gain to 
other operating expense, net as of December 31, 2018. The liability was $22,250 at December 31, 2017.

26. Related Party Transactions:

The Company maintains certain policies and procedures for the review, approval and ratification of related party 
transactions to ensure that all transactions with selected parties are fair, reasonable and in the Company’s best interests. All 
significant relationships and transactions are separately identified by management if they meet the definition of a related 
party or a related party transaction. Related party transactions include transactions that occurred during the year, or are 

F-82

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

currently proposed, in which the Company was or will be a participant, and for which any related person had or will have 
a direct or indirect material interest. All related party transactions are reviewed, approved and documented by the appropriate 
level of the Company’s management in accordance with these policies and procedures.

On December 29, 2014, PQ Holdings, CCMP and PQ Corporation entered into a consulting agreement relating to the 
provision of certain financial and strategic advisory services and consulting services. Similarly, the consulting agreement 
between PQ Holdings, INEOS Capital Partners and PQ Corporation was amended and restated. Under the new consulting 
agreements, the Company agreed to pay an annual management fee of $5,000 distributed to CCMP and INEOS AG equal 
to the Pro Rata Percentage, as defined, between CCMP and INEOS AG. These consulting agreements were terminated upon 
completion of the Company’s IPO on October 3, 2017. The Company recorded $3,777 and $3,584 of management advisory 
fees in other operating expense, net in the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31, 2017
and 2016, respectively.

Transactions with Board of Directors 

In connection with the offering by PQ Corporation of $525,000 aggregate principal amount of Senior Unsecured Notes 
due 2022 in May 2016, a member of the Company’s board of directors purchased $4,000 in principal amount of such notes. 
Interest accrued on the notes at an annual rate equal to three-month LIBOR plus 10.75%, with a 1.0% LIBOR floor, payable 
and reset quarterly. The director received interest payments in respect of the notes totaling $362 and $300 during the years 
ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively. The notes were partially redeemed in October 2017 in connection with 
the Company’s IPO, and redeemed in full in December 2017 in connection with the Company’s issuance and sale of the 
$300,000 Senior Unsecured Notes due 2025 (see Note 16).  The director received $4,000 of principal amount of such notes 
as well as $338 related to the prepayment penalties in connection with these two transactions.

Joint Venture Agreement 

The Company entered into a joint venture agreement (the “ZI Partnership Agreement”) in 1988 with CRI Zeolites 
Inc., a Royal Dutch Shell plc affiliate, to form Zeolyst International, our 50/50 joint venture partnership (the “Partnership”). 
Under the terms of the ZI Partnership Agreement, the Partnership leases certain land used in its Kansas City production 
facilities from PQ Corporation. This lease, which has been recorded as an operating lease, provided for rental payments of 
$295, $295 and $187 during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. The terms of this lease are 
evergreen as long as the ZI Partnership Agreement is in place. The Partnership recognized sales to the Company of $645, 
$2,475 and $1,191 during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016. respectively.

The Partnership purchases certain of its raw materials from the Company and is charged for various manufacturing 
costs incurred at the Company’s Kansas City production facility. The amount of these costs charged to the Partnership were 
$16,869, $17,470 and $10,707 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Certain administrative, 
marketing, engineering, management-related, and research and development services are provided to the Partnership by the 
Company. During the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, the Partnership was charged $12,727, $12,248 and 
$8,169, respectively, for these services. In addition, the Partnership was charged certain product demonstration costs of 
$1,768, $2,175 and $1,663 during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. These charges to the 
Partnership are recorded as reductions in either cost of goods sold or selling, general and administrative expenses in the 
consolidated statements of operations, depending on the nature of the expenditures.

Other 

From time to time, the Company makes sales to portfolio companies of funds that are affiliated with CCMP and 
companies that are affiliated with INEOS Capital Partners. The Company had sales of $5,587 and $8,396 to companies 
affiliated  with  INEOS  Capital  Partners  during  the  years  ended  December 31,  2018  and  2017,  respectively.  Sales  were 
immaterial to companies affiliated with INEOS Capital Partners during the years ended December 31, 2016.

F-83

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

27. Quarterly Financial Summary (Unaudited): 

The following tables summarize the Company’s quarterly financial results during the years ended December 31, 2018

and 2017:

Sales

Gross profit

Operating income

Net income

Net income attributable to PQ Group Holdings Inc.

Net income per share:

Basic income per share

Diluted income per share

Weighted average shares outstanding:

Basic

Diluted

Sales

Gross profit

Operating income

Net income (loss)
Net income (loss) attributable to PQ Group Holdings

Inc.

Net income (loss) per share:

Basic income (loss) per share

Diluted income (loss) per share
Weighted average shares outstanding:

Basic

Diluted

2018

First 
Quarter

Second 
Quarter

Third 
Quarter

Fourth 
Quarter

$

366,197

$

434,713

$

427,203

$

380,041

78,121

28,189

556

214

108,404

107,500

49,054

16,159

15,782

48,854

14,436

14,185

$

$

0.00

0.00

$

$

0.12

0.12

$

$

0.11

0.11

$

$

87,609

57,459

28,470

28,119

0.21

0.21

133,154,144

133,222,463

133,336,352

133,765,294

133,884,983

134,209,740

134,576,162

134,987,604

2017

First 
Quarter

Second 
Quarter

Third 
Quarter

Fourth 
Quarter(1)

$

332,931

$

389,267

$

391,829

$

358,074

82,712

37,652
(2,315)

107,414

102,559

55,080
(1,670)

46,385
(3,016)

(2,454)

(1,609)

(3,345)

$

$

(0.02) $
(0.02) $

(0.02) $
(0.02) $

(0.03) $
(0.03) $

84,151

26,771

65,564

65,011

0.49

0.49

103,947,888

104,015,815

104,096,837

133,138,140

103,947,888

104,015,815

104,096,837

133,895,646

(1)  

Net income includes a provisional net tax benefit of $64,343 as a result of the rate reduction from the TCJA, which 
was enacted during the quarter ended December 31, 2017. Refer to  Note 19 of these consolidated financial statements 
for further information.

F-84

PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

28. Supplemental Cash Flow Information: 

The following table presents supplemental cash flow information for the Company:

Cash paid during the year for:

Income taxes, net of refunds
Interest(1)

Non-cash investing activity:

Years ended December 31,

2018

2017

2016

$

23,842

$

29,199

$

16,981

105,057

170,131

132,579

Capital expenditures acquired on account but unpaid as of the year end

23,498

18,762

18,161

Non-cash financing activities:

Equity consideration for the Business Combination (Note 7)

Debt assumed in the Business Combination (Note 7)

Debt assumed in the Acquisition (Note 8)

—

—

—

—

—

16,609

910,800

22,911

—

(1)   Excludes capitalized interest and the net interest proceeds on swaps designated as net investment hedges, which are 
included within cash flows from investing activities in the Company’s consolidated statements of cash flows.  

The  following  table  provides  a  reconciliation  of  cash,  cash  equivalents,  and  restricted  cash  reported  within  the 
consolidated  balance  sheets  as  of  December 31,  2018,  2017  and  2016  to  the  total  of  the  same  amounts  shown  in  the 
consolidated statements of cash flows for the years then ended:

Cash and cash equivalents

Restricted cash included in prepaid and other current assets

Total cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash shown in the

consolidated statements of cash flows

29. Subsequent Events:

December 31,

2018
57,854

1,872

$

2017
66,195

1,048

$

2016
70,742

14,335

59,726

$

67,243

$

85,077

$

$

On February 21, 2019, the Company announced that it will change the structure of its internal organization to create 
four independent businesses in order to promote increased visibility to business unit performance, optimize the Company’s 
product portfolio and create efficiencies. The reorganization, which will be effective as of March 1, 2019, will lead to the 
recognition of four operating and reportable segments as follows:

•  Catalyst (including the Zeolyst Joint Venture)

•  Performance Chemicals

•  Performance Materials

•  Refining Services

Beginning with the quarter ending March 31, 2019, the segment results and disclosures will reflect the new segment 
structure for all periods presented. For the purposes of the Company’s goodwill impairment testing, the four new segments 
align with the Company’s existing reporting units at which level goodwill has been assigned and tested (see Note 14 to 
these  consolidated  financial  statements  for  information  regarding  the  Company’s  reporting  units  and  annual  goodwill 
impairment test).

Other than the change to the Company’s segments, the Company has evaluated subsequent events since the balance 

sheet date and determined that there are no additional items to disclose. 

F-85

SCHEDULE I
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES (PARENT)
CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS 
(in thousands) 

Stock compensation expense

Equity in net (income) loss from subsidiaries

Net income (loss)

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

Pension and postretirement benefits

Net (loss) gain from hedging activities

Foreign currency translation

Total other comprehensive income (loss)

Comprehensive income (loss)

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

$

19,464
(77,764)
58,300

$

8,799
(66,402)
57,603

7,029

72,717
(79,746)

(7,958)
(330)
(35,127)
(43,415)
14,885

(101)
(3,590)
61,713

58,022

$

115,625

$

6,865

4,557
(65,781)
(54,359)
(134,105)

$

$

See accompanying notes to condensed financial statements.

F-86

SCHEDULE I
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES (PARENT)
CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS
(in thousands, except share and per share amounts) 

ASSETS

Total current assets

Investment in subsidiaries

Total assets

LIABILITIES

Total current liabilities

Total liabilities

STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

Common stock ($0.01 par); authorized shares 450,000,000; issued shares 135,758,269
and 135,244,379 on December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017, respectively;
outstanding shares 135,592,045 and 135,244,379 on December 31, 2018 and
December 31, 2017, respectively

Preferred stock ($0.01 par); authorized shares 50,000,000; no shares issued or

outstanding on December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017

Additional paid-in capital

Retained earnings (accumulated deficit)

Treasury stock, at cost; shares 166,224 and 0 on December 31, 2018 and 2017,

respectively

Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income

Total PQ Group Holdings Inc. equity

Total liabilities and equity

December 31,
2018

December 31,
2017

$

$

$

— $

—

1,659,560

1,628,000

1,659,560

$

1,628,000

— $

—

—

—

1,358

1,352

—

1,674,703

25,523

(2,920)
(39,104)
1,659,560

—

1,655,114
(32,777)

—

4,311

1,628,000

$

1,659,560

$

1,628,000

See accompanying notes to condensed financial statements.

F-87

SCHEDULE I
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES (PARENT)
CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(in thousands) 

Cash flows from operating activities:

Net income (loss)

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by

operating activities:

Equity in net (income) loss from subsidiaries

Stock compensation expense

Net cash provided by operating activities

Cash flows from investing activities:

Investment in subsidiaries

Net cash used in investing activities

Cash flows from financing activities:

IPO proceeds

IPO costs

Net cash provided by financing activities

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash, cash equivalents and restricted

cash

Net change in cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash

Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at beginning of period

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

$

58,300

$

57,603

$

(79,746)

(77,764)
19,464

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

(66,402)
8,799

—

(480,696)
(480,696)

507,500
(26,804)
480,696

—

—

—

72,717

7,029

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at end of period

$

— $

— $

See accompanying notes to condensed financial statements.

F-88

SCHEDULE I
PQ GROUP HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES (PARENT)
CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
NOTES TO CONDENSED SCHEDULE I

1. Description of PQ Group Holdings Inc. and Subsidiaries

On August 17, 2015, PQ Holdings Inc. (“PQ Holdings”), Eco Services Operations LLC (“Eco Services”), certain 
investment funds affiliated with CCMP Capital Advisors, LLC (now known as CCMP Capital Advisors, LP; “CCMP”), 
and stockholders of PQ Holdings and Eco Services entered into a reorganization and transaction agreement pursuant to 
which the companies consummated a series of transactions to reorganize and combine the businesses of PQ Holdings and 
Eco Services (the “Business Combination”), under a new holding company, PQ Group Holdings Inc. (“PQ Group Holdings” 
or the “Parent Company”). The Business Combination was consummated on May 4, 2016.

In accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”), Eco Services is the 
accounting predecessor to PQ Group Holdings. Certain investment funds affiliated with CCMP held a controlling interest 
position in Eco Services prior to the Business Combination. In addition, certain investment funds affiliated with CCMP 
owned a non-controlling interest in PQ Holdings prior to the Business Combination and the merger with Eco Services 
constituted a change in control under the PQ Holdings credit agreements and bond indenture that were in place at the time 
of the Business Combination. Therefore, Eco Services is deemed to be the accounting acquirer. These Parent Company 
condensed financial statements are the continuation of Eco Services’ business prior to the Business Combination.

PQ Group Holdings is a holding company that conducts substantially all of its business operations through its wholly 
owned subsidiary, PQ Corporation. As specified in certain of PQ Corporation’s debt agreements entered into concurrently 
with the Business Combination, there are restrictions on the ability of PQ Corporation to make payments to its stockholder, 
PQ Group Holdings, on behalf of their equity interests (refer to Note 16 to the PQ Group Holdings consolidated financial 
statements for further information regarding PQ Corporation debt).

2. Basis of Presentation

The accompanying condensed Parent Company financial statements are required in accordance with Rule 4-08(e)
(3) of Regulation S-X. These condensed financial statements have been presented on a “parent-only” basis. Under a parent-
only presentation, the Parent Company’s investment in its consolidated subsidiary is presented under the equity method of 
accounting.  Under  the  equity  method,  the  investment  in  subsidiary  is  stated  at  cost  plus  contributions  and  equity  in 
undistributed  income  (loss)  of  the  subsidiary,  less  distributions  received  since  the  date  of  acquisition.  For  purposes  of 
presenting net income, this presentation assumes that the Parent Company was in existence for the full year ended December 
31, 2016, the year of the Business Combination. These parent-only financial statements should be read in conjunction with 
PQ Group Holdings’ audited consolidated financial statements.

3. Stock-Based Compensation

Refer to Note 22 of the notes to the PQ Group Holdings consolidated financial statements for a description of stock-

based compensation.

4. Common Stock

Refer to Note 21 of the notes to the PQ Group Holdings consolidated financial statements for a description of common 

stock.

F-89

Report of Independent Auditors

To the Management Committee of Zeolyst International:

We have audited the accompanying financial statements of Zeolyst International (the “Partnership”), which comprise the 
balance sheets as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the related statements of operations and accumulated earnings, 
changes in partners’ capital, and cash flows for the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018.  

Management's Responsibility for the Financial Statements

Management is responsible for the preparation and fair presentation of the financial statements in accordance with accounting 
principles generally accepted in the United States of America; this includes the design, implementation, and maintenance 
of  internal  control  relevant  to  the  preparation  and  fair  presentation  of  financial  statements  that  are  free  from  material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.

Auditors’ Responsibility

Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the financial statements based on our audits.  We conducted our audits in 
accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America.  Those standards require that we 
plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free from material 
misstatement.  

An  audit  involves  performing  procedures  to  obtain  audit  evidence  about  the  amounts  and  disclosures  in  the  financial 
statements.  The procedures selected depend on our judgment, including the assessment of the risks of material misstatement 
of the financial statements, whether due to fraud or error.  In making those risk assessments, we consider internal control 
relevant to the Partnership’s preparation and fair presentation of the financial statements in order to design audit procedures 
that  are  appropriate  in  the  circumstances,  but  not  for  the  purpose  of  expressing  an  opinion  on  the  effectiveness  of  the 
Partnership’s  internal  control.    Accordingly,  we  express  no  such  opinion.    An  audit  also  includes  evaluating  the 
appropriateness of accounting policies used and the reasonableness of significant accounting estimates made by management, 
as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements.  We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained 
is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our audit opinion.

Opinion

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the 
Partnership as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years 
in the period ended December 31, 2018 in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States 
of America.

Emphasis of Matter

As discussed within Footnote 13 to the financial statements, the Partnership has significant related party transactions. Our 
opinion is not modified with respect to this matter. 

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania
March 1, 2019 

F-90

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
BALANCE SHEETS 
(in thousands)

December 31,
2018

December 31,
2017

$

39,629

$

13,304

$

$

$

$

26,994

27,267

1,895

92,889

749

189,423

133,810

9,150

906

333,289

11,939

11,921

6,051

29,911

—

29,911

54,930

248,448

303,378

25,302

43,837

2,475

98,438

290

183,646

132,258

6,067

1,125

323,096

9,095

10,022

4,873

23,990

1,436

25,426

54,930

242,740

297,670

323,096

ASSETS

Cash

Trade receivables, net:

Receivables from third parties

Receivables from affiliates

Non-trade receivables from affiliates

Inventories

Other current assets

Total current assets

Property, plant and equipment, net

Intangible assets

Other long-term assets

Total assets

LIABILITIES

Trade accounts payable

Accounts payable to affiliates

Other current liabilities

Total current liabilities

Other long-term liabilities

Total liabilities

Commitments and contingencies (Note 12)

PARTNERS’ CAPITAL

Contributed capital

Accumulated earnings

Net partners’ capital

Total liabilities and partners' capital

$

333,289

$

See accompanying notes to financial statements.

F-91

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND ACCUMULATED EARNINGS 
(in thousands) 

Sales

Related party sales

Total sales

Cost of goods sold

Related party cost of goods sold

Total cost of goods sold

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expenses (SG&A)

Related party SG&A

Operating income

Interest expense, net

Other expense, net

Net income

$

$

2018
209,083

104,291

313,374

88,551

99,653

188,204

125,170

1,476

35,635

88,059

100

2,251

85,708

Accumulated earnings at beginning of year

Dividends paid

Accumulated earnings at end of year

242,740
(80,000)
248,448

$

$

See accompanying notes to financial statements.

Years ended
December 31,

$

2017
178,751

108,798

287,549

75,597

80,992

156,589

130,960

5,777

31,744

93,439

105

830

92,504

238,236
(88,000)
242,740

$

2016
168,875

93,655

262,530

63,591

78,316

141,907

120,623

3,069

34,018

83,536

169

505

82,862

180,374
(25,000)
238,236

F-92

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN PARTNERS’ CAPITAL 
(in thousands) 

PQ Corporation:
Balance, December 31, 2015

Dividends paid

Net income

Balance, December 31, 2016

Dividends paid

Net income

Balance, December 31, 2017

Dividends paid

Net income

Balance, December 31, 2018

CRI Zeolites Inc.:
Balance, December 31, 2015

Dividends paid

Net income

Balance, December 31, 2016

Dividends paid

Net income

Balance, December 31, 2017

Dividends paid

Net income

Balance, December 31, 2018

Total partners' capital at December 31, 2015

Total partners' capital at December 31, 2016

Total partners' capital at December 31, 2017

Total partners' capital at December 31, 2018

Contributed
capital

Accumulated
earnings

Net partners'
capital

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

27,465

$

27,465

$

27,465

$

27,465

27,465

$

$

27,465

$

27,465

$

27,465

54,930

54,930

54,930

54,930

$

$

$

$

$

90,187
(12,500)
41,431

119,118
(44,000)
46,252

121,370
(40,000)
42,854

124,224

90,187
(12,500)
41,431

119,118
(44,000)
46,252

121,370
(40,000)
42,854

124,224

180,374

238,236

242,740

248,448

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

117,652
(12,500)
41,431

146,583
(44,000)
46,252

148,835
(40,000)
42,854

151,689

117,652
(12,500)
41,431

146,583
(44,000)
46,252

148,835
(40,000)
42,854

151,689

235,304

293,166

297,670

303,378

See accompanying notes to financial statements.

F-93

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(in thousands)

Years ended
December 31,

2018

2017

2016

$

85,708

$

92,504

$

82,862

Cash flows from operating activities:

Net income

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by

operating activities:

Depreciation and amortization

Loss on sale or disposal of capital assets

Impairment of cost investment

Net change in returns allowance

Net change in inventory reserve

Working capital changes that provided (used) cash:

Receivables, including affiliates

Inventories

Other current assets

Accounts payable, including affiliates

Other current liabilities

Other long-term liabilities

Other long-term assets

15,954

101

—
(205)
—

15,663

5,549
(459)
(718)
1,178

—

6

Net cash provided by operating activities

122,777

Cash flows from investing activities:

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

Purchase of license

Net cash used in investing activities

Cash flows from financing activities:

Proceeds from line of credit

Payments on line of credit

Payments of cash dividends

Net cash used in financing activities

Net change in cash

Cash at beginning of period

Cash at end of period

Non-cash investing activity:

Capital expenditures acquired on account but unpaid

(12,452)
(4,000)
(16,452)

7,000
(7,000)
(80,000)
(80,000)
26,325

13,304

39,629

5,461

$

$

$

$

See accompanying notes to financial statements.

F-94

14,260

178

3,000

88

867

14,275
(1,119)
1,038
(7,377)
(3,795)
—
(230)
113,689

(9,465)
(6,500)
(15,965)

5,000
(5,000)
(88,000)
(88,000)
9,724

3,580

13,304

3,904

$

$

13,066

26

—
(445)
—

(16,589)
(14,726)
219

4,263
(3,669)
(952)
—

64,055

(23,982)
—
(23,982)

31,142
(46,142)
(25,000)
(40,000)
73

3,507

3,580

3,173

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(in thousands)

1. Organization:

Zeolyst International, a General Partnership (“Partnership”) was formed in 1988 pursuant to a Joint Venture Agreement 
(“the Agreement”) between PQ Corporation (“PQ”) and CRI Zeolites Inc. (“CRI”), a Royal Dutch Shell affiliate (collectively, 
the “Partners”). The percentage interests as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 are as follows:

PQ

CRI

50%

50%

The Partnership was formed pursuant to the Kansas Uniform Partnership Act. The Agreement specifies that the partners 
share equally in capital contributions. The Agreement states that the profits and losses of the Partnership will be allocated 
in accordance with the partners’ interests in the Partnership. The intent of the Partnership is to develop, manufacture, and 
sell zeolites and zeolite-containing catalysts.

The  Partnership  has  significant  transactions  with  its  partners  and  related  affiliates.  Refer  to  the  Related  Party 

Transactions footnote for further disclosure.

2. Partnership Business: 

The Partnership manufactures zeolites and zeolytic catalysts that are used by refiners to capture impurities in the 
processing of petroleum and other chemicals. The filtration ability of zeolites placed into a customer’s chemical process 
generally extends two to three years. As a result, a significant portion of the Partnership’s customer base tends to change 
on an annual basis. A significant percentage of the base materials purchased for the Partnership’s manufacturing process is 
acquired from related parties. In addition, a significant portion of the Partnership’s sales is transacted through Criterion 
Catalyst Company (“Criterion”) which is a subsidiary of CRI. The Partnership compensates Criterion with a 2% sales 
commission on specific sales transactions.

3. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies: 

These financial statements have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. These 
financial statements are accounted for on a historical cost basis and do not reflect the results of any purchase accounting 
adjustments recorded in the Partners’ respective consolidated financial statements.

Cash and Cash Equivalents. Cash and cash equivalents include investments with original terms to maturity of 90 days 

or less from the time of purchase.

Trade Accounts Receivables and Allowance for Doubtful Accounts: Trade accounts receivables are recorded at the 
invoiced amount and do not bear interest. The Partnership maintains allowances for doubtful accounts for estimated losses 
resulting from the inability of its customers to make required payments. Allowances for doubtful accounts are based on 
historical experience and known factors regarding specific customers. If the financial condition of the Partnership’s customers 
were to deteriorate, resulting in an impairment of their ability to make payments, additional allowances would be required. 
Account balances are charged off against the allowance when it is probable the receivable will not be recovered.

Inventories: Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or net realizable value, valued on the first-in, first-out (“FIFO”) 

method. The Partnership establishes reserves for slow-moving and obsolete inventory.

Property, Plant and Equipment: Property, plant, and equipment are carried at cost and include expenditures for new 
facilities and major renewals and betterments. Interest is capitalized on capital projects as applicable. Maintenance, repairs 
and minor renewals are charged to expense as incurred. When assets are sold or otherwise disposed of, the related cost and 
accumulated depreciation are removed from the accounts, and any resulting gain or loss is included in the results of operations. 

Depreciation is generally provided on the straight-line method based on estimated useful lives of the assets, ranging 

up to 33 years for buildings and improvements and 10 years for machinery and equipment.

We perform an impairment review of property, plant and equipment and other long-lived assets when events and 
circumstances indicate that those assets may be impaired by comparing the carrying amount of the assets to their fair value. 

F-95

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(in thousands)

Fair value is determined using quoted market prices where available, or other techniques including discounted cash flows. 
The Partnership’s estimates of future cash flows involve assumptions concerning future operating performance, economic 
conditions, and technological changes that may affect the future useful lives of the assets.

Intangibles and Other Long-term Assets: Other long-term assets primarily include investments, at cost and spare parts. 
In April 2018, the Partnership made a $4,000 strategic investment to buy down royalty obligations related to certain license 
agreements. On May 10, 2017, the Partnership made a $6,500 strategic investment for license of materials-based solutions 
for  catalytic  and  separations  processes. These  investments  are  accounted  for  under  the  cost  method  of  accounting.  In 
December 2017, the Partnership wrote down a $3,000 investment in a technology developer and licensor of materials-based 
solutions for catalytic and separations processes.

Revenue Recognition: In determining the appropriate amount of revenue to be recognized as the Partnership fulfills 
its obligations under its agreements, the Partnership performs the following steps: (i) identification of the contract with the 
customer; (ii) determination of whether the promised goods or services are performance obligations, including whether they 
are distinct in the context of the contract; (iii) measurement of the transaction price; (iv) allocation of the transaction price 
to the performance obligations based on estimated selling prices; and (v) recognition of revenue when (or as) the Partnership 
satisfies each performance obligation.

The  Partnership  identifies  a  contract  when  an  agreement  with  a  customer  creates  legally  enforceable  rights  and 
obligations, which occurs when a contract has been approved by both parties, the parties are committed to perform their 
respective obligations, each party’s rights and payment terms are clearly identified, commercial substance exists and it is 
probable that the Partnership will collect the consideration to which it is entitled.

The Partnership may offer rebates to customers who have reached a specified volume of optional purchases. The 
Partnership recognizes rebates given to customers as a reduction of revenue based on an allocation of the cost of honoring 
rebates earned and claimed to each of the underlying revenue transactions that result in progress by the customer toward 
earning the rebate. Rebates are recognized at the time revenue is recorded. The Partnership measures the rebate obligation 
based on the estimated amount of sales that will result in a rebate at the adjusted sales price per the respective sales agreement.

The Partnership recognizes revenue when all essential elements of the sales order have shipped and both title and risk 
of loss has passed to the customer. Hydrocracking and specialty catalyst orders are typically filled by a number of individual 
shipments, and those shipments may span the end of a fiscal quarter or year. If a portion of the order has not shipped and 
it is essential to the functionality of the customer’s end use, revenue is recognized when the order is completed. A shipment 
is considered essential if each individual shipment has no value to the customer on a stand-alone basis and if the remaining 
shipment is not considered inconsequential and perfunctory.

The Partnership reserves 3% of the Hydrocracking sales due to a clause in the contract that allows customers to return 
up to 5% of the unused products they purchase within 90 days, and based on historical experience. The total sales returns 
reserve as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 amounted to $534 and $737, respectively.

Shipping and Handling Costs: The Partnership classifies costs related to shipping and handling of products shipped 

to customers as cost of goods sold.

Research and Development: Research and development costs of $17,566, $16,011 and $16,033 for the years ended 
December 31,  2018,  2017  and  2016,  respectively,  were  expensed  as  incurred  and  reported  in  selling,  general  and 
administrative expenses in the accompanying statements of operations.

Foreign Exchange Transactions: The functional currency of the Partnership is the U.S. Dollar. The Partnership enters 
into transactions that are denominated in other currencies. Gains and losses on foreign currency transactions are included 
in other (income) / expense, net on the statements of operations. Foreign exchange losses of $1,726, gains of $2,569 and 
losses of $264 were recognized for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

Fair Value Measurements: The Partnership’s financial assets and liabilities are reflected in the financial statements at 
fair value. Fair value is defined as the price at which an asset could be exchanged in a current transaction between willing 
market participants. A liability’s fair value is defined as the amount that would be paid to transfer the liability to a market 
participant,  not  the  amount  that  would  be  paid  to  settle  the  liability  with  a  creditor.  The  Partnership’s  cash  balances 
approximate fair value due to their short-term maturity.

F-96

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(in thousands)

Use of Estimates: The preparation of the Partnership’s financial statements in conformity with generally accepted 
accounting principles requires management to make estimates that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and 
disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue 
and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

4. Recently Issued Accounting Standards: 

In August 2016, the FASB issued guidance which clarifies the classification of certain cash receipts and cash payments 
in the statement of cash flows, including debt prepayment or extinguishment costs and distributions from certain equity 
method investees. The new guidance is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2017 and should be applied 
retrospectively to each period presented. The Partnership adopted the new guidance on January 1, 2018 as required. The 
new guidance did not have a material impact on its financial statements. 

In February 2016, the FASB issued guidance (with subsequent targeted amendments) that modifies the accounting 
for leases. Under the new guidance, a lessee will recognize assets and liabilities for most leases (including those classified 
under existing GAAP as operating leases, which based on current standards are not reflected on the balance sheet), but will 
recognize expenses similar to current lease accounting. The new guidance also requires companies to provide expanded 
disclosures regarding leasing arrangements. The guidance is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2018, 
with early adoption permitted. The new guidance must be adopted using a modified retrospective transition method.  The 
Partnership can choose to apply the new guidance at the beginning of the earliest period presented in the financial statements, 
or at the date of adoption, with a cumulative-effect adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings and no recast of 
prior period results presented within the Partnership’s financial statements. The Partnership has elected to apply the new 
guidance as of the date of adoption.

The Partnership has operating lease agreements for which it expects to recognize right of use asset and corresponding 
liabilities on its balance sheet upon adoption of the new guidance. The Partnership is currently finalizing its lease portfolio 
analysis which will result in an immaterial increase in total assets and liabilities in its consolidated balance sheets. The 
Partnership does not believe that the new guidance will have a material impact on its results of operations or cash flows. 
The new guidance provides practical expedients, which the Partnership is currently finalizing its evaluation.

In May 2014, the FASB issued accounting guidance (with subsequent targeted amendments) that will significantly 
enhance comparability of revenue recognition practices across entities, industries, jurisdictions and capital markets. The 
core principle of the guidance is that revenue recognized from a transaction or event that arises from a contract with a 
customer should reflect the consideration to which an entity expects to be entitled in exchange for goods or services provided. 
To achieve that core principle, the new guidance sets forth a five-step revenue recognition model that will need to be applied 
consistently to all contracts with customers, except those that are within the scope of other topics in the Accounting Standards 
Codification (“ASC”). Also required are enhanced disclosures to help users of financial statements better understand the 
nature, amount, timing and uncertainty of revenues and cash flows from contracts with customers. The enhanced disclosures 
include qualitative and quantitative information about contracts with customers, significant judgments made in applying 
the revenue guidance, and assets recognized related to the costs to obtain or fulfill a contract. The new requirements are 
effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2017. The Partnership evaluated the key aspects of its 
revenue streams for impact under the new guidance and performed a detailed analysis of its customer agreements to quantify 
the changes under the guidance. The Partnership concluded that the guidance did not have a material impact on its existing 
revenue recognition practices upon adoption on January 1, 2018. The Partnership implemented the guidance under the 
modified retrospective transition method of adoption. Comparative information has not been restated and continues to be 
reported under the accounting standards in effect for those periods. The impact of adoption of the new revenue recognition 
guidance was immaterial for the year ended December 31, 2018, and there was no transition adjustment required upon 
adoption. See Note 5 to these financial statements for additional disclosures required by the new guidance.

F-97

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(in thousands)

5. Revenue from Contracts with Customers:

As described in Note 3, the Partnership applies the five-step revenue recognition model to each contract with its 

customers.

Evidence of a contract between the Partnership and its customers may take the form of a master service agreement 
(“MSA”), a MSA in combination with an underlying purchase order, a combination of a pricing quote with an underlying 
purchase order or an individual purchase order received from a customer. The Partnership and certain of its customers enter 
into MSAs that establish the terms, including prices, under which orders to purchase goods may be placed. In cases where 
the MSA contains a distinct order for goods or contains an enforceable minimum quantity to be purchased by the customer, 
the Partnership considers the MSA to be evidence of a contract between the Partnership and its customer as the MSA creates 
enforceable rights and obligations. In cases where the MSA does not contain a distinct order for goods, the Partnership’s 
contract with a customer is the purchase order issued under the MSA. Customers of the Partnership may also negotiate 
orders via pricing quotes, which typically detail product pricing, delivery terms and payment information.  When a customer 
procures goods under this method, the Partnership considers the combination of the pricing quote and the purchase order 
to create enforceable rights and obligations. Absent either a MSA or pricing quote, the Partnership considers an individual 
purchase order to create enforceable rights and obligations.

The Partnership identifies a performance obligation in a contract for each promised good that is separately identifiable 
from other promises in the contract and for which the customer can benefit from the good. The Partnership’s contracts have 
a single performance obligation, which is the promise to transfer individual goods to the customer. Single performance 
obligations are satisfied according to the shipping terms noted within the MSA or purchase order.

As described above, the Partnership’s MSAs with its customers may outline prices for individual products or contract 
provisions. Revenue from product sales are recorded at the sales price, which includes estimates of variable consideration 
for which reserves are established and which result from discounts, returns or other allowances that are offered within 
contracts between the Partnership and its customers.

The Partnership recognizes revenues when performance obligations under the terms of a contract with its customer 
are satisfied, which generally occurs at a point in time by transferring control of a product to the customer. The Partnership 
determines the point in time when a customer obtains control of a product and the Partnership satisfies the performance 
obligation by considering factors including when the Partnership has a right to payment for the product, the customer has 
legal title to the product, the Partnership has transferred possession of the product, the customer has assumed the risks and 
rewards of ownership of the product and the customer has accepted the product. Revenue is measured as the amount of 
consideration the Partnership expects to receive in exchange for transferring goods. The Partnership does not have any 
significant payment terms as payment is received at, or shortly after, the point of sale.

Contract Assets and Liabilities

A contract asset is a right to consideration in exchange for goods that the Partnership has transferred to a customer 
when that right is conditional on something other than the passage of time. A contract liability exists when the Partnership 
receives  consideration  in  advance  of  performance  obligations. The  Partnership  has  not  recorded  any  contract  assets  or 
contract liabilities on its balance sheet as of December 31, 2018.

Practical Expedients and Accounting Policy Elections

The Partnership has elected to use certain practical expedients and has made certain accounting policy elections as 
permitted under the new revenue recognition guidance. Certain of the Partnership’s contracts with customers are based on 
an individual purchase order; thus, the duration of these contracts are for one year or less. The Partnership has made an 
accounting policy election to omit certain disclosures related to remaining performance obligations for contracts which 
have an initial term of one year or less.

F-98

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 

The Partnership uses an output method to recognize revenues related to performance obligations. These performance 
obligations, as described above, are satisfied within a calendar year. As such, the Partnership has elected to utilize the “as-
invoiced” practical expedient, which permits the Partnership to recognize revenue in the amount to which it has a right to 
invoice the customer, provided that the amount corresponds directly with the value provided by the performance obligation 
as completed to date.

When the Partnership performs shipping and handling activities after the transfer of control to the customer (e.g. when 
control transfers prior to delivery), they are considered fulfillment activities as opposed to separate performance obligations, 
and the Partnership recognizes revenue upon the transfer of control to the customer. Accordingly, the costs associated with 
these shipping and handling activities are accrued when the related revenue is recognized under the Partnership’s policy 
election. The Partnership expenses incremental costs of obtaining a contract as incurred if the expected amortization period 
of the asset that the Partnership would have recognized is one year or less. Sales, value added and other taxes the Partnership 
collects concurrent with revenue producing activities are excluded from revenues. 

Disaggregated Revenue

The following table disaggregates the Partnership’s sales by end use for the year ended December 31, 2018:

Fuels and Emission Controls

End Use

Total

$

219,249

Packaging & Engineered Plastics

94,125

Total

$

313,374

6. Accounts Receivable and Allowance for Doubtful Accounts: 

The components of accounts receivable are as follows:

Trade accounts receivable

Allowance

7. Inventories: 

Inventories were classified and valued as follows: 

Finished products and work in process

Raw materials and containers

$

$

$

$

F-99

December 31,

2018

2017

54,795
(534)
54,261

$

$

69,876
(737)
69,139

December 31,

2018

2017

84,794

8,095

92,889

$

$

92,905

5,533

98,438

 
ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(in thousands)

8. Property, Plant and Equipment: 

A summary of property, plant and equipment, at cost, and related accumulated depreciation is as follows:

Land and buildings

Machinery and equipment

Construction in progress

Less: accumulated depreciation

December 31,

2018

2017

$

$

49,609

$

180,415

18,632

248,656
(114,846)
133,810

$

49,508

179,933

6,468

235,909
(103,651)
132,258

Depreciation expense was $16,260, $13,580 and $12,628 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016, 
respectively. Disposal of assets reduced PP&E and accumulated depreciation by $5,166, $7,299, and $314, respectively 
with a $101, $178, and $26 reduction to earnings for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016, respectively.

9. Other Current Liabilities: 

A summary of other current liabilities is as follows:

Accrued royalties and license fees

Accrued commissions

Accrued other

10. Revolver: 

December 31,

2018

2017

4,419

$

1,225

407

6,051

$

2,862

819

1,192

4,873

$

$

On March 2, 2016, the Partnership entered into a five-year revolving line of credit facility of $60,000, which carries 
an initial interest rate of LIBOR. The agreement expires on March 1, 2021. The interest rate on the facility is LIBOR plus 
an interest margin ranging from 0.75% to 1.00% per annum based on the Partnership’s debt to EBITDA ratio. A commitment 
fee is paid to the bank for this agreement. As of December 31, 2018, availability under this agreement was $60,000.

The revolving credit agreement contains certain restrictions and covenants that require the Partnership to maintain a 
minimum partners’ equity, as defined, of $100,000 plus 10% of net income, and a minimum EBITDA of $40,000 on a last 
twelve month basis measured quarterly. The Partnership was in compliance with all covenants during 2018.

Cash payments for interest were approximately $101, $108 and $180 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017

and 2016, respectively.

The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount at which the instrument could be exchanged in a current transaction. 
The carrying amount of the revolving line of credit approximates fair value because it is a short- term liquidity tool to fund 
operations, which is drawn down and paid back with cash generated from operations.

11. Partners’ Contributions: 

In accordance with the Agreement, in the event that cash flow from operations is insufficient to meet the Partnership’s 
requirements,  following  a  majority  vote  by  the  Management  Committee  of  the  Partnership  to  request  capital  from  the 
partners, the partners will provide additional capital to enable the Partnership to meet its obligations. No such contributions 

F-100

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(in thousands)

were made during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017, or 2016 as the Partnership had the ability to finance operations 
through cash flow from operations and borrowings under the Partnership’s revolving line of credit facility.

12. Income Taxes: 

As a partnership, Zeolyst International is not liable for the payment of taxes on income in the U.S. Net income and 
losses are allocated to the respective partners on an annual basis, and it is the partners’ responsibility to pay income taxes, 
if any, thereon according to their respective tax positions. 

13. Commitments and Contingent Liabilities: 

In 1998, the Partnership entered into a ten year tolling agreement (“the Tolling Agreement”) with CRI Belgium, a 
related party, for the manufacture of specialty extruded products. Effective January 2004, the 1998 Tolling Agreement was 
replaced by a new evergreen ten-year tolling agreement with CRI Belgium. Both parties can terminate this agreement without 
cause with twenty-four months’ notice. The Partnership pays CRI Belgium a daily charge rate based on the actual days of 
production. This charge is included in related party cost of goods sold and totaled $23,381, $19,241 and $18,330 for the 
years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. In addition, for certain capital expenditures, that are beneficial 
to the Partnership, the parties will mutually agree on future adjustments to the daily charge rates or propose an alternative 
method of the Partnership’s contribution to those costs. 

During 2007, the Partnership entered into a License Agreement with a third party to obtain exclusive licensing rights 
to use the technology in the manufacturing, using and selling of Powder catalyst and Shaped catalyst. The consideration 
for the licensing rights includes (1) a down payment of $3,200 payable in six annual installments to acquire the product 
license, and (2) royalty payments at a rate of 10% of the Powder and Shaped Net Sale price during the royalty period. The 
$3,200 is payable as follows: $500 was paid at the date of the agreement, $500 at first, second, and third anniversaries of 
the agreement, and $600 at the fourth and fifth anniversary of the agreement. The product license intangible is being amortized 
over the life of the agreement on a straight-line basis, which is estimated to be 15 years. Amortization expense of $213 was 
recognized in 2018, 2017 and 2016. The royalty period of 10 years began in 2013, immediately after the date on which the 
Partnership had cumulatively produced the first 250 metric tons of Powder and Shaped catalyst. If at the end of the Royalty 
Period, the cumulative of running royalties actually paid by the Partnership is less than $3,000, the Partnership will be 
obligated to pay the difference between the $3,000 and the actual cumulative running royalty amount. As of December 31, 
2018 and 2017 there were $2,153 and $2,283, respectively, liabilities recorded related to this agreement. 

During 2013 the Partnership entered into a Sublicense Agreement with a third party to obtain patent and know-how 
licensing rights to make, use, import, and sell the Licensed Process and Products in the Licensed field. The consideration 
for the licensing rights includes a payment of $1,500 payable in three installments. The $1,500 is payable as follows: $500 
will be paid at the date of the first successful sale of commercialized product, or 36 months from execution of the license 
agreement, $500 after sale of 0.5 million pounds of product, or 48 months from execution of the license agreement, and 
$500 after sale of 1.0 million pounds of product, or 60 months from execution of the license agreement. In October 2016, 
the agreement was amended to extend payment terms. The payment of $1,500 is payable as follows: $500 will be paid at 
the date of the first successful sale of commercialized product, or 69 months from execution of the license agreement, $500 
after sale of 0.5 million pounds of product, or 81 months from execution of the license agreement, and $500 after sale of 
1.0 million pounds of product, or 93 months from execution of the license agreement. The product license intangible will 
be amortized prospectively with this change in estimated life. Amortization expense of $12, $36 and $225 was recognized 
in the years ending December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. This agreement was terminated in 2018 with no 
payments due to third party. Amortization credit of $1,448 was recognized in the year ending December 31, 2018.

14. Related Party Transactions: 

Policies and Procedures 

The Partnership maintains certain policies and procedures for the review, approval, and ratification of related party 
transactions. All significant relationships and transactions are separately identified by management if they meet the definition 
of a related party or a related party transaction. Related party transactions include transactions that occurred during the year, 
in which the Partnership was or will be a participant and which any related person had or will have a direct or indirect 

F-101

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(in thousands)

material interest. Due to the nature of the Partnership, material related party transactions are identified on a transaction-
based approach. The types of transactions identified and reviewed include, but are not limited to, sales of products, purchases 
of inventory, tolling costs, sales and marketing costs, research and development, and management-related fees. All related 
party transactions are reviewed, approved and documented by the appropriate level of the Partnership’s management in 
accordance with these policies and procedures.

PQ 

Under the terms of the Agreement, the Partnership leases certain land used in its Kansas City production facilities 
from PQ. This lease, which has been recorded as an operating lease, provided for rental payments of $295, $295, and $280
for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. The rent expense is included in the related party cost 
of goods sold line item in the accompanying statements of operations. The terms of this lease are evergreen as long as the 
Partnership agreement is in place. The Partnership recognized sales to PQ of $645, $2,475, and $1,191 in the years ended 
December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016, respectively. The Partnership purchases certain of its raw materials from PQ and is 
charged for various manufacturing costs incurred at the PQ Kansas City production facility. The amount of these costs 
charged to the Partnership during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016 were $16,869, $17,470 and $15,514, 
respectively. These costs are a component of production costs and are included in the related party cost of goods sold line 
item  in  the  accompanying  statements  of  operations  when  the  inventory  is  sold.  Certain  administrative,  marketing, 
engineering, management-related, and research and development services are provided to the Partnership by PQ. During 
the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, the Partnership was charged $12,727, $12,248 and $12,325, respectively, 
for  these  services. These  amounts  are  included  in  the  related  party  selling,  general  and  administrative  line  item  in  the 
accompanying statements of operations. In addition, certain product demonstration costs of $1,768, $2,175 and $2,169 
during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively, were recorded in the related party cost of goods 
sold line of the accompanying statements of operations. 

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the accounts payable to affiliates consisted of $3,047 and $2,594 due to PQ. Included 

in trade accounts receivable at December 31, 2018 and 2017 was $360 and $69, respectively due from PQ. 

On December 18, 2013, PQ and ZI, entered into a real estate tax abatement agreement with the Unified Government 
of Wyandotte County and Kansas City, Kansas that will utilize an Industrial Revenue Bond financing structure to achieve 
a 75% real estate tax abatement on the value of the improvements that will be constructed during the expansion of PQ’s 
and ZI’s facilities at the jointly-operated Kansas City, Kansas plant. In accordance with ASC 210-20-45, the financing 
obligation and the industrial bond receivable have been presented on a net basis. 

CRI and Royal Dutch Shell Affiliates 

Royal Dutch Shell affiliates include CRI, Criterion, Shell Development Company, Shell Research and Technology 
Center-Amsterdam, CRI Center Marketing Asia Pacific, Shell International Oil Products, CRI Belgium and CRI Technology 
Services. As described in Note 2, a significant portion of the Partnership’s sales are transacted through Criterion. During 
the  years  ended  December 31,  2018,  2017  and  2016  the  Partnership  recognized  sales  transacted  through  Criterion  of 
$103,646, $106,325 and $92,463, respectively. The Partnership purchases certain of its raw materials and is charged for 
tolling, customer distribution and packaging costs incurred by Criterion. The amount of these costs charged to the Partnership 
during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016 were $31,383, $23,965 and $22,364, respectively. These costs 
are a component of production costs and are included in the related party cost of goods sold line item in the accompanying 
statements of operations when the inventory is sold. Certain engineering, management-related, broker-related, and research 
and development services are provided to the Partnership by CRI and Royal Dutch Shell affiliates. During the years ended 
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, the Partnership was charged $22,908, $19,496 and $21,694, respectively, for these 
services. These amounts are included in the related party selling, general and administrative line item in the accompanying 
statements of operations. 

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the accounts payable to affiliates balance consisted of $8,873 and $7,428, respectively, 
due to CRI and Shell affiliates. Included in trade accounts receivable at December 31, 2018 and 2017 was $26,907 and 
$43,768, respectively, of receivables related to sales transacted through Criterion, as described above. 

F-102

ZEOLYST INTERNATIONAL
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
(in thousands)

Zeolyst C.V. 

Zeolyst C.V. is a limited partnership formed in 1993 pursuant to a joint venture agreement between PQ Zeolites B.V. 
and CRI for the purpose of the production of Zeolite powders. The Partnership entered into an agreement with Zeolyst C.V. 
to purchase Zeolite powders manufactured by Zeolyst C.V. Under the terms of the agreement, products manufactured by 
Zeolyst C.V. are supplied solely to the Partnership. The Partnership has performed a qualitative and quantitative analysis 
and concluded that for Zeolyst C.V. for which it holds a variable interest but will not absorb a majority of the expected 
losses or residual returns, the Partnership is not the primary beneficiary and therefore, this VIE was not consolidated in the 
Partnership’s consolidated financial statements. The Partnership has no unfunded commitments or guarantees as a result of 
its involvement with Zeolyst C.V. The total carrying value of assets and liabilities for Zeolyst C.V was $125,412 and $9,636
as of December 31, 2018 and was $120,866 and $11,986 as of December 31, 2017, respectively. The Partnership currently 
does not have any exposure to any losses by Zeolyst C.V. The Partnership has purchased $49,338, $37,087 and $37,989
through the sales agreement during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. These costs are a 
component of production costs and are included in the related party cost of goods sold line item in the accompanying 
statements of operations when the inventory is sold. 

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the accounts receivable from affiliates balance consisted of $1,895 and $2,475, 

respectively, due from Zeolyst C.V. 

15. Subsequent Events: 

The Partnership has evaluated subsequent events from the balance sheet date through March 1, 2019 and determined 

there are no further items to disclose.

F-103

E
C
N
A
N
R
E
V
O
G

E
T
A
R
O
P
R
O
C

BOARD OF DIRECTORS

BELGACEM CHARIAG 
Director, President and  
Chief Executive Officer 

TIMOTHY WALSH 
Lead Independent Director
Chairperson,  
Compensation Committee 

GREG BRENNEMAN 
Director
Chairperson, Nominating and 
Corporate Governance Committee

ROBERT COXON 
Director
Chairperson, Health, Safety and  
Environment Committee
Audit Committee

MARTIN S. CRAIGHEAD 
Director
Nominating and Corporate  
Governance Committee
Health, Safety and  
Environment Committee 

ANDREW CURRIE 
Director
Compensation Committee
Nominating and Corporate  
Governance Committee

JONNY GINNS 
Director
Health, Safety and  
Environment Committee
MARK McFADDEN 
Director

KIMBERLY ROSS 
Director
Chairperson, Audit Committee

ROBERT TOTH 
Director
Health, Safety and  
Environment Committee

KYLE VANN 
Director
Compensation Committee 
Audit Committee

MANAGEMENT TEAM

BELGACEM CHARIAG 
President and  
Chief Executive Officer 

MICHAEL CREWS 
Executive Vice President 
Chief Financial Officer

PAUL FERRALL 
Senior Vice President 
Business Development 
WENDY GRAHAM 
Vice President 
Marketing and Commercial Strategy

SCOTT RANDOLPH 
Vice President 
President — Performance Materials

DR. UFUK SENTURK 
Vice President 
R&D and Technology

DAVID J. TAYLOR 
Vice President 
President — Performance Chemicals

JOSEPH S. KOSCINSKI 
Vice President 
Secretary and General Counsel

RAYMOND KOLBERG 
Vice President  
President — Catalysts

KURT BITTING 
Vice President  
President — Refining Services

WILLIAM J. SICHKO, JR. 
Vice President 
Chief Administration Officer

NAHLA A. AZMY 
Vice President 
Investor Relations and 
Financial Communications

INVESTOR  
INFORMATION
GLOBAL HEADQUARTERS 
300 Lindenwood Drive 
Malvern, PA 19355-1740 
(610) 651-4400 

WEBSITE 
investor.pqcorp.com

INVESTOR RELATIONS 
Nahla A. Azmy 
Vice President,  
Investor Relations and  
Financial Communications 
PQ Corporation 
(610) 651-4561

TRANSFER AGENT 
American Stock Transfer 
and Trust Company, LLC (AST) 
Toll-Free (800) 937-5449 
www.astfinancial.com

STOCK LISTING 
Listed on the New York Stock 
Exchange on September 29, 2017 
Ticker: PQG

SEC FILINGS 
All PQG filings are on 
www.sec.gov

INDEPENDENT AUDITORS 
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP 
Two Commerce Square 
Suite 1800 
2001 Market Street 
Philadelphia, PA 19103-7042 
(267) 330-3000

2019 ANNUAL MEETING 
OF SHAREHOLDERS 
Thursday, May 2, 2019 
10 a.m. EST 
PQ Corporation 
Global Headquarters  
(610) 651-4400

 
Leading the 
way to a 
sustainable 
future

300 Lindenwood Drive
Malvern, PA 19355-1740
(610) 651-4400

www.pqcorp.com